############################ #### anna_1.52_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Installer components to load: # All components of the installer needed to complete the install # will be loaded automatically and are not listed here. Some other # (optional) installer components are shown below. They are probably # not necessary, but may be interesting to some users. # . # Note that if you select a component that requires others, those # components will also be loaded. # d-i anna/choose_modules multiselect # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Installer components to load: # To save memory, only components that are certainly needed for an install # are selected by default. The other installer components are not all necessary # for a basic install, but you may need some of them, especially certain kernel # modules, so look through the list carefully and select the components you # need. # . # Note that if you select a component that requires others, those # components will also be loaded. # d-i anna/choose_modules_lowmem multiselect # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Continue the install without loading kernel modules? # No kernel modules were found. This probably is due to a mismatch between # the kernel used by this version of the installer and the kernel version # available in the archive. # . # If you're installing from a mirror, you can work around this problem by # choosing to install a different version of Debian. The install will probably # fail to work if you continue without kernel modules. # d-i anna/no_kernel_modules boolean false ### Description: for internal use only # Default retriever # d-i anna/retriever string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Install standard modules? # d-i anna/standard_modules boolean true ############################ #### apt-cdrom-setup_0.97_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Scan another CD or DVD? # Your installation CD or DVD has been scanned; its label is: # . # ${LABEL} # . # You now have the option to scan additional CDs or DVDs for use by the # package manager (apt). Normally these should be from the same set as the # installation CD/DVD. If you do not have any additional CDs or DVDs # available, this step can just be skipped. # . # If you wish to scan another CD or DVD, please insert it now. # d-i apt-setup/cdrom/set-first boolean false ### Description: Scan another CD or DVD? # The CD or DVD with the following label has been scanned: # . # ${LABEL} # . # If you wish to scan another CD or DVD, please insert it now. # d-i apt-setup/cdrom/set-next boolean false ### Description: Scan another CD or DVD? # The CD or DVD with the following label has already been scanned: # . # ${LABEL} # . # Please replace it now if you wish to scan another CD or DVD. # d-i apt-setup/cdrom/set-double boolean true ### Description: Scan another CD or DVD? # An attempt to configure apt to install additional packages from the # CD/DVD failed. # . # Please check that the CD/DVD has been inserted correctly. # d-i apt-setup/cdrom/set-failed boolean true ############################ #### apt-mirror-setup_0.97_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Use non-free software? # Some non-free software has been made to work with Debian. Though this # software is not at all a part of Debian, standard Debian tools can be used # to install it. This software has varying licenses which may prevent you # from using, modifying, or sharing it. # . # Please choose whether you want to have it available anyway. # d-i apt-setup/non-free boolean false ### Description: Use contrib software? # Some additional software has been made to work with Debian. Though this # software is free, it depends on non-free software for its operation. This # software is not a part of Debian, but standard Debian tools can be # used to install it. # . # Please choose whether you want this software to be made available to you. # d-i apt-setup/contrib boolean false ### Description: Downloading a file failed: # The installer failed to access the mirror. This may be a problem with your # network, or with the mirror. You can choose to retry the download, select # a different mirror, or ignore the problem and continue without all the # packages from this mirror. # d-i apt-setup/mirror/error select Retry # Possible choices: Retry, Change mirror, Ignore ### Description: Use a network mirror? # A network mirror can be used to supplement the software that is included # on the CD-ROM. This may also make newer versions of software available. # . # ${EXPLANATION} # d-i apt-setup/use_mirror boolean ### Description: Continue without a network mirror? # No network mirror was selected. # . # If you are installing from a netinst CD and choose not to use a mirror, # you will end up with only a very minimal base system. # d-i apt-setup/no_mirror boolean false ############################ #### apt-setup-udeb_0.97_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Downloading local repository key failed: # The installer failed to download the public key used to sign the local # repository at ${MIRROR}: # . # ${URL} # . # This may be a problem with your network, or with the server hosting this # key. You can choose to retry the download, or ignore the problem and # continue without all the packages from this repository. # d-i apt-setup/local/key-error select Retry # Possible choices: Retry, Ignore ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Host to use for security updates # d-i apt-setup/security_host string security.debian.org ### Description: Services to use: # Debian has two services that provide updates to releases: security and # release updates. # . # Security updates help to keep your system secured against attacks. Enabling # this service is strongly recommended. # . # Release updates provide more current versions for software that changes # relatively frequently and where not having the latest version could reduce # the usability of the software. It also provides regression fixes. # This service is only available for stable and oldstable releases. # . # Backported software are adapted from the development version to work with # this release. Although this software has not gone through such complete # testing as that contained in the release, it includes newer versions of # some applications which may provide useful features. Enabling backports # here does not cause any of them to be installed by default; it only # allows you to manually select backports to use. # d-i apt-setup/services-select multiselect security, updates # Possible choices: security updates (from ${SEC_HOST}), release updates, backported software ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Set to the list of architectures for which packages can be installed # without using 'dpkg --force-architecture', in addition to the native # architecture. If empty, only allow installing packages from the native # architecture. # d-i apt-setup/multiarch string ############################ #### base-installer_1.154_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Proceed with installation to unclean target? # The target file system contains files from a past installation. These files # could cause problems with the installation process, and if you proceed, # some of the existing files may be overwritten. # d-i base-installer/use_unclean_target boolean true ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Will configure APT in the target system not to install recommened # packages by default. For experienced users only. # d-i base-installer/install-recommends boolean true ############################ #### bootstrap-base_1.154_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Tool to use to generate boot initrd: # The list shows the available tools. If you are unsure which to select, # you should select the default. If your system fails to boot, you can # retry the installation using the other options. # d-i base-installer/initramfs/generator select # Possible choices: ${GENERATORS} ### Description: Drivers to include in the initrd: # The primary function of an initrd is to allow the kernel to mount the # root file system. It therefore needs to contain all drivers and supporting # programs required to do that. # . # A generic initrd is much larger than a targeted one and may even be so # large that some boot loaders are unable to load it but has the advantage that # it can be used to boot the target system on almost any hardware. With the # smaller targeted initrd there is a very small chance that not all needed # drivers are included. # d-i base-installer/initramfs-tools/driver-policy select # Possible choices: generic: include all available drivers, targeted: only include drivers needed for this system ### Description: Kernel to install: # The list shows the available kernels. Please choose one of them in order # to make the system bootable from the hard drive. # d-i base-installer/kernel/image select # Possible choices: ${KERNELS}, none ### Description: Continue without installing a kernel? # No installable kernel was found in the defined APT sources. # . # You may try to continue without a kernel, and manually install your own # kernel later. This is only recommended for experts, otherwise you will # likely end up with a machine that doesn't boot. # d-i base-installer/kernel/skip-install boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Packages to be included in base installation # d-i base-installer/includes string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Packages to be excluded in base installation # d-i base-installer/excludes string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Force use of a specific debootstrap script # d-i base-installer/debootstrap_script string ### Description: for internal use only # Use an (initramfs) initrd (linux 2.6 and later only) # d-i base-installer/kernel/linux/initrd-2.6 boolean true ### Description: for internal use # Default driver inclusion policy for initramfs-tools # d-i base-installer/kernel/linux/initramfs-tools/driver-policy string most ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # d-i base-installer/kernel/linux/extra-packages string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # d-i base-installer/kernel/linux/extra-packages-2.6 string ### Description: for internal use only # Kernel needs a link in /boot/ (linux only) # d-i base-installer/kernel/linux/link_in_boot boolean false ############################ #### cdebconf-gtk-udeb_0.192_amd64.udeb ############################ ############################ #### cdebconf-newt-udeb_0.192_amd64.udeb ############################ ############################ #### cdebconf-priority_0.192_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### cdebconf-text-udeb_0.192_amd64.udeb ############################ ############################ #### cdebconf-udeb_0.192_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # Default language # d-i debconf/language string en ### Description: Ignore questions with a priority less than: # Packages that use debconf for configuration prioritize the questions they # might ask you. Only questions with a certain priority or higher are # actually shown to you; all less important questions are skipped. # . # You can select the lowest priority of question you want to see: # - 'critical' is for items that will probably break the system # without user intervention. # - 'high' is for items that don't have reasonable defaults. # - 'medium' is for normal items that have reasonable defaults. # - 'low' is for trivial items that have defaults that will work in # the vast majority of cases. # . # For example, this question is of medium priority, and if your priority # were already 'high' or 'critical', you wouldn't see this question. # d-i debconf/priority select high # Possible choices: critical, high, medium, low ### Description: for internal use only # Frontend to use. Change this setting in your script to # switch the cdebconf frontend upon the next GO command. # d-i debconf/frontend string ### Description: for internal use only # Display again already asked questions # d-i debconf/showold boolean false ### Description: for internal use only # Set to true by cdebconf when translations have been permanently dropped # from the database due to DEBCONF_DROP_TRANSLATIONS=1 and cannot be # reloaded. # d-i debconf/translations-dropped boolean false ############################ #### cdebconf-gtk-entropy_0.28_amd64.udeb ############################ ############################ #### cdebconf-newt-entropy_0.28_amd64.udeb ############################ ############################ #### cdebconf-text-entropy_0.28_amd64.udeb ############################ ############################ #### cdebconf-gtk-terminal_0.23_amd64.udeb ############################ ############################ #### cdrom-checker_1.29_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Check CD-ROM integrity? # Warning: this check depends on your hardware and may take some time. # d-i cdrom-checker/start boolean false ### Description: Check the integrity of another CD-ROM? # d-i cdrom-checker/nextcd boolean false ############################ #### cdrom-detect_1.49_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Load CD-ROM drivers from removable media? # No common CD-ROM drive was detected. # . # You may need to load additional CD-ROM drivers from removable media, such as # a driver floppy. If you have such media available now, insert it, and # continue. Otherwise, you will be given the option to manually select # CD-ROM modules. # d-i cdrom-detect/load_media boolean true ### Description: Manually select a CD-ROM module and device? # No common CD-ROM drive was detected. # . # Your CD-ROM drive may be an old Mitsumi or another non-IDE, non-SCSI # CD-ROM drive. In that case you should choose which module to load and # the device to use. If you don't know which module and device are # needed, look for some documentation or try a network installation # instead of a CD-ROM installation. # d-i cdrom-detect/manual_config boolean true ### Description: Retry mounting the CD-ROM? # Your installation CD-ROM couldn't be mounted. This probably means that # the CD-ROM was not in the drive. If so you can insert it and try again. # d-i cdrom-detect/retry boolean true ### Description: Module needed for accessing the CD-ROM: # The automatic detection didn't find a CD-ROM drive. You can try to # load a specific module if you have an unusual CD-ROM drive (that is # neither IDE nor SCSI). # d-i cdrom-detect/cdrom_module select none # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Device file for accessing the CD-ROM: # In order to access your CD-ROM drive, please enter the device file that # should be used. Non-standard CD-ROM drives use non-standard device # files (such as /dev/mcdx). # . # You may switch to the shell on the second terminal (ALT+F2) to check the # available devices in /dev with "ls /dev". You can return to this screen # by pressing ALT+F1. # d-i cdrom-detect/cdrom_device string /dev/cdrom ### Description: for internal use only # File system used on cdrom-detect/cdrom_device. # d-i cdrom-detect/cdrom_fs string iso9660 ### Description: for internal use only # Set if the CD appears to be on a USB stick. # d-i cdrom-detect/hybrid boolean false ### Description: for internal use only # Set if the CD appears to be a live USB-HDD image. # d-i cdrom-detect/usb-hdd boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Set to false to prevent the system from ejecting the CD-ROM before rebooting # d-i cdrom-detect/eject boolean true ### Description: for internal use only # Debian version to install # d-i cdrom/suite select # Possible choices: stable, testing, unstable ### Description: for internal use only # Codename for the selected suite # d-i cdrom/codename string ############################ #### cdrom-retriever_1.35_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Failed to copy file from CD-ROM. Retry? # There was a problem reading data from the CD-ROM. Please make sure it is in # the drive. If retrying does not work, you should check the integrity of # your CD-ROM. # d-i retriever/cdrom/error boolean true ############################ #### load-cdrom_1.35_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### choose-mirror-bin_2.62_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: country code or "manual" (for internal use) # d-i mirror/country string ### Description: Debian version to install: # Debian comes in several flavors. Stable is well-tested and rarely changes. # Unstable is untested and frequently changing. Testing is a middle ground, # that receives many of the new versions from unstable if they are not too # buggy. # . # Only flavors available on the selected mirror are listed. # d-i mirror/suite select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: for internal use only # d-i mirror/codename string ### Description: Go back and try a different mirror? # The specified (default) Debian version (${RELEASE}) is not available from # the selected mirror. It is possible to continue and select a different # release for your installation, but normally you should go back and select # a different mirror that does support the correct version. # d-i mirror/no-default boolean true ### Description: Debian archive mirror country: # The goal is to find a mirror of the Debian archive that is close to you on the network -- be # aware that nearby countries, or even your own, may not be the best choice. # d-i mirror/http/countries select US # Possible choices: enter information manually, Algeria, Argentina, Australia, Austria, Bangladesh, Belarus, Belgium, Brazil, Bulgaria, Canada, Chile, China, Colombia, Costa Rica, Croatia, Czech Republic, Denmark, El Salvador, Estonia, Finland, France, French Polynesia, Georgia, Germany, Greece, Hong Kong, Hungary, Iceland, India, Indonesia, Iran\, Islamic Republic of, Ireland, Israel, Italy, Japan, Kazakhstan, Kenya, Korea\, Republic of, Latvia, Lithuania, Luxembourg, Macedonia\, Republic of, Malaysia, Mexico, Moldova, Netherlands, New Caledonia, New Zealand, Nicaragua, Norway, Philippines, Poland, Portugal, Romania, Russian Federation, Serbia, Singapore, Slovakia, Slovenia, South Africa, Spain, Sweden, Switzerland, Taiwan, Tajikistan, Thailand, Tunisia, Turkey, Ukraine, United Kingdom, United States, Uzbekistan, Vanuatu, Venezuela, Viet Nam, Zimbabwe ### Description: Debian archive mirror: # Please select a Debian archive mirror. You should use a mirror in # your country or region if you do not know which mirror has the best # Internet connection to you. # . # Usually, ftp..debian.org is a good choice. # d-i mirror/http/mirror select # Possible choices: ${mirrors} ### Description: Debian archive mirror hostname: # Please enter the hostname of the mirror from which Debian will be downloaded. # . # An alternate port can be specified using the standard [hostname]:[port] # format. # d-i mirror/http/hostname string mirror ### Description: Debian archive mirror directory: # Please enter the directory in which the mirror of the Debian archive is # located. # d-i mirror/http/directory string /debian/ ### Description: HTTP proxy information (blank for none): # If you need to use a HTTP proxy to access the outside world, enter the # proxy information here. Otherwise, leave this blank. # . # The proxy information should be given in the standard form of # "http://[[user][:pass]@]host[:port]/". # d-i mirror/http/proxy string ### Description: Debian archive mirror country: # The goal is to find a mirror of the Debian archive that is close to you on the network -- be # aware that nearby countries, or even your own, may not be the best choice. # d-i mirror/https/countries select US # Possible choices: enter information manually ### Description: Debian archive mirror hostname: # Please enter the hostname of the mirror from which Debian will be downloaded. # . # An alternate port can be specified using the standard [hostname]:[port] # format. # d-i mirror/ftp/hostname string mirror ### Description: Debian archive mirror directory: # Please enter the directory in which the mirror of the Debian archive is # located. # d-i mirror/ftp/directory string /debian/ ### Description: FTP proxy information (blank for none): # If you need to use a FTP proxy to access the outside world, enter the # proxy information here. Otherwise, leave this blank. # . # The proxy information should be given in the standard form of # "http://[[user][:pass]@]host[:port]/". # d-i mirror/ftp/proxy string ### Description: Protocol for file downloads: # Please select the protocol to be used for downloading files. If unsure, # select "http"; it is less prone to problems involving firewalls. # d-i mirror/protocol select http # Possible choices: ${protocols} ############################ #### clock-setup_0.123_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Is the system clock set to UTC? # System clocks are generally set to Coordinated Universal Time (UTC). # The operating system uses your time zone to convert system time into # local time. This is recommended unless you also use another operating # system that expects the clock to be set to local time. # d-i clock-setup/utc boolean true ### Description: Set the clock using NTP? # The Network Time Protocol (NTP) can be used to set the system's clock. # The installation process works best with a correctly set clock. # d-i clock-setup/ntp boolean true ### Description: NTP server to use: # The default NTP server is almost always a good choice, but if # you prefer to use another NTP server, you can enter it here. # d-i clock-setup/ntp-server string 0.debian.pool.ntp.org ### Description: Wait another 30 seconds for hwclock to set the clock? # Setting the hardware clock is taking longer than expected. The 'hwclock' # program used to set the clock may have problems talking to the hardware clock. # . # Check /var/log/syslog or see virtual console 4 for the details. # . # If you choose to not wait for hwclock to finish setting the clock, this # system's clock may not be set correctly. # d-i clock-setup/hwclock-wait boolean false ### Description: for internal use only # Set to true when rdate actually updates the system clock. # d-i clock-setup/system-time-changed boolean false ############################ #### console-keymaps-acorn_1.12-5_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-acorn/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, Belarusian, Belgian, Brazilian (ABNT2 layout), Brazilian (EUA layout), British English, Bulgarian, Canadian Multilingual, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Dvorak, Estonian, Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hebrew, Hungarian, Icelandic, Italian, Japanese, Kirghiz, Latin American, Latvian, Lithuanian, Macedonian, Norwegian, Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Slovakian, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Swiss French, Swiss German, Turkish (F layout), Turkish (Q layout), Ukrainian ############################ #### console-keymaps-amiga_1.12-5_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-amiga/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, French, German, Italian, Spanish, Swedish, Swiss German ############################ #### console-keymaps-at_1.12-5_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-at/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, Belarusian, Belgian, Brazilian (ABNT2 layout), Brazilian (EUA layout), British English, Bulgarian, Canadian French, Canadian Multilingual, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Dvorak, Estonian, Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hebrew, Hungarian, Icelandic, Italian, Japanese, Kirghiz, Latin American, Latvian, Lithuanian, Macedonian, Norwegian, Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Slovakian, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Swiss French, Swiss German, Thai, Turkish (F layout), Turkish (Q layout), Ukrainian ############################ #### console-keymaps-atari_1.12-5_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-atari/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, British English, French, German, Swedish ############################ #### console-keymaps-dec_1.12-5_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-dec/keymap select # Possible choices: American English ############################ #### console-keymaps-mac_1.12-5_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-mac/keymap select # Possible choices: American English (82 keys), American English (extended kbd), French (alternate), French (extended kbd), German (extended kbd) ############################ #### console-keymaps-sun_1.12-5_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-sun/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, British English, Czech, Finnish, French, German, Japanese (type 4), Japanese (type 5), Norwegian (type 4), Norwegian (type 5), Polish, Russian, Spanish (type 4), Spanish (type 5), Turkish (Q layout) ############################ #### console-keymaps-usb_1.12-5_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Keymap to use for a USB keyboard: # d-i console-keymaps-usb/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, Belgian, British English, Danish, Dvorak, Finnish, French, German, Italian, Italian, Portuguese, Spanish, Swedish, Swiss French, Swiss German ############################ #### console-setup-udeb_1.123_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Keyboard model: # Please select the model of the keyboard of this machine. # d-i keyboard-configuration/model select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Country of origin for the keyboard: # The layout of keyboards varies per country, with some countries # having multiple common layouts. Please select the country of origin # for the keyboard of this computer. # d-i keyboard-configuration/layout select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Keyboard layout: # Please select the layout matching the keyboard for this machine. # d-i keyboard-configuration/variant select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Keep the current keyboard layout in the configuration file? # The current keyboard layout in the configuration file # /etc/default/keyboard is defined as XKBLAYOUT="${XKBLAYOUT}" and # XKBVARIANT="${XKBVARIANT}". # . # Please choose whether you want to keep it. If you choose this option, # no questions about the keyboard layout will be asked and the current # configuration will be preserved. # d-i keyboard-configuration/unsupported_config_layout boolean true ### Description: Keep default keyboard layout (${XKBLAYOUTVARIANT})? # The default value for the keyboard layout is XKBLAYOUT="${XKBLAYOUT}" # and XKBVARIANT="${XKBVARIANT}". This default value is based on the # currently defined language/region and the settings in # /etc/X11/xorg.conf. # . # Please choose whether you want to keep it. If you choose this option, # no questions about the keyboard layout will be asked. # d-i keyboard-configuration/unsupported_layout boolean true ### Description: Keep current keyboard options in the configuration file? # The current keyboard options in the configuration file # /etc/default/keyboard are defined as XKBOPTIONS="${XKBOPTIONS}". # . # If you choose to keep these options, no questions about the keyboard # options will be asked. # d-i keyboard-configuration/unsupported_config_options boolean true ### Description: Keep default keyboard options (${XKBOPTIONS})? # The default value for the options of the keyboard layout is # XKBOPTIONS="${XKBOPTIONS}". It is based on the currently defined # language/region and the settings in /etc/X11/xorg.conf. # . # If you choose to keep it, no questions about the keyboard options # will be asked. # d-i keyboard-configuration/unsupported_options boolean true ### Description: Method for toggling between national and Latin mode: # You will need a way to toggle the keyboard between the national # layout and the standard Latin layout. # . # Right Alt or Caps Lock keys are often chosen for ergonomic reasons # (in the latter case, use the combination Shift+Caps Lock for normal Caps # toggle). Alt+Shift is also a popular combination; it will # however lose its usual behavior in Emacs and other programs # that use it for specific needs. # . # Not all listed keys are present on all keyboards. # d-i keyboard-configuration/toggle select Alt+Shift # Possible choices: Caps Lock, Right Alt (AltGr), Right Control, Right Shift, Right Logo key, Menu key, Alt+Shift, Control+Shift, Control+Alt, Alt+Caps Lock, Left Control+Left Shift, Left Alt, Left Control, Left Shift, Left Logo key, Scroll Lock key, No toggling ### Description: Method for temporarily toggling between national and Latin input: # When the keyboard is in national mode and one wants to type only a few # Latin letters, it might be more appropriate to switch temporarily to # Latin mode. The keyboard remains in that mode as long as the chosen key is # kept pressed. That key may also be used to input national letters when # the keyboard is in Latin mode. # . # You can disable this feature by choosing "No temporary switch". # d-i keyboard-configuration/switch select No temporary switch # Possible choices: No temporary switch, Both Logo keys, Right Alt (AltGr), Right Logo key, Left Alt, Left Logo key ### Description: Key to function as AltGr: # With some keyboard layouts, AltGr is a modifier key used to input # some characters, primarily ones that are unusual for the language of the # keyboard layout, such as foreign currency symbols and accented letters. # These are often printed as an extra symbol on keys. # d-i keyboard-configuration/altgr select Right Alt (AltGr) # Possible choices: The default for the keyboard layout, No AltGr key, Right Alt (AltGr), Right Control, Right Logo key, Menu key, Left Alt, Left Logo key, Keypad Enter key, Both Logo keys, Both Alt keys ### Description: Compose key: # The Compose key (known also as Multi_key) causes the computer to interpret # the next few keystrokes as a combination in order to produce a character # not found on the keyboard. # . # On the text console the Compose key does not work in Unicode mode. If not # in Unicode mode, regardless of what you choose here, you can always also # use the Control+period combination as a Compose key. # d-i keyboard-configuration/compose select No compose key # Possible choices: No compose key, Right Alt (AltGr), Right Control, Right Logo key, Menu key, Left Logo key, Caps Lock ### Description: Use Control+Alt+Backspace to terminate the X server? # By default the combination Control+Alt+Backspace does nothing. If # you want it can be used to terminate the X server. # d-i keyboard-configuration/ctrl_alt_bksp boolean false ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i keyboard-configuration/xkb-keymap select # Possible choices: American English, Albanian, Arabic, Asturian, Bangladesh, Belarusian, Bengali, Belgian, Bosnian, Brazilian, British English, Bulgarian, Bulgarian (phonetic layout), Burmese, Canadian French, Canadian Multilingual, Catalan, Chinese, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Dvorak, Dzongkha, Esperanto, Estonian, Ethiopian, Finnish, French, Georgian, German, Greek, Gujarati, Gurmukhi, Hebrew, Hindi, Hungarian, Icelandic, Irish, Italian, Japanese, Kannada, Kazakh, Khmer, Kirghiz, Korean, Kurdish (F layout), Kurdish (Q layout), Lao, Latin American, Latvian, Lithuanian, Macedonian, Malayalam, Nepali, Northern Sami, Norwegian, Persian, Philippines, Polish, Portuguese, Punjabi, Romanian, Russian, Serbian (Cyrillic), Sindhi, Sinhala, Slovak, Slovenian, Spanish, Swedish, Swiss French, Swiss German, Tajik, Tamil, Telugu, Thai, Tibetan, Turkish (F layout), Turkish (Q layout), Ukrainian, Uyghur, Vietnamese ### Description: for internal use # d-i keyboard-configuration/modelcode string ### Description: for internal use # d-i keyboard-configuration/layoutcode string ### Description: for internal use # d-i keyboard-configuration/variantcode string ### Description: for internal use # d-i keyboard-configuration/optionscode string ### Description: for internal use # d-i keyboard-configuration/store_defaults_in_debconf_db boolean true ############################ #### cpuburn-udeb_1.4a-5_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Are you sure you want to perform a burn test? # This process is designed to heavily load CPU chips. Undercooled, # overclocked or otherwise weak systems may fail causing possibly # permanent damage to electronic components. Use at your own risk. # . # Users should read the cpuburn documentation carefully before use. # d-i cpuburn-udeb/confirm boolean false ### Description: Burn-in duration: # Please select the duration of the CPU stress test. # d-i cpuburn-udeb/duration select 30 # Possible choices: 10m, 30m, 1h, 6h, 24h ############################ #### debian-edu-install-udeb_1.821+deb8u2_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### debian-edu-profile-udeb_1.821+deb8u2_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Profile(s) to apply to this machine: # Profiles determine how the machine can be used out-of-the-box: # . # - Main Server: reserved for the Debian Edu server. It does not # include any GUI (Graphical User Interface). There # should only be one such server on a Debian Edu # network. # - Workstation: for normal machines on the Debian Edu network. # - Roaming Workstation: for single user machines on the Debian Edu # network which some times travel outside the network. # - Thin Client Server: # includes 'Workstation' and requires two network # cards. # - Standalone: for machines meant to be used outside the Debian Edu # network. It includes a GUI and conflicts with other # profiles. # - Minimal: fully integrated into the Debian Edu network but # contains only a basic system without any GUI. # d-i debian-edu-install/profile multiselect # Possible choices: Main Server, Workstation, Roaming Workstation, Thin Client Server, Standalone, Minimal ### Description: Really use the automatic partitioning tool? # This will destroy the partition table on all disks in the machine. # REPEAT: THIS WILL WIPE CLEAN ALL HARD DISKS IN THE MACHINE! # If you have important data that are not backed up, you may want to # stop now in order to do a backup. In that case, you'll have to # restart the installation later. # d-i debian-edu-install/confirm boolean false ### Description: Participate in the package usage survey? # The system may anonymously supply the distribution developers with # statistics about the most used packages on this system. This # information influences decisions such as which packages should go on # the first distribution CD. # . # If you choose to participate, the automatic submission script will # run once every week, sending statistics to the distribution developers. # The collected statistics can be viewed on http://popcon.debian.org/. # . # This choice can be later modified by running "dpkg-reconfigure # popularity-contest". # d-i debian-edu-install/participate-popcon boolean ### Description: Available disk space is too small. Abort the installation? # The available disk space is too small for the selected profiles. # Please choose whether you want to abort the installation or continue # without setting up the recommended partitioning setup # . # If you choose to continue, one single partition will be used # for all system files _and_ user files. Note that this can cause stability # problems after a while. # d-i debian-edu-install/disk-too-small boolean true ### Description: for internal use - disable sync when installing packages # This value can be preseeded to true if tasksel/apt/dpkg should run # within a eatmydata environment disabling file system sync. # d-i debian-edu-install/quick-install boolean true ############################ #### di-utils_1.110_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Extra (custom) boot options to add for target system. # d-i debian-installer/add-kernel-opts string ### Description: Dummy template for preseeding unavailable questions # The answer to this question has been preseeded (${ID}). # If you see this template, you've found a bug in the installer; # please file a report. # d-i debian-installer/dummy string ### Description: ${TITLE} # d-i debian-installer/shell-plugin terminal ############################ #### di-utils-exit-installer_1.110_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### di-utils-reboot_1.110_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Are you sure you want to exit now? # If you have not finished the install, your system may be left in an # unusable state. # d-i di-utils-reboot/really_reboot boolean false ############################ #### di-utils-shell_1.110_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### eject-udeb_2.1.5+deb1+cvs20081104-13.1+deb8u1_amd64.udeb ############################ ############################ #### espeakup-udeb_0.71-19+deb8u1_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use # d-i espeakup/voice string ############################ #### finish-install_2.56_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Don't comment out regular Virtual Consoles during serial console installs # d-i finish-install/keep-consoles boolean false ############################ #### grub-installer_1.117+deb8u1_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Install the GRUB boot loader to the master boot record? # The following other operating systems have been detected on this # computer: ${OS_LIST} # . # If all of your operating systems are listed above, then it should be safe to # install the boot loader to the master boot record of your first hard # drive. When your computer boots, you will be able to choose to load one of # these operating systems or your new system. # d-i grub-installer/with_other_os boolean true ### Description: Install the GRUB boot loader to the master boot record? # It seems that this new installation is the only operating system # on this computer. If so, it should be safe to install the GRUB boot loader # to the master boot record of your first hard drive. # . # Warning: If the installer failed to detect another operating system that # is present on your computer, modifying the master boot record will make # that operating system temporarily unbootable, though GRUB can be manually # configured later to boot it. # d-i grub-installer/only_debian boolean true ### Description: Install the GRUB boot loader to the Serial ATA RAID disk? # Installation of GRUB on Serial ATA RAID is experimental. # . # GRUB is always installed to the master boot record (MBR) of the # Serial ATA RAID disk. It is also assumed that disk is listed as the # first hard disk in the boot order defined in the system's BIOS setup. # . # The GRUB root device is: ${GRUBROOT}. # d-i grub-installer/sataraid boolean true ### Description: Install the GRUB boot loader to the multipath device? # Installation of GRUB on multipath is experimental. # . # GRUB is always installed to the master boot record (MBR) of the multipath # device. It is also assumed that the WWID of this device is selected as boot # device in the system's FibreChannel adapter BIOS. # . # The GRUB root device is: ${GRUBROOT}. # d-i grub-installer/multipath boolean true ### Description: Device for boot loader installation: # You need to make the newly installed system bootable, by installing # the GRUB boot loader on a bootable device. The usual way to do this is to # install GRUB on the master boot record of your first hard drive. If you # prefer, you can install GRUB elsewhere on the drive, or to another drive, # or even to a floppy. # . # The device should be specified as a device in /dev. Below are some # examples: # - "/dev/sda" will install GRUB to the master boot record of your first # hard drive; # - "/dev/sda2" will use the second partition of your first hard drive; # - "/dev/sdc5" will use the first extended partition of your third hard # drive; # - "/dev/fd0" will install GRUB to a floppy. # d-i grub-installer/bootdev string ### Description: Device for boot loader installation: # You need to make the newly installed system bootable, by installing # the GRUB boot loader on a bootable device. The usual way to do this is to # install GRUB on the master boot record of your first hard drive. If you # prefer, you can install GRUB elsewhere on the drive, or to another drive, # or even to a floppy. # d-i grub-installer/choose_bootdev select # Possible choices: Enter device manually, ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: GRUB password: # The GRUB boot loader offers many powerful interactive features, which could # be used to compromise your system if unauthorized users have access to the # machine when it is starting up. To defend against this, you may choose a # password which will be required before editing menu entries or entering the # GRUB command-line interface. By default, any user will still be able to # start any menu entry without entering the password. # . # If you do not wish to set a GRUB password, leave this field blank. # d-i grub-installer/password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same GRUB password again to verify that you have typed it # correctly. # d-i grub-installer/password-again password ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # d-i grub-installer/password-crypted password ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Set this to false to install GRUB Legacy rather than GRUB 2, if possible. # d-i grub-installer/grub2_instead_of_grub_legacy boolean true ### Description: Install GRUB? # GRUB 2 is the next generation of GNU GRUB, the boot loader that is commonly # used on i386/amd64 PCs. It is now also available for ${ARCH}. # . # It has interesting new features but is still experimental software # for this architecture. If you choose to install it, you should be prepared # for breakage, and have an idea on how to recover your system if it # becomes unbootable. You're advised not to try this in production # environments. # d-i grub-installer/grub_not_mature_on_this_platform boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Skip installing grub? # d-i grub-installer/skip boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Make sure that at least one partition is marked as active (bootable). # d-i grub-installer/make_active boolean true ### Description: Force GRUB installation to the EFI removable media path? # It seems that this computer is configured to boot via EFI, but maybe # that configuration will not work for booting from the hard # drive. Some EFI firmware implementations do not meet the EFI # specification (i.e. they are buggy!) and do not support proper # configuration of boot options from system hard drives. # . # A workaround for this problem is to install an extra copy of the EFI # version of the GRUB boot loader to a fallback location, the # "removable media path". Almost all EFI systems, no matter how buggy, # will boot GRUB that way. # . # Warning: If the installer failed to detect another operating system # that is present on your computer that also depends on this fallback, # installing GRUB there will make that operating system temporarily # unbootable. GRUB can be manually configured later to boot it if # necessary. # d-i grub-installer/force-efi-extra-removable boolean false ############################ #### disk-detect_1.108_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Driver needed for your disk drive: # No disk drive was detected. If you know the name of the driver # needed by your disk drive, you can select it from the list. # d-i disk-detect/module_select select continue with no disk drive # Possible choices: continue with no disk drive, ${CHOICES}, none of the above ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Check for the presence of Serial ATA RAID (dmraid) disks? # d-i disk-detect/dmraid/enable boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Check for the presence of multipath devices? # d-i disk-detect/multipath/enable boolean false ############################ #### driver-injection-disk-detect_1.108_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Load drivers from internal virtual driver disk? # Installing on this hardware may require some drivers provided by the # manufacturer to be loaded from the built-in driver injection disk. # d-i driver-injection-disk/load boolean true ############################ #### ethdetect_1.108_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Driver needed by your Ethernet card: # No Ethernet card was detected. If you know the name of the driver # needed by your Ethernet card, you can select it from the list. # d-i ethdetect/module_select select no ethernet card # Possible choices: no ethernet card, ${CHOICES}, none of the above ### Description: Do you intend to use FireWire Ethernet? # No Ethernet card was detected, but a FireWire interface is present. # It's possible, though unlikely, that with the right FireWire hardware # connected to it, this could be your primary Ethernet interface. # d-i ethdetect/use_firewire_ethernet boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Prompt for missing firmware to be provided before the network is up? # d-i ethdetect/prompt_missing_firmware boolean true ############################ #### hw-detect_1.108_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Modules to load: # The following Linux kernel modules were detected as matching your # hardware. If you know some are unnecessary, or cause problems, you can # choose not to load them. If you're unsure, you should leave them all # selected. # d-i hw-detect/select_modules multiselect # Possible choices: ${list} ### Description: Start PC card services? # Please choose whether PC card services should be started in order to allow # the use of PCMCIA cards. # d-i hw-detect/start_pcmcia boolean true ### Description: PCMCIA resource range options: # Some PCMCIA hardware needs special resource configuration options in # order to work, and can cause the computer to freeze otherwise. For # example, some Dell laptops need "exclude port 0x800-0x8ff" to be # specified here. These options will be added to /etc/pcmcia/config.opts. # See the installation manual or the PCMCIA HOWTO for more information. # . # For most hardware, you do not need to specify anything here. # d-i hw-detect/pcmcia_resources string ### Description: Additional parameters for module ${MODULE}: # The module ${MODULE} failed to load. You may need to pass parameters # to the module to make it work; this is common with older hardware. # These parameters are often I/O port and IRQ numbers that vary from machine # to machine and cannot be determined from the hardware. An example string # looks something like "irq=7 io=0x220" # . # If you don't know what to enter, consult your documentation, or leave it # blank to not load the module. # d-i hw-detect/retry_params string ### Description: Load missing drivers from removable media? # A driver for your hardware is not available. You may need # to load drivers from removable media, such as a USB stick, or driver floppy. # . # If you have such media available now, insert it, and continue. # d-i hw-detect/load_media boolean false ### Description: Load missing firmware from removable media? # Some of your hardware needs non-free firmware files to operate. The # firmware can be loaded from removable media, such as a USB stick or # floppy. # . # The missing firmware files are: ${FILES} # . # If you have such media available now, insert it, and continue. # d-i hw-detect/load_firmware boolean true ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # d-i hw-detect/load-ide boolean false ############################ #### save-logs_2.58_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: How should the debug logs be saved or transferred? # Debugging log files for the installer can be saved to floppy, # served up over the web, or saved to a mounted file system. # d-i save-logs/menu select # Possible choices: floppy, web, mounted file system ### Description: Directory in which to save debug logs: # Please make sure the file system you want to save debug logs on is mounted # before you continue. # d-i save-logs/directory string /mnt ############################ #### iso-scan_1.53_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # Suite to install # d-i cdrom/suite select # Possible choices: stable, testing, unstable ### Description: for internal use only # Codename for the selected suite # d-i cdrom/codename string ### Description: Do full disk search for installer ISO image? # The quick scan for installer ISO images, which looks only in common # places, did not find an installer ISO image. It's possible that a # more thorough search will find the ISO image, but it may take a long # time. # d-i iso-scan/ask_second_pass boolean false ### Description: Device or partition to search for installation ISO(s): # You can select a device, manually specify a non-detected device, or # rescan available devices (useful for slow USB devices). # d-i shared/ask_device select all # Possible choices: All detected devices, ${DEVICES_LIST}, Enter device manually ### Description: Device name: # d-i shared/enter_device string ### Description: ISO file to use: # One or multiple ISO files have been detected on the selected device(s). # Please choose which one you want to use, or ask for a more thorough search. # d-i iso-scan/ask_which_iso select # Possible choices: ${ISOS_LIST}, Full search ### Description: Is ISO file ${FILENAME} the correct image for installation? # The ISO file ${FILENAME} on ${DEVICE} (${SUITE}, code ${CODENAME}, # self-described as '${DESCRIPTION}') will be used as the # installation ISO image. # . # If multiple ISO files exist on the same installer drive, # you may select which one you want to use. # d-i iso-scan/ask_right_iso boolean true ############################ #### load-iso_1.53_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### kbd-chooser_1.68_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Type of keyboard: # Please choose the type of keyboard to configure. # d-i console-tools/archs select # Possible choices: ${KBD-ARCHS-L10N} ### Description: For internal use (keyboard chosen by user) # d-i debian-installer/keymap string ### Description: For internal use (Is a serial console in use?) # d-i debian-installer/serial-console boolean false ### Description: For internal use (Is a User Mode Linux console in use?) # d-i debian-installer/uml-console boolean false ############################ #### initrd-kickseed_0.61_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### lilo-installer_1.47_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: LILO installation target: # The LILO program needs to be installed to make your new system # bootable. By installing it onto your disk's Master Boot Record, LILO will # take complete control of the boot process, but if you want to use a # different boot manager, just install LILO on the new Debian partition instead. # . # If unsure, install LILO into the Master Boot Record. # d-i lilo-installer/bootdev select # Possible choices: ${disc}: Master Boot Record, ${part}: new Debian partition, Other choice (Advanced) ### Description: LILO installation target: # The LILO program needs to be installed to make your new system # bootable. You may choose to install it onto a software RAID array or # another device. # d-i lilo-installer/bootdev_raid select # Possible choices: ${disc}: software RAID array, Other choice (Advanced) ### Description: LILO installation target: # Please enter the device name of the partition or disk onto which LILO should # be installed, such as /dev/hda or /dev/sda1. # d-i lilo-installer/manual_bootdev string ### Description: Would you like to make this partition active? # You have chosen to install LILO on a partition that is not the active one. # If this partition is not marked active, then LILO will not be loaded by the # boot loader. This may cause you to be unable to boot into the system # that is being installed. # . # You should make this partition active unless you have another boot loader # that will allow you to access your new Linux installation. # d-i lilo-installer/activate-part boolean true ### Description: LILO installation failed. Continue anyway? # The lilo package failed to install into /target/. Installing LILO # as a boot loader is a required step. The install problem might however be # unrelated to LILO, so continuing the installation may be possible. # d-i lilo-installer/apt-install-failed boolean true ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Skip installing lilo? # d-i lilo-installer/skip boolean false ############################ #### live-installer_49_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Type of installation: # The live system can be installed to hard disk using one of the following # options. # . # If you choose 'normal', the system will be installed as a regular system. # If you choose 'live', the installed system will continue to act as a # live system but it can then be launched directly from the hard disk. # d-i live-installer/mode select normal # Possible choices: normal, live ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # If false, uses base-installer for installation # d-i live-installer/enable boolean true ############################ #### localechooser_2.64_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # d-i debian-installer/language string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # d-i debian-installer/country string ### Description: System locale: # Select the default locale for the installed system. # d-i debian-installer/locale select # Possible choices: ${LOCALELIST} ### Description: for internal use only # d-i debian-installer/consoledisplay string ### Description: Language: # Choose the language to be used for the installation process. The selected # language will also be the default language for the installed system. # d-i localechooser/languagelist select en # Possible choices: ${NAMES_EN} ### Description: Continue the installation in the selected language? # The translation of the installer is incomplete for the selected language. # . # ${TXT-WARN} # . # ${TXT-ABORT} # d-i localechooser/translation/warn-severe boolean false ### Description: Continue the installation in the selected language? # The translation of the installer is not fully complete for the selected # language. # . # ${TXT-WARN} # d-i localechooser/translation/warn-light boolean true ### Description: Country to base default locale settings on: # ${TXT} # d-i localechooser/preferred-locale select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Additional locales: # Based on your previous choices, the default locale currently selected for the # installed system is '${LOCALE}'. # . # If you wish to use a different default or to also have other locales available, # you may choose additional locales to be installed. If you are unsure it is # best to just use the selected default. # d-i localechooser/supported-locales multiselect # Possible choices: ${LOCALELIST} ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/Africa select # Possible choices: Algeria, Angola, Benin, Botswana, Burkina Faso, Burundi, Cameroon, Cape Verde, Central African Republic, Chad, Congo, Congo\, The Democratic Republic of the, Côte d'Ivoire, Djibouti, Egypt, Equatorial Guinea, Eritrea, Ethiopia, Gabon, Gambia, Ghana, Guinea, Guinea-Bissau, Kenya, Lesotho, Liberia, Libya, Malawi, Mali, Mauritania, Morocco, Mozambique, Namibia, Niger, Nigeria, Rwanda, Sao Tome and Principe, Senegal, Sierra Leone, Somalia, South Africa, South Sudan, Sudan, Swaziland, Tanzania\, United Republic of, Togo, Tunisia, Uganda, Western Sahara, Zambia, Zimbabwe ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/Antarctica select # Possible choices: Antarctica ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/Asia select # Possible choices: Afghanistan, Bahrain, Bangladesh, Bhutan, Brunei Darussalam, Cambodia, China, Hong Kong, India, Indonesia, Iran\, Islamic Republic of, Iraq, Israel, Japan, Jordan, Kazakhstan, Korea\, Democratic People's Republic of, Korea\, Republic of, Kuwait, Kyrgyzstan, Lao People's Democratic Republic, Lebanon, Macao, Malaysia, Mongolia, Myanmar, Nepal, Oman, Pakistan, Palestine\, State of, Philippines, Qatar, Saudi Arabia, Singapore, Sri Lanka, Syrian Arab Republic, Taiwan, Tajikistan, Thailand, Timor-Leste, Turkey, Turkmenistan, United Arab Emirates, Uzbekistan, Viet Nam, Yemen ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/Atlantic_Ocean select # Possible choices: Bouvet Island, Falkland Islands (Malvinas), Saint Helena\, Ascension and Tristan da Cunha, South Georgia and the South Sandwich Islands ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/Caribbean select # Possible choices: Anguilla, Antigua and Barbuda, Aruba, Bahamas, Barbados, Bermuda, Bonaire\, Sint Eustatius and Saba, Cayman Islands, Cuba, Dominica, Dominican Republic, Grenada, Guadeloupe, Haiti, Jamaica, Martinique, Montserrat, Puerto Rico, Saint Barthélemy, Saint Kitts and Nevis, Saint Lucia, Saint Martin (French part), Saint Vincent and the Grenadines, Sint Maarten (Dutch part), Trinidad and Tobago, Turks and Caicos Islands, Virgin Islands\, British, Virgin Islands\, U.S. ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/Central_America select # Possible choices: Belize, Costa Rica, El Salvador, Guatemala, Honduras, Nicaragua, Panama ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/Europe select # Possible choices: Albania, Andorra, Armenia, Austria, Azerbaijan, Belarus, Belgium, Bosnia and Herzegovina, Bulgaria, Croatia, Cyprus, Czech Republic, Denmark, Estonia, Faroe Islands, Finland, France, Georgia, Germany, Gibraltar, Greece, Greenland, Guernsey, Holy See (Vatican City State), Hungary, Iceland, Ireland, Isle of Man, Italy, Jersey, Latvia, Liechtenstein, Lithuania, Luxembourg, Macedonia\, Republic of, Malta, Moldova, Monaco, Montenegro, Netherlands, Norway, Poland, Portugal, Romania, Russian Federation, San Marino, Serbia, Slovakia, Slovenia, Spain, Svalbard and Jan Mayen, Sweden, Switzerland, Ukraine, United Kingdom, Åland Islands ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/Indian_Ocean select # Possible choices: British Indian Ocean Territory, Christmas Island, Cocos (Keeling) Islands, Comoros, French Southern Territories, Heard Island and McDonald Islands, Madagascar, Maldives, Mauritius, Mayotte, Réunion, Seychelles ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/North_America select # Possible choices: Canada, Mexico, Saint Pierre and Miquelon, United States ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/Oceania select # Possible choices: American Samoa, Australia, Cook Islands, Fiji, French Polynesia, Guam, Kiribati, Marshall Islands, Micronesia\, Federated States of, Nauru, New Caledonia, New Zealand, Niue, Norfolk Island, Northern Mariana Islands, Palau, Papua New Guinea, Pitcairn, Samoa, Solomon Islands, Tokelau, Tonga, Tuvalu, United States Minor Outlying Islands, Vanuatu, Wallis and Futuna ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/South_America select # Possible choices: Argentina, Bolivia, Brazil, Chile, Colombia, Ecuador, French Guiana, Guyana, Paraguay, Peru, Suriname, Uruguay, Venezuela ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/countrylist/other select # Possible choices: Curaçao ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/continentlist select # Possible choices: Africa, Antarctica, Asia, Atlantic Ocean, Caribbean, Central America, Europe, Indian Ocean, North America, Oceania, South America, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/ar select # Possible choices: South Sudan, Jordan, United Arab Emirates, Bahrain, Algeria, Syrian Arab Republic, Saudi Arabia, Sudan, Iraq, Kuwait, Morocco, India, Yemen, Tunisia, Oman, Qatar, Lebanon, Libya, Egypt, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/bn select # Possible choices: Bangladesh, India, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/bo select # Possible choices: China, India, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/ca select # Possible choices: Andorra, Spain, France, Italy, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/de select # Possible choices: Belgium, Germany, Liechtenstein, Luxembourg, Switzerland, Austria, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/el select # Possible choices: Greece, Cyprus, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/en select # Possible choices: Antigua and Barbuda, Australia, Botswana, Canada, Hong Kong, India, Ireland, New Zealand, Nigeria, Philippines, Singapore, South Africa, United Kingdom, United States, Zambia, Zimbabwe, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/es select # Possible choices: Argentina, Bolivia, Chile, Colombia, Costa Rica, Cuba, Ecuador, El Salvador, Spain, United States, Guatemala, Honduras, Mexico, Nicaragua, Panama, Paraguay, Peru, Puerto Rico, Dominican Republic, Uruguay, Venezuela, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/eu select # Possible choices: Spain, France, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/fr select # Possible choices: Belgium, Canada, France, Luxembourg, Switzerland, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/it select # Possible choices: Italy, Switzerland, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/nl select # Possible choices: Aruba, Belgium, Netherlands, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/pa select # Possible choices: Pakistan, India, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/pt select # Possible choices: Brazil, Portugal, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/pt_BR select # Possible choices: Brazil, Portugal, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/ru select # Possible choices: Russian Federation, Ukraine, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/sq select # Possible choices: Macedonia\, Republic of, Albania, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/sr select # Possible choices: Serbia, Montenegro, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/sv select # Possible choices: Finland, Sweden, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/ta select # Possible choices: India, Sri Lanka, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/tr select # Possible choices: Cyprus, Turkey, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/zh_CN select # Possible choices: China, Taiwan, Singapore, Hong Kong, other ### Description: ${TXT1} # ${TXT2} # . # ${TXT3} # d-i localechooser/shortlist/zh_TW select # Possible choices: China, Singapore, Taiwan, Hong Kong, other ############################ #### lowmem_1.42_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### lowmemcheck_1.42_amd64.udeb ############################ ############################ #### ltsp-client-builder_5.5.4-4_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Set up an LTSP chroot environment? # Please choose whether you want to set up an LTSP chroot environment # on this machine, to act as a thin client server. # d-i ltsp-client-builder/run boolean false ### Description: for internal use: arguments for ltsp-build-client: # this option is meant to be used with debconf preseeding. # d-i ltsp-client-builder/build-client-opts string --mirror file:///media/cdrom --security-mirror none --updates-mirror none --accept-unsigned-packages ### Description: Interface for the thin client network: # Please choose which of this system's multiple spare interfaces should be # used for the thin client. # d-i ltsp-client-builder/dhcp-interface select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: for internal use: Packages for thin client server: # this option is meant to be used with debconf preseeding. # d-i ltsp-client-builder/server_packages string ltsp-server-standalone ### Description: for internal use: Create ltsp image? # this option is meant to be used with debconf preseeding. # d-i ltsp-client-builder/ltsp_update_image boolean false ### Description: for internal use: Configure spare interface? # this option is meant to be used with debconf preseeding. # d-i ltsp-client-builder/configure_network_interface boolean false ### Description: for internal use: Require use of CD-ROM for install? # this option is meant to be used with debconf preseeding. # d-i ltsp-client-builder/use_cdrom boolean true ############################ #### lvmcfg_1.36_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### lvmcfg-utils_1.36_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Activate existing volume groups? # ${COUNT} existing volume groups have been found. Please # indicate whether you want to activate them. # d-i lvmcfg/activevg boolean true ### Description: LVM configuration action: # This is the Logical Volume Manager configuration menu. # d-i lvmcfg/mainmenu select # Possible choices: Modify volume groups (VG), Modify logical volumes (LV), Leave ### Description: Volume groups configuration action: # d-i lvmcfg/vgmenu select # Possible choices: Create volume groups, Delete volume groups, Extend volume groups, Reduce volume groups, Leave ### Description: Logical volumes configuration action: # d-i lvmcfg/lvmenu select # Possible choices: Create logical volumes, Delete logical volumes, Leave ### Description: Devices for the new volume group: # Please select the devices for the new volume group. # . # You can select one or more devices. # d-i lvmcfg/vgcreate_parts multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Volume group name: # Please enter the name you would like to use for the new volume group. # d-i lvmcfg/vgcreate_name string ### Description: Volume group to delete: # Please select the volume group you wish to delete. # d-i lvmcfg/vgdelete_names select # Possible choices: ${GROUPS} ### Description: Really delete the volume group? # Please confirm the ${VG} volume group removal. # d-i lvmcfg/vgdelete_confirm boolean true ### Description: Volume group to extend: # Please select the volume group you wish to extend. # d-i lvmcfg/vgextend_names select # Possible choices: ${GROUPS} ### Description: Devices to add to the volume group: # Please select the devices you wish to add to the volume group. # . # You can select one or more devices. # d-i lvmcfg/vgextend_parts multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Volume group to reduce: # Please select the volume group you wish to reduce. # d-i lvmcfg/vgreduce_names select # Possible choices: ${GROUPS} ### Description: Device to remove from volume group: # Please select the device you wish to remove from the volume group. # d-i lvmcfg/vgreduce_parts select # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Logical volume name: # Please enter the name you would like to use for the new logical volume. # d-i lvmcfg/lvcreate_name string ### Description: Volume group: # Please select the volume group where the new logical volume # should be created. # d-i lvmcfg/lvcreate_vgnames select # Possible choices: ${GROUPS} ### Description: Logical volume size: # Please enter the size of the new logical volume. The size may be # entered in the following formats: 10K (Kilobytes), 10M (Megabytes), # 10G (Gigabytes), 10T (Terabytes). The default unit is Megabytes. # d-i lvmcfg/lvcreate_size string ### Description: Volume group: # Please select the volume group which contains the logical volume to # be deleted. # d-i lvmcfg/lvdelete_vgnames select # Possible choices: ${GROUPS} ### Description: Logical volume: # Please select the logical volume to be deleted on ${VG}. # d-i lvmcfg/lvdelete_lvnames select # Possible choices: ${LVS} ############################ #### main-menu_1.45_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Choose the next step in the install process: # d-i debian-installer/main-menu select ${DEFAULT} # Possible choices: ${MENU} ### Description: Choose an installation step: # This installation step depends on one or more other steps that # have not yet been performed. # d-i debian-installer/missing-provide select ${DEFAULT} # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ############################ #### mdcfg-utils_1.47_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Multidisk configuration actions # This is the Multidisk (MD) and software RAID configuration menu. # . # Please select one of the proposed actions to configure multidisk devices. # d-i mdcfg/mainmenu select # Possible choices: Create MD device, Delete MD device, Finish ### Description: Multidisk device type: # Please choose the type of the multidisk device to be created. # d-i mdcfg/createmain select # Possible choices: RAID0, RAID1, RAID5, RAID6, RAID10, Cancel ### Description: Active devices for the RAID0 multidisk device: # You have chosen to create a RAID0 array. Please choose the active devices # in this array. # d-i mdcfg/raid0devs multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Number of active devices for the RAID${LEVEL} array: # The RAID${LEVEL} array will consist of both active and spare partitions. The active # partitions are those used, while the spare devices will only be used if one or # more of the active devices fail. A minimum of ${MINIMUM} active devices is # required. # . # NOTE: this setting cannot be changed later. # d-i mdcfg/raiddevcount string ### Description: Active devices for the RAID${LEVEL} multidisk device: # You have chosen to create a RAID${LEVEL} array with ${COUNT} active devices. # . # Please choose which partitions are active devices. # You must select exactly ${COUNT} partitions. # d-i mdcfg/raiddevs multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Number of spare devices for the RAID${LEVEL} array: # d-i mdcfg/raidsparecount string ### Description: Spare devices for the RAID${LEVEL} multidisk device: # You have chosen to create a RAID${LEVEL} array with ${COUNT} spare devices. # . # Please choose which partitions will be used as spare devices. # You may choose up to ${COUNT} partitions. If you choose less than ${COUNT} # devices, the remaining partitions will be added to the array as "missing". # You will be able to add them later to the array. # d-i mdcfg/raidsparedevs multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Layout of the RAID10 multidisk device: # The layout must be n, o, or f (arrangement of the copies) followed # by a number (number of copies of each chunk). The number must be # smaller or equal to the number of active devices. # . # The letter is the arrangement of the copies: # n - near copies: Multiple copies of one data block are at similar # offsets in different devices. # f - far copies: Multiple copies have very different offsets # o - offset copies: Rather than the chunks being duplicated within a # stripe, whole stripes are duplicated but are rotated by one # device so duplicate blocks are on different devices. # . # NOTE: this setting cannot be changed later. # d-i mdcfg/raid10layout string ### Description: Multidisk device to be deleted: # Deleting a multidisk device will stop it and clear the superblock of all its # components. # . # Please note this will not immediately allow you to reuse the # partitions or devices in a new multidisk device. The array will however # be unusable after the deletion. # . # If you select a device for deletion, you will get some information about it # and you will be given the option of aborting this operation. # d-i mdcfg/deletemenu select # Possible choices: ${DEVICES}, Cancel ### Description: Really delete this multidisk device? # Please confirm whether you really want to delete the following multidisk # device: # . # Device: ${DEVICE} # Type: ${TYPE} # Component devices: # . # ${DEVICES} # d-i mdcfg/deleteverify boolean false ############################ #### load-media_1.36_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Load drivers from removable media now? # You probably need to load drivers from removable media before continuing # with the installation. If you know that the install will work without extra # drivers, you can skip this step. # . # If you do need to load drivers, insert the appropriate removable media, # such as a driver floppy or USB stick before continuing. # d-i retriever/media/loadnow boolean true ### Description: Unknown removable media. Try to load anyway? # Detected removable media that is not a known driver media. Please make sure # that the correct media is inserted. You can still continue if you have an # unofficial removable media you want to use. # d-i retriever/media/unknown boolean false ### Description: Load drivers from another removable media? # To load additional drivers from another removable media, please insert # the appropriate removable media, such as a driver floppy or USB stick # before continuing. # d-i retriever/media/loadanother boolean true ############################ #### media-retriever_1.36_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### download-installer_1.39_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### net-retriever_1.39_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Downloading a file failed: # The installer failed to download a file from the mirror. This may be a # problem with your network, or with the mirror. You can choose to retry # the download, select a different mirror, or cancel and choose another # installation method. # d-i retriever/net/error select Retry # Possible choices: Retry, Change mirror, Cancel ############################ #### netcfg_1.131+deb8u2_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Set to false to disable netcfg entirely via preseed. # d-i netcfg/enable boolean true ### Description: Auto-configure networking? # Networking can be configured either by entering all the information # manually, or by using DHCP (or a variety of IPv6-specific methods) to # detect network settings automatically. If you choose to use # autoconfiguration and the installer is unable to get a working # configuration from the network, you will be given the opportunity to # configure the network manually. # d-i netcfg/use_autoconfig boolean true ### Description: Domain name: # The domain name is the part of your Internet address to the right of your # host name. It is often something that ends in .com, .net, .edu, or .org. # If you are setting up a home network, you can make something up, but make # sure you use the same domain name on all your computers. # d-i netcfg/get_domain string ### Description: Name server addresses: # The name servers are used to look up host names on the network. # Please enter the IP addresses (not host names) of up to 3 name servers, # separated by spaces. Do not use commas. The first name server in the list # will be the first to be queried. If you don't want to use any name server, # just leave this field blank. # d-i netcfg/get_nameservers string ### Description: Primary network interface: # Your system has multiple network interfaces. Choose the one to use as # the primary network interface during the installation. If possible, the # first connected network interface found has been selected. # d-i netcfg/choose_interface select # Possible choices: ${ifchoices} ### Description: Wireless ESSID for ${iface}: # ${iface} is a wireless network interface. Please enter the name (the ESSID) # of the wireless network you would like ${iface} to use. If you would like # to use any available network, leave this field blank. # d-i netcfg/wireless_essid string ### Description: Wireless ESSID for ${iface}: # Attempting to find an available wireless network failed. # . # ${iface} is a wireless network interface. Please enter the name (the ESSID) # of the wireless network you would like ${iface} to use. To connect to any # available network, leave this field blank. # d-i netcfg/wireless_essid_again string ### Description: Wireless network type for ${iface}: # Choose WEP/Open if the network is open or secured with WEP. # Choose WPA/WPA2 if the network is protected with WPA/WPA2 PSK # (Pre-Shared Key). # d-i netcfg/wireless_security_type select # Possible choices: WEP/Open Network, WPA/WPA2 PSK ### Description: WEP key for wireless device ${iface}: # If applicable, please enter the WEP security key for the wireless # device ${iface}. There are two ways to do this: # . # If your WEP key is in the format 'nnnn-nnnn-nn', 'nn:nn:nn:nn:nn:nn:nn:nn', # or 'nnnnnnnn', where n is a number, just enter it as it is into this field. # . # If your WEP key is in the format of a passphrase, prefix it with 's:' # (without quotes). # . # Of course, if there is no WEP key for your wireless network, leave this # field blank. # d-i netcfg/wireless_wep string ### Description: WPA/WPA2 passphrase for wireless device ${iface}: # Enter the passphrase for WPA/WPA2 PSK authentication. This should be the # passphrase defined for the wireless network you are trying to use. # d-i netcfg/wireless_wpa string ### Description: Hostname: # Please enter the hostname for this system. # . # The hostname is a single word that identifies your system to the network. # If you don't know what your hostname should be, consult your network # administrator. If you are setting up your own home network, you can make # something up here. # d-i netcfg/get_hostname string debian ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Hostname to set for the system; ignores names provided by DHCP or DNS. # d-i netcfg/hostname string ### Description: Type of wireless network: # Wireless networks are either managed or ad-hoc. If you use a real access # point of some sort, your network is Managed. If another computer is your # 'access point', then your network may be Ad-hoc. # d-i netcfg/wireless_adhoc_managed select Infrastructure (Managed) network # Possible choices: Infrastructure (Managed) network, Ad-hoc network (Peer to peer) ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Set to true to force static network configuration # d-i netcfg/disable_autoconfig boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded (deprecated) # Set to true to force static network configuration (deprecated) # d-i netcfg/disable_dhcp boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Specifies what kind of network connection management tool should be # configured post-installation if multiple are available. Automatic # selection is used in this order when not specified: network-manager if # available (on Linux only), ethernet configuration through ifupdown on wired # installation and loopback configuration through ifupdown on wireless # installations. # d-i netcfg/target_network_config select # Possible choices: Network Manager, ifupdown (/etc/network/interfaces), No network configuration ### Description: Waiting time (in seconds) for link detection: # Please enter the maximum time you would like to wait for network link # detection. # d-i netcfg/link_wait_timeout string 3 ### Description: Wireless network: # Select the wireless network to use during the installation process. # d-i netcfg/wireless_show_essids select # Possible choices: ${essid_list} Enter ESSID manually ### Description: DHCP hostname: # You may need to supply a DHCP host name. If you are using # a cable modem, you might need to specify an account number here. # . # Most other users can just leave this blank. # d-i netcfg/dhcp_hostname string ### Description: Network configuration method: # From here you can choose to retry DHCP network autoconfiguration # (which may succeed if your DHCP server takes a long time to respond) # or to configure the network manually. Some DHCP servers require # a DHCP hostname to be sent by the client, so you can also choose # to retry DHCP network autoconfiguration with a hostname that you # provide. # d-i netcfg/dhcp_options select Configure network manually # Possible choices: Retry network autoconfiguration, Retry network autoconfiguration with a DHCP hostname, Configure network manually, ${wifireconf}, Do not configure the network at this time ### Description: Continue without a default route? # The network autoconfiguration was successful. However, no default route # was set: the system does not know how to communicate with hosts on the # Internet. This will make it impossible to continue with the installation # unless you have the first installation CD-ROM, a 'Netinst' CD-ROM, or # packages available on the local network. # . # If you are unsure, you should not continue without a default route: # contact your local network administrator about this problem. # d-i netcfg/no_default_route boolean ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Timeout for trying DHCP # d-i netcfg/dhcp_timeout string 25 ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Timeout for trying DHCPv6 # d-i netcfg/dhcpv6_timeout string 15 ### Description: IP address: # The IP address is unique to your computer and may be: # . # * four numbers separated by periods (IPv4); # * blocks of hexadecimal characters separated by colons (IPv6). # . # You can also optionally append a CIDR netmask (such as "/24"). # . # If you don't know what to use here, consult your network administrator. # d-i netcfg/get_ipaddress string ### Description: Point-to-point address: # The point-to-point address is used to determine the other endpoint of the # point to point network. Consult your network administrator if you do not # know the value. The point-to-point address should be entered as four numbers # separated by periods. # d-i netcfg/get_pointopoint string ### Description: Netmask: # The netmask is used to determine which machines are local to your # network. Consult your network administrator if you do not know the # value. The netmask should be entered as four numbers separated by # periods. # d-i netcfg/get_netmask string ### Description: Gateway: # The gateway is an IP address (four numbers separated by periods) that # indicates the gateway router, also known as the default router. All # traffic that goes outside your LAN (for instance, to the Internet) is # sent through this router. In rare circumstances, you may have no # router; in that case, you can leave this blank. If you don't know # the proper answer to this question, consult your network # administrator. # d-i netcfg/get_gateway string ### Description: Is this information correct? # Currently configured network parameters: # . # interface = ${interface} # ipaddress = ${ipaddress} # netmask = ${netmask} # gateway = ${gateway} # pointopoint = ${pointopoint} # nameservers = ${nameservers} # d-i netcfg/confirm_static boolean true ############################ #### netcfg-static_1.131+deb8u2_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: IP address: # The IP address is unique to your computer and may be: # . # * four numbers separated by periods (IPv4); # * blocks of hexadecimal characters separated by colons (IPv6). # . # You can also optionally append a CIDR netmask (such as "/24"). # . # If you don't know what to use here, consult your network administrator. # d-i netcfg/get_ipaddress string ### Description: Point-to-point address: # The point-to-point address is used to determine the other endpoint of the # point to point network. Consult your network administrator if you do not # know the value. The point-to-point address should be entered as four numbers # separated by periods. # d-i netcfg/get_pointopoint string ### Description: Netmask: # The netmask is used to determine which machines are local to your # network. Consult your network administrator if you do not know the # value. The netmask should be entered as four numbers separated by # periods. # d-i netcfg/get_netmask string ### Description: Gateway: # The gateway is an IP address (four numbers separated by periods) that # indicates the gateway router, also known as the default router. All # traffic that goes outside your LAN (for instance, to the Internet) is # sent through this router. In rare circumstances, you may have no # router; in that case, you can leave this blank. If you don't know # the proper answer to this question, consult your network # administrator. # d-i netcfg/get_gateway string ### Description: Is this information correct? # Currently configured network parameters: # . # interface = ${interface} # ipaddress = ${ipaddress} # netmask = ${netmask} # gateway = ${gateway} # pointopoint = ${pointopoint} # nameservers = ${nameservers} # d-i netcfg/confirm_static boolean true ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Set to false to disable netcfg entirely via preseed. # d-i netcfg/enable boolean true ### Description: Auto-configure networking? # Networking can be configured either by entering all the information # manually, or by using DHCP (or a variety of IPv6-specific methods) to # detect network settings automatically. If you choose to use # autoconfiguration and the installer is unable to get a working # configuration from the network, you will be given the opportunity to # configure the network manually. # d-i netcfg/use_autoconfig boolean true ### Description: Domain name: # The domain name is the part of your Internet address to the right of your # host name. It is often something that ends in .com, .net, .edu, or .org. # If you are setting up a home network, you can make something up, but make # sure you use the same domain name on all your computers. # d-i netcfg/get_domain string ### Description: Name server addresses: # The name servers are used to look up host names on the network. # Please enter the IP addresses (not host names) of up to 3 name servers, # separated by spaces. Do not use commas. The first name server in the list # will be the first to be queried. If you don't want to use any name server, # just leave this field blank. # d-i netcfg/get_nameservers string ### Description: Primary network interface: # Your system has multiple network interfaces. Choose the one to use as # the primary network interface during the installation. If possible, the # first connected network interface found has been selected. # d-i netcfg/choose_interface select # Possible choices: ${ifchoices} ### Description: Wireless ESSID for ${iface}: # ${iface} is a wireless network interface. Please enter the name (the ESSID) # of the wireless network you would like ${iface} to use. If you would like # to use any available network, leave this field blank. # d-i netcfg/wireless_essid string ### Description: Wireless ESSID for ${iface}: # Attempting to find an available wireless network failed. # . # ${iface} is a wireless network interface. Please enter the name (the ESSID) # of the wireless network you would like ${iface} to use. To connect to any # available network, leave this field blank. # d-i netcfg/wireless_essid_again string ### Description: Wireless network type for ${iface}: # Choose WEP/Open if the network is open or secured with WEP. # Choose WPA/WPA2 if the network is protected with WPA/WPA2 PSK # (Pre-Shared Key). # d-i netcfg/wireless_security_type select # Possible choices: WEP/Open Network, WPA/WPA2 PSK ### Description: WEP key for wireless device ${iface}: # If applicable, please enter the WEP security key for the wireless # device ${iface}. There are two ways to do this: # . # If your WEP key is in the format 'nnnn-nnnn-nn', 'nn:nn:nn:nn:nn:nn:nn:nn', # or 'nnnnnnnn', where n is a number, just enter it as it is into this field. # . # If your WEP key is in the format of a passphrase, prefix it with 's:' # (without quotes). # . # Of course, if there is no WEP key for your wireless network, leave this # field blank. # d-i netcfg/wireless_wep string ### Description: WPA/WPA2 passphrase for wireless device ${iface}: # Enter the passphrase for WPA/WPA2 PSK authentication. This should be the # passphrase defined for the wireless network you are trying to use. # d-i netcfg/wireless_wpa string ### Description: Hostname: # Please enter the hostname for this system. # . # The hostname is a single word that identifies your system to the network. # If you don't know what your hostname should be, consult your network # administrator. If you are setting up your own home network, you can make # something up here. # d-i netcfg/get_hostname string debian ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Hostname to set for the system; ignores names provided by DHCP or DNS. # d-i netcfg/hostname string ### Description: Type of wireless network: # Wireless networks are either managed or ad-hoc. If you use a real access # point of some sort, your network is Managed. If another computer is your # 'access point', then your network may be Ad-hoc. # d-i netcfg/wireless_adhoc_managed select Infrastructure (Managed) network # Possible choices: Infrastructure (Managed) network, Ad-hoc network (Peer to peer) ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Set to true to force static network configuration # d-i netcfg/disable_autoconfig boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded (deprecated) # Set to true to force static network configuration (deprecated) # d-i netcfg/disable_dhcp boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Specifies what kind of network connection management tool should be # configured post-installation if multiple are available. Automatic # selection is used in this order when not specified: network-manager if # available (on Linux only), ethernet configuration through ifupdown on wired # installation and loopback configuration through ifupdown on wireless # installations. # d-i netcfg/target_network_config select # Possible choices: Network Manager, ifupdown (/etc/network/interfaces), No network configuration ### Description: Waiting time (in seconds) for link detection: # Please enter the maximum time you would like to wait for network link # detection. # d-i netcfg/link_wait_timeout string 3 ### Description: Wireless network: # Select the wireless network to use during the installation process. # d-i netcfg/wireless_show_essids select # Possible choices: ${essid_list} Enter ESSID manually ############################ #### network-console_1.51_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Network console option: # This is the network console for the Debian installer. From here, you # may start the Debian installer, or execute an interactive shell. # . # To return to this menu, you will need to log in again. # d-i network-console/login select Start menu # Possible choices: Start installer, Start installer (expert mode), Start shell ### Description: Remote installation password: # You need to set a password for remote access to the Debian installer. A # malicious or unqualified user with access to the installer can have # disastrous results, so you should take care to choose a password that # is not easy to guess. It should not be a word found in the dictionary, # or a word that could be easily associated with you, like your middle # name. # . # This password is used only by the Debian installer, and will be # discarded once you finish the installation. # d-i network-console/password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same remote installation password again to verify that # you have typed it correctly. # d-i network-console/password-again password ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # This variable contains the URL that provides a list of authorized # SSH public keys # d-i network-console/authorized_keys_url string ############################ #### nobootloader_1.45_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### partman-auto_126_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Partitioning method: # The installer can guide you through partitioning a disk (using different # standard schemes) or, if you prefer, you can do it manually. With guided # partitioning you will still have a chance later to review and customise # the results. # . # If you choose guided partitioning for an entire disk, you will next be # asked which disk should be used. # d-i partman-auto/init_automatically_partition select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Device to partition, in either devfs or non format # d-i partman-auto/disk string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Method to use for partitioning # d-i partman-auto/method string ### Description: Partitioning method: # If you choose guided partitioning for an entire disk, you will next be # asked which disk should be used. # d-i partman-auto/automatically_partition select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: Partitioning scheme: # Selected for partitioning: # . # ${TARGET} # . # The disk can be partitioned using one of several different schemes. # If you are unsure, choose the first one. # d-i partman-auto/choose_recipe select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # File to load for expert recipe # d-i partman-auto/expert_recipe_file string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Expert recipe content # d-i partman-auto/expert_recipe string ### Description: Select disk to partition: # Note that all data on the disk you select will be erased, but not before # you have confirmed that you really want to make the changes. # d-i partman-auto/select_disk select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ############################ #### partman-auto-crypto_22_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### partman-auto-lvm_56_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Name of the volume group for the new system: # d-i partman-auto-lvm/new_vg_name string ### Description: Name of the volume group for the new system: # The selected volume group name is already in use. Please choose # another name. # d-i partman-auto-lvm/new_vg_name_exists string ### Description: Continue installation without /boot partition? # The recipe you selected does not contain a separate partition for /boot. # This is normally needed to allow you to boot the system when using LVM. # . # You can choose to ignore this warning, but that may result in a failure to # reboot the system after the installation is completed. # d-i partman-auto-lvm/no_boot boolean ############################ #### partman-auto-raid_28_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # RAID recipe for automated install # d-i partman-auto-raid/recipe string ### Description: for internal use only # Initial RAID device used # d-i partman-auto-raid/raidnum string ############################ #### partman-base_184_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: ${TYPE} # ${DESCRIPTION} # d-i partman/exception_handler select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: This is an overview of your currently configured partitions and mount points. Select a partition to modify its settings (file system, mount point, etc.), a free space to create partitions, or a device to initialize its partition table. # d-i partman/choose_partition select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: Continue with the installation? # No partition table changes and no creation of file systems have been planned. # . # If you plan on using already created file systems, be aware that existing # files may prevent the successful installation of the base system. # d-i partman/confirm_nochanges boolean false ### Description: Write the changes to disks? # If you continue, the changes listed below will be written to the disks. # Otherwise, you will be able to make further changes manually. # . # WARNING: This will destroy all data on any partitions you have # removed as well as on the partitions that are going to be formatted. # . # ${ITEMS} # d-i partman/confirm boolean false ### Description: Write the changes to disks? # If you continue, the changes listed below will be written to the disks. # Otherwise, you will be able to make further changes manually. # . # ${ITEMS} # d-i partman/confirm_nooverwrite boolean false ### Description: What to do with this device: # d-i partman/storage_device select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: How to use this free space: # d-i partman/free_space select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: Partition settings: # You are editing partition #${PARTITION} of ${DEVICE}. ${OTHERINFO} ${DESTROYED} # d-i partman/active_partition select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Shell command or commands to run immediately before partitioning # d-i partman/early_command string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Default filesystem used for new partitions # d-i partman/default_filesystem string ext4 ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Adjust the policy for starting and ending alignment of new partitions. You # can generally leave this alone unless optimal alignment causes some kind of # problem. # . # Cylinder alignment was required by very old DOS-era systems, and is not # usually needed nowadays. However, a few buggy BIOSes may try to calculate # cylinder/head/sector addresses for partitions and get confused if # partitions aren't cylinder-aligned. # . # Minimal alignment ensures that new partitions are aligned to physical # blocks on the disk, avoiding performance degradation that may occur with # cylinder alignment particularly on modern disks. # . # Optimal alignment ensures that new partitions are aligned to a suitable # multiple of the physical block size, guaranteeing optimal performance. # d-i partman/alignment select optimal # Possible choices: cylinder, minimal, optimal ############################ #### partman-basicfilesystems_113_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Go back to the menu and correct errors? # The test of the file system with type ${TYPE} in partition #${PARTITION} # of ${DEVICE} found uncorrected errors. # . # If you do not go back to the partitioning menu and correct these errors, # the partition will be used as is. # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/check_failed boolean ### Description: Go back to the menu and correct errors? # The test of the swap space in partition #${PARTITION} of ${DEVICE} found # uncorrected errors. # . # If you do not go back to the partitioning menu and correct these errors, # the partition will be used as is. # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/swap_check_failed boolean ### Description: Do you want to return to the partitioning menu? # You have not selected any partitions for use as swap space. Enabling swap # space is recommended so that the system can make better use of the # available physical memory, and so that it behaves better when physical # memory is scarce. You may experience installation problems if you do not # have enough physical memory. # . # If you do not go back to the partitioning menu and assign a swap partition, # the installation will continue without swap space. # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/no_swap boolean true ### Description: Do you want to return to the partitioning menu? # No mount point is assigned for the ${FILESYSTEM} file system in partition # #${PARTITION} of ${DEVICE}. # . # If you do not go back to the partitioning menu and assign a mount point # from there, this partition will not be used at all. # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/no_mount_point boolean ### Description: Mount point for this partition: # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/mountpoint select # Possible choices: / - the root file system, /boot - static files of the boot loader, /home - user home directories, /tmp - temporary files, /usr - static data, /var - variable data, /srv - data for services provided by this system, /opt - add-on application software packages, /usr/local - local hierarchy, Enter manually, Do not mount it ### Description: Mount point for this partition: # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/fat_mountpoint select # Possible choices: /dos, /windows, Enter manually, Do not mount it ### Description: Mount point for this partition: # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/mountpoint_manual string ### Description: Label for the file system in this partition: # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/choose_label string ### Description: Percentage of the file system blocks reserved for the super-user: # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/specify_reserved string ### Description: Typical usage of this partition: # Please specify how the file system is going to be used, so that # optimal file system parameters can be chosen for that use. # . # standard = standard parameters, # news = one inode per 4KB block, # largefile = one inode per megabyte, # largefile4 = one inode per 4 megabytes. # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/specify_usage select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Mount options: # Mount options can tune the behavior of the file system. # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/mountoptions multiselect # Possible choices: ${descriptions} ### Description: Go back to the menu and correct this problem? # Your boot partition has not been configured with the ext2 # file system. This is needed by your machine in order to boot. Please go # back and use the ext2 file system. # . # If you do not go back to the partitioning menu and correct this error, # the partition will be used as is. This means that you may not be able # to boot from your hard disk. # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/boot_not_ext2 boolean ### Description: Go back to the menu and correct this problem? # Your boot partition is not located on the first partition of your # hard disk. This is needed by your machine in order to boot. Please go # back and use your first partition as a boot partition. # . # If you do not go back to the partitioning menu and correct this error, # the partition will be used as is. This means that you may not be able # to boot from your hard disk. # d-i partman-basicfilesystems/boot_not_first_partition boolean ############################ #### partman-basicmethods_58_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Go back to the menu? # No file system is specified for partition #${PARTITION} of ${DEVICE}. # . # If you do not go back to the partitioning menu and assign a file system # to this partition, it won't be used at all. # d-i partman-basicmethods/method_only boolean ############################ #### partman-btrfs_17_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### partman-crypto_81_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Encryption method for this partition: # Changing the encryption method will set other encryption-related fields # to their default values for the new encryption method. # d-i partman-crypto/crypto_type select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: Encryption for this partition: # d-i partman-crypto/cipher select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Key size for this partition: # d-i partman-crypto/keysize select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: Initialization vector generation algorithm for this partition: # Different algorithms exist to derive the initialization vector # for each sector. This choice influences the encryption security. # Normally, there is no reason to change this from the # recommended default, except for compatibility with older systems. # d-i partman-crypto/ivalgorithm select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: Type of encryption key for this partition: # d-i partman-crypto/keytype select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: Type of encryption key hash for this partition: # The encryption key is derived from the passphrase by applying a # one-way hash function to it. Normally, there is no reason to change # this from the recommended default and doing so in the wrong way # can reduce the encryption strength. # d-i partman-crypto/keyhash select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: Really erase the data on ${DEVICE}? # The data on ${DEVICE} will be overwritten with zeroes. It can no longer be # recovered after this step has completed. This is the last opportunity to # abort the erase. # d-i partman-crypto/plain_warn_erase boolean false ### Description: Really erase the data on ${DEVICE}? # The data on ${DEVICE} will be overwritten with random data. It can no # longer be recovered after this step has completed. This is the last # opportunity to abort the erase. # d-i partman-crypto/crypto_warn_erase boolean false ### Description: Write the changes to disk and configure encrypted volumes? # Before encrypted volumes can be configured, the current # partitioning scheme has to be written to disk. These changes # cannot be undone. # . # After the encrypted volumes have been configured, no additional # changes to the partitions on the disks containing encrypted volumes # are allowed. Please decide if you are satisfied with the current # partitioning scheme for these disks before continuing. # . # ${ITEMS} # d-i partman-crypto/confirm boolean false ### Description: Keep current partition layout and configure encrypted volumes? # After the encrypted volumes have been configured, no additional changes # to the partitions on the disks containing encrypted volumes are # allowed. Please decide if you are satisfied with the current # partitioning scheme for these disks before continuing. # d-i partman-crypto/confirm_nochanges boolean false ### Description: Encryption passphrase: # You need to choose a passphrase to encrypt ${DEVICE}. # . # The overall strength of the encryption depends strongly on this # passphrase, so you should take care to choose a passphrase that is # not easy to guess. It should not be a word or sentence found in # dictionaries, or a phrase that could be easily associated with you. # . # A good passphrase will contain a mixture of letters, numbers and # punctuation. Passphrases are recommended to have a length of 20 or # more characters. # d-i partman-crypto/passphrase password ### Description: Re-enter passphrase to verify: # Please enter the same passphrase again to verify that you have typed it # correctly. # d-i partman-crypto/passphrase-again password ### Description: Use weak passphrase? # You entered a passphrase that consists of less than ${MINIMUM} characters, # which is considered too weak. You should choose a stronger passphrase. # d-i partman-crypto/weak_passphrase boolean false ### Description: The encryption key for ${DEVICE} is now being created. # d-i partman-crypto/entropy entropy ### Description: Are you sure you want to use a random key? # You have chosen a random key type for ${DEVICE} but requested the # partitioner to create a file system on it. # . # Using a random key type means that the partition data is going to # be destroyed upon each reboot. This should only be used for # swap partitions. # d-i partman-crypto/use_random_for_nonswap boolean false ### Description: Proceed to install crypto components despite insufficient memory? # There does not seem to be sufficient memory available to install # additional crypto components. If you choose to go ahead and continue # anyway, the installation process could fail. # d-i partman-crypto/install_udebs_low_mem boolean ### Description: Encryption configuration actions # This menu allows you to configure encrypted volumes. # d-i partman-crypto/mainmenu select # Possible choices: Create encrypted volumes, Finish ### Description: Devices to encrypt: # Please select the devices to be encrypted. # . # You can select one or more devices. # d-i partman-crypto/create/partitions multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ############################ #### partman-efi_67_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Go back to the menu and resume partitioning? # No EFI partition was found. # d-i partman-efi/no_efi boolean ### Description: Force UEFI installation? # This machine's firmware has started the installer in UEFI mode but # it looks like there may be existing operating systems already # installed using "BIOS compatibility mode". If you # continue to install Debian in UEFI mode, it might be difficult to # reboot the machine into any BIOS-mode operating systems later. # . # If you wish to install in UEFI mode and don't care about # keeping the ability to boot one of the existing systems, you have the # option to force that here. If you wish to keep the option to boot an # existing operating system, you should choose NOT to force UEFI # installation here. # d-i partman-efi/non_efi_system boolean ############################ #### partman-ext3_84+deb8u1_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Go back to the menu and correct this problem? # Your boot partition has not been configured with the ext2 or ext3 # file system. This is needed by your machine in order to boot. Please go # back and use either the ext2 or ext3 file system. # . # If you do not go back to the partitioning menu and correct this error, # the partition will be used as is. This means that you may not be able # to boot from your hard disk. # d-i partman-ext3/boot_not_ext2_or_ext3 boolean ### Description: Go back to the menu and correct this problem? # Your boot partition is not located on the first primary partition of your # hard disk. This is needed by your machine in order to boot. Please go # back and use your first primary partition as a boot partition. # . # If you do not go back to the partitioning menu and correct this error, # the partition will be used as is. This means that you may not be able # to boot from your hard disk. # d-i partman/boot_not_first_partition boolean ### Description: Return to the menu to set the bootable flag? # The boot partition has not been marked as a bootable partition, even # though this is required by your machine in order to boot. You should go # back and set the bootable flag for the boot partition. # . # If you don't correct this, the partition will be used as is and it is # likely that the machine cannot boot from its hard disk. # d-i partman-ext3/boot_not_bootable boolean ### Description: Do you want to return to the partitioning menu? # The partition ${PARTITION} assigned to ${MOUNTPOINT} starts at an offset of # ${OFFSET} bytes from the minimum alignment for this disk, which may lead to # very poor performance. # . # Since you are formatting this partition, you should correct this problem # now by realigning the partition, as it will be difficult to change later. # To do this, go back to the main partitioning menu, delete the partition, # and recreate it in the same position with the same settings. This will # cause the partition to start at a point best suited for this disk. # d-i partman-ext3/bad_alignment boolean ############################ #### partman-iscsi_36_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: iSCSI configuration actions # This menu allows you to configure iSCSI volumes. # d-i partman-iscsi/mainmenu select # Possible choices: Log into iSCSI targets, Finish ### Description: iSCSI target portal address: # Enter an IP address to scan for iSCSI targets. To use a port other than the # default of 3260, use "IP:port" notation, for example "1.2.3.4:3261". # d-i partman-iscsi/login/address string ### Description: iSCSI initiator username for ${PORTAL}: # Some iSCSI targets require the initiator (client) to authenticate using a # username and password. If that is the case for this target, enter the # username here. Otherwise, leave this blank. # d-i partman-iscsi/login/username string ### Description: iSCSI initiator password for ${PORTAL}: # Enter the initiator password needed to authenticate to this iSCSI target. # d-i partman-iscsi/login/password password ### Description: iSCSI target username for ${PORTAL}: # In some environments, the iSCSI target needs to authenticate to the # initiator as well as the other way round. If that is the case here, enter # the incoming username which the target is expected to supply. Otherwise, # leave this blank. # d-i partman-iscsi/login/incoming_username string ### Description: iSCSI target password for ${PORTAL}: # Enter the incoming password which the iSCSI target is expected to supply. # d-i partman-iscsi/login/incoming_password password ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # If true, automatically log into all discovered targets. # d-i partman-iscsi/login/all_targets boolean false ### Description: iSCSI targets on ${PORTAL}: # Select the iSCSI targets you wish to use. # d-i partman-iscsi/login/targets multiselect # Possible choices: ${TARGETS} ############################ #### partman-jfs_45_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Use unrecommended JFS root file system? # Your root file system is a JFS file system. This can cause problems # with the boot loader used by default by this installer. # . # You should use a small /boot partition with another file system, such as ext3. # d-i partman-jfs/jfs_root boolean false ### Description: Use unrecommended JFS /boot file system? # You have mounted a JFS file system as /boot. This is likely to cause # problems with the boot loader used by default by this installer. # . # You should use another file system, such as ext3, for the /boot partition. # d-i partman-jfs/jfs_boot boolean false ############################ #### partman-lvm_107_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Write the changes to disks and configure LVM? # Before the Logical Volume Manager can be configured, the current # partitioning scheme has to be written to disk. These changes cannot # be undone. # . # After the Logical Volume Manager is configured, no additional changes # to the partitioning scheme of disks containing physical volumes are # allowed during the installation. Please decide if you are satisfied # with the current partitioning scheme before continuing. # . # ${ITEMS} # d-i partman-lvm/confirm boolean false ### Description: Keep current partition layout and configure LVM? # After the Logical Volume Manager is configured, no additional changes # to the partitions in the disks containing physical volumes are # allowed. Please decide if you are satisfied with the current # partitioning scheme in these disks before continuing. # d-i partman-lvm/confirm_nochanges boolean false ### Description: LVM configuration action: # Summary of current LVM configuration: # . # Free Physical Volumes: ${FREE_PVS} # Used Physical Volumes: ${USED_PVS} # Volume Groups: ${VGS} # Logical Volumes: ${LVS} # d-i partman-lvm/mainmenu select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES_L10N} ### Description: Devices for the new volume group: # Please select the devices for the new volume group. # . # You can select one or more devices. # d-i partman-lvm/vgcreate_parts multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Volume group name: # Please enter the name you would like to use for the new volume group. # d-i partman-lvm/vgcreate_name string ### Description: Volume group to delete: # Please select the volume group you wish to delete. # d-i partman-lvm/vgdelete_names select # Possible choices: ${GROUPS} ### Description: Really delete the volume group? # Please confirm the ${VG} volume group removal. # d-i partman-lvm/vgdelete_confirm boolean true ### Description: Volume group to extend: # Please select the volume group you wish to extend. # d-i partman-lvm/vgextend_names select # Possible choices: ${GROUPS} ### Description: Devices to add to the volume group: # Please select the devices you wish to add to the volume group. # . # You can select one or more devices. # d-i partman-lvm/vgextend_parts multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Volume group to reduce: # Please select the volume group you wish to reduce. # d-i partman-lvm/vgreduce_names select # Possible choices: ${GROUPS} ### Description: Devices to remove from the volume group: # Please select the devices you wish to remove from the volume group. # . # You can select one or more devices. # d-i partman-lvm/vgreduce_parts multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Logical volume name: # Please enter the name you would like to use for the new logical volume. # d-i partman-lvm/lvcreate_name string ### Description: Volume group: # Please select the volume group where the new logical volume # should be created. # d-i partman-lvm/lvcreate_vgnames select # Possible choices: ${GROUPS} ### Description: Logical volume size: # Please enter the size of the new logical volume. The size may be # entered in the following formats: 10K (Kilobytes), 10M (Megabytes), # 10G (Gigabytes), 10T (Terabytes). The default unit is Megabytes. # d-i partman-lvm/lvcreate_size string ### Description: Logical volume: # Please select the logical volume to delete. # d-i partman-lvm/lvdelete_lvnames select # Possible choices: ${LVS} ### Description: Remove existing logical volume data? # The selected device already contains the following LVM logical volumes, # volume groups and physical volumes which are about to be removed: # . # Logical volume(s) to be removed: ${LVTARGETS} # . # Volume group(s) to be removed: ${VGTARGETS} # . # Physical volume(s) to be removed: ${PVTARGETS} # . # Note that this will also permanently erase any data currently on the # logical volumes. # d-i partman-lvm/device_remove_lvm boolean false ############################ #### partman-md_74_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Software RAID configuration actions # This is the software RAID (or MD, "multiple device") configuration menu. # . # Please select one of the proposed actions to configure software RAID. # d-i partman-md/mainmenu select # Possible choices: Create MD device, Delete MD device, Finish ### Description: Software RAID device type: # Please choose the type of the software RAID device to be created. # d-i partman-md/createmain select # Possible choices: RAID0, RAID1, RAID5, RAID6, RAID10 ### Description: Active devices for the RAID0 array: # You have chosen to create a RAID0 array. Please choose the active devices # in this array. # d-i partman-md/raid0devs multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Number of active devices for the RAID${LEVEL} array: # The RAID${LEVEL} array will consist of both active and spare devices. The # active devices are those used, while the spare devices will only be used if # one or more of the active devices fail. A minimum of ${MINIMUM} active # devices is required. # . # NOTE: this setting cannot be changed later. # d-i partman-md/raiddevcount string ### Description: Active devices for the RAID${LEVEL} array: # You have chosen to create a RAID${LEVEL} array with ${COUNT} active devices. # . # Please choose which partitions are active devices. # You must select exactly ${COUNT} partitions. # d-i partman-md/raiddevs multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Number of spare devices for the RAID${LEVEL} array: # d-i partman-md/raidsparecount string ### Description: Spare devices for the RAID${LEVEL} array: # You have chosen to create a RAID${LEVEL} array with ${COUNT} spare devices. # . # Please choose which partitions will be used as spare devices. # You may choose up to ${COUNT} partitions. If you choose less than ${COUNT} # devices, the remaining partitions will be added to the array as "missing". # You will be able to add them to the array later. # d-i partman-md/raidsparedevs multiselect # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Layout of the RAID10 array: # The layout must be n, o, or f (arrangement of the copies) followed # by a number (number of copies of each chunk). The number must be # smaller or equal to the number of active devices. # . # The letter is the arrangement of the copies: # n - near copies: Multiple copies of one data block are at similar # offsets in different devices. # f - far copies: Multiple copies have very different offsets # o - offset copies: Rather than the chunks being duplicated within a # stripe, whole stripes are duplicated but are rotated by one # device so duplicate blocks are on different devices. # . # NOTE: this setting cannot be changed later. # d-i partman-md/raid10layout string ### Description: Software RAID device to be deleted: # Deleting a software RAID device will stop it and clear the superblock of # all its components. # . # Please note this will not immediately allow you to reuse the partitions or # devices in a new software RAID device. The array will however be unusable # after the deletion. # . # If you select a device for deletion, you will get some information about it # and you will be given the option of aborting this operation. # d-i partman-md/deletemenu select # Possible choices: ${DEVICES} ### Description: Really delete this software RAID device? # Please confirm whether you really want to delete the following software # RAID device: # . # Device: ${DEVICE} # Type: ${TYPE} # Component devices: # . # ${DEVICES} # d-i partman-md/deleteverify boolean false ### Description: Write the changes to the storage devices and configure RAID? # Before RAID can be configured, the changes # have to be written to the storage devices. These changes cannot be # undone. # . # When RAID is configured, no additional changes # to the partitions in the disks containing physical volumes are # allowed. Please convince yourself that you are satisfied with the # current partitioning scheme in these disks. # . # ${ITEMS} # d-i partman-md/confirm boolean false ### Description: Keep current partition layout and configure RAID? # When RAID is configured, no additional changes # to the partitions in the disks containing physical volumes are # allowed. Please convince yourself that you are satisfied with the # current partitioning scheme in these disks. # d-i partman-md/confirm_nochanges boolean false ### Description: Remove existing software RAID partitions? # The selected device contains partitions used for software RAID devices. # The following devices and partitions are about to be removed: # . # Software RAID devices about to be removed: ${REMOVED_DEVICES} # . # Partitions used by these RAID devices: ${REMOVED_PARTITIONS} # . # Note that this will also permanently erase any data currently on the # software RAID devices. # d-i partman-md/device_remove_md boolean false ############################ #### partman-nbd_0.24_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: NBD configuration action: # There are currently ${NUMBER} devices connected. # d-i partman-nbd/mainmenu select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Network Block Device server: # Please enter the host name or the IP address of the system running # nbd-server. # d-i partman-nbd/server string ### Description: Network Block Device port or name: # Please enter the port on which the nbd-server is running. In case the entered # data contains a non-digit character, a name-based export will be assumed. # d-i partman-nbd/port string ### Description: Network Block Device device node: # Please select the NBD device node that you wish to connect or # disconnect. # d-i partman-nbd/device select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ############################ #### partman-partitioning_108_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Write previous changes to disk and continue? # Before you can select a new partition size, any previous changes have to be # written to disk. # . # You cannot undo this operation. # . # Please note that the resize operation may take a long time. # d-i partman-partitioning/confirm_resize boolean ### Description: New partition size: # The minimum size for this partition is ${MINSIZE} (or ${PERCENT}) and its # maximum size is ${MAXSIZE}. # . # Hint: "max" can be used as a shortcut to specify the maximum size, or # enter a percentage (e.g. "20%") to use that percentage of the maximum size. # d-i partman-partitioning/new_size string some number ### Description: New partition size: # The maximum size for this partition is ${MAXSIZE}. # . # Hint: "max" can be used as a shortcut to specify the maximum size, or # enter a percentage (e.g. "20%") to use that percentage of the maximum size. # d-i partman-partitioning/new_partition_size string some number ### Description: Location for the new partition: # Please choose whether you want the new partition to be created at the # beginning or at the end of the available space. # d-i partman-partitioning/new_partition_place select # Possible choices: Beginning, End ### Description: Type for the new partition: # d-i partman-partitioning/new_partition_type select # Possible choices: Primary, Logical ### Description: Flags for the new partition: # d-i partman-partitioning/set_flags multiselect # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Partition name: # d-i partman-partitioning/set_name string ### Description: Continue with partitioning? # This partitioner doesn't have information about the default type of # the partition tables on your architecture. Please send an e-mail # message to debian-boot@lists.debian.org with information. # . # Please note that if the type of the partition table is unsupported by # libparted, then this partitioner will not work properly. # d-i partman-partitioning/unknown_label boolean true ### Description: Continue with partitioning? # This partitioner is based on the library libparted which doesn't have # support for the partition tables used on your architecture. It is # strongly recommended that you exit this partitioner. # . # If you can, please help to add support for your partition table type # to libparted. # d-i partman-partitioning/unsupported_label boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # You may preseed this template to override the partitioner's # platform-specific default choice of disk label. For example, on x86 # architectures it may be useful to set this to "gpt" to cause new partition # tables to be created using GPT. # d-i partman-partitioning/default_label string ### Description: Partition table type: # Select the type of partition table to use. # d-i partman-partitioning/choose_label select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Create new empty partition table on this device? # You have selected an entire device to partition. If you proceed with # creating a new partition table on the device, then all current partitions # will be removed. # . # Note that you will be able to undo this operation later if you wish. # d-i partman-partitioning/confirm_new_label boolean false ### Description: Write a new empty partition table? # Because of limitations in the current implementation of the Sun # partition tables in libparted, the newly created partition table has # to be written to the disk immediately. # . # You will NOT be able to undo this operation later and all existing # data on the disk will be irreversibly removed. # . # Confirm whether you actually want to create a new partition table and # write it to disk. # d-i partman-partitioning/confirm_write_new_label boolean false ### Description: Are you sure you want a bootable logical partition? # You are trying to set the bootable flag on a logical partition. The # bootable flag is generally only useful on primary partitions, so setting it # on logical partitions is normally discouraged. Some BIOS versions are known # to fail to boot if there is no bootable primary partition. # . # However, if you are sure that your BIOS does not have this problem, or if # you are using a custom boot manager that pays attention to bootable logical # partitions, then setting this flag may make sense. # d-i partman-partitioning/bootable_logical boolean false ############################ #### partman-target_96_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to resume partitioning? # The attempt to mount a file system with type ${TYPE} in ${DEVICE} at # ${MOUNTPOINT} failed. # . # You may resume partitioning from the partitioning menu. # d-i partman-target/mount_failed boolean true ### Description: How to use this partition: # d-i partman-target/choose_method select # Possible choices: ${DESCRIPTIONS} ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Normally, filesystems are mounted using a universally unique identifier # (UUID) as a key; this allows them to be mounted properly even if their # device name changes. UUIDs are long and difficult to read, so, if you # prefer, the installer can mount filesystems based on the traditional device # names, or based on a label you assign. However, note that traditional # device names may change based on the order in which the kernel discovers # devices at boot, which may cause the wrong filesystem to be mounted; # similarly, labels are likely to clash if you plug in a new disk or a USB # drive, and if that happens your system's behaviour when started will be # random. # . # If you set "label" here, any filesystems without a label will be mounted # using a UUID instead. # . # Devices with stable names, such as LVM logical volumes, will continue to # use their traditional names rather than UUIDs. # d-i partman/mount_style select uuid # Possible choices: traditional, label, uuid ############################ #### partman-xfs_55_all.udeb ############################ ############################ #### pkgsel_0.43_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # type of upgrade to perform # d-i pkgsel/upgrade select safe-upgrade # Possible choices: none, safe-upgrade, full-upgrade ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Comma/space-separated list of extra packages to install # d-i pkgsel/include string ############################ #### ppp-udeb_2.4.6-3.1_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: Interface name: # Please enter the name of the network interface connected to the PPPoE # modem. # d-i ppp/interface string _ ### Description: ISP account username: # Please enter the username for the PPP connection. # . # This information should have been provided by your Internet Service # Provider. # d-i ppp/username string ### Description: ISP account password: # Please enter the password for the PPP connection. # . # This information should have been provided by your Internet Service # Provider. # d-i ppp/password password ############################ #### file-preseed_1.66_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Path to debconf preconfiguration file (or files) to load # d-i preseed/file string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Optional md5sum (or sums) for the preconfiguration files # d-i preseed/file/checksum string ############################ #### network-preseed_1.66_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Location of initial preconfiguration file: # In order to perform an automated install, you need to supply a # preconfiguration file (which can in turn pull in other files). # To do that, you need to provide a (perhaps partial) URL. # . # This can be as simple as the machine name where your preseed # files reside up to a full URL. Any of these could be made to work: # intra [for example.com, these three are equivalent] # intra.example.com # http://intra.example.com/d-i/./lenny/preseed.cfg # http://192.168.0.1/~phil/test47.txt # floppy://preseed.cfg # file:///hd-media/kiosk/./preseed.cfg # . # For fully automated installs, preseed/url should itself be preseeded # (via kernel command line, DHCP, or syslinux.cfg on customised media) # . # See http://wiki.debian.org/DebianInstaller/Preseed for inspiration. # d-i preseed/url string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Optional md5sum (or sums) for the preconfiguration files # d-i preseed/url/checksum string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # If true, attempt a fully automatic install # d-i auto-install/enable boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Path added to local server to give the preseed root # d-i auto-install/defaultroot string d-i/jessie/./preseed.cfg ############################ #### preseed-common_1.66_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Shell command or commands to run in the d-i environment during boot # d-i preseed/boot_command string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Shell command or commands to run in the d-i environment as early as possible # d-i preseed/early_command string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Shell command or commands to run in the d-i environment as late as possible # d-i preseed/late_command string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Programs to be obtained & run # d-i preseed/run string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Additional preseed files to load # d-i preseed/include string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # md5sums of additional preseed files to load # d-i preseed/include/checksum string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Shell command to run that may output a list of preseed files to load # d-i preseed/include_command string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # If true, preseed questions but don't mark them as seen # d-i preseed/interactive boolean false ############################ #### rescue-check_1.51_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Enable rescue mode? # d-i rescue/enable boolean false ############################ #### rescue-mode_1.51_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: Device to use as root file system: # Enter a device you wish to use as your root file system. You will be able # to choose among various rescue operations to perform on this file system. # . # If you choose not to use a root file system, you will be given a reduced # choice of operations that can be performed without one. This may be useful # if you need to correct a partitioning problem. # d-i rescue/root select # Possible choices: ${PARTITIONS}, Assemble RAID array, Do not use a root file system ### Description: Rescue operations # d-i rescue/menu select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Passphrase for ${DEVICE}: # Please enter the passphrase for the encrypted volume ${DEVICE}. # . # If you don't enter anything, the volume will not be available during # rescue operations. # d-i rescue/passphrase password ### Description: Partitions to assemble: # Select the partitions to assemble into a RAID array. If you select # "Automatic", then all devices containing RAID physical volumes will be # scanned and assembled. # . # Note that a RAID partition at the end of a disk may sometimes cause that # disk to be mistakenly detected as containing a RAID physical volume. In # that case, you should select the appropriate partitions individually. # d-i rescue/assemble-raid multiselect # Possible choices: Automatic, ${PARTITIONS} ### Description: Mount separate /boot partition? # The installed system appears to use a separate /boot partition. # . # It is normally a good idea to mount it as it will allow operations such # as reinstalling the boot loader. However, if the file system on /boot is # corrupt then you may want to avoid mounting it. # d-i rescue/separate-boot boolean true ############################ #### rootskel_1.110_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Enable frame buffer console on boot # d-i debian-installer/framebuffer boolean true ### Description: for internal use only # Always halt the machine # d-i debian-installer/exit/always_halt boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Halt the machine # d-i debian-installer/exit/halt boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Power off the machine # d-i debian-installer/exit/poweroff boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Theme to use for the (newt or gtk) frontend # d-i debian-installer/theme string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # d-i debian-installer/allow_unauthenticated boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # d-i debian-installer/allow_unauthenticated_ssl boolean false ############################ #### rootskel-gtk_1.31_amd64.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Enable directfb hardware acceleration # d-i directfb/hw-accel boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Set the mouse protocol for directfb # d-i mouse/protocol string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Set mouse device (serial port) for directfb # d-i mouse/device string ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Set left-handed mouse for directfb # d-i mouse/left boolean false ############################ #### tzsetup-udeb_0.66_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: ${DESCRIPTION} # If the desired time zone is not listed, then please go back to the step # "Choose language" and select a country that uses the desired time zone # (the country where you live or are located). # d-i time/zone select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: location # d-i tzsetup/country/AQ select # Possible choices: McMurdo, Rothera, Palmer, Mawson, Davis, Casey, Vostok, Dumont-d'Urville, Syowa ### Description: state # d-i tzsetup/country/AU select Australia/Canberra # Possible choices: Australian Capital Territory, New South Wales, Victoria, Northern Territory, Queensland, South Australia, Tasmania, Western Australia, Eyre Highway, Yancowinna County, Lord Howe Island ### Description: state # d-i tzsetup/country/BR select America/Sao_Paulo # Possible choices: Acre, Alagoas, Amazonas, Amapá, Bahia, Ceará, Distrito Federal, Espírito Santo, Fernando de Noronha, Goiás, Maranhão, Minas Gerais, Mato Grosso do Sul, Mato Grosso, Pará, Paraíba, Pernambuco, Piauí, Paraná, Rio de Janeiro, Rio Grande do Norte, Rondônia, Roraima, Rio Grande do Sul, Santa Catarina, Sergipe, São Paulo, Tocantins ### Description: zone # d-i tzsetup/country/CA select Canada/Eastern # Possible choices: Newfoundland, Atlantic, Eastern, Central, East Saskatchewan, Saskatchewan, Mountain, Pacific ### Description: city # d-i tzsetup/country/CD select Africa/Kinshasa # Possible choices: Kinshasa, Lubumbashi ### Description: zone # d-i tzsetup/country/CL select America/Santiago # Possible choices: Santiago, Easter Island ### Description: location # d-i tzsetup/country/DE select Europe/Berlin # Possible choices: Berlin, Busingen ### Description: location # d-i tzsetup/country/EC select America/Guayaquil # Possible choices: Guayaquil, Galapagos ### Description: location # d-i tzsetup/country/ES select Europe/Madrid # Possible choices: Madrid, Ceuta, Canary Islands ### Description: location # d-i tzsetup/country/FM select Pacific/Ponape # Possible choices: Yap, Truk, Pohnpei, Kosrae ### Description: location # d-i tzsetup/country/GL select America/Godthab # Possible choices: Godthab, Danmarkshavn, Scoresbysund, Thule ### Description: city # d-i tzsetup/country/ID select Asia/Jakarta # Possible choices: Western (Sumatra\, Jakarta\, Java\, West and Central Kalimantan), Central (Sulawesi\, Bali\, Nusa Tenggara\, East and South Kalimantan), Eastern (Maluku\, Papua) ### Description: zone # d-i tzsetup/country/KI select Pacific/Tarawa # Possible choices: Tarawa (Gilbert Islands), Enderbury (Phoenix Islands), Kiritimati (Line Islands) ### Description: city # d-i tzsetup/country/KZ select Asia/Almaty # Possible choices: Almaty, Qyzylorda, Aqtobe, Atyrau, Oral ### Description: city # d-i tzsetup/country/MN select Asia/Ulaanbaatar # Possible choices: Ulaanbaatar, Hovd, Choibalsan ### Description: zone # d-i tzsetup/country/MX select Mexico/General # Possible choices: Central, Mountain, Pacific ### Description: location # d-i tzsetup/country/NZ select Pacific/Auckland # Possible choices: Auckland, Chatham Islands ### Description: location # d-i tzsetup/country/PF select Pacific/Tahiti # Possible choices: Tahiti (Society Islands), Marquesas Islands, Gambier Islands ### Description: location # d-i tzsetup/country/PT select Europe/Lisbon # Possible choices: Lisbon, Madeira Islands, Azores ### Description: zone # d-i tzsetup/country/RU select Europe/Moscow # Possible choices: Moscow-01 - Kaliningrad, Moscow+00 - Moscow, Moscow+02 - Yekaterinburg, Moscow+03 - Omsk, Moscow+04 - Krasnoyarsk, Moscow+05 - Irkutsk, Moscow+06 - Yakutsk, Moscow+07 - Vladivostok, Moscow+08 - Magadan ### Description: location # d-i tzsetup/country/UM select Pacific/Midway # Possible choices: Johnston Atoll, Midway Islands, Wake Island ### Description: zone # d-i tzsetup/country/US select US/Eastern # Possible choices: Eastern, Central, Mountain, Pacific, Alaska, Hawaii, Arizona, East Indiana, Samoa ### Description: zone # d-i tzsetup/country/PG select # Possible choices: Pacific/Port_Moresby (most locations), Pacific/Bougainville (Bougainville) ############################ #### usb-discover_1.11_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # Probe for USB devices? # d-i debian-installer/probe/usb boolean true ############################ #### user-setup-udeb_1.61_all.udeb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # d-i passwd/root-password-crypted password ### Description: for internal use only # d-i passwd/user-password-crypted password ### Description: for internal use only # d-i passwd/user-uid string ### Description: for internal use only # d-i passwd/user-default-groups string audio cdrom dip floppy video plugdev netdev scanner bluetooth debian-tor lpadmin ### Description: Allow login as root? # If you choose not to allow root to log in, then a user account will be # created and given the power to become root using the 'sudo' command. # d-i passwd/root-login boolean true ### Description: Root password: # You need to set a password for 'root', the system administrative # account. A malicious or unqualified user with root access can have # disastrous results, so you should take care to choose a root password # that is not easy to guess. It should not be a word found in dictionaries, # or a word that could be easily associated with you. # . # A good password will contain a mixture of letters, numbers and punctuation # and should be changed at regular intervals. # . # The root user should not have an empty password. If you leave this # empty, the root account will be disabled and the system's initial user # account will be given the power to become root using the "sudo" # command. # . # Note that you will not be able to see the password as you type it. # d-i passwd/root-password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same root password again to verify that you have typed it # correctly. # d-i passwd/root-password-again password ### Description: Create a normal user account now? # It's a bad idea to use the root account for normal day-to-day activities, # such as the reading of electronic mail, because even a small mistake can # result in disaster. You should create a normal user account to use for # those day-to-day tasks. # . # Note that you may create it later (as well as any additional account) by # typing 'adduser ' as root, where is an username, # like 'imurdock' or 'rms'. # d-i passwd/make-user boolean true ### Description: Full name for the new user: # A user account will be created for you to use instead of the root # account for non-administrative activities. # . # Please enter the real name of this user. This information will be used # for instance as default origin for emails sent by this user as well as # any program which displays or uses the user's real name. Your full # name is a reasonable choice. # d-i passwd/user-fullname string ### Description: Username for your account: # Select a username for the new account. Your first name is a reasonable choice. # The username should start with a lower-case letter, which can be # followed by any combination of numbers and more lower-case letters. # d-i passwd/username string ### Description: Choose a password for the new user: # A good password will contain a mixture of letters, numbers and punctuation # and should be changed at regular intervals. # d-i passwd/user-password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same user password again to verify you have typed it # correctly. # d-i passwd/user-password-again password ### Description: Enable shadow passwords? # Shadow passwords make your system more secure because nobody is able to # view even encrypted passwords. The passwords are stored in a separate file # that can only be read by special programs. The use of shadow passwords # is strongly recommended, except in a few cases such as NIS environments. # d-i passwd/shadow boolean true ############################ #### abook_0.6.0~pre2-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to enable abook system wide for mutt? # abook offers the possibility to be used as query backend from within # mutt. If you acknowledge this question the package will create an # /etc/Muttrc.d/abook.rc file that enables querying the abook database and # adding mail addresses to abook with pressing "A" from pager mode. # d-i abook/muttrc.d boolean true ############################ #### adduser_3.113+nmu3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want system-wide readable home directories? # By default, users' home directories are readable by all users on the # system. If you want to increase security and privacy, you might want # home directories to be readable only for their owners. But if in doubt, # leave this option enabled. # . # This will only affect home directories of users added from now # on with the adduser command. # d-i adduser/homedir-permission boolean true ############################ #### adjtimex_1.29-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should adjtimex be run at installation and at every startup? # Running adjtimex at system startup will set the kernel time parameters to # the values in /etc/default/adjtimex. # . # You should not choose this option if you just want to # use adjtimex to inspect the current parameters. # d-i adjtimex/run_daemon boolean true ### Description: Run adjtimexconfig when adjtimex is installed or upgraded? # The adjtimexconfig script will use adjtimex to find values for the kernel # variables "tick" and "frequency" that will make the system clock approximately # agree with the hardware clock (also known as the CMOS clock). It then # saves these values in the configuration file /etc/default/adjtimex so the # settings will be restored on every boot, when /etc/init.d/adjtimex runs. # . # The script takes 70 seconds to run, so running it for every upgrade # may be a waste of time. Alternatively, you can run adjtimexconfig # manually when needed, or determine the kernel variables by using other # methods and set them manually in /etc/default/adjtimex. # d-i adjtimex/compare_rtc boolean true ############################ #### aegis_4.24.3-3_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### aide-common_0.16~a2.git20130520-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Initialize AIDE database? # Before AIDE can be used, you will have to initialize a database. You # can immediately do this here, or run the '/usr/sbin/aideinit' script # from a shell later. # d-i aide/aideinit boolean false ### Description: Overwrite existing /var/lib/aide/aide.db.new? # You have already a newly generated AIDE database in # /var/lib/aide/aide.db.new. If you choose this option, the existing file # will be be overwritten by the new data obtained from the current state # of your file system. # d-i aideinit/overwritenew boolean true ### Description: Copy aide.db.new to aide.db? # It is advisable for you to first look over /var/lib/aide/aide.db.new # file before replacing the existing db. You can have the package # replace the database anyway here. # . # If you do not choose this option, you will need to copy the file # /var/lib/aide/aide.db.new to /var/lib/aide/aide.db before AIDE can use # it. # d-i aideinit/copynew boolean false ############################ #### am-utils_6.2+rc20110530-3.2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use # d-i am-utils/import-amd-conf-done boolean false ### Description: Import old amd configuration? # amd package configuration files are available (the "amd" package was # the precursor to am-utils) # . # A mechanism is available to import these files, but it may fail # in some cases. # d-i am-utils/import-amd-conf boolean false ### Description: Is the amd master map propagated through NIS? # At large sites the automounter tables (called 'maps') may be available # through the "Network Information Service", or NIS for short (formerly known # as "Yellow pages"). This is the recommended way of using the automounter # on client systems. # . # The master map contains the list of mount points to be managed by amd. # This master map can be propagated through NIS or can be a file. Whatever # answer you choose here does not prevent amd from retrieving the other maps # via NIS. # . # Only the *master* map is concerned here. # d-i am-utils/use-nis boolean false ### Description: Name of the master map: # The master map is the map containing amd's startup arguments and refers to # other maps. # . # It's generally called "amd.master". # d-i am-utils/nis-master-map string amd.master ### Description: Master map style: # The Amd master map can be of different styles: # . # With the `config' style, every key in the master map specifies a different # configuration. You might have different configurations depending on which # OS is booted, or on what the machine's purpose is. The value associated # with each key is the list of mountpoints and maps to be used with this # configuration. # . # Example map: # . # linux /home amd.home /boot amd.boot -cache:=all # freebsd /home amd.home /usr/sys amd.usr-sys # . # You will need to specify which key to use. # . # The `onekey' style is the same as `config' except there is only one single # configuration. No key needs to be specified. # . # With the `mountpoint' style, every key in the master map is the mount # point and the value is the map name to be used for this mount point, plus # some options if needed. This is the default map style for FreeBSD. # . # Example map: # . # /home amd.home # /boot amd.boot -cache:=all # . # With the `custom' style, you will be prompted for a command to extract the # master map which will be run everytime amd starts. # d-i am-utils/nis-master-map-key-style select onekey # Possible choices: config, onekey, mountpoint, custom ### Description: NIS key to use for this system: # The key is typically the name of the os ("linux" for example), or a # description of this computer's usage ("marketing", "r&d", etc). # d-i am-utils/nis-key string default ### Description: Command to run to extract the master map: # Please enter a shell command to run when amd starts up. This command # should print a valid list of amd command line maps on stdout. # d-i am-utils/nis-custom string echo "/amd-is-misconfigured /usr/share/am-utils/amd.net" ### Description: Use the 'net' map? # Amd can be configured to use the net map. With this map, one can access # all the filesystems exported via NFS from a particular host by looking # under: # /net// # . # While convenient, this can result in mounting a lot of filesystems # simultaneously. # d-i am-utils/map-net boolean true ### Description: Use the passwd map? # A map for automounting of home directories on /home. # . # If you use the following system for the home directories of # your users, then you will not need to do any configuration, because amd # provides a special "passwd" map type for this case. Amd will break the # string # . # /anydir/[dom1[/...]/]domN/login # . # to: # . # rfs:=/anydir/domN # rhost:=domN[[....].dom1] # sublink:=login # . # If your home directories do *not* follow this pattern, you should not enable # this feature. # d-i am-utils/map-home boolean false ### Description: Other maps to use: # If you need to use other maps, enter them here. # . # A map entry requires the two following elements: # 1. A mount point (where the map will be mounted and accessed) # 2. The name of a map, in a text file, DBM file, or the name of a # NIS map. # . # For example, if you have a text map in /etc/am-utils/amd.test to be # mounted on /foo and a NIS map called amd.other to be mounted on /bar, then # you should enter: # . # /foo /etc/am-utils/amd.test /bar amd.other # d-i am-utils/map-others string ### Description: Cluster name to use: # A map entry can use the '\${cluster}' selector, to identify a machine as # belonging to a particular cluster. # . # If you use that facility, set the cluster name here. If you leave it # blank, amd will use the DNS domain name instead. # d-i am-utils/clustername string ############################ #### amanda-common_3.3.6-4_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### ampache_3.6-rzb2752+dfsg-5_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Configure and restart the web server? # The web server needs to be reconfigured and restarted to enable Ampache. # Please choose whether you want to restart it automatically now or do it # yourself later. # . # To manually restart the web server, use one of the following commands: # "/etc/init.d/apache2 restart" or "/etc/init.d/lighttpd restart" # d-i ampache/restart_webserver boolean true ############################ #### analog_6.0-20+b2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable the anlgform web interface to analog? # Analog includes a CGI script called anlgform that provides a web interface # to the software. # . # Enabling it may have security implications and expose # information, such as web site logs, that shouldn't be public. # d-i analog/anlgform boolean false ############################ #### anthy_9100h-24_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Extra dictionaries to use: # The anthy package can use add-on dictionaries in addition to the # system dictionary. The following are currently available: # . # - base.t : Anthy-specific words which are compatible with cannadic; # - extra.t: Anthy-specific words which are not compatible with cannadic; # - 2ch.t : Slang used in 2ch, the web's biggest Japanese discussion forum. # d-i anthy/dictionaries multiselect base.t, extra.t # Possible choices: ${dictionaries} ############################ #### aolserver4-daemon_4.5.1-18_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Server hostname: # AOLserver needs a hostname to use for redirect page URLs and for # identifying itself. # . # It is generally the fully-qualified DNS hostname of the computer, or # localhost if it is not networked. Any name valid for a URL string can # be used. # d-i aolserver4/hostname string localhost ### Description: Server IP address: # AOLserver needs an IP address to listen to. # . # The default is the address of the loopback interface. If the server # is to be remotely accessible this should be replaced by the address # of the appropriate network interface. # d-i aolserver4/address string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Server TCP port: # AOLserver needs a port number assigned for its use. This is almost always # port 80 (the standard HTTP port), but might be different if another # web server is installed, or some other service is listening on # that port. # d-i aolserver4/port string 80 ############################ #### apparmor_2.9.0-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Additional home directory locations: # Please enter a space separated list of any additional locations for user # home directories. These locations are in addition to those specified in # /etc/apparmor.d/tunables/home and must end with a '/'. # . # Example: if user's directories are stored in /srv/nfs/home and /mnt/homes, # you should enter "/srv/nfs/home/ /mnt/homes/". # d-i apparmor/homedirs string ############################ #### approx_5.5-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: TCP port for approx service: # Please enter the TCP port on which approx should listen for requests. # The default is the value used by apt-proxy, for compatibility with # its clients' /etc/apt/sources.list files. # d-i approx/port string 9999 ############################ #### apt-build_0.12.45_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Directory used by apt-build to download and build packages: # d-i apt-build/build_dir string /var/cache/apt-build/build ### Description: Directory used to store packages built by apt-build: # d-i apt-build/repository_dir string /var/cache/apt-build/repository ### Description: Add apt-build repository to sources.list? # In order to install built package via APT, you must add a line like this # to your sources.list: # deb file:${repo} apt-build main # d-i apt-build/add_to_sourceslist boolean true ### Description: Optimization level: # These are equivalent to -O1, -O2 and -O3. Optimization level is time # dependant. The higher optimization level you choose, more time will be # required for compiling, but the faster your programs will be. # Warning: Strong optimization may lead to stability problems. # d-i apt-build/olevel select Medium # Possible choices: Light, Medium, Strong ### Description: Architecture: # If your architecture is not here, choose one and edit your configuration # file (/etc/apt/apt-build.conf) by hand, and please do a wishlist bugreport. # d-i apt-build/arch_intel select native # Possible choices: generic, native, i386, i486, i586, pentium, pentium-mmx, pentiumpro, i686, pentium2, pentium3, pentium3m, pentium-m, pentium4, pentium4m, prescott, nocona, core2, corei7, corei7-avx, core-avx-i, atom ### Description: Architecture: # If your architecture is not here, choose one and edit your configuration # file (/etc/apt/apt-build.conf) by hand, and please do a wishlist bugreport. # d-i apt-build/arch_amd select native # Possible choices: native, k6, k6-2, k6-3, athlon, athlon-tbird, athlon-4, athlon-xp, athlon-mp, k8, opteron, athlon64, athlon-fx, i8-sse3, opteron-sse3, athlon64-sse3, amdfam10, barcelona, bdver1, btver1 ### Description: Architecture: # If your architecture is not here, choose one and edit your configuration # file (/etc/apt/apt-build.conf) by hand, and please do a wishlist bugreport. # d-i apt-build/arch_amd64 select native # Possible choices: native, nocona, core2, corei7, corei7-avx, core-avx-i, atom, k8, opteron, athlon64, athlon-fx, k8-sse3, opteron-sse3, athlon64-sse3, amdfam10, barcelona, bdver1, btver1 ### Description: Architecture: # If your architecture is not here, choose one and edit your configuration # file (/etc/apt/apt-build.conf) by hand, and please do a wishlist bugreport. # d-i apt-build/arch_sparc select native # Possible choices: native, v7, v8, sparclite, sparclet, v9, cypress, supersparc, hypersparc, leon, f930, f934, sparclite86x, tsc701, ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara, niagara2, niagara3, niagara4 ### Description: Architecture: # If your architecture is not here, choose one and edit your configuration # file (/etc/apt/apt-build.conf) by hand, and please do a wishlist bugreport. # d-i apt-build/arch_arm select native # Possible choices: native, armv2, armv2a, armv3, armv3m, armv4, armv4t, armv5, armv5t, armv5te, armv6, armv6j, armv6t2, armv6zk, armv6-m, armv7, armv7-a, armv7-r, armv7-m, iwmmxt, iwmmxt2, ep9312 ### Description: Architecture: # If your architecture is not here, choose one and edit your configuration # file (/etc/apt/apt-build.conf) by hand, and please do a wishlist bugreport. # d-i apt-build/arch_alpha select native # Possible choices: native, ev4, ev5, ev56, pca56, ev6, ev67 ### Description: Options to add to gcc: # d-i apt-build/options string ### Description: Options to add to make: # d-i apt-build/make_options string ### Description: for internal use # d-i apt-build/archtype string ############################ #### apt-cacher_1.7.10+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Daemon mode for apt-cacher: # Please select the method for starting the apt-cacher daemon. # . # Choose "daemon" to run as a stand-alone daemon, "inetd" to run under inetd or # "manual" to use the (deprecated) CGI mode or some other manual configuration. # d-i apt-cacher/mode select daemon # Possible choices: daemon, inetd, manual ############################ #### apt-cacher-ng_0.8.0-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatic remapping of client requests: # Apt-Cacher NG can download packages from repositories other than those # requested by the clients. This allows it to cache content effectively, # and makes it easy for an administrator to switch to another mirror later. # The URL remapping can be set up automatically, using a configuration # based on the current state of /etc/apt/sources.list. # . # Please specify whether the remapping should be configured once now, or # reconfigured on every update of Apt-Cacher NG (modifying the # configuration files each time), or left unconfigured. # . # Selecting "No automated setup" will leave the existing configuration # unchanged. It will need to be updated manually. # d-i apt-cacher-ng/gentargetmode select Set up once # Possible choices: Set up once, Set up now and update later, No automated setup ### Description: Listening address(es) for Apt-Cacher NG: # Please specify the local addresses that Apt-Cacher NG should listen on # (multiple entries must be separated by spaces). # . # Each entry must be an IP address or hostname associated with a local # network interface. Generic protocol-specific addresses are also # supported, such as 0.0.0.0 for listening on all IPv4-enabled interfaces. # . # If this field is left empty, Apt-Cacher NG will listen on all # interfaces, with all supported protocols. # . # The special word "keep" keeps the value from the current (or default) # configuration unchanged. # d-i apt-cacher-ng/bindaddress string keep ### Description: Listening TCP port: # Please specify the TCP port that Apt-Cacher NG should listen on for # incoming HTTP (proxy) requests. The default value is port 3142, but it # can be set to 9999 to emulate apt-proxy. # . # If this field is left empty, the value from the current configuration # remains unchanged. # d-i apt-cacher-ng/port string keep ### Description: Top-level directory for package cache: # The main cache storage directory should be located on a file system without # file name restrictions. # . # If this field is left empty, the value from the current configuration # remains unchanged or is set to the default of /var/cache/apt-cacher-ng. # d-i apt-cacher-ng/cachedir string keep ### Description: Proxy to use for downloads: # Please specify the proxy server to use for downloads. # . # Username and password for the proxy server can be included here following the # user:pass@host:port scheme. However, please check the documentation for limitations. # . # If this field is left empty, Apt-Cacher NG will not use any proxy # server. # . # The special word "keep" keeps the value from the current (or default) # configuration unchanged. # d-i apt-cacher-ng/proxy string keep ############################ #### apt-listchanges_2.85.13+nmu1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Method to be used to display changes: # Changes in packages can be displayed in various ways by apt-listchanges: # . # pager : display changes one page at a time; # browser : display HTML-formatted changes using a web browser; # xterm-pager : like pager, but in an xterm in the background; # xterm-browser: like browser, but in an xterm in the background; # gtk : display changes in a GTK window; # text : print changes to the terminal (without pausing); # mail : only send changes via e-mail; # none : do not run automatically from APT. # . # This setting can be overridden at execution time. By default, all the # options except for 'none' will also send copies by mail. # d-i apt-listchanges/frontend select pager # Possible choices: pager, browser, xterm-pager, xterm-browser, gtk, text, mail, none ### Description: E-mail address(es) which will receive changes: # Optionally, apt-listchanges can e-mail a copy of displayed changes to # a specified address. # . # Multiple addresses may be specified, delimited by commas. Leaving this # field empty disables mail notifications. # d-i apt-listchanges/email-address string root ### Description: Prompt for confirmation after displaying changes? # After displaying the list of changes, apt-listchanges can pause with # a confirmation prompt. This is useful when running from APT, as it # offers an opportunity to abort the upgrade if a change is unwelcome. # . # This can be overridden at execution time, and has no effect if the # configured frontend option is 'mail' or 'none'. # d-i apt-listchanges/confirm boolean false ### Description: Should apt-listchanges skip changes that have already been seen? # A record of already displayed changes can be kept in order to avoid # displaying them again. This is useful, for example, when retrying an upgrade. # d-i apt-listchanges/save-seen boolean true ### Description: Changes displayed with APT: # Please choose which type of changes should be displayed with APT. # . # news : important news items only; # changelogs: detailed changelogs only; # both : news and changelogs. # d-i apt-listchanges/which select news # Possible choices: news, changelogs, both ############################ #### apt-listdifferences_1.20141011_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Initialize the apt-listdifferences source packages database now? # The source packages database for apt-listdifferences can be initialized now. # Depending on your Internet connection, this may take a while, but it will also # provide immediate functionality for the tool. # . # If you do not choose this option, apt-listdifferences will instead become functional slowly # over time as more and more reference source packages get added to its database # when they are first seen. # d-i apt-listdifferences/initialize boolean true ### Description: Remove the apt-listdifferences source packages database? # The apt-listdifferences source packages database is currently still present on disk. You can save # a lot of space by removing it now, but if you ever plan to reinstall # apt-listdifferences, the data will need to be downloaded again. # d-i apt-listdifferences/purge boolean false ############################ #### apticron_1.1.57_all.deb ############################ ### Description: E-Mail address(es) to notify: # Specify e-mail addresses, space separated, that should be notified of # pending updates. # d-i apticron/notification string root ############################ #### argus-server_2.0.6.fixes.1-16.3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Startup behaviour: # It is possible to start argus at boot time, upon initiating a PPP # connection, both, or never, which requires user intervention in order to # start argus. # d-i argus/startup select boot # Possible choices: boot, dialup, both, none ### Description: Should /etc/default/argus-server be overwritten? # If you select this option, the installation script will always overwrite # /etc/default/argus-server. Otherwise, you will manage that file yourself. # d-i argus/overwrite_conffile boolean ############################ #### arno-iptables-firewall_2.0.1.e-1_all.deb ############################ ### description: External network interfaces: # The external network interfaces connect this machine # to untrusted networks (e.g. the Internet). The firewall will only permit # connections attempts with explicitly allowed source/destination-port # combinations on these interfaces. You have to specify all external # interfaces (e.g. eth0 and/or ppp0). # . # For a ppp-interface that doesn't exist yet you can use the wildcard device # called "ppp+", but you can only use ppp+ if there aren't any other ppp # interfaces! # . # If no interfaces are specified here, no firewall setup will # be performed. # . # Multiple interfaces should be specified space separated. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/config-ext-if string ### description: Is DHCP used on external interfaces? # This machine might use DHCP to dynamically obtain its IP address from # your Internet service provider (ISP). This will be almost always the case # if you have a non-permanent (e.g. dialup) connection. # . # If DHCP is not explicitly enabled, the firewall will block all DHCP-related # network traffic. # . # Leave this enabled, if you are unsure. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/dynamic-ip boolean true ### description: Open external TCP-ports: # The default firewall policy is to deny all incoming traffic on the # external interfaces. If this machine provides services to the outside # world (e.g. the Internet) they have to be explicitly enabled. # . # Please specify the TCP-ports numbers associated with the services that # shall be accessible from the outside world. Some frequently used ports are: 80 # (http), 443 (https) or 22 (ssh). # . # In addition to single port numbers you may also specify port ranges (e.g. # 10000:11000). Multiple entries should be entered space separated. # . # If unsure, leave this empty. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/services-tcp string ### description: Open external UDP-ports: # The default firewall policy is to deny all incoming traffic on the # external interfaces. If this machine provides services for the outside # world (e.g. the Internet) they have to be explicitly enabled. # . # Please specify the UDP-ports numbers associated with the services that # shall be accessible from the outside world. # . # In addition to single port numbers you may also specify port ranges (e.g. # 10000:11000). Multiple entries should be entered space separated. # . # If unsure, leave this empty. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/services-udp string ### description: Should the firewall be (re)started now? # For security reasons the new firewall setup is not applied # automatically. You might want to perform a manual inspection of the # firewall configuration in /etc/arno-iptables-firewall/firewall.conf, especially # when upgrading to a new version, as configuration variables might have changed. # . # In order to later manually apply the new # firewall settings before the next reboot, invoke 'invoke-rc.d # arno-iptables-firewall start'. # . # If you do not need manual inspection, the firewall-setup can be applied now. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/restart boolean true ### description: Do you want to enable NAT? # If the connected internal networks should be able to access the outside # world (e.g. the Internet) through the firewall, masquerading (NAT) has # to be enabled. # . # When in doubt, you can safely leave this disabled. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/nat boolean false ### description: Internal network interfaces: # The internal network interfaces connect this machine # to trusted networks (e.g. the office or home LAN). The firewall will permit # all connection attempts on these interfaces. If you specify such interfaces, # you will be able to permit the internal networks to access the Internet through # this host. If there are no such interfaces, leave this empty. # . # Multiple interfaces should be entered space separated. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/config-int-if string ### description: Internal subnets: # You have to specify which subnets are connected to the internal network # interfaces. Hosts in the internal networks can connect to all the services on # this machine. # . # Give subnets in CIDR notation (e.g. 192.168.1.0/24). If you have # multiple internal networks, they should be space separated. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/config-int-net string ### description: Internal networks with access to external networks: # If you want to restrict the access to the external networks, you can specify # the allowed internal subnets in CIDR notation (e.g. 192.168.1.0/24). It is # also possible to specify single hosts by their IP addresses. If you have # multiple internal networks and/or hosts, they should be given space separated. # . # If you leave this empty, the value is automatically set to equal the internal # network. Therefore the WHOLE internal network will have access to the external # networks, so be careful to only specify networks that should have access to # the outside world. # . # If you are unsure, leave this empty. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/config-int-nat-net string ### description: Should the machine be pingable from the outside world? # For increased security the firewall can be setup to ignore ICMP echo # requests (pings). While this is generally a good idea (the host seems to # be down at a first glance), this is sometimes not useful (e.g. failure # diagnostics). # . # If you are not sure, leave this disabled. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/icmp-echo boolean false ### description: Do you want to manage the firewall setup with debconf? # A basic firewall setup that is suitable for most purposes can be created by # answering a few questions. This should be the preferred option for all who are # not familiar with firewall-related topics. # . # If you do not want that, the firewall will not work before you have edited # the configuration manually. # d-i arno-iptables-firewall/debconf-wanted boolean true ############################ #### libasedrive-serial_3.7-5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Communication port to use with the smart card reader: # The driver needs to know which serial port the Athena ASEDrive IIIe card # reader is connected to. # d-i libasedrive-serial/port select # Possible choices: ttyS0, ttyS1, ttyS2, ttyS3, none ############################ #### code-aster-gui_1.13.1-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Aster platform: # Select Aster platform. # d-i astk/platform select LINUX64 # Possible choices: LINUX, P_LINUX, LINUX64, P_LINUX64 ### Description: ASTK server domain name: # Please enter the domain name of the server that this ASTK client # should connect to. # d-i astk/domainname string ### Description: ASTK server host name: # Please enter the host name (without domain name) of the server # that this ASTK client should connect to. # d-i astk/servername string ### Description: ASTK client node name: # Please enter the public name by which this client will be known on # the network. It must be a unique name within the domain. # d-i astk/node string ### Description: Standard editor: # Please select the command line that ASTK should use to launch an # editor. # d-i astk/EDITOR select /usr/bin/nedit # Possible choices: /usr/bin/nedit, /usr/bin/gedit --display=\@D, /usr/bin/kwrite --display \@D, /usr/bin/xemacs -display \@D, /usr/bin/emacs -display \@D, /usr/bin/xedit -display \@D, /usr/bin/xterm -display \@D -e \@E -e vi ### Description: Standard terminal emulator: # Please select the command line that ASTK should use to launch a # terminal window. # d-i astk/TERMINAL select /usr/bin/gnome-terminal --display=\@D --command=\@E # Possible choices: /usr/bin/xterm -display \@D -e \@E, /usr/bin/gnome-terminal --display=\@D --command=\@E, /usr/bin/konsole --display \@D -e \@E ############################ #### code-aster-run_1.13.1-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Aster platform: # Select Aster platform. # d-i astk/platform select LINUX64 # Possible choices: LINUX, P_LINUX, LINUX64, P_LINUX64 ### Description: ASTK client node name: # Please enter the public name by which this client will be known on # the network. It must be a unique name within the domain. # d-i astk/node string ### Description: Standard editor: # Please select the command line that ASTK should use to launch an # editor. # d-i astk/EDITOR select /usr/bin/nedit # Possible choices: /usr/bin/nedit, /usr/bin/gedit --display=\@D, /usr/bin/kwrite --display \@D, /usr/bin/xemacs -display \@D, /usr/bin/emacs -display \@D, /usr/bin/xedit -display \@D, /usr/bin/xterm -display \@D -e \@E -e vi ### Description: Standard terminal emulator: # Please select the command line that ASTK should use to launch a # terminal window. # d-i astk/TERMINAL select /usr/bin/gnome-terminal --display=\@D --command=\@E # Possible choices: /usr/bin/xterm -display \@D -e \@E, /usr/bin/gnome-terminal --display=\@D --command=\@E, /usr/bin/konsole --display \@D -e \@E ############################ #### atftpd_0.7.git20120829-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should the server be started by inetd? # atftpd can be started by the inetd superserver or as a daemon and handle # incoming connections by itself. The latter is only recommend for very high # usage server. # d-i atftpd/use_inetd boolean true ### Description: Server timeout: # How many seconds the main thread waits before exiting. # d-i atftpd/tftpd-timeout string 300 ### Description: Retry timeout: # How many seconds to wait for a reply before retransmitting a packet. # d-i atftpd/retry-timeout string 5 ### Description: Maximum number of threads: # Maximum number of concurrent threads that can be running. # d-i atftpd/maxthread string 100 ### Description: Verbosity level: # Level of logging. 7 logs everything including debug logs. 1 will log only # the system critical logs. 5 (LOG_NOTICE) is the default value. # d-i atftpd/verbosity select 5 (LOG_NOTICE) # Possible choices: 7 (LOG_DEBUG), 6 (LOG_INFO), 5 (LOG_NOTICE), 4 (LOG_WARNING), 1 (LOG_ALERT) ### Description: Enable 'timeout' support? # d-i atftpd/timeout boolean true ### Description: Enable 'tsize' support? # d-i atftpd/tsize boolean true ### Description: Enable 'block size' support? # d-i atftpd/blksize boolean true ### Description: Enable multicast support? # d-i atftpd/multicast boolean true ### Description: TTL for multicast packets: # d-i atftpd/ttl string 1 ### Description: Port to listen for tftp request: # d-i atftpd/port string 69 ### Description: Port range for multicast file transfer: # Multicast transfer will use any available port in a given set. For # example, "2000-2003, 3000" allow atftpd to use port 2000 to 2003 and 3000. # d-i atftpd/mcast_port string 1758 ### Description: Address range for multicast transfer: # Multicast transfer will use any available addresses from a given set of # addresses. Syntax is "a.b.c.d-d,a.b.c.d,..." # d-i atftpd/mcast_addr string 239.239.239.0-255 ### Description: Log to file instead of syslog? # If your server does intensive tftp file serving, it is a good idea to # accept here. That will avoid cluttering your syslog with tftpd logs. # d-i atftpd/logtofile boolean false ### Description: Log file: # A file where atftpd will write its logs. This file will be made writable for # the user 'nobody' and group 'nogroup'. # d-i atftpd/logfile string /var/log/atftpd.log ### Description: Base directory: # The directory tree from where atftpd can serve files. That directory must # be world readable. # d-i atftpd/basedir string /srv/tftp ############################ #### auctex_11.87-3+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: (La)TeX macros parsing mode: # To improve the performance of AUCTeX, every currently installed TeX macro # package and LaTeX style file will be parsed. # . # This may take a lot of time, so it should probably be done in the # background. You may also choose to have it done in the foreground, or to # skip that step. # . # The cached data gets automatically updated via dpkg triggers, so that # no specific action is required whenever you install new (La)TeX packages or # remove old ones. # . # This update can be run manually at any moment by running # 'update-auctex-elisp'. # d-i auctex/doauto select Background # Possible choices: Background, Foreground, None ############################ #### auth2db_0.2.5-2+dfsg-5_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to activate Auth2DB Alerts? # This feature of Auth2DB will make you able to receive alerts # to a email box when some events are met, for example, too many # SSH connection failures from some IP. # . # Despite the choice you made, you can easily reconfigure this # using 'dpkg-reconfigure auth2db' command or a equivalent GUI. # d-i auth2db/activate_alerts boolean true ############################ #### avelsieve_1.9.9-2.4_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### awffull_3.10.2-4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Directory to put the output in: # d-i awffull/directory string /var/www/awffull ### Description: Webserver's rotated log filename: # d-i awffull/logfile string /var/log/apache2/access.log.1 ############################ #### ax25-apps_0.0.8-rc2+cvs20130510-4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Make listen setuid root? # The listen program needs to make calls as the root user. One way of doing # this is to make the program setuid root. This is generally a bad idea as # there are better ways, such as using the sudo program, to do this. # However, you have the option of making it setuid root here if you like. # d-i ax25-apps/suid_listen boolean false ############################ #### backup-manager_0.7.10.1-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Archives location: # Please enter the name of the directory where backup-manager will # store the generated archives. # . # The size of archives may be rather important so you should store them # on a disk with enough available space. # d-i backup-manager/backup-repository string /var/archives ### Description: Archives storage format: # d-i backup-manager/filetype select tar.gz # Possible choices: tar, tar.gz, tar.bz2, tar.lz, zip, dar ### Description: Follow symlinks? # The tar, tar.gz and tar.bz2 filetypes may dereference the symlinks in # generated archives. # . # Enabling this feature will dump the files pointed by symlinks and # is likely to generate huge archives. # d-i backup-manager/dump_symlinks boolean false ### Description: Directories to skip in archives: # Please enter a space-separated list of directories which should not be # archived. # d-i backup-manager/blacklist string /var/archives ### Description: Archives name format: # Files generated by backup-manager may use different file naming # conventions. # . # The long format is "host-full-path-to-directory.tar.gz" while the short # format only uses the last directory name. For instance, /home/me # would be named me.tar.gz. # d-i backup-manager/name-format select long # Possible choices: long, short ### Description: Age of kept archives (days): # Please choose the number of days backup-manager will keep the files # before purging them. Combining several directories and a large number of # days for keeping them may lead to huge archives. # d-i backup-manager/time-to-live string 5 ### Description: Directories to backup: # Please enter a space-separated list of all the directories you want # to backup. # . # You should rather enter several subdirectories instead of the # parent in order to have more pertinent files in your backup repository. # . # For instance, "/home/user1 /home/user2 /home/user3" is more appropriate # than "/home" alone. # d-i backup-manager/directories string /etc /home ### Description: Enable automatic burning? # Archives may be burnt on a CDR/CDRW/DVD media. # . # Using this feature requires a writable media to be present at the running # time. # d-i backup-manager/burning-enabled boolean false ### Description: Device to use for burning data: # d-i backup-manager/burning-device string /dev/cdrom ### Description: Maximum size of your media (MB): # d-i backup-manager/burning-maxsize string 650 ### Description: Burning method: # When burning data, backup-manager will try to burn the whole archives # repository. If it does not fit in the media, it will try to burn only the # daily generated archives. # . # The CDRW/DVD-RW methods will first blank the media and then burn the data. # . # The CDR/DVD method will only burn the data, assuming that the media is empty # (or that the disc does not need formatting, like DVD+RW). # d-i backup-manager/burning-method select CDRW # Possible choices: CDRW, CDR, DVD, DVD-RW ### Description: Enable backup-manager's uploading system? # Archives may be uploaded to remote hosts using ftp or ssh. # . # Using this feature requires valid ftp or ssh account on remote hosts. # d-i backup-manager/want_to_upload boolean false ### Description: Transfer mode to use: # The "ftp" transfer mode requires a valid FTP account on remote hosts. # . # The "scp" mode requires a valid SSH account on remote hosts. # SSH Key authentication is used to establish the connection. # d-i backup-manager/transfert_mode select scp # Possible choices: scp, ftp ### Description: Remote hosts list: # Please enter a space-separated list of hosts (IP or FQDN) where archives will # be uploaded. # d-i backup-manager/upload-hosts string ### Description: SSH user's login: # For the scp transfer mode to be possible, a SSH account will be used. The SSH login # to use is required as well as the path to the private key. # . # Remote hosts must have the user's public key listed in their authorized_keys files # (see ssh-keygen(1) for details). # d-i backup-manager/upload-user-scp string bmngr ### Description: FTP user's login: # Please enter the FTP user to use for uploading files to remote hosts. # d-i backup-manager/upload-user-ftp string ### Description: SSH private key file: # Despite of the ftp transfer mode, ssh doesn't require a password. The # authentication is based on the SSH key. # . # Don't forget to add the user's public key to the remote host's # authorized_keys file (see ssh-keygen(1) for details about ssh key # authentication). # d-i backup-manager/upload-key string ### Description: FTP user's password: # Enter the password of the FTP user to use for uploading files to remote # hosts. # d-i backup-manager/upload-passwd password ### Description: Remote host's repository: # Please enter where - on the remote hosts - archives should be stored. # . # If backup-manager is installed on those hosts, it is recommended to use a # subdirectory of its archive repository so that even uploaded archives will be purged # when needed. # d-i backup-manager/upload-dir string /var/archives/uploads ### Description: CRON frequency: # Although backup-manager is designed to make daily archives, it can be run # less frequently, like once a week or even once a month. # . # Note that you can also choose not to run backup-manager at all with CRON. # d-i backup-manager/cron_frequency select never # Possible choices: never, daily, weekly, monthly ### Description: Owner user of the repository: # For security reason, the repository where archives will be stored is accessible # by a specific user. # . # The repository and archives inside will be readable and writeable by this user. # d-i backup-manager/repo_user string root ### Description: Owner group of the repository: # For security reason, the repository where archives will be stored is accessible # by a specific group. # . # The repository and archives inside will be readable and writeable by this group. # d-i backup-manager/repo_group string root ### Description: Remove deprecated file /etc/cron.d/backup-manager? # In previous version, backup-manager uses /etc/cron.d directory but this directory is not # handled by anacron. Thus, it is not possible to run backup-manager's job asynchronously, if # cron.d is used. # . # In order to let anacron handle backup-manager's job, the following CRON subdirectories are used: # /etc/cron.daily, /etc/cron.weekly and /etc/cron.monthly, depending on the chosen frequency. # . # As jobs handled by the cron.d subdirectory may be skipped if the system is not running, # it is recommended to use one of those directories instead. # d-i backup-manager/cron_d_remove_deprecated boolean false ### Description: Encrypt archives? # If you don't trust the physical device where you store your data, you may want # to be sure that your archives won't be accessible by a malicious user. # . # Backup Manager can encrypt your archives with GPG, that means that you will # need a GPG identity to use that feature. # d-i backup-manager/enable_encryption boolean false ### Description: GPG recipient: # You have to set the recipient for which the archive is encrypted. A valid # specification is a short or long key id, or a descriptive name, as explained # in the gpg man page. # . # The public key for this identity must be in the key ring of the user running gpg, # which may be root in most of the cases. # d-i backup-manager/encryption_recipient string ############################ #### backuppc_3.3.0-2+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Which web server would you like to reconfigure automatically: # BackupPC supports any web server with CGI enabled, but this automatic # configuration process only supports Apache. # d-i backuppc/reconfigure-webserver multiselect apache2 # Possible choices: apache2 ### Description: Do you want to restart the webservers now if needed? # Remember that in order to activate the new configuration # the webservers have to be restarted. # d-i backuppc/restart-webserver boolean true ### Description: Temporary password for internal use # Temporary password. Should not be translated. # d-i backuppc/tmppass password ############################ #### bacula-director-mysql_5.2.6+dfsg-9.3_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### bacula-director-pgsql_5.2.6+dfsg-9.3_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### bacula-director-sqlite3_5.2.6+dfsg-9.3_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### bandwidthd_2.0.1+cvs20090917-7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Interface to listen on: # Bandwidthd needs to know which interface it should listen for traffic on. # Only a single interface can be specified. If you want to listen on all # interfaces you should specify the metainterface "any". # Running "bandwidthd -l" will list available interfaces. # d-i bandwidthd/dev select # Possible choices: ${interfaces} ### Description: Subnets to log details about: # Bandwidthd can create graphs for one or several ip-subnets. Subnets are # specified either in dotted-quad format (192.168.0.0 255.255.0.0) or in # CIDR format (192.168.0.0/16) and separated by a comma. # Example: 192.168.0.0/16, 10.0.0.0 255.0.0.0, 172.16.1.0/24. # If you don't know what to specify then you can use 0.0.0.0/0 but it is # strongly discouraged. # d-i bandwidthd/subnet string ### Description: Output CDF data logs? # Bandwidthd can log captured traffic information to Common Data File (CDF) # logs. These logs are required if you want to keep old information stored # between restarts of the bandwidthd daemon. Also see the recovercdf # configuration option. # d-i bandwidthd/outputcdf boolean true ### Description: Recover old data from logs on restart? # If old data is going to be outputed in the graphs, it needs to be read # when BandwidthD is restarted. Parsing the CDF logs can take quite some # time on a slow machine so you might want to disable it, but then you'll # lose the information in the graphs after a reboot and similar.... Also make # sure the output_cdf config option is enabled. # d-i bandwidthd/recovercdf boolean true ### Description: Graph webpage autorefresh delay (seconds): # With this option you can tweak the delay used in the html as "META # REFRESH" value. The default is 150 seconds (2.5 minutes). To disable # automatic reloads of the webpage enter 0. This way the visitor will have # to manually push refresh in his browser to get updated graphs. # d-i bandwidthd/metarefresh string ### Description: Put interface in PROMISC mode? # If this option is enabled, all interfaces used to capture traffic # information will be put in promiscuous mode. This way traffic thats not # routed via the machine running bandwidthd might be trackable anyway. # Enabling promiscuous mode will probably not be able to capture any more # traffic in a normal switched network. Also rootkit detectors might warn # about bandwidthd being a virus if using promiscuous mode. You should # probably leave this option disabled. # d-i bandwidthd/promisc boolean false ### Description: This sensors identification string: # Each sensor should have an identification string to be able to tell from # where the traffic in the PostgreSQL-database was detected on. This # option is usually set to the fully qualified hostname of the machine # running the bandwidthd sensor. This needs to be a unique string which # no other bandwidthd sensor that reports to the same database uses. # d-i bandwidthd-pgsql/sensorid string ############################ #### bandwidthd-pgsql_2.0.1+cvs20090917-7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Interface to listen on: # Bandwidthd needs to know which interface it should listen for traffic on. # Only a single interface can be specified. If you want to listen on all # interfaces you should specify the metainterface "any". # Running "bandwidthd -l" will list available interfaces. # d-i bandwidthd/dev select # Possible choices: ${interfaces} ### Description: Subnets to log details about: # Bandwidthd can create graphs for one or several ip-subnets. Subnets are # specified either in dotted-quad format (192.168.0.0 255.255.0.0) or in # CIDR format (192.168.0.0/16) and separated by a comma. # Example: 192.168.0.0/16, 10.0.0.0 255.0.0.0, 172.16.1.0/24. # If you don't know what to specify then you can use 0.0.0.0/0 but it is # strongly discouraged. # d-i bandwidthd/subnet string ### Description: Output CDF data logs? # Bandwidthd can log captured traffic information to Common Data File (CDF) # logs. These logs are required if you want to keep old information stored # between restarts of the bandwidthd daemon. Also see the recovercdf # configuration option. # d-i bandwidthd/outputcdf boolean true ### Description: Recover old data from logs on restart? # If old data is going to be outputed in the graphs, it needs to be read # when BandwidthD is restarted. Parsing the CDF logs can take quite some # time on a slow machine so you might want to disable it, but then you'll # lose the information in the graphs after a reboot and similar.... Also make # sure the output_cdf config option is enabled. # d-i bandwidthd/recovercdf boolean true ### Description: Graph webpage autorefresh delay (seconds): # With this option you can tweak the delay used in the html as "META # REFRESH" value. The default is 150 seconds (2.5 minutes). To disable # automatic reloads of the webpage enter 0. This way the visitor will have # to manually push refresh in his browser to get updated graphs. # d-i bandwidthd/metarefresh string ### Description: Put interface in PROMISC mode? # If this option is enabled, all interfaces used to capture traffic # information will be put in promiscuous mode. This way traffic thats not # routed via the machine running bandwidthd might be trackable anyway. # Enabling promiscuous mode will probably not be able to capture any more # traffic in a normal switched network. Also rootkit detectors might warn # about bandwidthd being a virus if using promiscuous mode. You should # probably leave this option disabled. # d-i bandwidthd/promisc boolean false ### Description: This sensors identification string: # Each sensor should have an identification string to be able to tell from # where the traffic in the PostgreSQL-database was detected on. This # option is usually set to the fully qualified hostname of the machine # running the bandwidthd sensor. This needs to be a unique string which # no other bandwidthd sensor that reports to the same database uses. # d-i bandwidthd-pgsql/sensorid string ############################ #### base-passwd_3.5.37_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to move the user ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Move user "${name}" (${id}) to before the NIS compat "+" entry # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/user-move boolean true ### Description: Do you want to move the group ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Move group "${name}" (${id}) to before the NIS compat "+" entry # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/group-move boolean true ### Description: Do you want to add the user ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Add user "${name}" (${id}) # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/user-add boolean true ### Description: Do you want to add the group ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Add group "${name}" (${id}) # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/group-add boolean true ### Description: Do you want to remove the user ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Remove user "${name}" (${id}) # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/user-remove boolean true ### Description: Do you want to remove the group ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Remove group "${name}" (${id}) # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/group-remove boolean true ### Description: Do you want to change the UID of user ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Change the UID of user "${name}" from ${old_uid} to ${new_uid} # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/user-change-uid boolean true ### Description: Do you want to change the GID of user ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Change the GID of user "${name}" from ${old_gid} (${old_group}) to # ${new_gid} (${new_group}) # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/user-change-gid boolean true ### Description: Do you want to change the GECOS of user ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Change the GECOS of user "${name}" from "${old_gecos}" to "${new_gecos}" # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/user-change-gecos boolean true ### Description: Do you want to change the home directory of user ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Change the home directory of user "${name}" from ${old_home} to # ${new_home} # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/user-change-home boolean true ### Description: Do you want to change the shell of user ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Change the shell of user "${name}" from ${old_shell} to ${new_shell} # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/user-change-shell boolean true ### Description: Do you want to change the GID of group ${name}? # update-passwd has found a difference between your system accounts and the # current Debian defaults. It is advisable to allow update-passwd to # change your system; without those changes some packages might not work # correctly. For more documentation on the Debian account policies, please # see /usr/share/doc/base-passwd/README. # . # The proposed change is: # . # Change the GID of group "${name}" from ${old_gid} to ${new_gid} # . # If you allow this change, a backup of modified files will be made with # the extension .org, which you can use if necessary to restore the # current settings. If you do not make this change now, you can make it # later with the update-passwd utility. # d-i base-passwd/group-change-gid boolean true ############################ #### bastet_0.43-3+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove old-format Bastet highscores file? # The new version of Bastet cannot read highscores files in the old # format, like the one at /var/games/bastet.scores. # . # You can decide to remove the old scores file now. If you leave it on # the system it will be ignored by Bastet and will no longer be # tracked by the package management system. # d-i bastet/score_file_compatibility boolean false ############################ #### beep_1.3-3+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Install beep as: # beep must be run as root since it needs to access the speaker hardware. # There are several possibilities to make the program usable: Either only # for root (no suid bit at all), executable only by users of the group # audio, or usable for all. # . # Since each program set as suid root can be a security risk this is not done # by default. However, the program is quite small (~150 lines of code), so it # is fairly easy to verify the safety of the code yourself, if you don't # trust the package maintainer's judgement. # d-i beep/suid_option select suid root with only group audio executable # Possible choices: usable for all, usable for group audio, usable only for root ############################ #### ibulgarian_4.1-3_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### wbulgarian_4.1-3_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### bidentd_1.1.4-1.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Logging level for bidentd: # Bisqwit's IDENT Daemon can emit various amounts of information to the # daemon facility of the system logs. # . # The choices have the following meaning: # "Be very quiet" Log nothing # "Be quiet" Log only errors # "Log all requests" Log all requests (can generate lots of noise) # "Be somewhat verbose" Log a little more than with "log all requests" # "Be quite verbose" Log even more than "be somewhat verbose" # "Be really verbose" Log very much (will generate lots of noise) # "Manual config" Do not touch inetd.conf # . # You should choose "Log all requests" unless you know you need one of the # other choices. The verbose options are mostly useful for debugging. # d-i bidentd/loglevel select Log all requests # Possible choices: Be very quiet, Be quiet, Log all requests, Be somewhat verbose, Be quite verbose, Be really verbose, Manual config ############################ #### bilibop-rules_0.4.23_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you intend to install bilibop-rules on a Live System ? # Some bilibop-rules settings can be useful on non-volatile Operating Systems, # when running from a removable and writable media (USB sticks, external HDD # or SD cards); but they are currently useless or even harmful for LiveCD or # LiveUSB systems. # . # If you choose this option, no other question will be asked; bilibop udev # rules will be applied but nothing else will be modified on your system. # Note that in that case, this package is overkill and you should probably # replace it by the lighter but as much as efficient bilibop-udev package. # d-i bilibop-rules/on-live-system boolean false ### Description: Do you want to use custom bilibop rules and build them now ? # If tens of removable media are plugged on the computer your system boots # from, bilibop udev rules can significantly increase boot time. This can be # avoided by using custom udev rules, which are specific to the device your # system is installed on. # . # That said, if this device can boot from different hardware port types (as # USB/Firewire, USB/eSATA, USB/MMC/SD, etc.), you should check the resulting # rules by booting your system on the alternative port type, and if necessary # by running 'dpkg-reconfigure bilibop-rules' again with proper options, or # even by editing '/etc/udev/rules.d/66-bilibop.rules'. # d-i bilibop-rules/bilibop_rules_generator/customize boolean false ### Description: What do you want to do with your custom rules ? # The file '/etc/udev/rules.d/66-bilibop.rules' exists. It is specific to the # drive on which your system is installed and overrides the one, more generic, # that is provided by the bilibop-rules package (in '/lib/udev/rules.d'). # . # If the device hosting the running system is able to boot from different # hardware port types (USB/Firewire, USB/eSATA, USB/MMC/SD-card, etc.), you # should boot it from the alternative port type and check if your custom rules # work fine in all cases. In the doubt, you should remove the custom rules # file. # d-i bilibop-rules/bilibop_rules_generator/overwrite select keep # Possible choices: keep existing custom rules, rebuild custom rules, remove custom rules ### Description: Options to pass to the bilibop rules generator: # Possible options you can pass to the bilibop rules generator are the # followings: # . # -a vendor,model # -a manufacturer,product,serial # -e ID_VENDOR,ID_MODEL,ID_SERIAL_SHORT # -e ID_SERIAL # . # The two first ones cannot be mixed; for example, '-a model,serial' is not a # valid option; use '-a model -e ID_SERIAL' instead. In the doubt, you should # probably set it to an empty string (defaults to # '-a manufacturer,product,serial'). # d-i bilibop-rules/bilibop_rules_generator/options string ### Description: What kind of GRUB device map do you want to use ? # The '/boot/grub/device.map' file can store obsolete information. In some cases, # this can lead to failures when the GRUB bootloader menu is updated. To avoid # that, it is possible to replace the device map by a fake one, mapping only # the physical drive hosting your system; or by a link to a temporary file, # which may be created either at boot time with a fake content, or on demand # with an updated content. # . # If your external system is embedded on a device able to boot from different # hardware port types (USB/Firewire, USB/eSATA, USB/MMC/SD, etc.), it is not # recommended to use a static device map. The dynamic fake device map should # work in all cases. # d-i bilibop-rules/grub_device_map_manager select keep # Possible choices: the existing one, a static device map (not recommended), a static fake device map, a dynamic fake device map, a dynamically updated device map ### Description: What persistent rules do you want to make unpersistent ? # Some udev rules files can store information about components of the computer # your system is plugged on: # . # /etc/udev/rules.d/70-persistent-cd.rules # /etc/udev/rules.d/70-persistent-net.rules # . # These files are cumulative and can store obsolete information, possibly # leading to unexpected behaviour of your network manager or CD burner # application. It is possible to replace them by symlinks to temporary files # to keep them always up to date. Note that it is possible to do or undo that # at any time by running # . # dpkg-reconfigure bilibop-rules # d-i bilibop-rules/make_unpersistent_rules select keep # Possible choices: keep them in their current state, make unpersistent cd rules only, make unpersistent net rules only, make unpersistent rules for all (recommended), make persistent rules for all ### Description: Do you want to hide Physical Volumes your system does not need ? # It seems that the drive on which your system is installed contains Logical # Volumes. It is possible to set LVM to activate only the Physical Volumes # that your system needs. This can mainly avoid name conflicts between the # Volumes used by your system and those that could be found on internal or # external drives plugged on the same computer. # . # If you choose to use this feature, this will overwrite '/etc/lvm/lvm.conf', # and you should read 'README.Debian' in the documentation of the package. # Otherwise, you can do it later with # . # dpkg-reconfigure -p low bilibop-rules # d-i bilibop-rules/physical_volumes_filter/system-only boolean false ### Description: for internal use only # d-i bilibop-rules/physical_volumes_filter/filter string ### Description: for internal use only # d-i bilibop-rules/physical_volumes_filter/global_filter string ### Description: for internal use only # d-i bilibop-rules/physical_volumes_filter/obtain_device_list_from_udev string ############################ #### bind9_9.9.5.dfsg-9+deb8u15_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: User account for running the BIND9 daemon: # The default is to run the BIND9 daemon (named) under the 'bind' # user account. To use a different account, please enter the # appropriate username. # d-i bind9/start-as-user string bind ### Description: Other startup options for named: # Please provide any additional options (other than username) that should # be passed to the BIND9 daemon (named) on startup. # d-i bind9/different-configuration-file string ### Description: Should resolv.conf settings be overridden? # Please choose whether the resolver should be forced to use the # local BIND9 daemon (named) rather than what the current connection # recommends, when this machine moves around. # d-i bind9/run-resolvconf boolean false ############################ #### bindgraph_0.2a-5.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Should bindgraph start on boot? # Bindgraph can start on boot time as a daemon. Then it will monitor # your BIND logfile for changes. This is recommended. # . # The other method is to call bindgraph.pl by hand with the -l parameter. # d-i bindgraph/start_on_boot boolean true ### Description: Bindgraph log file: # Please specify the name of the log file from which data should be # pulled to create the databases for bindgraph. If unsure, leave the # default value. # d-i bindgraph/logfile string /var/log/bind9-query.log ### Description: Remove RRD files on purge? # Bindgraph keeps its database files under /var/lib/bindgraph. Please choose # whether this directory should be removed completely on purge. # d-i bindgraph/stay_on_purge boolean true ############################ #### biomaj_1.2.3-4_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Configure MySQL connection now? # Once the MySQL database for BioMAJ has been created and configured, it # can populate itself automatically instead of needing to be updated # manually. # . # Please specify whether the database connection should be configured now. # d-i biomaj/mysql boolean ### Description: MySQL server: # Please enter the hostname or IP address of the # MySQL server you want to use. # d-i biomaj/mysql_host string ### Description: MySQL login for BioMAJ database: # Please enter the login to use when connecting to the MySQL database # server to access the biomaj_log database. # d-i biomaj/mysql_login string ### Description: MySQL password for BioMAJ database: # Please enter the password to use when connecting to the MySQL database # server to access the biomaj_log database. # d-i biomaj/mysql_passwd password ############################ #### bitlbee-common_3.2.2-2+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: On what TCP port should BitlBee listen for connections? # BitlBee normally listens on the regular IRC port, 6667. This might not be # a very good idea when you're running a real IRC daemon as well. 6668 might # be a good alternative. Leaving this value blank means that BitlBee will not # be run automatically. # d-i bitlbee/serveport string stillhavetoask ############################ #### boinc-client_7.4.23+dfsg-1+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to remove the BOINC data directory? # The BOINC data directory /var/lib/boinc-client contains the information to # which projects the BOINC core client is attached, the work unit cache and # several other data. If you no longer need this data, this is your chance to # remove them. # . # If no longer have need of the data being stored in the BOINC data directory, # you should choose this option. If you want to hold this data for another # time, or if you would rather handle this process manually, you should refuse # this option. # d-i boinc-client/remove_boinc_dir boolean true ############################ #### bottlerocket_0.05b3-14.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Serial device for bottlerocket to access: # BottleRocket requires the use of a serial device to access the X10 # FireCracker interface. # d-i bottlerocket/x10_port string ttyS0 ############################ #### boxbackup-client_0.11.1~r2837-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should the BoxBackup client be configured automatically? # The package configuration scripts can create the configuration files # for the BoxBackup client. # . # You should choose this option if you are not familiar with BoxBackup's # configuration options. # . # Please read the /usr/share/doc/boxbackup-client/README.Debian for details # about the configuration of the BoxBackup client. # d-i boxbackup-client/debconf boolean false ### Description: Run mode for the BoxBackup client: # The BoxBackup client supports two modes of backup: # . # In the 'lazy' mode, the backup daemon will regularly scan the file system # searching for modified files. It will then upload the files older than a # specified age to the backup server. # . # In the 'snapshot' mode the backup will be explicitly run at regular intervals. # A cron file (/etc/cron.d/boxbackup-client) is provided with the # package and should be adapted to suit your needs. # d-i boxbackup-client/backupMode select # Possible choices: lazy, snapshot ### Description: Account number for this node on the backup server: # The administrator of the BoxBackup server should have assigned this client # a hexadecimal account number. # . # If no account number has been assigned yet, leave this field blank and # configure it later by running 'dpkg-reconfigure boxbackup-client' as root. # d-i boxbackup-client/accountNumber string ### Description: Fully qualified domain name of the backup server: # Please enter the fully qualified domain name of the BoxBackup server which # your client will use. # . # The client will connect to the server on TCP port 2201. # d-i boxbackup-client/backupServer string ### Description: List of directories to backup: # Please give a space-separated list of directories to be backed up onto # the remote server. # . # Those directories should not contain mounted file systems at any level # in their subdirectories. # d-i boxbackup-client/backupDirs string ### Description: Interval (in seconds) between directory scans: # BoxBackup regularly scans the selected directories, looking for modified # files. # . # Please choose the scan interval in seconds. # d-i boxbackup-client/UpdateStoreInterval string 3600 ### Description: Minimum time to wait (in seconds) before uploading a file: # A file will be uploaded to the server only after a certain time after its # last modification. # . # Low interval values will trigger frequent uploads to the server and more # revisions being created with older revisions being removed earlier. # d-i boxbackup-client/MinimumFileAge string 21600 ### Description: Maximum time to wait (in seconds) before uploading a file: # Frequently modified files are likely to never get uploaded if they # never reach the minimum wait time. # . # Please enter the maximum time to reach before the upload of a modified # file to the server is enforced. # d-i boxbackup-client/MaxUploadWait string 86400 ### Description: Recipient for alert notifications: # The BoxBackup client sends alert notifications when a problem occurs # during the backup. # . # Please enter either a local user name (for example 'root') or an email # address (for example 'admin@example.org'). # d-i boxbackup-client/notifyMail string root ### Description: Generate the client private key and X.509 certificate request? # The BoxBackup client needs an RSA private key and the corresponding X.509 # certificate to authenticate itself with the server. # . # Both can be generated automatically. You will need to send the # certificate request to the BoxBackup server administrator who will # sign it and send it back to you along with the server's Certification # Authority certificate. # . # These files should be copied into BoxBackup's configuration # directory. The file names to use are given in the # /etc/boxbackup/bbackupd.conf file. # d-i boxbackup-client/generateCertificate boolean true ############################ #### boxbackup-server_0.11.1~r2837-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should BoxBackup be configured automatically? # The package configuration scripts can create the configuration files # for the BoxBackup server. # . # You should choose this option if you are not familiar with BoxBackup's # configuration options. The configuration can be done manually with the # 'raidfile-config' and 'bbstored-config' scripts. # . # The server will not start if it is not configured. In all cases, # reading the /usr/share/doc/boxbackup-server/README.Debian is # recommended. # d-i boxbackup-server/debconf boolean false ### Description: Location of the RAID directories: # Please choose the location for the three RAID file directories. # . # To enable RAID, the directory names should be a space-separated list of # three partitions, each on different physical hard drives (for example: # '/raid/0.0 /raid/0.1 /raid/0.2'). # . # If you don't want to enable RAID, just specify the path to one directory # where the backups will be stored (for example, /usr/local/lib/boxbackup). # . # These directories will be created if they do not exist. # d-i boxbackup-server/raidDirectories string ### Description: Block size for the userland RAID system: # BoxBackup uses userland RAID techniques. # . # Please choose the block size to use for the storage. # For maximum efficiency, you should choose the block size of the underlying # file system (which can be displayed for ext2 filesystems with the 'tune2fs -l' # command). # . # This value should be set even if you don't plan to use RAID. # d-i boxbackup-server/raidBlockSize string 4096 ### Description: Generate a server private key and X.509 certificate request? # The BoxBackup server needs an RSA private key and the corresponding X.509 # certificate to perform client-server authentication and communication # encryption. # . # Both can be generated automatically. You will need to sign the # certificate with your root CA (see the boxbackup-server package) and # put this signed certificate and the root CA certificate in the # configuration folder. # d-i boxbackup-server/generateCertificate boolean true ############################ #### ibrazilian_3.0~beta4-17_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wbrazilian_3.0~beta4-17_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### byobu_5.87-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Launch Byobu at shell login for all users? # Byobu can be launched automatically on all shell logins (via the console, # SSH, etc.), to provide a screen session manager. # . # If you select this option, a symlink will be created in /etc/profile.d. # This setting is system-wide, for all user logins. Individual users can # opt out by using the utility "byobu-config" or by creating the file # "disable-autolaunch" in their byobu configuration directory. # d-i byobu/launch-by-default boolean false ############################ #### ca-certificates_20141019+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Trust new certificates from certificate authorities? # This package may install new CA (Certificate Authority) certificates when # upgrading. You may want to check such new CA certificates and select only # certificates that you trust. # . # - yes: new CA certificates will be trusted and installed; # - no : new CA certificates will not be installed by default; # - ask: prompt for each new CA certificate. # d-i ca-certificates/trust_new_crts select yes # Possible choices: yes, no, ask ### Description: New certificates to activate: # During upgrades, new certificates will be added. Please choose # those you trust. # d-i ca-certificates/new_crts multiselect # Possible choices: ${new_crts} ### Description: Certificates to activate: # This package installs common CA (Certificate Authority) certificates in # /usr/share/ca-certificates. # . # Please select the certificate authorities you trust so that their # certificates are installed into /etc/ssl/certs. They will be compiled # into a single /etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt file. # d-i ca-certificates/enable_crts multiselect # Possible choices: ${enable_crts} ############################ #### cacti_0.8.8b+dfsg-8+deb8u6_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Web server: # Please select the web server for which Cacti should be automatically # configured. # . # Select "None" if you would like to configure the web server manually. # d-i cacti/webserver select apache2 # Possible choices: apache2, lighttpd, None ############################ #### calamaris_2.99.4.0-19_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Type of proxy log files to analyze: # Calamaris is able to process log files from Squid or Squid3. If you choose # 'auto' it will look first for Squid log files and then for Squid3 log files. # . # Choosing 'auto' is recommended when only one proxy is installed. # Otherwise, the appropriate setting can be enforced here. # d-i calamaris/cache_type select auto # Possible choices: auto, squid, squid3 ### Description: Output method for Calamaris daily analysis reports: # The result of the Calamaris analysis can be sent as an email to a # specified address or stored as a web page. # . # Please choose which of these methods you want to use. # d-i calamaris/daily/task select mail # Possible choices: nothing, mail, web, both ### Description: Recipient for daily analysis reports by mail: # Please choose the address that should receive daily Calamaris # analysis reports. # . # This setting is only needed if the reports are to be sent by email. # d-i calamaris/daily/mail string root ### Description: Directory for storing HTML daily analysis reports: # Please choose the directory where daily Calamaris analysis reports # should be stored. # . # This setting is only needed if the reports are to be generated as # HTML. # d-i calamaris/daily/html string /var/www/calamaris/daily/index.html ### Description: Title of the daily analysis reports: # Please choose the text that will be used as a prefix to the title for # the daily Calamaris analysis reports. # d-i calamaris/daily/title string Squid daily ### Description: Output method for Calamaris weekly analysis reports: # The result of the Calamaris analysis can be sent as an email to a # specified address or stored as a web page. # . # Please choose which of these methods you want to use. # d-i calamaris/weekly/task select mail # Possible choices: nothing, mail, web, both ### Description: Recipient for weekly analysis reports by mail: # Please choose the address that should receive weekly Calamaris # analysis reports. # . # This setting is only needed if the reports are to be sent by email. # d-i calamaris/weekly/mail string root ### Description: Directory for storing HTML weekly analysis reports: # Please choose the directory where weekly Calamaris analysis reports # should be stored. # . # This setting is only needed if the reports are to be generated as # HTML. # d-i calamaris/weekly/html string /var/www/calamaris/weekly/index.html ### Description: Title of the weekly analysis reports: # Please choose the text that will be used as a prefix to the title for # the weekly Calamaris analysis reports. # d-i calamaris/weekly/title string Squid weekly ### Description: Output method for Calamaris monthly analysis reports: # The result of the Calamaris analysis can be sent as an email to a # specified address or stored as a web page. # . # Please choose which of these methods you want to use. # d-i calamaris/monthly/task select mail # Possible choices: nothing, mail, web, both ### Description: Recipient for monthly analysis reports by mail: # Please choose the address that should receive monthly Calamaris # analysis reports. # . # This setting is only needed if the reports are to be sent by email. # d-i calamaris/monthly/mail string root ### Description: Directory for storing HTML monthly analysis reports: # Please choose the directory where monthly Calamaris analysis reports # should be stored. # . # This setting is only needed if the reports are to be generated as # HTML. # d-i calamaris/monthly/html string /var/www/calamaris/monthly/index.html ### Description: Title of the monthly analysis reports: # Please choose the text that will be used as a prefix to the title for # the monthly Calamaris analysis reports. # d-i calamaris/monthly/title string Squid monthly ### Description: Names of proxy log files to analyze: # Calamaris is supposed to run before the logrotation of the Squid logfiles. # If you want to let it run right after the logrotation of Squid (e.g. by # adding Calamaris to /etc/logrotate.d/squid), you should change this entry # to access.log.1. # d-i calamaris/cache_file string access.log ############################ #### canna_3.7p3-13_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should the Canna server run automatically? # This package contains the Canna server and server-related # utilities. If you are only interested in these utilities, # you can disable the Canna server now. # d-i canna/run_cannaserver boolean true ### Description: Should the Canna server run in network mode? # By default the Canna server will run without support for network # connections, and will only accept connections on UNIX domain sockets, # from clients running on the same host. # . # If you choose this option, network support will be activated, and the # Canna server will accept connections on TCP sockets from clients that # may be on remote hosts. Some clients (such as egg and yc-el) require # this mode even if they run on the local host. # d-i canna/run_with_inet boolean false ### Description: Manage /etc/hosts.canna automatically? # The /etc/hosts.canna file lists hosts allowed to connect to the # Canna server. # . # You should not accept this option if you prefer managing the # file's contents manually. # d-i canna/manage_allow_hosts_with_debconf boolean true ### Description: Hosts allowed to connect to this Canna server: # Please enter the names of the hosts allowed to connect to this Canna server, # separated by spaces. # . # You can use "unix" to allow access via UNIX domain sockets. # d-i canna/allow_hosts string unix localhost ############################ #### libcanna1g_3.7p3-13_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Canna input style: # Please choose the default Canna input style: # verbose: Canna3.5 default style with verbose comments; # 1.1 : old Canna style (ver. 1.1); # 1.2 : old Canna style (ver. 1.2); # jdaemon: jdaemon style; # just : JustSystems ATOK style; # lan5 : LAN5 style; # matsu : Matsu word processor style; # skk : SKK style; # tut : TUT-Code style; # unix : UNIX style; # vje : vje style; # wx2+ : WX2+ style. # d-i canna/default_style select verbose # Possible choices: verbose, 1.1, 1.2, jdaemin, just, lan5, matsu, skk, tut, unix, vje, wx2+ ############################ #### cdebconf_0.192_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Interface to use: # Packages that use debconf for configuration share a common look and feel. # You can select the type of user interface they use. # . # ${descriptions} # d-i cdebconf/frontend select # Possible choices: ${echoices} ### Description: None # 'None' will never ask you any question. # d-i cdebconf/frontend/none string ### Description: Text # 'Text' is a traditional plain text interface. # d-i cdebconf/frontend/text string ### Description: Newt # 'Newt' is a full-screen, character based interface. # d-i cdebconf/frontend/newt string ### Description: GTK # 'GTK' is a graphical interface that may be used in any graphical environment. # d-i cdebconf/frontend/gtk string ############################ #### cdebconf-gtk_0.192_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### ceilometer-api_2014.1.3-6_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Register Ceilometer in the Keystone endpoint catalog? # Each OpenStack service (each API) should be registered in order to be # accessible. This is done using "keystone service-create" and "keystone # endpoint-create". This can be done automatically now. # . # Note that you will need to have an up and running Keystone server on which to # connect using the Keystone authentication token. # d-i ceilometer/register-endpoint boolean false ### Description: Keystone server IP address: # Please enter the IP address of the Keystone server, so that ceilometer-api can # contact Keystone to do the Ceilometer service and endpoint creation. # d-i ceilometer/keystone-ip string ### Description: Keystone authentication token: # To configure its endpoint in Keystone, ceilometer-api needs the Keystone # authentication token. # d-i ceilometer/keystone-auth-token password ### Description: Ceilometer endpoint IP address: # Please enter the IP address that will be used to contact Ceilometer. # . # This IP address should be accessible from the clients that will use this # service, so if you are installing a public cloud, this should be a public # IP address. # d-i ceilometer/endpoint-ip string ### Description: Name of the region to register: # OpenStack supports using availability zones, with each region representing # a location. Please enter the zone that you wish to use when registering the # endpoint. # d-i ceilometer/region-name string regionOne ############################ #### ceilometer-common_2014.1.3-6_all.deb ############################ ### Description: IP address of your RabbitMQ host: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the IP address of that server. # d-i ceilometer/rabbit_host string localhost ### Description: Username for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the username used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i ceilometer/rabbit_userid string guest ### Description: Password for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the password used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i ceilometer/rabbit_password password ### Description: Authentication server hostname: # Please specify the hostname of the authentication server for Ceilometer. # Typically this is also the hostname of the OpenStack Identity Service # (Keystone). # d-i ceilometer/auth-host string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Authentication server tenant name: # Please specify the authentication server tenant name. # d-i ceilometer/admin-tenant-name string admin ### Description: Authentication server username: # Please specify the username to use with the authentication server. # d-i ceilometer/admin-user string admin ### Description: Authentication server password: # Please specify the password to use with the authentication server. # d-i ceilometer/admin-password password ############################ #### pawserv_20061220+dfsg3-4.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Servers to be run from inetd: # This package includes both the pawserv daemon (permitting remote hosts to # read local files while running PAW/Paw++) and the zserv daemon (allowing # remote hosts to log in using CERN's ZFTP protocol). # . # These servers are run from the inetd superserver and either both or # only one of them may be enabled. Enabling 'pawserv' alone is # sufficient for most users. # d-i pawserv/which_servers select Pawserv # Possible choices: Pawserv, Zserv, Both ############################ #### cfengine2_2.2.10-5+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Start cfexecd at boot-time? # cfexecd is a scheduler that periodically runs cfagent, the program that # actually does the work. # . # If you invoke cfagent by hand or choose to run it from cron instead, you # may not require this. # d-i cfengine2/run_cfexecd boolean false ### Description: Start cfservd at boot-time? # cfservd manages file-serving to remote cfagent processes. # . # It also provides a facility for remote hosts (after authenticating) to ask # cfservd to run cfagent. # d-i cfengine2/run_cfservd boolean false ### Description: Start cfenvd at boot-time? # cfenvd monitors the system environment (disk usage, run queue length etc.) # and notes the mean and standard deviation for each. # . # Information gathered here is easily available to cfagent, and can be # output using cfenvgraph. # d-i cfengine2/run_cfenvd boolean false ############################ #### checksecurity_2.0.15_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### chef_11.12.8-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: URL of Chef server # Please choose the full URI that clients will use to connect to the # server (for instance: http://chef.example.com:4000). # . # This setting will be stored in /etc/chef/client.rb as # "chef_server_url". # d-i chef/chef_server_url string ############################ #### chemical-structures_2.2.dfsg.0-12_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Should apache2 be restarted? # In order to activate the new configuration, apache2 has # to be restarted. You can also restart apache2 by manually executing # 'invoke-rc.d apache2 restart'. # d-i chemical-structures/restart-webserver boolean false ############################ #### chkrootkit_0.50-3.2~deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should chkrootkit be run automatically every day? # The chkrootkit program can be run automatically via a daily cron job. If you # choose this option, you'll also be given the opportunity to # specify options for the daily run. # d-i chkrootkit/run_daily boolean false ### Description: Arguments to use with chkrootkit in the daily run: # The following are useful arguments to pass to chkrookit: # -r : use an alternate root directory; # -n : do not attempt to analyze NFS-mounted files; # -q : run in quiet mode [highly recommended]. # d-i chkrootkit/run_daily_opts string -q ### Description: Only report problems if they differ from previous day's problems? # If you choose this option, chkrootkit will # only report problems when they differ from the previous day's run. # . # Using this option is not recommended as it is likely to hide existing # security problems. # d-i chkrootkit/diff_mode boolean false ############################ #### cinder-api_2014.1.3-11+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Register Cinder in the Keystone endpoint catalog? # Each OpenStack service (each API) should be registered in order to be # accessible. This is done using "keystone service-create" and "keystone # endpoint-create". This can be done automatically now. # . # Note that you will need to have an up and running Keystone server on which to # connect using the Keystone authentication token. # d-i cinder/register-endpoint boolean false ### Description: Keystone server IP address: # Please enter the IP address of the Keystone server, so that cinder-api can # contact Keystone to do the Cinder service and endpoint creation. # d-i cinder/keystone-ip string ### Description: Keystone authentication token: # To configure its endpoint in Keystone, cinder-api needs the Keystone # authentication token. # d-i cinder/keystone-auth-token password ### Description: Cinder endpoint IP address: # Please enter the IP address that will be used to contact Cinder. # . # This IP address should be accessible from the clients that will use this # service, so if you are installing a public cloud, this should be a public # IP address. # d-i cinder/endpoint-ip string ### Description: Name of the region to register: # OpenStack supports using availability zones, with each region representing # a location. Please enter the zone that you wish to use when registering the # endpoint. # d-i cinder/region-name string regionOne ############################ #### cinder-common_2014.1.3-11+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Set up a database for Cinder? # No database has been set up for Cinder to use. Before # continuing, you should make sure you have the following information: # . # * the type of database that you want to use; # * the database server hostname (that server must allow TCP connections from this # machine); # * a username and password to access the database. # . # If some of these requirements are missing, do not choose this option and run with # regular SQLite support. # . # You can change this setting later on by running "dpkg-reconfigure -plow # cinder". # d-i cinder/configure_db boolean false ### Description: Authentication server hostname: # Please specify the hostname of the authentication server. Typically # this is also the hostname of the OpenStack Identity Service (Keystone). # d-i cinder/auth-host string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Authentication server tenant name: # Please specify the authentication server tenant name. # d-i cinder/admin-tenant-name string admin ### Description: Authentication server username: # Please specify the username to use with the authentication server. # d-i cinder/admin-user string admin ### Description: Authentication server password: # Please specify the password to use with the authentication server. # d-i cinder/admin-password password ### Description: Cinder volume group: # Please specify the name of the LVM volume group on which Cinder # will create partitions. # d-i cinder/volume_group string ### Description: IP address of your RabbitMQ host: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the IP address of that server. # d-i cinder/rabbit_host string localhost ### Description: Username for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the username used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i cinder/rabbit_userid string guest ### Description: Password for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the password used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i cinder/rabbit_password password ############################ #### circuslinux_1.0.3-31_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Merge score files? # Do you want me to run the merge_scorefile script for you? # d-i circuslinux/merge_score_files boolean ### Description: Scorefile exists # A merged scorefile in /var/games/circuslinux already exists! # d-i circuslinux/score_file_exists boolean ############################ #### citadel-server_8.24-1+b3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Listening address for the Citadel server: # Please specify the IP address which the server should be listening to. If you # specify 0.0.0.0, the server will listen on all addresses. # . # This can usually be left to the default unless multiple instances # of Citadel are running on the same computer. # d-i citadel/ServerIPAddress string 0.0.0.0 ### Description: Authentication method to use: # Please choose the user authentication mode. By default Citadel will use its # own internal user accounts database. If you choose "Host", Citadel users # will have accounts on the host system, authenticated via /etc/passwd or a # PAM source. "LDAP" means an RFC 2307 compliant directory server; "Active # Directory" means the nonstandard Microsoft Active Directory LDAP scheme. # . # Do not change this option unless you are sure it is required, since # changing back requires a full reinstall of Citadel. # d-i citadel/LoginType select Internal # Possible choices: Internal, Host, LDAP, Active Directory ### Description: LDAP host: # Please enter host name or IP address of your LDAP server. # d-i citadel/LDAPServer string 0.0.0.0 ### Description: LDAP port number: # Please enter the port number of your LDAP service (usually 389). # d-i citadel/LDAPServerPort string 389 ### Description: LDAP base DN: # Please enter the Base DN to search for authentication # (for example: dc=example,dc=com). # d-i citadel/LDAPBaseDN string dc=example,dc=com ### Description: LDAP bind DN: # Please enter the DN of an account to use for binding to the LDAP server # for performing queries. The account does not require any other # privileges. If your LDAP server allows anonymous queries, you can # leave this blank. # d-i citadel/LDAPBindDN string ### Description: LDAP bind password: # If you entered a Bind DN in the previous question, you must now enter # the password associated with that account. Otherwise, you can leave this # blank. # d-i citadel/LDAPBindDNPassword string OpenSesame ### Description: Citadel administrator username: # Please enter the name of the Citadel user account that should be granted # administrative privileges once created. # If using internal authentication this user account will be created if it does # not exist. For external authentication this user account has to exist. # d-i citadel/Administrator string admin ### Description: Administrator password: # While not mandatory, it is highly recommended that you set a password # for the administrator user. # d-i citadel/Password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same administrator password again to verify that you have # typed it correctly. # d-i citadel/Password_again password ############################ #### ckermit_302-5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable Internet Kermit Service Daemon (IKSD) in inetd.conf? # The Internet Kermit Service Daemon (IKSD) is the C-Kermit program running # as an Internet service, similar to an FTP or Telnet server. It executes # Telnet protocol just like a Telnet server and it transfers files like an # FTP server. But unlike an FTP server, IKSD uses the Kermit file transfer # protocol (which is more powerful and flexible) and allows both FTP-like # client/server connections as well as direct keyboard interaction. Secure # authentication methods and encrypted sessions are available, as well as a # wide range of file transfer and management functions, which can be # scripted to automate arbitrarily complex tasks. # d-i ckermit/iksd boolean false ### Description: Enable anonymous IKSD logins? # IKSD supports anonymous logins (using chroot), similar to anonymous FTP. # d-i ckermit/iksd-anon boolean false ### Description: Directory for anonymous IKSD logins: # Enter directory for anonymous IKSD logins. A chroot() will be performed # into this directory on login. This directory will NOT be created. # . # The default is /home/ftp (same as wu-ftpd). # d-i ckermit/iksd-anondir string /home/ftp ############################ #### clamav-base_0.100.0+dfsg-0+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### clamav-daemon_0.100.0+dfsg-0+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Handle the configuration file automatically? # Some options must be configured for clamav-daemon. # . # The ClamAV suite won't work if it isn't configured. If you do not # configure it automatically, you'll have to configure # /etc/clamav/clamd.conf manually or run 'dpkg-reconfigure clamav-daemon' # later. In any case, manual changes in /etc/clamav/clamd.conf will # be respected. # d-i clamav-daemon/debconf boolean true ### Description: Socket type: # Please choose the type of socket clamd will be listening on. # . # If you choose TCP, clamd can be accessed remotely. If you choose local # UNIX sockets, clamd can be accessed through a file. Local UNIX sockets # are recommended for security reasons. # d-i clamav-daemon/TcpOrLocal select UNIX # Possible choices: TCP, UNIX ### Description: Local (UNIX) socket clamd will listen on: # d-i clamav-daemon/LocalSocket string /var/run/clamav/clamd.ctl ### Description: Gracefully handle left-over UNIX socket files? # d-i clamav-daemon/FixStaleSocket boolean true ### Description: Group owner of clamd local (UNIX) socket: # d-i clamav-daemon/LocalSocketGroup string clamav ### Description: Creation mode for clamd local (UNIX) socket: # d-i clamav-daemon/LocalSocketMode string 666 ### Description: TCP port clamd will listen on: # d-i clamav-daemon/TCPSocket string 3310 ### Description: IP address clamd will listen on: # Enter "any" to listen on every IP address configured. If you want # to listen on a single address or host name, enter it here. # d-i clamav-daemon/TCPAddr string any ### Description: Do you want to enable mail scanning? # This option enables scanning mail contents for viruses. # You need this option enabled if you want to use clamav-milter, or if # you want to enable phishing checks. # d-i clamav-daemon/ScanMail boolean true ### Description: Do you want to enable archive scanning? # If archive scanning is enabled, the daemon will extract archives such as # bz2, tar.gz, deb and many more, to check their contents for viruses. # . # For more information about what archives are supported, see # /usr/share/doc/clamav-docs/clamdoc.pdf or the manpage clamscan(5). # d-i clamav-daemon/ScanArchive boolean true ### Description: Maximum stream length (unit Mb) allowed: # You can set a limit on the stream length that can be scanned. # d-i clamav-daemon/StreamMaxLength string 25 ### Description: Maximum directory depth that will be allowed: # This value must be set if you want to allow the daemon to follow # directory symlinks. # . # Entering '0' will disable this limit. # d-i clamav-daemon/MaxDirectoryRecursion string 0 ### Description: Do you want the daemon to follow directory symlinks? # d-i clamav-daemon/FollowDirectorySymlinks boolean false ### Description: Do you want the daemon to follow regular file symlinks? # d-i clamav-daemon/FollowFileSymlinks boolean false ### Description: Timeout for stopping the thread-scanner (seconds): # Entering '0' will disable the timeout. # d-i clamav-daemon/ReadTimeout string 180 ### Description: Number of threads for the daemon: # d-i clamav-daemon/MaxThreads string 12 ### Description: Number of pending connections allowed: # d-i clamav-daemon/MaxConnectionQueueLength string 15 ### Description: Do you want to use the system logger? # It is possible to log the daemon activity to the system logger. This can be # done independently of whether you want to log activity to a special file. # d-i clamav-daemon/LogSyslog boolean false ### Description: Log file for clamav-daemon (enter none to disable): # d-i clamav-daemon/LogFile string /var/log/clamav/clamav.log ### Description: Do you want to log time information with each message? # d-i clamav-daemon/LogTime boolean true ### Description: Do you want to enable log rotation? # d-i clamav-daemon/LogRotate boolean true ### Description: Do you want to enable on-access scanning? # d-i clamav-daemon/ScanOnAccess boolean false ### Description: Maximum file size to scan: # A value of 0 disables the limit. # d-i clamav-daemon/OnAccessMaxFileSize string 5M ### Description: Do you want to permit the use of the ALLMATCHSCAN command? # If set to no, clamd will reject any ALLMATCHSCAN command as invalid. # d-i clamav-daemon/AllowAllMatchScan boolean true ### Description: Do you want memory or nested map scans to dump the content to disk? # If you turn on this option, more data is written to disk and is available # when the LeaveTemporaryFiles option is enabled. # d-i clamav-daemon/ForceToDisk boolean false ### Description: Do you want to completely turn off authenticode verification? # Certain PE files contain an authenticode signature. By default the signature # chain in the PE file is checked against a database of trusted and # revoked certificates if the file being scanned is marked as a virus. # If any certificate in the chain validates against any trusted root, but # does not match any revoked certificate, the file is marked as whitelisted. # If the file does match a revoked certificate, the file is marked as virus. # d-i clamav-daemon/DisableCertCheck boolean false ### Description: Do you want to enable scanning within SWF files? # If you turn off this option, the original files will still be scanned, but # without decoding and additional processing. # d-i clamav-daemon/ScanSWF boolean true ### Description: Maximum size of a file to check for embedded PE: # Files larger than this value will skip the additional analysis step. # Note: disabling this limit or setting it too high may result in severe damage # to the system. # d-i clamav-daemon/MaxEmbeddedPE string 10M ### Description: Maximum size of a HTML file to normalize: # HTML files larger than this value will not be normalized or scanned. # Note: disabling this limit or setting it too high may result in severe damage # to the system. # d-i clamav-daemon/MaxHTMLNormalize string 10M ### Description: Maximum size of a normalized HTML file to scan: # HTML files larger than this value after normalization will not be scanned. # Note: disabling this limit or setting it too high may result in severe damage # to the system. # d-i clamav-daemon/MaxHTMLNoTags string 2M ### Description: Maximum size of a script file to normalize: # Script content larger than this value will not be normalized or scanned. # Note: disabling this limit or setting it too high may result in severe damage # to the system. # d-i clamav-daemon/MaxScriptNormalize string 5M ### Description: Maximum size of a ZIP file to reanalyze type recognition: # ZIP files larger than this value will skip the step to potentially reanalyze as PE. # Note: disabling this limit or setting it too high may result in severe damage # to the system. # d-i clamav-daemon/MaxZipTypeRcg string 1M ### Description: Delay in seconds between daemon self checks: # During the SelfCheck the daemon checks if it needs to reload the virus # database. It also tries to repair problems caused by bugs in the daemon, # (that is, in some cases it's able to repair broken data structures). # d-i clamav-daemon/SelfCheck string 3600 ### Description: User to run clamav-daemon as: # It is recommended to run the ClamAV programs as a non-privileged user. # This will work with most MTAs with a little tweaking, but if you want to # use clamd for filesystem scans, running as root is probably unavoidable. # Please see README.Debian in the clamav-base package for details. # d-i clamav-daemon/User string clamav ### Description: Groups for clamav-daemon (space-separated): # Please enter any extra groups for clamd. # . # By default, clamd runs as a non-privileged user. If you need clamd to # be able to access files owned by another user (e.g., in combination with # an MTA), then you will need to add clamd to the group for that piece of # software. Please see README.Debian in the clamav-base package for details. # d-i clamav-daemon/AddGroups string ### Description: Do you want to load bytecode from the database? # d-i clamav-daemon/Bytecode boolean true ### Description: Security level to apply to the bytecode: # . # - TrustSigned : trust bytecode loaded from signed virus database files, # but insert runtime safety checks for bytecode loaded # from unsigned sources # - Paranoid : always insert runtime checks # d-i clamav-daemon/BytecodeSecurity select TrustSigned # Possible choices: TrustSigned, Paranoid ### Description: Bytecode execution timeout in milliseconds: # d-i clamav-daemon/BytecodeTimeout string 60000 ############################ #### clamav-freshclam_0.100.0+dfsg-0+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Virus database update method: # Please choose the method for virus database updates. # . # daemon: freshclam is running as a daemon all the time. You should choose # this option if you have a permanent network connection; # ifup.d: freshclam will be running as a daemon as long as your Internet # connection is up. Choose this one if you use a dialup Internet # connection and don't want freshclam to initiate new connections; # cron: freshclam is started from cron. Choose this if you want full control # of when the database is updated; # manual: no automatic invocation of freshclam. This is not recommended, # as ClamAV's database is constantly updated. # d-i clamav-freshclam/autoupdate_freshclam select daemon # Possible choices: daemon, ifup.d, cron, manual ### Description: Local database mirror site: # Please select the closest local mirror site. # . # Freshclam updates its database from a world wide network of mirror # sites. Please select the closest mirror. If you leave # the default setting, an attempt will be made to guess a # nearby mirror. # d-i clamav-freshclam/local_mirror select db.local.clamav.net # Possible choices: db.local.clamav.net, db.ac.clamav.net (Ascension Island), db.ad.clamav.net (Andorra), db.ae.clamav.net (United Arab Emirates), db.af.clamav.net (Afghanistan), db.ag.clamav.net (Antigua and Barbuda), db.ai.clamav.net (Anguilla), db.al.clamav.net (Albania), db.am.clamav.net (Armenia), db.an.clamav.net (Netherlands Antilles), db.ao.clamav.net (Angola), db.aq.clamav.net (Antarctica), db.ar.clamav.net (Argentina), db.as.clamav.net (American Samoa), db.at.clamav.net (Austria), db.au.clamav.net (Australia), db.aw.clamav.net (Aruba), db.ax.clamav.net (Aland Islands), db.az.clamav.net (Azerbaijan), db.ba.clamav.net (Bosnia and Herzegovina), db.bb.clamav.net (Barbados), db.bd.clamav.net (Bangladesh), db.be.clamav.net (Belgium), db.bf.clamav.net (Burkina Faso), db.bg.clamav.net (Bulgaria), db.bh.clamav.net (Bahrain), db.bi.clamav.net (Burundi), db.bj.clamav.net (Benin), db.bm.clamav.net (Bermuda), db.bn.clamav.net (Brunei Darussalam), db.bo.clamav.net (Bolivia), db.br.clamav.net (Brazil), db.bs.clamav.net (Bahamas), db.bt.clamav.net (Bhutan), db.bv.clamav.net (Bouvet Island), db.bw.clamav.net (Botswana), db.by.clamav.net (Belarus), db.bz.clamav.net (Belize), db.ca.clamav.net (Canada), db.cc.clamav.net (Cocos (Keeling) Islands), db.cd.clamav.net (Congo The Democratic Republic of the), db.cf.clamav.net (Central African Republic), db.cg.clamav.net (Congo Republic of), db.ch.clamav.net (Switzerland), db.ci.clamav.net (Cote d'Ivoire), db.ck.clamav.net (Cook Islands), db.cl.clamav.net (Chile), db.cm.clamav.net (Cameroon), db.cn.clamav.net (China), db.co.clamav.net (Colombia), db.cr.clamav.net (Costa Rica), db.cs.clamav.net (Serbia and Montenegro), db.cu.clamav.net (Cuba), db.cv.clamav.net (Cape Verde), db.cx.clamav.net (Christmas Island), db.cy.clamav.net (Cyprus), db.cz.clamav.net (Czech Republic), db.de.clamav.net (Germany), db.dj.clamav.net (Djibouti), db.dk.clamav.net (Denmark), db.dm.clamav.net (Dominica), db.do.clamav.net (Dominican Republic), db.dz.clamav.net (Algeria), db.ec.clamav.net (Ecuador), db.ee.clamav.net (Estonia), db.eg.clamav.net (Egypt), db.eh.clamav.net (Western Sahara), db.er.clamav.net (Eritrea), db.es.clamav.net (Spain), db.et.clamav.net (Ethiopia), db.fi.clamav.net (Finland), db.fj.clamav.net (Fiji), db.fk.clamav.net (Falkland Islands (Malvinas)), db.fm.clamav.net (Micronesia Federal State of), db.fo.clamav.net (Faroe Islands), db.fr.clamav.net (France), db.ga.clamav.net (Gabon), db.gb.clamav.net (United Kingdom), db.gd.clamav.net (Grenada), db.ge.clamav.net (Georgia), db.gf.clamav.net (French Guiana), db.gg.clamav.net (Guernsey), db.gh.clamav.net (Ghana), db.gi.clamav.net (Gibraltar), db.gl.clamav.net (Greenland), db.gm.clamav.net (Gambia), db.gn.clamav.net (Guinea), db.gp.clamav.net (Guadeloupe), db.gq.clamav.net (Equatorial Guinea), db.gr.clamav.net (Greece), db.gs.clamav.net (South Georgia and the South Sandwich Islands), db.gt.clamav.net (Guatemala), db.gu.clamav.net (Guam), db.gw.clamav.net (Guinea-Bissau), db.gy.clamav.net (Guyana), db.hk.clamav.net (Hong Kong), db.hm.clamav.net (Heard and McDonald Islands), db.hn.clamav.net (Honduras), db.hr.clamav.net (Croatia/Hrvatska), db.ht.clamav.net (Haiti), db.hu.clamav.net (Hungary), db.id.clamav.net (Indonesia), db.ie.clamav.net (Ireland), db.il.clamav.net (Israel), db.im.clamav.net (Isle of Man), db.in.clamav.net (India), db.io.clamav.net (British Indian Ocean Territory), db.iq.clamav.net (Iraq), db.ir.clamav.net (Iran Islamic Republic of), db.is.clamav.net (Iceland), db.it.clamav.net (Italy), db.je.clamav.net (Jersey), db.jm.clamav.net (Jamaica), db.jo.clamav.net (Jordan), db.jp.clamav.net (Japan), db.ke.clamav.net (Kenya), db.kg.clamav.net (Kyrgyzstan), db.kh.clamav.net (Cambodia), db.ki.clamav.net (Kiribati), db.km.clamav.net (Comoros), db.kn.clamav.net (Saint Kitts and Nevis), db.kp.clamav.net (Korea Democratic People's Republic), db.kr.clamav.net (Korea Republic of), db.kw.clamav.net (Kuwait), db.ky.clamav.net (Cayman Islands), db.kz.clamav.net (Kazakhstan), db.la.clamav.net (Lao People's Democratic Republic), db.lb.clamav.net (Lebanon), db.lc.clamav.net (Saint Lucia), db.li.clamav.net (Liechtenstein), db.lk.clamav.net (Sri Lanka), db.lr.clamav.net (Liberia), db.ls.clamav.net (Lesotho), db.lt.clamav.net (Lithuania), db.lu.clamav.net (Luxembourg), db.lv.clamav.net (Latvia), db.ly.clamav.net (Libyan Arab Jamahiriya), db.ma.clamav.net (Morocco), db.mc.clamav.net (Monaco), db.md.clamav.net (Moldova Republic of), db.mg.clamav.net (Madagascar), db.mh.clamav.net (Marshall Islands), db.mk.clamav.net (Macedonia The Former Yugoslav Republic of), db.ml.clamav.net (Mali), db.mm.clamav.net (Myanmar), db.mn.clamav.net (Mongolia), db.mo.clamav.net (Macau), db.mp.clamav.net (Northern Mariana Islands), db.mq.clamav.net (Martinique), db.mr.clamav.net (Mauritania), db.ms.clamav.net (Montserrat), db.mt.clamav.net (Malta), db.mu.clamav.net (Mauritius), db.mv.clamav.net (Maldives), db.mw.clamav.net (Malawi), db.mx.clamav.net (Mexico), db.my.clamav.net (Malaysia), db.mz.clamav.net (Mozambique), db.na.clamav.net (Namibia), db.nc.clamav.net (New Caledonia), db.ne.clamav.net (Niger), db.nf.clamav.net (Norfolk Island), db.ng.clamav.net (Nigeria), db.ni.clamav.net (Nicaragua), db.nl.clamav.net (Netherlands), db.no.clamav.net (Norway), db.np.clamav.net (Nepal), db.nr.clamav.net (Nauru), db.nu.clamav.net (Niue), db.nz.clamav.net (New Zealand), db.om.clamav.net (Oman), db.pa.clamav.net (Panama), db.pe.clamav.net (Peru), db.pf.clamav.net (French Polynesia), db.pg.clamav.net (Papua New Guinea), db.ph.clamav.net (Philippines), db.pk.clamav.net (Pakistan), db.pl.clamav.net (Poland), db.pm.clamav.net (Saint Pierre and Miquelon), db.pn.clamav.net (Pitcairn Island), db.pr.clamav.net (Puerto Rico), db.ps.clamav.net (Palestinian Territory Occupied), db.pt.clamav.net (Portugal), db.pw.clamav.net (Palau), db.py.clamav.net (Paraguay), db.qa.clamav.net (Qatar), db.re.clamav.net (Reunion Island), db.ro.clamav.net (Romania), db.ru.clamav.net (Russian Federation), db.rw.clamav.net (Rwanda), db.sa.clamav.net (Saudi Arabia), db.sb.clamav.net (Solomon Islands), db.sc.clamav.net (Seychelles), db.sd.clamav.net (Sudan), db.se.clamav.net (Sweden), db.sg.clamav.net (Singapore), db.sh.clamav.net (Saint Helena), db.si.clamav.net (Slovenia), db.sj.clamav.net (Svalbard and Jan Mayen Islands), db.sk.clamav.net (Slovak Republic), db.sl.clamav.net (Sierra Leone), db.sm.clamav.net (San Marino), db.sn.clamav.net (Senegal), db.so.clamav.net (Somalia), db.sr.clamav.net (Suriname), db.st.clamav.net (Sao Tome and Principe), db.sv.clamav.net (El Salvador), db.sy.clamav.net (Syrian Arab Republic), db.sz.clamav.net (Swaziland), db.tc.clamav.net (Turks and Caicos Islands), db.td.clamav.net (Chad), db.tf.clamav.net (French Southern Territories), db.tg.clamav.net (Togo), db.th.clamav.net (Thailand), db.tj.clamav.net (Tajikistan), db.tk.clamav.net (Tokelau), db.tl.clamav.net (Timor-Leste), db.tm.clamav.net (Turkmenistan), db.tn.clamav.net (Tunisia), db.to.clamav.net (Tonga), db.tp.clamav.net (East Timor), db.tr.clamav.net (Turkey), db.tt.clamav.net (Trinidad and Tobago), db.tv.clamav.net (Tuvalu), db.tw.clamav.net (Taiwan), db.tz.clamav.net (Tanzania), db.ua.clamav.net (Ukraine), db.ug.clamav.net (Uganda), db.uk.clamav.net (United Kingdom), db.um.clamav.net (United States Minor Outlying Islands), db.us.clamav.net (United States), db.uy.clamav.net (Uruguay), db.uz.clamav.net (Uzbekistan), db.va.clamav.net (Holy See (Vatican City State)), db.vc.clamav.net (Saint Vincent and the Grenadines), db.ve.clamav.net (Venezuela), db.vg.clamav.net (Virgin Islands British), db.vi.clamav.net (Virgin Islands U.S.), db.vn.clamav.net (Vietnam), db.vu.clamav.net (Vanuatu), db.wf.clamav.net (Wallis and Futuna Islands), db.ws.clamav.net (Western Samoa), db.ye.clamav.net (Yemen), db.yt.clamav.net (Mayotte), db.yu.clamav.net (Yugoslavia), db.za.clamav.net (South Africa), db.zm.clamav.net (Zambia), db.zw.clamav.net (Zimbabwe), db.ipv6.clamav.net (IPv6 mirror) ### Description: HTTP proxy information (leave blank for none): # If you need to use an HTTP proxy to access the outside world, enter the # proxy information here. Otherwise, leave this blank. # . # Please use URL syntax ("http://host[:port]") here. # d-i clamav-freshclam/http_proxy string ### Description: Proxy user information (leave blank for none): # If you need to supply a username and password to the proxy, enter it here. # Otherwise, leave this blank. # . # When entering user information, use the standard form of # "user:pass". # d-i clamav-freshclam/proxy_user string ### Description: Number of freshclam updates per day: # d-i clamav-freshclam/update_interval string 24 ### Description: Network interface connected to the Internet: # Please enter the name of the network interface connected to the Internet. # Example: eth0. # . # If the daemon runs when the network is down, the log file will be filled # with entries like 'ERROR: Connection with database.clamav.net failed.', # making it easy to miss when freshclam really can't update the database. # . # You can leave this field blank and the daemon will be started from # the initialization scripts instead. You should then make sure the computer is # permanently connected to the Internet to avoid filling the log files. # . # If the computer has multiple network interfaces connecting to the Internet use # a space-separated list of device names. # d-i clamav-freshclam/internet_interface string ### Description: Should clamd be notified after updates? # Please confirm whether clamd should be notified to reload the database after # successful updates. # . # If you do not choose this option, clamd's database reloads will be notably # delayed (it performs this check every 6 hours by default), posing the risk # that a new virus may slip through even if the database is up to date. # Do not use this if you do not use clamd, as it will produce errors. # d-i clamav-freshclam/NotifyClamd boolean true ### Description: Do you want to enable support for Google Safe Browsing? # When activated for the first time, freshclam will download a new database # file (safebrowsing.cvd) which will be automatically loaded by clamd and # clamscan during the next reload, provided that the heuristic phishing # detection is turned on. This database includes information about websites # that may be phishing sites or possible sources of malware. When using this # option, it's mandatory to run freshclam at least every 30 minutes. # Freshclam uses the ClamAV's mirror infrastructure to distribute the # database and its updates but all the contents are provided under Google's # terms of use. # d-i clamav-freshclam/SafeBrowsing boolean false ### Description: Do you want to download the bytecode database? # d-i clamav-freshclam/Bytecode boolean true ### Description: Private mirror for freshclam: # This option allows you to easily point freshclam to private mirrors. # If PrivateMirror is set, freshclam does not attempt to use DNS # to determine whether its databases are out-of-date, instead it will # use the If-Modified-Since request or directly check the headers of the # remote database files. For each database, freshclam first attempts # to download the CLD file. If that fails, it tries to download the # CVD file. This option overrides DatabaseMirror, DNSDatabaseInfo # and ScriptedUpdates. It can be used multiple times to provide # fall-back mirrors. # d-i clamav-freshclam/PrivateMirror string ### Description: Do you want to enable log rotation? # d-i clamav-freshclam/LogRotate boolean true ############################ #### clamav-milter_0.100.0+dfsg-0+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Handle the configuration file automatically? # Some options must be configured for clamav-milter. # . # It won't work if it isn't configured. If you do not # configure it automatically, you'll have to configure # /etc/clamav/clamav-milter.conf manually or run "dpkg-reconfigure clamav-milter" # later. In any case, manual changes in /etc/clamav/clamav-milter.conf will # be respected. # d-i clamav-milter/debconf boolean true ### Description: Communication interface with Sendmail: # Please choose the method that should be used by clamav-milter to # communicate with Sendmail. The following formats can be used: # - Unix domain socket: [[unix|local]:]/path/to/file # - IPv4 socket : inet:port@[hostname|ip-address] # - IPv6 socket : inet6:port@[hostname|ip-address] # d-i clamav-milter/MilterSocket string /var/run/clamav/clamav-milter.ctl ### Description: Remove stale socket after unclean shutdown? # d-i clamav-milter/FixStaleSocket boolean true ### Description: Group owner of clamav-milter local (UNIX) socket: # d-i clamav-milter/MilterSocketGroup string clamav ### Description: Creation mode for clamav-milter local (UNIX) socket: # d-i clamav-milter/MilterSocketMode string 666 ### Description: User to run clamav-milter as: # It is recommended to run the ClamAV programs as a non-privileged user. # This will work with most MTAs with a little tweaking. # . # Please see README.Debian in the clamav-base package for details. # d-i clamav-milter/User string clamav ### Description: Groups for clamav-milter (space-separated): # By default, clamav-milter runs as a non-privileged user. If you need # clamav-milter to be able to access files owned by another user (for # instance when it is used in combination with an MTA), the user # running clamav-milter need to be added to the relevant group(s). # . # Please see README.Debian in the clamav-base package for # details. # d-i clamav-milter/AddGroups string ### Description: Wait timeout for data coming from clamd: # Please enter the delay (in seconds) before clamav-milter times out when it is # waiting for incoming data from clamd. # . # Choosing "0" will disable this timeout. # d-i clamav-milter/ReadTimeout string 120 ### Description: Should clamav-milter stay in foreground (not forking)? # d-i clamav-milter/Foreground boolean false ### Description: Chroot to directory: # Clamav-milter can run in a chroot jail. It will enter it after reading # the configuration file and before dropping root privileges. # . # If this field is left empty, no chrooting will occur. # d-i clamav-milter/Chroot string ### Description: PID file: # Please specify the process identifier file location for clamav-milter's # listening daemon (main thread). # d-i clamav-milter/PidFile string /var/run/clamav/clamav-milter.pid ### Description: Temporary directory path: # Please specify the directory for clamav-milter's files that are temporarily # buffered for scanning. If unset, $TMPDIR and $TEMP will be honored. # d-i clamav-milter/TemporaryDirectory string /tmp ### Description: Clamd socket to connect to for scanning: # Please specify the socket to use to connect to the ClamAV daemon for # scanning purposes. Possible choices are: # - a local unix socket using an absolute path, in "unix:path" format # (for example: unix:/var/run/clamd/clamd.socket); # - a local or remote TCP socket in "tcp:host:port" format (for example: # tcp:192.168.0.1). The "host" value can be either a hostname or an IP # address, and the "port" is only required for IPv6 addresses, # defaulting to 3310 otherwise. # . # You may specify multiple choices, separated by spaces. In such case, the # clamd servers will be selected in a round-robin fashion. # d-i clamav-milter/ClamdSocket string unix:/var/run/clamav/clamd.ctl ### Description: Hosts excluded from scanning: # Please specify, in CIDR notation (host(name)/mask), the hosts for # which no scanning should be performed on incoming mail. Multiple entries # should be separated by spaces. The "local" shortcut can be used to # specify locally-originated (non-SMTP) email. # . # If this field is left empty, all incoming mail will be scanned. # d-i clamav-milter/LocalNet string ### Description: Mail addresses whitelist: # Please specify the path to a whitelist file, listing email addresses # that should cause scanning to be bypassed. # . # Each line in this file should be a POSIX regular expression; lines # starting with "#", ":" or "!" will be ignored as comments. # . # Lines may start with "From:" (with no space after the colon) to make # the whitelisting apply to matching sender addresses; otherwise, or # with a "To:" prefix, it affects recipient addresses. # d-i clamav-milter/Whitelist string ### Description: Action to perform on infected messages: # Please choose the action to perform on "infected" messages: # . # - Accept : accept the message for delivery; # - Reject : immediately refuse delivery (with a 5xx error); # - Defer : return a temporary failure message (4xx); # - Blackhole : accept the message then drop it; # - Quarantine: accept the message then quarantine it. With # Sendmail, the quarantine queue can be examined # with "mailq -qQ". With Postfix, such mails are placed # on hold. # d-i clamav-milter/OnInfected select Quarantine # Possible choices: Accept, Reject, Defer, Blackhole, Quarantine ### Description: Action to perform on error conditions: # Please choose the action to perform on errors such as failure to # allocate data structures, no scanners available, # network timeouts, unknown scanner replies...: # . # - Accept: accept the message for delivery; # - Reject: immediately refuse delivery (with a 5xx error); # - Defer : return a temporary failure message (4xx). # d-i clamav-milter/OnFail select Defer # Possible choices: Accept, Reject, Defer ### Description: Specific rejection reason for infected messages: # Please specify the rejection reason that will be included in reject mails. # . # This option is only useful together with "OnInfected Reject". # . # The "%v" string may be used to include the virus name. # d-i clamav-milter/RejectMsg string ### Description: Add headers to processed messages? # If you choose this option, "X-Virus-Scanned" and "X-Virus-Status" headers # will be attached to each processed message, possibly replacing existing # similar headers. # d-i clamav-milter/AddHeader select Replace # Possible choices: Replace, Yes, No, Add ### Description: Log file for clamav-milter: # Specify the full path to the clamav-milter log file, which must be # writable for the clamav daemon. Enter none to disable. # . # Logging via syslog is configured independently of this setting. # d-i clamav-milter/LogFile string /var/log/clamav/clamav-milter.log ### Description: Disable log file locking? # By default the log file is locked for writing. The lock protects against # running clamav-milter multiple times. This option disables log file locking. # d-i clamav-milter/LogFileUnlock boolean false ### Description: Maximum size of the log file (MB): # Please specify the maximum size for the log file. Using "0" will # allow that file to grow indefinitely. # d-i clamav-milter/LogFileMaxSize string 1M ### Description: Log time with each message? # d-i clamav-milter/LogTime boolean true ### Description: Use system logger? # Please choose whether you want to use the system logger (syslog). This # option can be used along with logging in a dedicated file. # d-i clamav-milter/LogSyslog boolean false ### Description: Type of syslog messages: # Please choose the type of syslog messages as detailed in the system # logger's documentation. # d-i clamav-milter/LogFacility string LOG_LOCAL6 ### Description: Enable verbose logging? # d-i clamav-milter/LogVerbose boolean false ### Description: Information to log on infected messages: # Please choose the level of information that will be logged when infected # messages are found: # - Off : no logging; # - Basic: minimal information; # - Full : verbose information. # d-i clamav-milter/LogInfected select Off # Possible choices: Off, Basic, Full ### Description: Information to log if no threat is found: # Please choose the level of information that will be logged when no threat is # found in a scanned message (this is useful in debugging but drastically # increases the log size): # - Off : no logging; # - Basic: minimal information; # - Full : verbose information. # d-i clamav-milter/LogClean select Off # Possible choices: Off, Basic, Full ### Description: Size limit for scanned messages (MB): # Please specify the maximum size for scanned messages. Messages bigger than # this limit will not be scanned. # . # You should check that this value is lower than the value of "StreamMaxLength" # in the clamd.conf file. # d-i clamav-milter/MaxFileSize string 25M ### Description: Do you want clamav-milter to support multiple recipients? # This option affects the behaviour of LogInfected, LogClean and VirusAction # when a message with multiple recipients is scanned: # If SupportMultipleRecipients is off (the default) # then one single log entry is generated for the message and, in case the # message is determined to be malicious, the command indicated by VirusAction # is executed just once. In both cases only the last recipient is reported. # If SupportMultipleRecipients is on: # then one line is logged for each recipient and the command indicated # by VirusAction is also executed once for each recipient. # . # Note: although it's probably a good idea to enable this option, the default value # is currently set to off for legacy reasons. # d-i clamav-milter/SupportMultipleRecipients boolean false ### Description: Do you want to enable log rotation? # d-i clamav-milter/LogRotate boolean true ############################ #### clamsmtp_1.10-13_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Add a clamsmtp system user and group? # New installations of clamsmtp install with a system user and group of # "clamsmtp". The "clamav" user is added to the clamsmtp group to # allow the clamav-daemon process to view the quarantine directory. If # this option is set, the installation process will also update the ownership # and permissions of the quarantine and run directories. # d-i clamsmtp/addusergroup boolean true ### Description: Fix directory permissions? # clamsmtpd needs read and write permissions to the virus spool directory, # and the run directory in which its PID file is created. Additionally, the # Clam AV daemon must have read access to the spool directory to scan for # viruses. # . # The post-installation script can fix the permissions and ownership of these # two directories. It will consult the /etc/clamsmtpd.conf and # /etc/default/clamsmtp files for the administratively assigned TempDirectory, # PidFile, User, and Group variables, and then update the two directories # appropriately. # . # Be sure to check directory permissions after running the init script with the # parameters 'start' or 'restart'. # d-i clamsmtp/do-fixperms boolean false ### Description: Purge spool directory on --purge? # The virus spool directory may contain quarantined viruses that can be removed # automatically when purging the package. # d-i clamsmtp/purge boolean true ############################ #### cloud-init_0.7.6~bzr976-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Data sources to read from: # Cloud-init supports searching different "Data Sources" for information # that it uses to configure a cloud instance. # . # Please note that "EC2 Metadata service" should be used only if # the EC2 metadata service is present. Otherwise, it will trigger # a very noticeable timeout on boot. # d-i cloud-init/datasources multiselect NoCloud, AltCloud, CloudStack, ConfigDrive, Ec2, MAAS, OVF, GCE, None # Possible choices: /var/lib/cloud/seed only, AltCloud Config Drive, CloudStack metadata service, OpenStack Config Drive, EC2 Metadata service, Ubuntu MAAS, OVF Transports, Google Cloud Engine, Failsafe datasource ############################ #### collectd-core_5.4.1-6+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically try to migrate your RRD files? # The layout of the RRD files created by collectd has changed significantly # since version 3.x. In order to keep your old data you have to migrate it. # This can be done by using /usr/lib/collectd/utils/migrate-3-4.px. # . # This step can be done automatically. In this case a backup of # /var/lib/collectd/ is made in /var/backups/. This script is still # experimental, though. Do not expect it to work in all cases. # . # See /usr/share/doc/collectd-core/NEWS.Debian.gz for details. # d-i collectd/auto-migrate-3-4 boolean false ### Description: Automatically try to migrate your RRD files? # The layout of some RRD files created by collectd has changed since version # 4.x. In order to keep your old data you have to migrate it. This can be done # by using /usr/lib/collectd/utils/migrate-4-5.px. # . # This step can be done automatically. In this case a backup of # /var/lib/collectd/ is made in /var/backups/. This script is still # experimental, though. Do not expect it to work in all cases. # . # See /usr/share/doc/collectd-core/NEWS.Debian.gz and the collectd wiki at # for details. # d-i collectd/auto-migrate-4-5 boolean false ### Description: Remove all collected data (e.g. RRD files)? # The /var/lib/collectd/ directory which contains the data files containing the # collected statistics is about to be removed. For example, this directory # includes (in the default configuration) all RRD files. # . # If you're purging the collectd package in order to replace it with a more # recent or custom version or if you want to keep the data for further # analysis, the data should be kept. # d-i collectd/postrm_purge_data boolean true ############################ #### common-lisp-controller_7.10_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Short Common Lisp site name: # You can configure what the Common Lisp implementations are going to use as # 'short site name'. # . # This is mostly unused except in some error reporting tools. # d-i common-lisp-controller/short-site-name string Unknown ### Description: Long Common Lisp site name: # You can configure what the Common Lisp implementations are going to use as # 'long site name'. # . # This is mostly unused except in some error reporting tools. # d-i common-lisp-controller/long-site-name string Site name not initialized ############################ #### htcondor_8.2.3~dfsg.1-6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Manage initial HTCondor configuration automatically? # The setup for HTCondor can be handled automatically, asking a few questions # to create an initial configuration appropriate for a machine that is either # a member of an existing pool or a fully functional "Personal HTCondor # installation". This generated initial configuration can be further extended # later on. # . # Otherwise, HTCondor will be installed with a default configuration that needs # to be customized manually. # d-i condor/wantdebconf boolean false ### Description: Enable submission of usage statistics? # The HTCondor authors politely request that each HTCondor pool sends them periodic # updates with basic information about the status of the pool. Updates include # only the total number of machines, the number of jobs submitted, the number # of machines running jobs, the host name of the central manager, and the name # of the pool. These updates help the HTCondor Team see how HTCondor is being used # around the world. # d-i condor/phonehome boolean false ### Description: Address of the central manager: # If this machine is intended to join an existing HTCondor pool, the address of the # central manager machine has to be specified. Any address format supported # by HTCondor can be used, including macro expressions. # . # Example: condor-manager.example.org # d-i condor/centralmanager string ### Description: Role of this machine in the HTCondor pool: # Please specify the intended role or roles of this machine, for which the # corresponding daemons will be started automatically. # . # A machine in a HTCondor pool can have multiple roles. In general there is one # central manager and multiple nodes that run jobs. Often the central manager # is also the machine from which users submit jobs. However, it is also # possible to have multiple machines available for job submission. # d-i condor/daemons multiselect SCHEDD, STARTD # Possible choices: Job submission, Job execution, Central manager ### Description: Email address of the local HTCondor administrator: # The HTCondor administrator will receive error messages if something goes wrong # with HTCondor on this machine. # d-i condor/admin string root@localhost ### Description: user directory domain label: # This label is a string that HTCondor uses to decide if a submitting # machine and an execute machine share the same directory of user accounts # (that is, whether UID 1000 on one machine is the same person as UID 1000 # on the other). If the labels on the two machines match, HTCondor will run # each job under the UID that submitted the job, and send emails about # them to user@DOMAIN (using this label as the value of DOMAIN). If not, # HTCondor will run all jobs as user "nobody". Leaving it blank will cause # HTCondor to run all jobs on this machine as user "nobody". # . # Any domain format supported by HTCondor can be used, including macro # expressions. Example: $(FULL_HOSTNAME) # d-i condor/uiddomain string ### Description: File system domain label: # This label is an arbitrary string that is used to decide if a submitting # machine and an execute machine share the same file system. In a dedicated # cluster all machines will most likely use a shared file system and hence # should use the same label. If left blank, it will automatically be set to # the fully qualified hostname of the local machine, which will prevent # HTCondor assuming that any two machines share a file system. # . # Example: my_shared_volume # d-i condor/filesystemdomain string ### Description: Perform a "Personal HTCondor installation"? # A Personal HTCondor installation is a fully functional HTCondor pool on a single # machine. HTCondor will automatically configure and advertise as many slots as # it detects CPU cores on this machine. HTCondor daemons will not be available # through external network interfaces. # . # This configuration is not appropriate if this machine is intended to be a # member of a pool. # d-i condor/personal boolean true ### Description: Amount of physical memory to withhold from HTCondor (in MB): # By default, HTCondor considers all the physical memory of a machine as # available to be used by HTCondor jobs. If this value is defined, # HTCondor subtracts it from the amount of memory it advertises as available. # . # Example (to reserve 1 GB): 1024 # d-i condor/reservedmemory string ### Description: Machines with write access to this host: # All machines that are to participate in the HTCondor pool need to be listed # here. This setting can be a plain comma-separated list, a domain with # wildcards, or a macro expression. By default only localhost is allowed to # access HTCondor daemons on this machine. # . # Example: *.condor-pool.example.org # d-i condor/allowwrite string ### Description: Run HTCondor jobs regardless of other machine activity? # By default HTCondor only starts jobs when a machine is idle, i.e. no keyboard # activity or CPU load for some time. Moreover, it also suspends jobs whenever # there is console activity and doesn't continue them until the machine becomes # idle again. However, for a dedicated compute node or a Personal HTCondor # installation it might be desirable to always start jobs as soon as they are # submitted (given that resources are still available), and to run them # continuously regardless of other activity on this machine. # . # If you plan to compose a custom policy it is best to keep HTCondor's default # here. # d-i condor/startpolicy boolean false ############################ #### configure-debian_1.0.2-0.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Which subsection do you want? # d-i configure-debian/packages_subsection select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Which program do you want to configure? # d-i configure-debian/packages_program select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Would you like to configure another program? # d-i configure-debian/packages_another boolean ############################ #### console-common_0.7.88_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Policy for handling keymaps: # The keymap records the layout of symbols on the keyboard. # . # - 'Select keymap from arch list': select one of the predefined keymaps # specific for your architecture (recommended for non-USB keyboards); # - 'Don't touch keymap': don't overwrite the keymap in /etc/console, # which is maintained manually with install-keymap(8); # - 'Keep kernel keymap': prevent any keymap from being loaded next time # the system boots; # - 'Select keymap from full list': list all the predefined keymaps. # Recommended when using cross-architecture (often USB) keyboards. # d-i console-data/keymap/policy select Don't touch keymap # Possible choices: Select keymap from arch list, Don't touch keymap, Keep kernel keymap, Select keymap from full list ### Description: Keyboard layout family: # Please specify the generic family name for the keyboard # layout. Usually, the layout family name is taken from the first keys on the # left of the top letters row of the keymap. # d-i console-data/keymap/family select qwerty # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Keyboard layout: # In order to refine the keymap choice, please select the # physical layout of the keyboard. # d-i console-data/keymap/template/layout select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Keyboard variant: # The selected keyboard layout has several variants. Please select the # one matching the keyboard. # d-i console-data/keymap/template/variant select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Keymap: # The selected keyboard allows a choice from a range of keymaps. # Usually these were designed either for specific tastes (for instance # with dead keys) or for specific needs (such as programming). # d-i console-data/keymap/template/keymap select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Keymap: # If the keyboard is designed for a different computer architecture, you should # choose a specific keymap in the full map. # d-i console-data/keymap/full select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Are you ready for the ADB key codes transition? # The kernel is configured to have the keyboard send ADB key codes. This # behavior is now deprecated and no longer supported. # . # For best results, you should reconfigure the kernel with # CONFIG_MAC_ADBKEYCODES=n. Alternatively, you can pass # 'keyboard_sends_linux_keycodes=1' as an argument to the kernel. # . # Please be aware that the transition will most probably break the X # configuration, so it is strongly recommended to close all X sessions # now and adapt the configuration afterwards by running # 'dpkg-reconfigure console-data'. # d-i console-data/keymap/powerpcadb boolean ### Description: for internal use # d-i console-data/bootmap-md5sum string none ############################ #### console-cyrillic_0.9-16.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to setup Cyrillic on the console at boot-time? # If you accept, the package console-cyrilic will setup Cyrillic on # the console at boot-time. # . # Otherwise, refuse if you don't use Cyrillic the whole time or if for some # reason you want to use the console setup by console-data package. # d-i console-cyrillic/bootsetup boolean false ### Description: Should /etc/console-cyrillic be changed by Debconf? # This template is never presented to the user. It is used internally by # the package installation scripts. # d-i console-cyrillic/change_config boolean ### Description: What virtual consoles do you use? # Please enter a space delimited list of virtual consoles you use. The usual # Unix filename wildcards are allowed (*, ? and [...]). # . # If you are unsure, then use the default /dev/tty[1-6], it is for six # virtual consoles. If you use devfs, then enter /dev/vc/[1-6] instead. # d-i console-cyrillic/ttys string /dev/tty[1-6] ### Description: Choose a font for the console. # Please choose the font you would like to use on the console. If you # change your mind later on, you can use the command `dpkg-reconfigure # console-cyrillic' to answer again all these questions. # . # Different videomodes require different font sizes. Usually font size 16 is # for videomodes 80x25 and 80x30, font size 14 is for videomodes 80x28 and # 80x34 and font size 8 is for videomodes 80x43, 80x50 and 80x60. # . # Not all fonts are suitable for all alphabets. A table for the available # fonts, and supported sizes and alphabets follows. # . # Legend: # . # a -- Asian Cyrillic letters; # b -- Belarusian alphabet; # r -- Russian alphabet with letters `E with diaeresis'; # u -- Ukrainian alphabet; # y -- Macedonian and Serbian alphabets. # . # Remark: All fonts support the Bulgarian alphabet and the basic Russian # alphabet. # . # Font name Available sizes Supported alphabets # ------------------------------------------------------------- # A 16 14 8 # A Asian 16 abr # Alt 16 14 8 r # Antiq 16 r # Antiq Asian 16 abr # Arab 18 16 14 8 br y # B 16 r # B Asian 16 abr # C 16 bruy # Cage 19 18 16 15 14 12 11 10 8 # DOS 16 14 8 br # ISO 16 14 br y # Lenta 16 bruy # Pln 16 14 8 bruy # Sarge 16 br # Sans 16 bruy # Terminus Asian 16 14 abr # Terminus Slavic 16 14 bruy # Terminus Unicode 16 14 abruy # Thin 16 14 br # UniCyr 16 14 8 bruy # d-i console-cyrillic/fontstyle select Terminus Unicode Framebuffer # Possible choices: Terminus Unicode Normal, Terminus Unicode Bold, Terminus Unicode Framebuffer, Terminus Slavic Normal, Terminus Slavic Bold, Terminus Slavic Framebuffer, Terminus Asian Normal, Terminus Asian Bold, Terminus Asian Framebuffer, UniCyr, DOS, Alt, Pln, Antiq, Antiq Asian, Sans, Lenta, Cage, Thin, Sarge, A, A Asian, B, B Asian, C, ISO, Arab ### Description: What is your favourite font size? # Please select the size for the chosen font. If unsure choose the standard # font size (16). # d-i console-cyrillic/fontsize select 16 # Possible choices: ${fontsizes} ### Description: Choose the keyboard layout # Please choose the keyboard layout to load at boot time. # d-i console-cyrillic/kbdtype select # Possible choices: Belarusian, Bulgarian BDS, Bulgarian phonetic, Kazakh, Kazakh with letter IO, Macedonian, Mongolian, Russian, Russian Winkeys, Serbian, Ukrainian, Ukrainian Winkeys ### Description: Toggling between Cyrillic and Latin characters # How you will toggle between Cyrillic and Latin characters? Several # possibilities are available. # . # If you choose the Caps Lock key, then use the combination Shift+Caps Lock # for normal Caps toggle. # . # Obviously you may use Windows logo keys and Menu key only if your keyboard # has them. # d-i console-cyrillic/toggle select Right Alt # Possible choices: Caps Lock, Right Alt, Right Control, Right Shift, Alt+Shift, Control+Shift, Control+Alt, Left Windows logo key, Right Windows logo key, Menu key ### Description: Switching temporarily between Cyrillic and Latin characters # Sometimes you are in Cyrillic mode and want to type only a few Latin # letters. In this case it may be desirable to have a key for temporary # switching between Cyrillic and Latin letters. When this key is pressed in # Cyrillic mode the keyboard types Latin letters and in reverse, when the # keyboard is in Latin mode and you are pressing this key the keyboard will # type Cyrillic letters. # . # If you don't like this feature, choose the option "No temporary switch". # d-i console-cyrillic/switch select Both Windows logo keys # Possible choices: Right Alt, Menu key, Left Windows logo key, Right Windows logo key, Both Windows logo keys, No temporary switch ### Description: What is your encoding? # And finally you should choose your encoding. # . # If you want to live on the bleeding edge then choose UNICODE (=UTF-8). # . # The Linux community in Russia prefers the KOI8-R encoding. # . # The Ukrainian encoding KOI8-U is especially designed to be compatible with # KOI8-R. # . # If you live in Macedonia or Serbia and Montenegro, then ISO-8859-5 is for you. # . # If you live in Bulgaria or Belarus, then choose CP1251. # . # If you live in Kazakhstan or Mongolia, then choose UNICODE, PT154 or RK1048. # . # CP1251 is used in MS Windows and OS/2. MAC-CYRILLIC is used in the # operating systems of Apple Computers. CP866 is Russian encoding for DOS. # MIK is Bulgarian encoding for DOS. # d-i console-cyrillic/encoding select UNICODE # Possible choices: UNICODE, CP866, CP1251, ISO-8859-5, KOI8-R, KOI8-U, MAC-CYRILLIC, MIK, PT154, RK1048 ############################ #### console-data_1.12-5_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Policy for handling keymaps: # The keymap records the layout of symbols on the keyboard. # . # - 'Select keymap from arch list': select one of the predefined keymaps # specific for your architecture (recommended for non-USB keyboards); # - 'Don't touch keymap': don't overwrite the keymap in /etc/console, # which is maintained manually with install-keymap(8); # - 'Keep kernel keymap': prevent any keymap from being loaded next time # the system boots; # - 'Select keymap from full list': list all the predefined keymaps. # Recommended when using cross-architecture (often USB) keyboards. # d-i console-data/keymap/policy select Don't touch keymap # Possible choices: Select keymap from arch list, Don't touch keymap, Keep kernel keymap, Select keymap from full list ### Description: Keyboard layout family: # Please specify the generic family name for the keyboard # layout. Usually, the layout family name is taken from the first keys on the # left of the top letters row of the keymap. # d-i console-data/keymap/family select qwerty # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Keyboard layout: # In order to refine the keymap choice, please select the # physical layout of the keyboard. # d-i console-data/keymap/template/layout select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Keyboard variant: # The selected keyboard layout has several variants. Please select the # one matching the keyboard. # d-i console-data/keymap/template/variant select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Keymap: # The selected keyboard allows a choice from a range of keymaps. # Usually these were designed either for specific tastes (for instance # with dead keys) or for specific needs (such as programming). # d-i console-data/keymap/template/keymap select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Keymap: # If the keyboard is designed for a different computer architecture, you should # choose a specific keymap in the full map. # d-i console-data/keymap/full select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Are you ready for the ADB key codes transition? # The kernel is configured to have the keyboard send ADB key codes. This # behavior is now deprecated and no longer supported. # . # For best results, you should reconfigure the kernel with # CONFIG_MAC_ADBKEYCODES=n. Alternatively, you can pass # 'keyboard_sends_linux_keycodes=1' as an argument to the kernel. # . # Please be aware that the transition will most probably break the X # configuration, so it is strongly recommended to close all X sessions # now and adapt the configuration afterwards by running # 'dpkg-reconfigure console-data'. # d-i console-data/keymap/powerpcadb boolean ### Description: for internal use # d-i console-data/bootmap-md5sum string none ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-acorn/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, Belarusian, Belgian, Brazilian (ABNT2 layout), Brazilian (EUA layout), British English, Bulgarian, Canadian Multilingual, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Dvorak, Estonian, Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hebrew, Hungarian, Icelandic, Italian, Japanese, Kirghiz, Latin American, Latvian, Lithuanian, Macedonian, Norwegian, Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Slovakian, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Swiss French, Swiss German, Turkish (F layout), Turkish (Q layout), Ukrainian ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-amiga/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, French, German, Italian, Spanish, Swedish, Swiss German ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-at/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, Belarusian, Belgian, Brazilian (ABNT2 layout), Brazilian (EUA layout), British English, Bulgarian, Canadian French, Canadian Multilingual, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Dvorak, Estonian, Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hebrew, Hungarian, Icelandic, Italian, Japanese, Kirghiz, Latin American, Latvian, Lithuanian, Macedonian, Norwegian, Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Serbian, Slovakian, Slovene, Spanish, Swedish, Swiss French, Swiss German, Thai, Turkish (F layout), Turkish (Q layout), Ukrainian ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-atari/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, British English, French, German, Swedish ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-dec/keymap select # Possible choices: American English ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-mac/keymap select # Possible choices: American English (82 keys), American English (extended kbd), French (alternate), French (extended kbd), German (extended kbd) ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i console-keymaps-sun/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, British English, Czech, Finnish, French, German, Japanese (type 4), Japanese (type 5), Norwegian (type 4), Norwegian (type 5), Polish, Russian, Spanish (type 4), Spanish (type 5), Turkish (Q layout) ### Description: Keymap to use for a USB keyboard: # d-i console-keymaps-usb/keymap select # Possible choices: American English, Belgian, British English, Danish, Dvorak, Finnish, French, German, Italian, Italian, Portuguese, Spanish, Swedish, Swiss French, Swiss German ############################ #### console-setup_1.123_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Character set to support: # Please choose the character set that should be supported by the console font. # . # If you don't use a framebuffer, the choices that start with "." will # reduce the number of available colors on the console. # d-i console-setup/codeset47 select # Possible choices: . Arabic, # Armenian, # Cyrillic - KOI8-R and KOI8-U, # Cyrillic - non-Slavic languages, # Cyrillic - Slavic languages (also Bosnian and Serbian Latin), . Ethiopic, # Georgian, # Greek, # Hebrew, # Lao, # Latin1 and Latin5 - western Europe and Turkic languages, # Latin2 - central Europe and Romanian, # Latin3 and Latin8 - Chichewa; Esperanto; Irish; Maltese and Welsh, # Latin7 - Lithuanian; Latvian; Maori and Marshallese, . Latin - Vietnamese, # Thai, . Combined - Latin; Slavic Cyrillic; Hebrew; basic Arabic, . Combined - Latin; Slavic Cyrillic; Greek, . Combined - Latin; Slavic and non-Slavic Cyrillic, Guess optimal character set ### Description: Font for the console: # "VGA" has a traditional appearance and has medium coverage of # international scripts. "Fixed" has a simplistic appearance and has # better coverage of international scripts. "Terminus" may help to # reduce eye fatigue, though some symbols have a similar aspect which # may be a problem for programmers. # . # If you prefer a bold version of the Terminus font, choose either # TerminusBold (if you use a framebuffer) or TerminusBoldVGA (otherwise). # d-i console-setup/fontface47 select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Font size: # Please select the size of the font for the console. For reference, # the font used when the computer boots has size 8x16. # d-i console-setup/fontsize-text47 select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Font size: # Please select the size of the font for the console. For reference, # the font used when the computer boots has size 8x16. Some font sizes # require the kbd console package (not console-tools) plus framebuffer. # d-i console-setup/fontsize-fb47 select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Encoding to use on the console: # d-i console-setup/charmap47 select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: for internal use # d-i console-setup/fontsize string ### Description: for internal use # d-i console-setup/codesetcode string ### Description: for internal use # d-i console-setup/store_defaults_in_debconf_db boolean true ############################ #### keyboard-configuration_1.123_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Keyboard model: # Please select the model of the keyboard of this machine. # d-i keyboard-configuration/model select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Country of origin for the keyboard: # The layout of keyboards varies per country, with some countries # having multiple common layouts. Please select the country of origin # for the keyboard of this computer. # d-i keyboard-configuration/layout select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Keyboard layout: # Please select the layout matching the keyboard for this machine. # d-i keyboard-configuration/variant select # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Keep the current keyboard layout in the configuration file? # The current keyboard layout in the configuration file # /etc/default/keyboard is defined as XKBLAYOUT="${XKBLAYOUT}" and # XKBVARIANT="${XKBVARIANT}". # . # Please choose whether you want to keep it. If you choose this option, # no questions about the keyboard layout will be asked and the current # configuration will be preserved. # d-i keyboard-configuration/unsupported_config_layout boolean true ### Description: Keep default keyboard layout (${XKBLAYOUTVARIANT})? # The default value for the keyboard layout is XKBLAYOUT="${XKBLAYOUT}" # and XKBVARIANT="${XKBVARIANT}". This default value is based on the # currently defined language/region and the settings in # /etc/X11/xorg.conf. # . # Please choose whether you want to keep it. If you choose this option, # no questions about the keyboard layout will be asked. # d-i keyboard-configuration/unsupported_layout boolean true ### Description: Keep current keyboard options in the configuration file? # The current keyboard options in the configuration file # /etc/default/keyboard are defined as XKBOPTIONS="${XKBOPTIONS}". # . # If you choose to keep these options, no questions about the keyboard # options will be asked. # d-i keyboard-configuration/unsupported_config_options boolean true ### Description: Keep default keyboard options (${XKBOPTIONS})? # The default value for the options of the keyboard layout is # XKBOPTIONS="${XKBOPTIONS}". It is based on the currently defined # language/region and the settings in /etc/X11/xorg.conf. # . # If you choose to keep it, no questions about the keyboard options # will be asked. # d-i keyboard-configuration/unsupported_options boolean true ### Description: Method for toggling between national and Latin mode: # You will need a way to toggle the keyboard between the national # layout and the standard Latin layout. # . # Right Alt or Caps Lock keys are often chosen for ergonomic reasons # (in the latter case, use the combination Shift+Caps Lock for normal Caps # toggle). Alt+Shift is also a popular combination; it will # however lose its usual behavior in Emacs and other programs # that use it for specific needs. # . # Not all listed keys are present on all keyboards. # d-i keyboard-configuration/toggle select Alt+Shift # Possible choices: Caps Lock, Right Alt (AltGr), Right Control, Right Shift, Right Logo key, Menu key, Alt+Shift, Control+Shift, Control+Alt, Alt+Caps Lock, Left Control+Left Shift, Left Alt, Left Control, Left Shift, Left Logo key, Scroll Lock key, No toggling ### Description: Method for temporarily toggling between national and Latin input: # When the keyboard is in national mode and one wants to type only a few # Latin letters, it might be more appropriate to switch temporarily to # Latin mode. The keyboard remains in that mode as long as the chosen key is # kept pressed. That key may also be used to input national letters when # the keyboard is in Latin mode. # . # You can disable this feature by choosing "No temporary switch". # d-i keyboard-configuration/switch select No temporary switch # Possible choices: No temporary switch, Both Logo keys, Right Alt (AltGr), Right Logo key, Left Alt, Left Logo key ### Description: Key to function as AltGr: # With some keyboard layouts, AltGr is a modifier key used to input # some characters, primarily ones that are unusual for the language of the # keyboard layout, such as foreign currency symbols and accented letters. # These are often printed as an extra symbol on keys. # d-i keyboard-configuration/altgr select Right Alt (AltGr) # Possible choices: The default for the keyboard layout, No AltGr key, Right Alt (AltGr), Right Control, Right Logo key, Menu key, Left Alt, Left Logo key, Keypad Enter key, Both Logo keys, Both Alt keys ### Description: Compose key: # The Compose key (known also as Multi_key) causes the computer to interpret # the next few keystrokes as a combination in order to produce a character # not found on the keyboard. # . # On the text console the Compose key does not work in Unicode mode. If not # in Unicode mode, regardless of what you choose here, you can always also # use the Control+period combination as a Compose key. # d-i keyboard-configuration/compose select No compose key # Possible choices: No compose key, Right Alt (AltGr), Right Control, Right Logo key, Menu key, Left Logo key, Caps Lock ### Description: Use Control+Alt+Backspace to terminate the X server? # By default the combination Control+Alt+Backspace does nothing. If # you want it can be used to terminate the X server. # d-i keyboard-configuration/ctrl_alt_bksp boolean false ### Description: Keymap to use: # d-i keyboard-configuration/xkb-keymap select # Possible choices: American English, Albanian, Arabic, Asturian, Bangladesh, Belarusian, Bengali, Belgian, Bosnian, Brazilian, British English, Bulgarian, Bulgarian (phonetic layout), Burmese, Canadian French, Canadian Multilingual, Catalan, Chinese, Croatian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, Dvorak, Dzongkha, Esperanto, Estonian, Ethiopian, Finnish, French, Georgian, German, Greek, Gujarati, Gurmukhi, Hebrew, Hindi, Hungarian, Icelandic, Irish, Italian, Japanese, Kannada, Kazakh, Khmer, Kirghiz, Korean, Kurdish (F layout), Kurdish (Q layout), Lao, Latin American, Latvian, Lithuanian, Macedonian, Malayalam, Nepali, Northern Sami, Norwegian, Persian, Philippines, Polish, Portuguese, Punjabi, Romanian, Russian, Serbian (Cyrillic), Sindhi, Sinhala, Slovak, Slovenian, Spanish, Swedish, Swiss French, Swiss German, Tajik, Tamil, Telugu, Thai, Tibetan, Turkish (F layout), Turkish (Q layout), Ukrainian, Uyghur, Vietnamese ### Description: for internal use # d-i keyboard-configuration/modelcode string ### Description: for internal use # d-i keyboard-configuration/layoutcode string ### Description: for internal use # d-i keyboard-configuration/variantcode string ### Description: for internal use # d-i keyboard-configuration/optionscode string ### Description: for internal use # d-i keyboard-configuration/store_defaults_in_debconf_db boolean true ############################ #### courier-base_0.73.1-1.6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Create directories for web-based administration? # Courier uses several configuration files in /etc/courier. Some of # these files can be replaced by a subdirectory whose contents are # concatenated and treated as a single, consolidated, configuration # file. # . # The web-based administration provided by the courier-webadmin package # relies on configuration directories instead of configuration files. # If you agree, any directories needed for the web-based # administration tool will be created unless there is already a # plain file in place. # d-i courier-base/webadmin-configmode boolean false ### Description: Path to Maildir directory: # Please give the relative path name from each user's home directory to the # Maildir directory where the Courier servers store and access the # user's email. Please refer to the maildir.courier(5) manual page if you are # unfamiliar with the mail storage format used by Courier. # d-i courier-base/maildir string Maildir ############################ #### courier-mta_0.73.1-1.6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Default domain: # Please specify a valid email domain. Most header rewriting functions will # append this domain to all email addresses which do not specify a domain, # such as local accounts. # d-i courier-mta/defaultdomain string ### Description: "From" header for delivery notifications: # Please specify a valid value for the "From" header for mail delivery # notifications. These notifications cannot be sent without that setting. # d-i courier-mta/dsnfrom string ############################ #### courier-ssl_0.73.1-1.6_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### courier-webadmin_0.73.1-1.6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Activate CGI program? # To allow courier-webadmin to work out of the box, the CGI # program /usr/lib/courier/courier/webmail/webadmin needs to # be installed as /usr/lib/cgi-bin/courierwebadmin with the SUID bit set. # . # This may have serious security implications, because # courierwebadmin runs as root. Moreover, that solution is # not guaranteed to work, # depending on the web server software and its configuration. # . # If you choose this option and the web server setup is # policy-compliant, you can access the administration frontend through # http://localhost/cgi-bin/courierwebadmin. # d-i courier-webadmin/install-cgi boolean false ### Description: Password for Courier administration: # A password is needed to protect access to the Courier administration # web interface. Please choose one now. # d-i courier-webadmin/password password ############################ #### sqwebmail_0.73.1-1.6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Calendaring mode: # Please specify if you would like to enable calendaring in 'local' mode, # enable groupware or 'net' mode or disable it. # The courier-pcp package is required to use the groupware mode. # . # Local mode adds very little overhead over a disabled calendaring # mode. On the other hand, groupware mode is less resources-friendly and # requires a separate daemon process to be run. # . # For more information, please refer to /usr/share/doc/sqwebmail/PCP.html. # d-i sqwebmail/calendarmode select local # Possible choices: local, net, disabled ### Description: Ispell dictionary: # SqWebMail allows you to spellcheck your emails. Please select an # appropriate dictionary for ispell. # d-i sqwebmail/dictionary select default # Possible choices: ${DICTS} ### Description: Installation method for HTML documents and images: # The HTML documents and images in /usr/share/sqwebmail can be made # accessible at /var/www/sqwebmail via a symbolic link; or by being # copied directly into a directory there; or not at all. # . # The 'copy' option is recommended for security reasons. However, if # 'FollowSymLinks' or 'SymLinksIfOwnerMatch' are already enabled in # Apache configuration, the first option can be considered. The last # option needs manual actions to configure the web server. # . # Please note that /var/www/sqwebmail will be removed if this package is # purged unless the 'custom' option is chosen. # d-i sqwebmail/install-www select symlink # Possible choices: symlink, copy, custom ### Description: for internal use # d-i sqwebmail/install-www-backup string ############################ #### couriergraph_0.25-4.3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Should CourierGraph start on boot? # Couriergraph can start on boot time as a daemon. Then it will monitor # your mail logfile for changes. This is recommended. # . # The other method is to call couriergraph.pl by hand with the -l parameter. # d-i couriergraph/start_on_boot boolean true ### Description: Logfile to be used by couriergraph: # Enter the logfile which should be used to create the databases for # couriergraph. If unsure, leave default. # d-i couriergraph/logfile string /var/log/mail.log ### Description: Remove RRD files on purge? # Couriergraph keeps its database files under /var/lib/couriergraph. State # whether this directory should be removed completely on purge or not. # d-i couriergraph/stay_on_purge boolean true ############################ #### cpuburn_1.4a-5_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### cpufrequtils_008-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable cpufreq governor at install time? # This is an internal (hidden) debconf question. It should not be translated. # d-i cpufrequtils/enable boolean true ############################ #### crm114_20100106-6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Proceed with CRM114 upgrade? # The version of the crm114 package that is about to be installed is # not able to use .css files created by the currently installed version. This means # that any crm114 command is likely to fail with an error code, possibly rejecting # incoming e-mail. # . # If the mail system on this machine depends on crm114, it is highly # recommended that delivery (or just crm114 processing) should be temporarily # disabled before the package is upgraded. # . # If you proceed with the upgrade, you should carefully check whether crm114 # is still properly operating with existing .css files. If it does not, these # files should be rebuilt by using the mailreaver cache, or recreated from # scratch. # d-i crm114/cssupgrade boolean false ### Description: Force CRM114 upgrade? # If you enable this option, crm114 package won't ask any safety questions # during the upgrade. It is your full responsibility to arrange things in # advance in such a way that nothing breaks after the upgrade. # d-i crm114/forceupgrade boolean false ############################ #### cryptsetup_1.6.6-5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Continue with cryptsetup removal? # This system has unlocked dm-crypt devices: ${cryptmap} # . # If these devices are managed with cryptsetup, you might be unable to # lock the devices after the package removal, though other tools can be # used for managing dm-crypt devices. Any system shutdown or reboot will # lock the devices. # . # Do not choose this option if you want to lock the dm-crypt devices # before package removal. # d-i cryptsetup/prerm_active_mappings boolean true ############################ #### cups_1.7.5-11+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want CUPS to print unknown jobs as raw jobs? # The Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) enforces a MIME type for all # print jobs. Since not all sources of print jobs can attach an # appropriate type, many jobs get submitted as the MIME type # application/octet-stream and could be rejected if CUPS cannot guess # the job's format. # . # CUPS can handle all such jobs as "raw" jobs, which causes them to be # sent directly to the printer without processing. # . # It is recommended to choose this option if the server will be # accepting print jobs from Windows computers or Samba servers. # d-i cupsys/raw-print boolean true ### Description: Printer communication backends: # CUPS uses backend programs to communicate with the printer device or port. # . # Unfortunately, some backend programs are likely to cause some trouble. # For example, some PPC kernels crash with the parallel backend. # . # Please choose the backend program to be used by CUPS. The default choice # should fit the most common environments. # d-i cupsys/backend multiselect lpd, socket, usb, snmp, dnssd # Possible choices: lpd, socket, usb, snmp, dnssd ############################ #### cups-bsd_1.7.5-11+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to set up the BSD lpd compatibility server? # The CUPS package contains a server that can accept BSD-style print # jobs and submit them to CUPS. It should only be set up if other # computers are likely to submit jobs over the network via the "BSD" or # "LPR" services, and these computers cannot be converted to use the # IPP protocol that CUPS uses. # d-i cups-bsd/setuplpd boolean false ############################ #### cvsd_1.0.24_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Location of chroot jail: # cvsd can run in a chroot jail. This is the preferred method of # operation. Specify the location of the chroot jail. If you make this # 'none' no chroot jail will be created and used. # A chroot file hierarchy will be created in the specified location. # d-i cvsd/rootjail string /var/lib/cvsd ### Description: The maximum number of connections that can be handled: # It is possible to specify a maximum number of connections that cvsd # can handle simultaneously. Specifying 0 (zero) will put no limit to # the number of connections. # d-i cvsd/maxconnections string 10 ### Description: Nice value cvsd should run at: # cvsd can be run at reduced priority so it will not take up too # many resources, especially if a user specifies a -z option to cvs. # The priority can also be increased (negative value here). # d-i cvsd/nice string 1 ### Description: Umask cvsd should run at: # Specify the umask cvsd and cvs should use when creating files. # . # The umask should be specified as an octal value and represents # the permissions that should be taken away when creating a file # (e.g. using 027 will create files with mode 640 or rw-r-----). # d-i cvsd/umask string 027 ### Description: Address and port on which cvsd will listen: # With the first argument you can specify the address cvsd should listen on. # The '*' address specifies that cvsd should listen on all addresses. # You can specify a IPv4 address, IPv6 address, a hostname or '*'. # . # The second argument is the service name (e.g. cvspserver) or port number # (default 2401) cvsd will listen on. # . # The address and port should be separated by a space and you can specify multiple # address-port combinations by separating them with spaces. # d-i cvsd/listen string * 2401 ### Description: Repositories to serve: # The whole idea of cvsd is to serve repositories. Specify a colon ':' # separated list of repositories to serve. The location of these repositories # is relative to the specified chroot jail (${rootjail}) and should start with a '/'. # . # The repositories here should be initialized by hand with something like # 'cvs -d ${rootjail}/myrepos init' after which passwords can be set with # 'cvsd-passwd ${rootjail}/myrepos anonymous'. See the file # /usr/share/doc/cvsd/README.gz for details on creating repositories. # d-i cvsd/repositories string /demo:/myrepos ### Description: Resources of pserver processes to limit: # The pserver wrapper can be configured to limit the resource usage that # a pserver process can have. These resource limits will be set on each # pserver process and not on the wrapper. # . # Choose from the list the resources that you want to limit. # You will be asked to specify limits about every resource you selected here. # . # Note that not all resources may be available on all systems and that # resources may be system and kernel specific so use these with caution. # The results of exceeding the set limits may also be system specific # but will most likely stop the cvs process and close the connection # (may be problematic with write access to cvs repository). # d-i cvsd/limits multiselect # Possible choices: coredumpsize, cputime, datasize, filesize, memorylocked, openfiles, maxproc, memoryuse, stacksize, virtmem ### Description: Maximum file size of a core dump: # Set this to 0 (zero) (should be the system default) to prevent core dumps. # Otherwise this limits the size of core dumps to the specified value. # . # This value may be specified with a suffix of 'b' (bytes), 'k' # (1024 bytes) or 'm' (1024*1024 bytes), where 'k' is the default. # d-i cvsd/limit_coredumpsize string 0 ### Description: Maximum amount of cpu time consumed: # This limits the number of cpu seconds the cvs process can use. # This will prevent too much cpu time from being allocated to a single connection. # . # This value can be formatted as 'mm:ss' or have a 'm' or 's' # suffix where 's' is default. # d-i cvsd/limit_cputime string 1:00 ### Description: Maximum size of program's data segment: # This limits the amount of memory the cvs program can use. This # specific item limits the size of the data segment. # . # This value may be specified with a suffix of 'b' (bytes), 'k' # (1024 bytes) or 'm' (1024*1024 bytes), where 'k' is the default. # d-i cvsd/limit_datasize string 10m ### Description: Maximum size of files created: # This limits the maximum size of a file created by cvs. # Note that the cvs pserver process needs to be able to create # lock files and possibly write history or other files so # don't set this to 0 (zero). # . # This value may be specified with a suffix of 'b' (bytes), 'k' # (1024 bytes) or 'm' (1024*1024 bytes), where 'k' is the default. # d-i cvsd/limit_filesize string 1m ### Description: Maximum amount of locked memory: # This limits the amount of memory the cvs process may lock. # cvs probably doesn't need to lock any memory at all. # . # This value may be specified with a suffix of 'b' (bytes), 'k' # (1024 bytes) or 'm' (1024*1024 bytes), where 'k' is the default. # d-i cvsd/limit_memorylocked string 10m ### Description: Maximum number of open files: # This limits the number of files and connections that the cvs # process can have open at a single moment. The cvs process needs # to access quite a few files so don't set this too low. # d-i cvsd/limit_openfiles string 1024 ### Description: Maximum number of processes: # This limits the maximum number of processes that a single user may have. # cvs may need to spawn additional processes to run scripts or do subtasks # so don't set this too low. # d-i cvsd/limit_maxproc string 20 ### Description: Maximum size of resident memory: # This specifies the amount of physical memory a process may have. # . # This value may be specified with a suffix of 'b' (bytes), 'k' # (1024 bytes) or 'm' (1024*1024 bytes), where 'k' is the default. # d-i cvsd/limit_memoryuse string 10m ### Description: Maximum stack size: # This limits the size of the stack. # . # This value may be specified with a suffix of 'b' (bytes), 'k' # (1024 bytes) or 'm' (1024*1024 bytes), where 'k' is the default. # d-i cvsd/limit_stacksize string 10m ### Description: Maximum amount of virtual memory allocated: # This limits the total amount of virtual memory a process may have allocated. # . # This value may be specified with a suffix of 'b' (bytes), 'k' # (1024 bytes) or 'm' (1024*1024 bytes), where 'k' is the default. # d-i cvsd/limit_virtmem string 10m ### Description: Maximum number of threads: # This limits the number of threads that a single process may have. # . # This is not available under Linux so it is not in the list # for cvsd/limits. If Hurd has it it may be useful. # d-i cvsd/limit_pthreads string 20 ### Description: Remove chroot jail containing repositories? # The following directory is configured as a chroot jail for cvsd: # ${rootjail} # You may choose to remove the chroot jail but you will also lose all the # repositories inside the chroot jail. If you have not backed up your # repositories you want to keep do not remove it now and manually remove # it later once your repositories are safe. # . # If you do choose to remove the chroot directory, all directories under # it will be removed, even if they are on another file system. # . # If you choose to keep the chroot jail please note that the cvsd user and # group will be removed so uid and gid file information may no longer be # consistent. # d-i cvsd/remove_chroot boolean false ############################ #### cxref_1.6e-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically configure cxref-cpp? # cxref-cpp is a cpp-like program used by cxref for better comment # processing and support. Proper operation of cxref-cpp requires # configuration against the gcc and cpp versions you have installed on your # system. These of course may change with each upgrade. This package can # attempt to automatically keep track of your installed gcc and cpp versions # and reconfigure cxref-cpp accordingly, or it can leave such configuration # up to you. In the latter case, you can run /usr/bin/cxref-cpp-configure # as root whenever you wish, and/or you can edit the file # /etc/cxref/cxref-cpp.defines by hand. In the former case, the defines # file will be automatically updated every time the cxref package is # reconfigured. In addition, cxref-cpp will detect any gcc version mismatch # at runtime and regenerate a temporary cxref-cpp.defines file on the fly, # warning the user of the situation. # d-i cxref/cxref-cpp-autoconf boolean true ############################ #### cyrus-common_2.4.17+nocaldav-0+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove the mail and news spools? # The Cyrus mail and news spools, as well as users' sieve scripts, # can be removed when the package is purged. # . # This question only applies to the default spools and sieve script # directories in /var. If you modified their location in imapd.conf, the # new locations will not be removed; just the old ones in /var. # d-i cyrus-common/removespools boolean false ############################ #### sasl2-bin_2.1.26.dfsg1-13+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove /etc/sasldb2? # Cyrus SASL can store usernames and passwords in the /etc/sasldb2 database # file. # . # If important data is stored in that file, you should back it up # now or choose not to remove the file. # d-i cyrus-sasl2/purge-sasldb2 boolean false ### Description: Backup file name for /etc/sasldb2: # Cyrus SASL has stored usernames and passwords in the /etc/sasldb2 database # file. # . # That file has to be upgraded to a newer database # format. First, a backup of the current file will be created. # You can use that if you need to manually downgrade Cyrus SASL. # However, automatic downgrades are not supported. # . # Please specify the backup file name. You should check the available # disk space in that location. If the backup file already exists, it will be overwritten. # Leaving this field empty will select the default value # (/var/backups/sasldb2.bak). # d-i cyrus-sasl2/backup-sasldb2 string /var/backups/sasldb2.bak ############################ #### d-push_2.0.7-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Web server to reconfigure automatically: # Please choose the web server that should be automatically configured # to run d-push. # d-i d-push/reconfigure-webserver multiselect # Possible choices: apache2, lighttpd ############################ #### dailystrips_1.0.28-11_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### darcsweb_1.1-3.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Web server to configure: # Please choose the web server that should be configured automatically # for use with darcsweb. # . # If you choose "None", the web server should be configured manually. # d-i darcsweb/webserver select Apache2 # Possible choices: Apache2, None ############################ #### darkstat_3.0.718-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you really want to upgrade darkstat ? # The database file format of darkstat has changed, and can't be upgraded. # . # If you confirm the upgrade, the database file # /var/lib/darkstat/darkstat.db will be removed (because it will prevent # darkstat starting). A new database file will be created from scratch when # darkstat restarts. # . # If you don't confirm the upgrade, the package will be left non-configured, # and if you wish to use an older version of darkstat you will have to # downgrade manually. # d-i darkstat/upgrade-question/db_purge-2.5-1 boolean true ############################ #### dash_0.5.7-4+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Use dash as the default system shell (/bin/sh)? # The system shell is the default command interpreter for shell scripts. # . # Using dash as the system shell will improve the system's overall # performance. It does not alter the shell presented to interactive # users. # d-i dash/sh boolean true ############################ #### davfs2_1.5.2-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should unprivileged users be allowed to mount WebDAV resources? # The file /sbin/mount.davfs must have the SUID bit set if you want to allow # unprivileged (non-root) users to mount WebDAV resources. # . # If you do not choose this option, only root will be allowed to mount WebDAV # resources. This can later be changed by running 'dpkg-reconfigure davfs2'. # d-i davfs2/suid_file boolean false ### Description: User running the mount.davfs daemon: # Once the davfs resource has been mounted, the daemon will drop the # root privileges and will run with an unprivileged user ID. # . # Please choose which login name should be used by the daemon. # d-i davfs2/user_name string davfs2 ### Description: Group for users who will be allowed to mount WebDAV resources: # Mounting WebDAV resources creates a file in # /var/run/mount.davfs. This directory will be owned by the group # specified here. # d-i davfs2/group_name string davfs2 ### Description: Do you want to create a new user? # The "${user_name}" user does not exist on the system and will be # created if you choose this option. # d-i davfs2/new_user boolean true ### Description: Do you want to create a new group? # The "${group_name}" group does not exist on the system and will be # created if you choose this option. # d-i davfs2/new_group boolean true ############################ #### dbconfig-common_1.8.47+nmu3+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Will this server be used to access remote databases? # For the database types that support it, dbconfig-common includes support # for configuring databases on remote systems. When installing a package's # database via dbconfig-common, the questions related to remote # configuration are asked with a priority such that they are # skipped for most systems. # . # If you select this option, the default behavior will be to prompt you # with questions related to remote database configuration when you install # new packages. # . # If you are unsure, you should not select this option. # d-i dbconfig-common/remote-questions-default boolean false ### Description: Keep "administrative" database passwords? # By default, you will be prompted for all administrator-level database # passwords when you configure, upgrade, or remove applications with # dbconfig-common. These passwords will not be stored in the # configuration database (debconf) for # any longer than they are needed. # . # This behavior can be disabled, in which case the passwords will # remain in the database. That # database is protected by Unix file permissions, though this is # less secure and thus not the default setting. # . # If you would rather not be bothered for an administrative password # every time you upgrade a database application with dbconfig-common, # you should choose this option. Otherwise, you should refuse this option. # d-i dbconfig-common/remember-admin-pass boolean false ### Description: Configure database for ${pkg} with dbconfig-common? # The ${pkg} package must have a database installed and configured before # it can be used. This can be optionally handled with # dbconfig-common. # . # If you are an advanced database administrator and know that you want # to perform this configuration manually, or if your database has already # been installed and configured, you should refuse this option. Details on what # needs to be done should most likely be provided in /usr/share/doc/${pkg}. # . # Otherwise, you should probably choose this option. # d-i dbconfig-common/dbconfig-install boolean true ### Description: Reinstall database for ${pkg}? # Since you are reconfiguring ${pkg}, you may also want to reinstall the # database which it uses. # . # If you wish to reinstall the database for ${pkg}, you should select # this option. If you do not wish to do so (if you are reconfiguring # the package for unrelated reasons), you should not select this option. # d-i dbconfig-common/dbconfig-reinstall boolean false ### Description: Perform upgrade on database for ${pkg} with dbconfig-common? # According to the maintainer for this package, database upgrade # operations need to be performed on ${pkg}. Typically, this is due to # changes in how a new upstream version of the package needs to store # its data. # . # If you want to handle this process manually, you should # refuse this option. Otherwise, you should choose this option. # During the upgrade, a backup of the database will be made in # /var/cache/dbconfig-common/backups, from which the database can # be restored in the case of problems. # d-i dbconfig-common/dbconfig-upgrade boolean true ### Description: Deconfigure database for ${pkg} with dbconfig-common? # Since you are removing ${pkg}, it's possible that you no longer # want the underlying database. # . # If you like, database removal can be handled with dbconfig-common. # . # If you know that you do want to keep this database, or if you want # to handle the removal of this database manually, you should refuse # this option. # d-i dbconfig-common/dbconfig-remove boolean true ### Description: Database type to be used by ${pkg}: # The ${pkg} package can be configured to use one of several database types. # Below, you will be presented with the available choices. # d-i dbconfig-common/database-type select # Possible choices: ${database_types} ### Description: Do you want to purge the database for ${pkg}? # If you no longer need the database for ${pkg}, you can choose to # remove it now. # . # If you no longer have need of the data being stored by ${pkg}, you # should choose this option. If you want to keep this data, # or if you would rather handle this process manually, you should # refuse this option. # d-i dbconfig-common/purge boolean false ### Description: Do you want to back up the database for ${pkg} before upgrading? # The underlying database for ${pkg} needs to be upgraded as part of the # installation process. Just in case, the database can be backed up # before this is done, so that if something goes wrong, you can revert # to the previous package version and repopulate the database. # d-i dbconfig-common/upgrade-backup boolean true ### Description: Password confirmation: # d-i dbconfig-common/password-confirm password ### Description: Password confirmation: # d-i dbconfig-common/app-password-confirm password ### Description: Next step for database upgrade: # An error occurred while upgrading the database: # . # ${error} # . # Fortunately, ${dbfile} holds a backup of the database, made just before # the upgrade. # . # If at this point you choose "retry", you will be prompted with all the configuration # questions once more and another attempt will be made at performing the # operation. "retry (skip questions)" will immediately attempt the operation # again, skipping all questions. If you choose "abort", the operation will # fail and you will need to downgrade, reinstall, reconfigure this package, # or otherwise manually intervene to continue using it. # d-i dbconfig-common/upgrade-error select abort # Possible choices: abort, retry, retry (skip questions) ### Description: Next step for database installation: # An error occurred while installing the database: # . # ${error} # . # If at this point you choose "retry", you will be prompted with all the configuration # questions once more and another attempt will be made at performing the # operation. "retry (skip questions)" will immediately attempt the operation # again, skipping all questions. If you choose "abort", the operation will # fail and you will need to downgrade, reinstall, reconfigure this package, # or otherwise manually intervene to continue using it. If you choose # "ignore", the operation will continue, ignoring further errors from # dbconfig-common. # d-i dbconfig-common/install-error select abort # Possible choices: abort, retry, retry (skip questions), ignore ### Description: Next step for database removal: # An error occurred while removing the database: # . # ${error} # . # For some reason it was not possible to perform some of the actions necessary # to remove the database for ${pkg}. At this point you have two options: you # can find out what has caused this error and fix it, or you can refuse # the offer for help removing the database (the latter implies you will # have to remove the database manually). # . # If at this point you choose "retry", you will be prompted with all the configuration # questions once more and another attempt will be made at performing the # operation. "retry (skip questions)" will immediately attempt the operation # again, skipping all questions. If you choose "abort", the operation will # fail and you will need to downgrade, reinstall, reconfigure this package, # or otherwise manually intervene to continue using it. # d-i dbconfig-common/remove-error select abort # Possible choices: abort, retry ### Description: Next step: # Configuring the database for ${pkg} requires the package ${dbpackage} # to be installed and configured first, which is not something that can be # checked for automatically. # . # If in doubt, you should choose "abort", and install ${dbpackage} before # continuing with the configuration of this package. If you choose "retry", # you will be allowed to choose different answers (in case you chose the # wrong database type by mistake). If you choose "ignore", then installation # will continue as normal. # d-i dbconfig-common/missing-db-package-error select abort # Possible choices: abort, retry, ignore ### Description: Host name of the ${dbvendor} database server for ${pkg}: # Please select the remote hostname to use, or select "new host" to # enter a new host. # d-i dbconfig-common/remote/host select # Possible choices: ${hosts} ### Description: Port number for the ${dbvendor} service: # Please specify the port the ${dbvendor} database on the remote host is # running on. To use the # default port, leave this field blank. # d-i dbconfig-common/remote/port string ### Description: Host running the ${dbvendor} server for ${pkg}: # Please provide the hostname of a remote ${dbvendor} server. # . # You must have already arranged for the administrative # account to be able to remotely create databases and grant # privileges. # d-i dbconfig-common/remote/newhost string ### Description: ${dbvendor} database name for ${pkg}: # Please provide a name for the ${dbvendor} database to be used by ${pkg}. # d-i dbconfig-common/db/dbname string ### Description: ${dbvendor} username for ${pkg}: # Please provide a ${dbvendor} username for ${pkg} to register with the # database server. A ${dbvendor} user is not necessarily the same as a # system login, especially if the database is on a remote server. # . # This is the user which will own the database, tables and other # objects to be created by this installation. This user will have # complete freedom to insert, change or delete data in the database. # d-i dbconfig-common/db/app-user string ### Description: ${dbvendor} storage directory for ${pkg}: # Please provide a path where the ${dbvendor} database file for ${pkg} # should be installed into. # . # The permissions for this directory will be set to match the permissions # for the generated database file. # d-i dbconfig-common/db/basepath string ### Description: Connection method for MySQL database of ${pkg}: # By default, ${pkg} will be configured to use a MySQL server # through a local unix socket (this provides the best performance). # However, if you would like to connect with a different method, or to a # different server entirely, select an option from the choices below. # d-i dbconfig-common/mysql/method select unix socket # Possible choices: unix socket, tcp/ip ### Description: MySQL application password for ${pkg}: # Please provide a password for ${pkg} to register with the # database server. If left blank, a random password will be # generated. # d-i dbconfig-common/mysql/app-pass password ### Description: Name of the database's administrative user: # Please provide the name of the account with which this package should perform # administrative actions. This user is the one which is able to create # new database users. # . # For MySQL, this is almost always "root". Note that this is NOT the # same as the UNIX login "root". # d-i dbconfig-common/mysql/admin-user string root ### Description: Password of the database's administrative user: # Please provide the password for the administrative account with which this # package should create its MySQL database and user. # d-i dbconfig-common/mysql/admin-pass password ### Description: Connection method for PostgreSQL database of ${pkg}: # By default, ${pkg} will be configured to use a PostgreSQL server # through a local unix socket (this provides the best performance). # However, if you would like to connect with a different method, or to a # different server entirely, select an option from the choices below. # d-i dbconfig-common/pgsql/method select unix socket # Possible choices: unix socket, tcp/ip, tcp/ip + ssl ### Description: PostgreSQL application password for ${pkg}: # Please provide a password for ${pkg} to register with the database # server. If left blank, a random password will be generated. # . # If you are using "ident" based authentication, the supplied password will # not be used and can be left blank. Otherwise, PostgreSQL access may # need to be reconfigured to allow password-authenticated access. # d-i dbconfig-common/pgsql/app-pass password ### Description: Name of the database's administrative user: # Please provide the name of the account with which this package should perform # administrative actions. This user is the one which is able to create # new database users. # d-i dbconfig-common/pgsql/admin-user string postgres ### Description: Password of your database's administrative user: # Please provide the password for the account with which this package should perform # administrative actions. # . # For a standard PostgreSQL package installation, # a database password is not required, since authentication is done at the # system level. # d-i dbconfig-common/pgsql/admin-pass password ### Description: Method for authenticating the PostgreSQL administrator: # PostgreSQL servers provide several different mechanisms for authenticating # connections. Please select what method the administrative user should use # when connecting to the server. # . # With "ident" authentication on the local machine, the # server will check that the owner of the unix socket is allowed to connect. # . # With "ident" authentication to remote hosts, RFC 1413 based ident is # used (note this can be considered a security risk). # . # With "password" authentication, a password will be passed to the server # for use with some authentication backend (such as "md5" or "pam"). Note # that the password is still passed in the clear across network # connections if your connection is not configured to use SSL. # . # For a standard PostgreSQL package installation running on the same host, # "ident" is recommended. # d-i dbconfig-common/pgsql/authmethod-admin select ident # Possible choices: ident, password ### Description: Method for authenticating PostgreSQL user: # PostgreSQL servers provide several different mechanisms for authenticating # connections. Please select what method the database user should use # when connecting to the server. # . # With "ident" authentication on the local machine, the # server will check that the owner of the unix socket is allowed to connect. # . # With "ident" authentication to remote hosts, RFC 1413 based ident is # used (note this can be considered a security risk). # . # With "password" authentication, a password will be passed to the server # for use with some authentication backend (such as "md5" or "pam"). Note # that the password is still passed in the clear across network # connections if your connection is not configured to use SSL. # . # For a standard PostgreSQL package installation running on the same host, # "ident" is recommended. # d-i dbconfig-common/pgsql/authmethod-user select # Possible choices: ident, password ### Description: Change PostgreSQL configuration automatically? # It has been determined that the database installation for ${pkg} # can not be automatically accomplished without making changes to # the PostgreSQL server's access controls. It is suggested that this # be done by dbconfig-common when the package is installed. If # instead you would prefer it done manually, the following line needs # to be added to your pg_hba.conf: # . # ${pghbaline} # d-i dbconfig-common/pgsql/changeconf boolean false ### Description: Revert PostgreSQL configuration automatically? # As ${pkg} is now being removed, it may no longer be necessary to # have an access control entry in the PostgreSQL server's configuration. # While keeping such an entry will not break any software on the # system, it may be seen as a potential security concern. It is suggested # that this be done by dbconfig-common when the package is removed. # If instead you would prefer it done manually, the following line # needs to be removed from your pg_hba.conf: # . # ${pghbaline} # d-i dbconfig-common/pgsql/revertconf boolean false ### Description: for internal use. # d-i dbconfig-common/internal/reconfiguring boolean false ### Description: for internal use. # d-i dbconfig-common/internal/skip-preseed boolean false ############################ #### ddclient_3.8.2-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Dynamic DNS service provider: # Please select the dynamic DNS service you are using. If the service you use is # not listed, choose "other" and you will be asked for the protocol and the # server name. # d-i ddclient/service select www.dyndns.com # Possible choices: www.dyndns.com, www.easydns.com, www.dslreports.com, www.zoneedit.com, other ### Description: Dynamic DNS server: # Please enter the name of the server which is providing you with dynamic DNS # service (example: members.dyndns.org). # d-i ddclient/server string ### Description: Dynamic DNS update protocol: # Please select the dynamic DNS update protocol used by your dynamic DNS service # provider. # d-i ddclient/protocol select dyndns2 # Possible choices: dyndns2, dslreports1, easydns, hammernode1, zoneedit1, dyndns1 ### Description: DynDNS fully qualified domain names: # Please enter the list of fully qualified domain names for the local host(s) # (for instance, "myname.dyndns.org" with only one host or # "myname1.dyndns.org,myname2.dyndns.org" for two hosts). # d-i ddclient/names string ### Description: Username for dynamic DNS service: # Please enter the username to use with the dynamic DNS service. # d-i ddclient/username string ### Description: Password for dynamic DNS service: # Please enter the password to use with the dynamic DNS service. # d-i ddclient/password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter your dynamic DNS service password again to make sure # you typed it correctly. # d-i ddclient/password-repeat password ### Description: Find public IP using checkip.dyndns.com? # Please choose whether ddclient should try to find the IP address # of this machine via the DynDNS web interface. This is recommended # for machines that are using Network Address Translation. # d-i ddclient/checkip boolean true ### Description: Network interface used for dynamic DNS service: # Please enter the name of the network interface (eth0/wlan0/ppp0/...) # to use for dynamic DNS service. # d-i ddclient/interface string ### Description: Run ddclient on DHCP update? # You should enable this option if ddclient should be run every time the # IP address is changed by the DHCP client (dhclient). # Note: This mode is not compatible with daemon mode. # d-i ddclient/run_dhclient boolean false ### Description: Run ddclient on PPP connect? # You should enable this option if ddclient should be run every time a PPP connection is # established. # Note: This mode is not compatible with daemon mode. # d-i ddclient/run_ipup boolean false ### Description: Run ddclient as daemon? # Please choose whether you want ddclient to be run in daemon mode on system # startup. # d-i ddclient/run_daemon boolean false ### Description: Interval between ddclient runs: # Please choose the delay between interface address checks. # Values may be given in seconds (e.g. "5s"), in minutes (e.g. "3m"), in # hours (e.g. "7h") or in days (e.g. "1d"). # d-i ddclient/daemon_interval string 300 ### Description: Selection method for updated names: # You'll have to select which host names to update using ddclient. You can # select host names to update from a list (taken from your DynDNS account) # or enter them manually. # d-i ddclient/fetchhosts select From list # Possible choices: From list, Manually ### Description: Host names to keep updated: # The list of host names managed via your DynDNS account has been downloaded. # Please choose the one(s) for which ddclient should be used to keep IP address # records up to date. # d-i ddclient/hostslist multiselect # Possible choices: ${choices} ############################ #### debconf_1.5.56+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Interface to use: # Packages that use debconf for configuration share a common look and feel. # You can select the type of user interface they use. # . # The dialog frontend is a full-screen, character based interface, while the # readline frontend uses a more traditional plain text interface, and both the # gnome and kde frontends are modern X interfaces, fitting the respective # desktops (but may be used in any X environment). The editor frontend lets you # configure things using your favorite text editor. The noninteractive # frontend never asks you any questions. # d-i debconf/frontend select Dialog # Possible choices: Dialog, Readline, Gnome, Kde, Editor, Noninteractive ### Description: Ignore questions with a priority less than: # Debconf prioritizes the questions it asks you. Pick the lowest priority of # question you want to see: # - 'critical' only prompts you if the system might break. # Pick it if you are a newbie, or in a hurry. # - 'high' is for rather important questions # - 'medium' is for normal questions # - 'low' is for control freaks who want to see everything # . # Note that no matter what level you pick here, you will be able to see # every question if you reconfigure a package with dpkg-reconfigure. # d-i debconf/priority select high # Possible choices: critical, high, medium, low ############################ #### debian-edu-config_1.818+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Should the init.d/update-hostname script run at boot time? # d-i debian-edu-config/update-hostname boolean false ### Description: Do you want to run enable-nat on your system? # The enable-nat script activates NAT for your Thin-Clients and overwrites # your iptables rules. # d-i debian-edu-config/enable-nat boolean false ### Description: Enter the Kerberos KDC master key: # A password is needed as Kerberos master key and for all default principals. # You can use your root password or type something else. Make sure you remember # the password. # . # Note that you will not be able to see the password as you type it. # d-i debian-edu-config/kdc-password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same password again to verify that you have typed it # correctly. # d-i debian-edu-config/kdc-password-again password ### Description: Enter the LDAP super-admin password: # A password is used as initial password for the super-admin user of GOsa². # You can use your root password or type something else. Make sure you remember # the password. # . # Note that you will not be able to see the password as you type it. # d-i debian-edu-config/ldap-password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same password again to verify that you have typed it # correctly. # d-i debian-edu-config/ldap-password-again password ### Description: The username of the first user in LDAP: # This is the username of the administrative user created in LDAP on # the Main-Server # . # for internal use # d-i debian-edu-config/first-user-name string ### Description: The full name of the first user in LDAP: # This is the full name of the administrative user created in LDAP on # the Main-Server # . # for internal use # d-i debian-edu-config/first-user-fullname string ### Description: The password of the initial user: # This password is used as the initial password for the first user in # LDAP. You can use your root password or type something else. Make # sure you remember the password. # . # Note that you will not be able to see the password as you type it. # . # for internal use # d-i debian-edu-config/first-user-password password ############################ #### debian-edu-install_1.821+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use # Preseed this during installation to insert the firstboot init.d script # into the boot sequence. # d-i debian-edu-install/run-firstboot boolean false ############################ #### debian-installer-launcher_19+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### junior-config_1.24_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Debian Junior users: # Please select, among the whole system user list, users who should get # a Debian Junior user menu. # d-i junior-config/group multiselect # Possible choices: ${users} ### Description: Build user menus at: # The metapackages of the Debian Junior Debian Pure Blend # contain extra menus that will be auto generated from existing packages. # If the role based user menu option was choosen these menus will be built # when a user who is registered to a given role uses the "update-menus" # utility. This can be done automatically for all users who are registered # for Debian Junior after installation of each single metapackage, # at the end of the whole installation process to save time in case # of installing more than one metapackage or just leave the call of # "update-menus" to the users themselves. # * Each package installation : Call "update-menus" after each metapackage # (time consuming); # * End of installation : Call "update-menus" only once at the end of # the whole installation/upgrading process; # * Never : Do not call "update-menus" at all. # d-i shared/junior-config/usermenus select never # Possible choices: Each package installation, End of installation, Never ### Description: Do you want user menus? # The menus for the Debian Junior Debian Pure Blend could be # implemented as user menus which means they are visible only for those # users that will be selected explicitely. Be warned that selecting # the users from a large list does not scale very well so it makes no # real sense to activate this feature if there are more than 50 users # on this machine. # d-i shared/junior-config/useusermenus boolean ############################ #### med-config_2.0_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Debian Med users: # Please select, among the whole system user list, users who should get # a Debian Med user menu. # d-i med-config/group multiselect # Possible choices: ${users} ### Description: Build user menus at: # The metapackages of the Debian Med Debian Pure Blend # contain extra menus that will be auto generated from existing packages. # If the role based user menu option was choosen these menus will be built # when a user who is registered to a given role uses the "update-menus" # utility. This can be done automatically for all users who are registered # for Debian Med after installation of each single metapackage, # at the end of the whole installation process to save time in case # of installing more than one metapackage or just leave the call of # "update-menus" to the users themselves. # * Each package installation : Call "update-menus" after each metapackage # (time consuming); # * End of installation : Call "update-menus" only once at the end of # the whole installation/upgrading process; # * Never : Do not call "update-menus" at all. # d-i shared/med-config/usermenus select never # Possible choices: Each package installation, End of installation, Never ### Description: Do you want user menus? # The menus for the Debian Med Debian Pure Blend could be # implemented as user menus which means they are visible only for those # users that will be selected explicitely. Be warned that selecting # the users from a large list does not scale very well so it makes no # real sense to activate this feature if there are more than 50 users # on this machine. # d-i shared/med-config/useusermenus boolean ############################ #### science-config_1.4_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Debian Science users: # Please select, among the whole system user list, users who should get # a Debian Science user menu. # d-i science-config/group multiselect # Possible choices: ${users} ### Description: Build user menus at: # The metapackages of the Debian Science Debian Pure Blend # contain extra menus that will be auto generated from existing packages. # If the role based user menu option was choosen these menus will be built # when a user who is registered to a given role uses the "update-menus" # utility. This can be done automatically for all users who are registered # for Debian Science after installation of each single metapackage, # at the end of the whole installation process to save time in case # of installing more than one metapackage or just leave the call of # "update-menus" to the users themselves. # * Each package installation : Call "update-menus" after each metapackage # (time consuming); # * End of installation : Call "update-menus" only once at the end of # the whole installation/upgrading process; # * Never : Do not call "update-menus" at all. # d-i shared/science-config/usermenus select never # Possible choices: Each package installation, End of installation, Never ### Description: Do you want user menus? # The menus for the Debian Science Debian Pure Blend could be # implemented as user menus which means they are visible only for those # users that will be selected explicitely. Be warned that selecting # the users from a large list does not scale very well so it makes no # real sense to activate this feature if there are more than 50 users # on this machine. # d-i shared/science-config/useusermenus boolean ############################ #### debian-security-support_2018.01.29~deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### debsecan_0.4.17_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want debsecan to send daily reports? # debsecan can check the security status of the host # once per day, and notify you of any changes by email. # . # If you choose this option, debsecan will download a small file # once a day. Your package list will not be transmitted to # the server. # d-i debsecan/report boolean true ### Description: Email address to which daily reports should be sent: # d-i debsecan/mailto string root ### Description: Main suite from which packages are installed: # To present more useful data, debsecan needs to know # the Debian release from which you usually install packages. # . # If you specify "GENERIC" (the default), only basic debsecan # functionality is available. If you specify the suite # matching your sources.list configuration, information about # fixed and obsolete packages will be included in email reports. # d-i debsecan/suite select GENERIC # Possible choices: GENERIC, sarge, etch, lenny, squeeze, wheezy, jessie, sid ### Description: URL of vulnerability information: # debsecan fetches vulnerability information from the network. # If your system is not connected to the Internet, you can enter # the URL of a local mirror here. If you leave this option # empty, the built-in default URL is used. # d-i debsecan/source string ############################ #### designate-api_2014.1-18+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Register Designate in the Keystone endpoint catalog? # Each OpenStack service (each API) should be registered in order to be # accessible. This is done using "keystone service-create" and "keystone # endpoint-create". This can be done automatically now. # . # Note that you will need to have an up and running Keystone server on which to # connect using the Keystone authentication token. # d-i designate/register-endpoint boolean false ### Description: Keystone server IP address: # Please enter the IP address of the Keystone server, so that designate-api can # contact Keystone to do the Designate service and endpoint creation. # d-i designate/keystone-ip string ### Description: Keystone authentication token: # To configure its endpoint in Keystone, designate-api needs the Keystone # authentication token. # d-i designate/keystone-auth-token password ### Description: Designate endpoint IP address: # Please enter the IP address that will be used to contact Designate. # . # This IP address should be accessible from the clients that will use this # service, so if you are installing a public cloud, this should be a public # IP address. # d-i designate/endpoint-ip string ### Description: Name of the region to register: # OpenStack supports using availability zones, with each region representing # a location. Please enter the zone that you wish to use when registering the # endpoint. # d-i designate/region-name string regionOne ############################ #### designate-common_2014.1-18+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Set up a database for Designate? # No database has been set up for designate to use. Before continuing, you # should make sure you have the following information: # . # * the type of database that you want to use; # * the database server hostname (that server must allow TCP connections from # this machine); # * a username and password to access the database. # . # If some of these requirements are missing, do not choose this option and run # with regular SQLite support. # . # You can change this setting later on by running "dpkg-reconfigure -plow # designate-common". # d-i designate/configure_db boolean false ### Description: Authentication server hostname: # Please specify the hostname of the authentication server for Designate. # Typically this is also the hostname of the OpenStack Identity Service # (Keystone). # d-i designate/auth-host string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Authentication server tenant name: # Please specify the authentication server tenant name. # d-i designate/admin-tenant-name string admin ### Description: Authentication server username: # Please specify the username to use with the authentication server. # d-i designate/admin-user string admin ### Description: Authentication server password: # Please specify the password to use with the authentication server. # d-i designate/admin-password password ### Description: IP address of your RabbitMQ host: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the IP address of that server. # d-i designate/rabbit_host string localhost ### Description: Username for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the username used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i designate/rabbit_userid string guest ### Description: Password for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the password used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i designate/rabbit_password password ############################ #### desktop-profiles_1.4.20_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### dhis-client_5.5-4_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### dibbler-client_0.8.2-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should the Dibbler client be launched when the system starts? # The Dibbler client can be configured to be launched when the system # is started. If you choose this option, this host will have a correct # IPv6 setup after booting. Please ensure that a DHCPv6 server is # available on the network. # d-i dibbler-client/start boolean true ### Description: Interfaces to be configured: # Dibbler can configure any or all of a computer's network interfaces. # . # More than one interface may be specified by separating the interface names # with spaces. # d-i dibbler-client/interfaces string eth0 ### Description: Additional parameters to obtain: # The Dibbler client can request that the DHCPv6 server supplies additional # configuration parameters. # d-i dibbler-client/options multiselect dns # Possible choices: dns, domain ############################ #### dibbler-relay_0.8.2-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should the Dibbler relay be launched when the system starts? # The Dibbler relay can be configured to be launched when the system is # started. If you choose this option, this node will forward # DHCPv6 messages between clients, servers and other relays. # d-i dibbler-relay/start boolean true ############################ #### dibbler-server_0.8.2-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should the Dibbler server be launched when the system starts? # The Dibbler server can be configured to be launched when the system # is started. If you choose this option, this node will act as a # DHCPv6 server. It will provide IPv6 addresses and additional # configuration options to other nodes in the network. # d-i dibbler-server/start boolean true ############################ #### dictd_1.12.1+dfsg-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Method for running dictd: # The dictd server can be run either as a stand-alone daemon or from inetd. You can also # disable it entirely. # . # It is recommended to run it as a daemon. # d-i dictd/run_mode select daemon # Possible choices: daemon, inetd, disabled ############################ #### dictionaries-common_1.23.17_all.deb ############################ ### Description: System default ispell dictionary: # Please indicate which dictionary ispell should use as system-wide # default when no other spell-checking dictionary is specified. # . # This sets up the /usr/lib/ispell/default.aff and # /usr/lib/ispell/default.hash symlinks, as well as ispell's global # ispell-wrapper and Emacs defaults. # . # Use "Manual symlink setting" if you want to handle the symlinks # yourself. In this case ispell will have no global ispell-wrapper or # Emacs defaults. # . # The default ispell dictionary can be changed at any time by running # "select-default-ispell". # d-i dictionaries-common/default-ispell select # Possible choices: ${echoices}, Manual symlink setting ### Description: System default wordlist: # Please indicate which wordlist the "/usr/share/dict/words" symlink # should point to. This will provide a simple list of dictionary words # for basic spell-checking and word searches. Use "Manual symlink # setting" if you want to handle this symlink yourself. # . # The default wordlist can be changed at any time by running # "select-default-wordlist". # d-i dictionaries-common/default-wordlist select # Possible choices: ${echoices}, Manual symlink setting ### Description: Remove obsolete /etc/dictionary link? # This system has an obsolete symlink "/etc/dictionary". This is no # longer meaningful, and should be removed. # . # You will be asked to explicitly select the default wordlist during # installation of wordlist packages. You can change your selection at any # time by running "select-default-wordlist". # d-i dictionaries-common/old_wordlist_link boolean true ############################ #### discover_2.1.2-7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Packages to install: # Some packages were found to be useful with your hardware. # Please select those you want to install. # d-i discover/install_hw_packages multiselect # Possible choices: ${PACKAGES} ############################ #### dist_3.5-36-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Name of your organization: # You don't seem to have an /etc/news/organization file. Usually that # contains the name of your organization as you want it to appear on the # Organization line of outgoing articles/mail/patches. Please supply the # name of your organization as you want it to appear on the Organization # line of outgoing articles/patches. (It is nice if this also specifies # your location. Your city name is probably sufficient if well known.) For # example: # . # University of Southern North Dakota, Hoople # . # Type in "--none--" if you do not want to specify one. # d-i shared/news/organization string --none-- ############################ #### distcc_3.1-6.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Start the distcc daemon on startup? # distcc can be run as a daemon, listening on port 3632 for incoming # connections. # . # You have the option of starting the distcc daemon automatically on the # computer startup. If in doubt, it's advised not to start it automatically # on startup. If you later change your mind, you can run: 'dpkg-reconfigure # distcc'. # d-i distcc/daemon boolean false ### Description: Allowed client networks: # The distcc daemon implements access control based on the IP address of the # client, that is trying to connect. Only the hosts or networks listed # here are allowed to connect. # . # You can list multiple hosts and/or networks, separated by spaces. Hosts are # represented by their IP address, networks have to be in CIDR notation, # f.e. "192.168.1.0/24". # . # To change the list at a later point, you can run: 'dpkg-reconfigure distcc'. # d-i distcc/daemon-allow string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Listen interfaces: # The distcc daemon can be bound to a specific network interface. # . # You probably want to choose the interface of your local network by entering # its IP address. If distccd should listen on all interfaces, just enter # nothing. # . # Be sure to protect distccd from unauthorized access, by being careful in # your choice of the listen interface and allowed networks. distccd should # never be accessible from untrusted networks. If that is needed, secureshell # should be used instead of the daemon. # . # To change the address at a later point, you can run: 'dpkg-reconfigure distcc'. # d-i distcc/daemon-listen string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Nice level: # You can start the distcc daemon with a nice level, to give it a low priority # compared to other processes. The start script will only accept values between # 0 and 20. # . # To change this value at a later point, you can run: 'dpkg-reconfigure distcc'. # d-i distcc/daemon-nice string 10 ### Description: Maximum number of concurrent jobs: # You can tell the distcc daemon to accept a maximum number of jobs at a time. # This can be useful on systems that should stay interactive while they serve # as a distcc server. Usually, you will want to set this to a value matching # or doubling the number of cores on this system. # . # To change this value at a later point, you can run: 'dpkg-reconfigure distcc'. # d-i distcc/daemon-jobs string ### Description: Enable Zeroconf support? # distcc has Zeroconf support. # . # If you enable it here, please read /usr/share/doc/distcc/README.Debian to # learn how clients must be configured to make use of it. Also note, that # you need to install the dbus package, if you're going to use Zeroconf. # . # To change this value at a later point, you can run: 'dpkg-reconfigure distcc'. # d-i distcc/daemon-zeroconf boolean false ############################ #### dma_0.9-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: System mail name: # The 'mail name' is the domain name used to 'qualify' mail addresses # without a domain name. # . # This name will also be used by other programs. It should be the # single, fully qualified domain name (FQDN). # . # Thus, if a mail address on the local host is foo@example.org, # the correct value for this option would be example.org. # d-i dma/mailname string ### Description: Smarthost: # Please enter the IP address or the host name of a mail server that # this system should use as outgoing smarthost. If no smarthost is # specified, dma will try to deliver all messages by itself. # d-i dma/relayhost string ############################ #### dnet-common_2.64_all.deb ############################ ### Description: DECnet node name: # All nodes on a DECnet network have a node name. This is similar to the IP # hostname but can only be a maximum of 6 characters long. It is common that # the DECnet name is the same as the IP name (if your machine has one). If you # do not know the answer to this question please contact your system # administrator. # d-i dnet-common/nodename string linux ### Description: DECnet node address: # All nodes on a DECnet network have a node address. This is two numbers # separated with a period (e.g. 3.45) where the first number denotes the area # and the second is the node within that area. # . # Do not make up a number here. If you do not know your DECnet node address # then ask your system administrator. # d-i dnet-common/nodeaddr string 1.10 ### Description: Configure DECnet now: # You can configure your system as a DECnet node now or later. # If you have already set up your system to use DECnet you can # skip this and leave the configuration as it is. # . # If you choose to configure now this will set up your system. # This operation needs to change the MAC address of your network cards, # it may work directly or it may require a reboot. # Please close all open connections such as ssh sessions and downloads # before you continue. # . # If you opt to configure later you can run this configure step again # with: dpkg-reconfigure dnet-common # . # If you are unsure, select 'configure later' and contact your # system administrator. # d-i dnet-common/configure-action select skip and leave config as it is # Possible choices: configure now, configure later, skip and leave config as it is ############################ #### dokuwiki_0.0.20140505.a+dfsg-4_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Web server(s) to configure automatically: # DokuWiki runs on any web server supporting PHP, but only listed # web servers can be configured automatically. # . # Please select the web server(s) that should be configured # automatically for DokuWiki. # d-i dokuwiki/system/configure-webserver multiselect apache2 # Possible choices: apache2, lighttpd ### Description: Should the web server(s) be restarted now? # In order to activate the new configuration, the reconfigured web # server(s) have to be restarted. # d-i dokuwiki/system/restart-webserver boolean true ### Description: Wiki location: # Specify the directory below the server's document root from which # DokuWiki should be accessible. # d-i dokuwiki/system/documentroot string /dokuwiki ### Description: Authorized network: # Wikis normally provide open access to their content, allowing anyone # to modify it. Alternatively, access can be restricted by IP address. # . # If you select "localhost only", only people on the local host (the machine # the wiki is running on) will be able to connect. "local network" will # allow people on machines in a local network (which you will need to # specify) to talk to the wiki. "global" will allow anyone, anywhere, to # connect to the wiki. # . # The default is for site security, but more permissive settings should # be safe unless you have a particular need for privacy. # d-i dokuwiki/system/accessible select localhost only # Possible choices: localhost only, local network, global ### Description: Local network: # The specification of your local network should either be # an IP network in CIDR format (x.x.x.x/y) or a domain specification (like # .example.com). # . # Anyone who matches this specification will be given full and complete # access to DokuWiki's content. # d-i dokuwiki/system/localnet string 10.0.0.0/24 ### Description: Purge pages on package removal? # By default, DokuWiki stores all its pages in a file database in # /var/lib/dokuwiki. # . # Accepting this option will leave you with a tidier system when the # DokuWiki package is removed, but may cause information loss if you have an # operational wiki that gets removed. # d-i dokuwiki/system/purgepages boolean false ### Description: Make the configuration web-writeable? # DokuWiki includes a web-based configuration interface. To be usable, it # requires the web server to have write permission to the configuration # directory. # . # Accepting this option will give the web server write permissions on the # configuration directory and files. # . # The configuration files will still be readable and editable by hand # regardless of whether or not you accept this option. # d-i dokuwiki/system/writeconf boolean false ### Description: Make the plugins directory web-writeable? # DokuWiki includes a web-based plugin installation interface. To be usable, # it requires the web server to have write permission to the plugins directory. # . # Accepting this option will give the web server write permissions to the # plugins directory. # . # Plugins can still be installed by hand regardless of whether or not you # accept this option. # d-i dokuwiki/system/writeplugins boolean false ### Description: Wiki title: # The wiki title will be displayed in the upper right corner of the default # template and on the browser window title. # d-i dokuwiki/wiki/title string Debian DokuWiki ### Description: Wiki license: # Please choose the license you want to apply to your wiki content. If none of # these licenses suits your needs, you will be able to add your own to the file # /etc/dokuwiki/license.php and to refer it in the main configuration file # /etc/dokuwiki/local.php when the installation is finished. # . # Creative Commons "No Rights Reserved" is designed to waive as many rights as # legally possible. # . # CC Attribution is a permissive license that only requires licensees to # give credit to the author. # . # CC Attribution-ShareAlike and GNU Free Documentation License are # copyleft-based free licenses (requiring modifications to be released under # similar terms). # . # CC Attribution-NonCommercial and CC Attribution-Noncommercial-ShareAlike # are non-free licenses, in that they forbid commercial use. # d-i dokuwiki/wiki/license select cc-by-sa # Possible choices: CC0 "No Rights Reserved", CC Attribution, CC Attribution-ShareAlike, GNU Free Documentation Licence, CC Attribution-NonCommercial, CC Attribution-NonCommercial-ShareAlike ### Description: Enable ACL? # Enable this to use an Access Control List for restricting what the users of # your wiki may do. # . # This is a recommended setting because without ACL support you will not have # access to the administration features of DokuWiki. # d-i dokuwiki/wiki/acl boolean true ### Description: Administrator username: # Please enter a name for the administrator account, which will be able to # manage DokuWiki's configuration and create new wiki users. The username # should be composed of lowercase ASCII letters only. # . # If this field is left blank, no administrator account will be created now. # d-i dokuwiki/wiki/superuser string admin ### Description: Administrator real name: # Please enter the full name associated with the wiki administrator account. # This name will be stored in the wiki password file as an informative # field, and will be displayed with the wiki page changes made by the # administrator account. # d-i dokuwiki/wiki/fullname string DokuWiki Administrator ### Description: Administrator email address: # Please enter the email address associated with the wiki administrator account. # This address will be stored in the wiki password file, and may be used # to get a new administrator password if you lose the original. # d-i dokuwiki/wiki/email string webmaster@localhost ### Description: Administrator password: # Please choose a password for the wiki administrator. # d-i dokuwiki/wiki/password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same "admin" password again to verify # you have typed it correctly. # d-i dokuwiki/wiki/confirm password ### Description: Initial ACL policy: # Please select what initial ACL configuration should be set up to match # the intended usage of this wiki: # "open": both readable and writeable for anonymous users; # "public": readable for anonymous users, writeable for registered users; # "closed": readable and writeable for registered users only. # . # This is only an initial setup; you will be able to adjust the ACL rules later. # d-i dokuwiki/wiki/policy select public # Possible choices: open, public, closed ############################ #### dotlrn_2.5.0+dfsg2-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Host running the PostgreSQL server for dotLRN: # Please provide the hostname of a remote PostgreSQL server. # . # You must have already arranged for the administrative # account to be able to remotely create databases and grant # privileges. # d-i dotlrn/db_host string localhost ### Description: Database administrator username: # Please enter the PostgreSQL administrator username, needed for # the database creation. # d-i dotlrn/dba_name string postgres ### Description: Database administrator password: # Please enter the PostgreSQL administrator password, needed for # the database creation. # d-i dotlrn/dba_password password ### Description: Database username for dotLRN: # Please provide a PostgreSQL username for dotLRN to register with the # database server. A PostgreSQL user is not necessarily the same as a # system login, especially if the database is on a remote server. # . # This is the user which will own the database, tables and other # objects to be created by this installation. This user will have # complete freedom to insert, change or delete data in the database. # d-i dotlrn/dbu_name string www-data ### Description: Database owner password: # Please enter the password of the dotLRN database owner. # d-i dotlrn/dbu_password password ### Description: Database owner password confirmation: # Please confirm the password of the dotLRN database owner. # d-i dotlrn/dbu_confirm password ### Description: Grant PostgreSQL access to the dotLRN user? # Please specify whether /etc/postgresql/.../pg_hba.conf should # allow the dotLRN user to access the database. # d-i dotlrn/pg_grant_access boolean ############################ #### idanish_1.6.36-5_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### wdanish_1.6.36-5_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### dtc-xen_0.5.17-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: SOAP server login: # Dtc-xen will start it's Python based SOAP server to listen for incoming # requests over a TCP socket. A remote application (like the dtc web hosting # control panel) can then connect to it in order to start, stop, create and # destroy a VPS. # . # Please enter the login name to connect to the server. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_soap_login string dtc-xen ### Description: SOAP server pass: # Dtc-xen will generate a .htpasswd file for the login you have just # configured. # . # Please enter the password to use in that file. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_soap_pass password ### Description: Debian repository for VPS creation: # Please enter the repository to use for creating the VPS (Virtual Private # Server). The current /etc/apt/sources.list file will be copied to the # created VPS so the repository you enter here will be used only during # the debootstrap stage of the VPS creation. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_debian_repository string ftp://ftp.us.debian.org/debian ### Description: Network mask for the VPS: # Please enter the network mask to use in the created Virtual Private # Server's network settings. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_netmask string ### Description: Network address for the VPS: # Please enter the network address to use in the created Virtual Private # Server's network settings. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_network string ### Description: Broadcast address for the VPS: # Please enter the network broadcast address to use in the created # Virtual Private Server's network settings. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_broadcast string ### Description: Gateway address for the VPS: # Please enter the network gateway address to use in the created # Virtual Private Server's network settings. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_gateway string ### Description: Xen kernel release name: # Please enter the kernel version number as it appears with the # 'uname -a' command. # . # A kernel domU with that name must be located in /boot (example: # vmlinuz-2.6.16.27-xenU) and its corresponding modules must be in # /lib/modules. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_linux_kernel_name string ### Description: Name of the initrd image: # Please enter the name of the initrd ram disk image to use when # setting-up a Linux Xen startup file. Leave this blank to not # setup your domU with a initrd image at all. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_linux_domu_initrd string ### Description: Volume group to create VPS in: # Dtc-xen creates physical partitions in an existing LVM volume group # . # Please enter that volume group name. The volume group size must fit # all the virtual machines you will set up later on this server. If # you don't want to use LVM (because you don't care if loopback is # slower), leave this setting to the default value. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_lvm_name string ### Description: VPS mountpoint: # In order to do the setup of the VPS it's managing, dtc-xen will mount an LVM # device or a file loopback on the dom0 of your Xen server, and then use it as a # partition for your VPS. Loopback mounts by default are limited to a small # number, and since LVM is also faster to access, it is the much preferred # option. This will also be used to automatically set your /etc/fstab mount # points so you can do maintenance and mount VPSes with less hassle. Enter the # desired path prefix for these mount points. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_vps_mountpoint string /var/lib/dtc-xen/mnt ### Description: Debian os to setup: # Select the Debian operating system that you want to have setup when dtc-xen # creates a new VM instance with debootstrap. # d-i dtc-xen/conf_debian_release select squeeze # Possible choices: etch, lenny, squeeze, wheezy, sid ############################ #### dtc-xen-firewall_0.5.17-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: DTC-Xen incoming connection IP address: # This package will bock all connections incoming connection to the default port # of DTC-Xen. Only the IP address of your management server holding the DTC web # panel should be allowed, for security reasons. Please enter the IP address of # your control panel so it will be allowed to connect. # . # By default, all IP will be allowed to connect, which might not be what you # want as this is quite unsecure. # d-i dtc-xen-firewall/conf_soap_server_allowed_ip string 0.0.0.0 ############################ #### durep_0.9-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: HTTP directory for supplementary files: # If this package shall provide disk usage information through a HTTP # CGI-service, it needs a public web directory containing additional files like # style sheet and images. This directory should be visible as '/durep' on the # web site where the durep.cgi page is located. # . # Due to FHS policy these files are not automatically installed to system # directories. To make them accessible, they can either be copied into a # location inside the HTTP root directory, or the web server needs to be # configured accordingly. # . # To configure the Apache webserver (for example), the following directive # creates the needed directory alias: # . # Alias /durep /usr/share/durep/www # . # To install supplementary files into another root directory please specify its # path here. The directory must already exist. A typical answer would be # '/var/www'. The subdirectory '/durep' with files will be created # automatically, the files will be installed from '/usr/share/durep/www' unless # they already exist. # d-i durep/httpfileroot string ### Description: Do you want to enable daily report generation? # If you wish, a daily script will create disk usage statistics of chosen # filesystems. They will be kept for seven days. # . # WARNING: with the default configuration, the statistics are stored in the # public httpd directory, /var/www/durep. This may breach the privacy of the # users. # d-i durep/makereports boolean false ### Description: List of filesystems for durep reports: # To specify single filesystems to report on, enter their mount points # separated by spaces (eg. "/data /var"). A single dot (".") means scanning # of the whole UNIX filesystem tree. # d-i durep/filesystems string . ############################ #### idutch_2.10-2_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wdutch_2.10-2_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### dvi2ps_5.1j-1.2_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### dwww_1.12.1+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Location of web server's document root: # dwww needs to know the path of the directory which contains your web server's # document root. The web standard suggests /var/www. # d-i dwww/docrootdir string /var/www ### Description: Location of web server's cgi directory: # dwww needs to know the path of the directory which contains your web server's # CGI scripts. The web standard suggests /usr/lib/cgi-bin, but your web server # may already be configured for a different location. # d-i dwww/cgidir string /usr/lib/cgi-bin ### Description: Name of CGI user: # dwww needs to know what user will be running the dwww CGI script, as the cache # directory must be owned by that user. # d-i dwww/cgiuser string www-data ### Description: Host name of the web server: # dwww needs to know the host name of your web server. # d-i dwww/servername string localhost ### Description: Web server's port: # dwww needs to know what port your web server is running on. Normally web # servers run on port 80. # d-i dwww/serverport string 80 ### Description: Should post-installation script index your documentation files? # dwww-index++(8) program will be run once a week to index your documentation files # registered with doc-base package. # . # The index can also be generated (in the background) by the post-installation script. # This process needs quite a lot of computer resources, and can take several minutes # so you can choose now if you would like to do this. # d-i dwww/index_docs boolean false ############################ #### efingerd_1.6.5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Permit users to have their own configurable finger replies? # You can decide if efingerd honours users' ~/.efingerd files. # . # If someone from network fingers given user, and the user has ~/.efingerd # file readable and executable for efingerd daemon, this file will be # executed and its output will be sent to the fingerer. # . # This can be either desired or not, depending on your system policy. In # particular, allowing .efingerd files allows users to cheat about their # real identity. However, efingerd can be configured to display users' full # names (from passwd) as the first line of the reply, so they cannot hide # themselves completely. # . # There is however a slight security concern: if you allow .efingerd files, # these files will be executed under efingerd UID, so malicious users gain # access to all files owned by efingerd - this becomes important when you # make efingerd to log into some files writable by the daemon, unless you # take appropriate precautions. # . # If you are the only user, or you trust your users, there is no reason to # disable .efingerd files (and this is probably a reason you want to install # efingerd for). However, if you expect your users to be nasty, you should # better think about protecting from them - in particular, if you enable # logging, make sure they cannot fiddle with the logfile - this is UP TO # YOU. # d-i efingerd/allow_files boolean true ### Description: Display users' real names? # By default, efingerd displays users real names (from passwd) as the first # line of finger reply. You may want to suppress it, but if you allow the # use of .efingerd files at the same time, be aware that users can hide # their identity for the fingerer. # . # If in doubt, select this option. # d-i efingerd/show_names boolean true ############################ #### ejabberd_14.07-4+deb8u3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: The name of the host ejabberd will serve: # Please enter the hostname of your Jabber server (in lowercase). # d-i ejabberd/hostname string localhost ### Description: The username of an admin account for ejabberd: # Please provide the name of an account to administrate the ejabberd server. # After the installation of ejabberd you can use this account to log in with any # Jabber client to do administrative tasks or go to # http://${hostname}:5280/admin/ and log in with this account to enter the admin # interface. Enter the username part here (e.g. ${user}), but use the full Jabber # ID (e.g. ${user}@${hostname}) to log into ejabberd web interface; otherwise it # will fail. # . # Leave empty if you don't want to create an admin account automatically. # d-i ejabberd/user string ### Description: The password for the admin account: # Please enter the password for the administrative user. # d-i ejabberd/password password ### Description: The password for the admin account again for verification: # Please reenter the password for the administrative user for verification. # d-i ejabberd/verify password ############################ #### elilo_3.14-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically run elilo? # It is necessary to run /usr/sbin/elilo to install the new elilo binary into # the EFI partition. # . # WARNING: This procedure will write data into the debian directory of the # EFI disk partition, possibly overwriting files installed there by hand. # . # Not installing the new elilo binary on the EFI disk partition may leave the # system in an unbootable state. Alternatives to automatic updating of the # partition include running /usr/sbin/elilo by hand, or installing the new # /usr/lib/elilo/elilo.efi executable into the EFI disk partition manually. # d-i elilo/runme boolean true ### Description: Reformat and reload EFI partition? # The structure of files in the EFI disk partition has changed since pre-3.2 # versions of the elilo package. The EFI boot manager entry for Debian needs # to be updated to reflect these changes. # . # In most cases, if no manual changes to the EFI partition content need to # be preserved, this update can be handled automatically. # d-i elilo/format boolean true ############################ #### emacspeak_40.0+dfsg-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require # translation. # d-i shared/emacspeak/fake select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Default speech server: # The /etc/emacspeak.conf file will be configured so that the command # '/usr/bin/emacspeak' will start Emacs with emacspeak support using # this server. # . # You may change the selection later by running # 'dpkg-reconfigure emacspeak' as root, or temporarily override the # selection by setting the environment variable DTK_PROGRAM. # d-i shared/emacspeak/device select espeak # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Hardware port of the speech generation device: # If a hardware device is used to generate speech, please enter the # Unix device file associated with it, such as '/dev/ttyS0' or # '/dev/ttyUSB0'. # . # If you use a software method to generate speech, please enter 'none'. # d-i shared/emacspeak/port string none ### Description: Users of speech server: # Users must be members of group ${group} to access the speech server # connected to ${port}. Please review the space-separated list of # current members of that group, and add or remove usernames if needed. # . # If you later add users to the system, you can either reconfigure # the emacspeak package afterwards, or enroll the user in ${group} # with 'adduser ${group} '. # . # Group membership is checked at login time, so new members must log # out and log in again before using the speech server. # d-i shared/emacspeak/groupies string ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require # translation. This variable holds the path to the speech server, # relative to /usr/share//site-lisp/emacspeak/servers. # d-i shared/emacspeak/program string ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require # translation. This variable holds the path to the interpreter if any # used to run the speech server. # d-i shared/emacspeak/tcl string ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require # translation. This variable holds all the available choices for # speech servers, and the corresponding values of "program", "tcl", and # "device" for the above variables. # d-i shared/emacspeak/database select # Possible choices: ${choices} ############################ #### emacspeak-ss_1.12.1-4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require # translation. # d-i shared/emacspeak/fake select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Default speech server: # The /etc/emacspeak.conf file will be configured so that the command # '/usr/bin/emacspeak' will start Emacs with emacspeak support using # this server. # . # You may change the selection later by running # 'dpkg-reconfigure emacspeak' as root, or temporarily override the # selection by setting the environment variable DTK_PROGRAM. # d-i shared/emacspeak/device select DECtalk Express # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Hardware port of the speech generation device: # If a hardware device is used to generate speech, please enter the # Unix device file associated with it, such as '/dev/ttyS0' or # '/dev/ttyUSB0'. # . # If you use a software method to generate speech, please enter 'none'. # d-i shared/emacspeak/port string none ### Description: Users of speech server: # Users must be members of group ${group} to access the speech server # connected to ${port}. Please review the space-separated list of # current members of that group, and add or remove usernames if needed. # . # If you later add users to the system, you can either reconfigure # the emacspeak package afterwards, or enroll the user in ${group} # with 'adduser ${group} '. # . # Group membership is checked at login time, so new members must log # out and log in again before using the speech server. # d-i shared/emacspeak/groupies string ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require # translation. This variable holds the path to the speech server, # relative to /usr/share//site-lisp/emacspeak/servers. # d-i shared/emacspeak/program string ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require # translation. This variable holds the path to the interpreter if any # used to run the speech server. # d-i shared/emacspeak/tcl string ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require # translation. This variable holds all the available choices for # speech servers, and the corresponding values of "program", "tcl", and # "device" for the above variables. # d-i shared/emacspeak/database select # Possible choices: ${choices} ############################ #### email-reminder_0.7.8-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Run daily email-reminder cronjob? # By default, email-reminder checks once a day for reminders that need # to be sent out. # d-i email-reminder/send_reminders boolean true ### Description: SMTP server: # Specify the address of the outgoing mail server that email-reminder # should use to send its emails. # d-i email-reminder/smtp_server string localhost ### Description: SMTP username: # If the outgoing mail server requires a username, enter it here. # . # Leave this blank if the SMTP server doesn't require authentication. # d-i email-reminder/smtp_username string ### Description: SMTP password: # If the outgoing mail server requires a password, enter it here. # . # Leave this blank if the SMTP server doesn't require authentication. # d-i email-reminder/smtp_password password ### Description: Connect to the SMTP server using SSL? # If the SMTP server supports SSL and you choose this option, data # exchanged with it will be encrypted. # d-i email-reminder/smtp_ssl boolean false ### Description: Reminder mails originating address: # Reminder emails will appear to come from this address. The default # should work unless the SMTP server requires routable domains in # source addresses. # d-i email-reminder/mail_from string root@localhost ############################ #### encfs_1.7.4-5_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### iesperanto_2.1.2000.02.25-49_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### esmtp_1.2-12_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically overwrite configuration files? # The mail configuration file /etc/esmtprc can be automatically updated on # each upgrade with the information supplied to the debconf database. If you # do not want this to happen (i.e., you want to maintain control of this file # yourself) then unset this option to prevent the program touching this file. # d-i esmtp/overwriteconfig boolean false ### Description: SMTP server hostname: # d-i esmtp/hostname string localdomain ### Description: SMTP server port number: # d-i esmtp/hostport string 25 ### Description: Authentication username: # This is the username to be given to the mailhub if authentication is # required by the SMTP server. # . # Do NOT set the username and password on the system configuration file # unless you are the sole user of this machine. Esmtp is not run with suid # privileges therefore the system configuration file must be readable by # everyone. If your SMTP server requires authorization and you are not the # only user then accept the default options in the system configuration file # for local delivery and specify your personal SMTP account details in the # user configuration file. # d-i esmtp/username string ### Description: Authentication password: # This is the password to be given to the mailhub if authentication is # required by the SMTP server. # d-i esmtp/password password ### Description: Whether to use the Starttls extension # d-i esmtp/starttls select disabled # Possible choices: enabled, disabled, required ### Description: Certificate passphrase: # This is the certificate passphrase for the StartTLS extension. # d-i esmtp/certificate_passphrase password ### Description: Mail Delivery Agent # This is the Mail Delivery Agent used for local mail delivery. # d-i esmtp/mda select # Possible choices: none, procmail, maildrop ############################ #### ispanish_1.11-9_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### etckeeper_1.15_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove etckeeper ${VCS} repository and associated files? # Etckeeper is being purged from the system, and was used to # store /etc in a ${VCS} repository. If you choose to remove the # repository, this will DESTROY all history etckeeper has recorded # for /etc. # d-i etckeeper/purge boolean true ############################ #### evolution_3.12.9~git20141130.241663-1+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Action for remaining Evolution processes: # Evolution processes are still present on this system, preventing a safe # upgrade. # . # You can either abort the upgrade to work on the situation, or have the # processes killed automatically, with a possible impact on running sessions. # d-i evolution/kill_processes select # Possible choices: Abort, Kill processes and proceed ############################ #### exim4_4.84.2-2+deb8u5_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### exim4-base_4.84.2-2+deb8u5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove undelivered messages in spool directory? # There are e-mail messages in the Exim spool directory # /var/spool/exim4/input/ which have not yet been delivered. Removing # Exim will cause them to remain undelivered until Exim is re-installed. # . # If this option is not chosen, the spool directory is kept, allowing # the messages in the queue to be delivered at a later date after # Exim is re-installed. # d-i exim4/purge_spool boolean false ############################ #### exim4-config_4.84.2-2+deb8u5_all.deb ############################ ### Description: General type of mail configuration: # Please select the mail server configuration type that best meets your needs. # . # Systems with dynamic IP addresses, including dialup systems, should generally # be configured to send outgoing mail to another machine, called a 'smarthost' # for delivery because many receiving systems on the Internet block # incoming mail from dynamic IP addresses as spam protection. # . # A system with a dynamic IP address can receive its own mail, or local # delivery can be disabled entirely (except mail for root and postmaster). # d-i exim4/dc_eximconfig_configtype select local delivery only; not on a network # Possible choices: internet site; mail is sent and received directly using SMTP, mail sent by smarthost; received via SMTP or fetchmail, mail sent by smarthost; no local mail, local delivery only; not on a network, no configuration at this time ### Description: Really leave the mail system unconfigured? # Until the mail system is configured, it will be broken and cannot be # used. Configuration at a later time can be done either by hand or by # running 'dpkg-reconfigure exim4-config' as root. # d-i exim4/no_config boolean true ### Description: System mail name: # The 'mail name' is the domain name used to 'qualify' mail addresses # without a domain name. # . # This name will also be used by other programs. It should be the # single, fully qualified domain name (FQDN). # . # Thus, if a mail address on the local host is foo@example.org, # the correct value for this option would be example.org. # . # This name won't appear on From: lines of outgoing messages if rewriting # is enabled. # d-i exim4/mailname string ### Description: Other destinations for which mail is accepted: # Please enter a semicolon-separated list of recipient domains for # which this machine should consider itself the final destination. # These domains are commonly called 'local domains'. The local hostname # (${fqdn}) and 'localhost' are always added to the list given here. # . # By default all local domains will be treated identically. If both # a.example and b.example are local domains, acc@a.example and # acc@b.example will be delivered to the same final destination. If # different domain names should be treated differently, it is # necessary to edit the config files afterwards. # d-i exim4/dc_other_hostnames string ### Description: Domains to relay mail for: # Please enter a semicolon-separated list of recipient domains for # which this system will relay mail, for example as a fallback MX or # mail gateway. This means that this system will accept mail for these # domains from anywhere on the Internet and deliver them according to # local delivery rules. # . # Do not mention local domains here. Wildcards may be used. # d-i exim4/dc_relay_domains string ### Description: Machines to relay mail for: # Please enter a semicolon-separated list of IP address ranges for # which this system will unconditionally relay mail, functioning as a # smarthost. # . # You should use the standard address/prefix format (e.g. 194.222.242.0/24 # or 5f03:1200:836f::/48). # . # If this system should not be a smarthost for any other host, leave # this list blank. # d-i exim4/dc_relay_nets string ### Description: Visible domain name for local users: # The option to hide the local mail name in outgoing mail was enabled. # It is therefore necessary to specify the domain name this system # should use for the domain part of local users' sender addresses. # d-i exim4/dc_readhost string ### Description: IP address or host name of the outgoing smarthost: # Please enter the IP address or the host name of a mail server that # this system should use as outgoing smarthost. If the smarthost only # accepts your mail on a port different from TCP/25, append two colons # and the port number (for example smarthost.example::587 or # 192.168.254.254::2525). Colons in IPv6 addresses need to be doubled. # . # If the smarthost requires authentication, please refer to # the Debian-specific README files in /usr/share/doc/exim4-base for # notes about setting up SMTP authentication. # d-i exim4/dc_smarthost string ### Description: Root and postmaster mail recipient: # Mail for the 'postmaster', 'root', and other system accounts needs to # be redirected to the user account of the actual system administrator. # . # If this value is left empty, such mail will be saved in /var/mail/mail, # which is not recommended. # . # Note that postmaster's mail should be read on the system to which it is # directed, rather than being forwarded elsewhere, so (at least one of) # the users listed here should not redirect their mail off this machine. # A 'real-' prefix can be used to force local delivery. # . # Multiple user names need to be separated by spaces. # d-i exim4/dc_postmaster string ### Description: IP-addresses to listen on for incoming SMTP connections: # Please enter a semicolon-separated list of IP addresses. The Exim SMTP # listener daemon will listen on all IP addresses listed here. # . # An empty value will cause Exim to listen for connections on all # available network interfaces. # . # If this system only receives mail directly from local services # (and not from other hosts), it is suggested to prohibit external # connections to the local Exim daemon. Such services include e-mail # programs (MUAs) which talk to localhost only as well as fetchmail. # External connections are impossible when 127.0.0.1 is entered here, # as this will disable listening on public network interfaces. # d-i exim4/dc_local_interfaces string notset ### Description: Keep number of DNS-queries minimal (Dial-on-Demand)? # In normal mode of operation Exim does DNS lookups at startup, and when # receiving or delivering messages. This is for logging purposes and # allows keeping down the number of hard-coded values in the # configuration. # . # If this system does not have a DNS full service resolver available at # all times (for example if its Internet access is a dial-up line using # dial-on-demand), this might have unwanted consequences. For example, # starting up Exim or running the queue (even with no messages waiting) # might trigger a costly dial-up-event. # . # This option should be selected if this system is using Dial-on-Demand. # If it has always-on Internet access, this option should be disabled. # d-i exim4/dc_minimaldns boolean false ### Description: Split configuration into small files? # The Debian exim4 packages can either use 'unsplit configuration', a # single monolithic file (/etc/exim4/exim4.conf.template) or 'split # configuration', where the actual Exim configuration files are built # from about 50 smaller files in /etc/exim4/conf.d/. # . # Unsplit configuration is better suited for large modifications and is # generally more stable, whereas split configuration offers a comfortable # way to make smaller modifications but is more fragile and might break # if modified carelessly. # . # A more detailed discussion of split and unsplit configuration can be # found in the Debian-specific README files in /usr/share/doc/exim4-base. # d-i exim4/use_split_config boolean ### Description: Hide local mail name in outgoing mail? # The headers of outgoing mail can be rewritten to make it appear to have been # generated on a different system. If this option is chosen, # '${mailname}', 'localhost' and '${dc_other_hostnames}' in From, Reply-To, # Sender and Return-Path are rewritten. # d-i exim4/hide_mailname boolean ### Description: Delivery method for local mail: # Exim is able to store locally delivered email in different formats. # The most commonly used ones are mbox and Maildir. mbox uses a single # file for the complete mail folder stored in /var/mail/. With Maildir # format every single message is stored in a separate file in ~/Maildir/. # . # Please note that most mail tools in Debian expect the local delivery # method to be mbox in their default. # d-i exim4/dc_localdelivery select mbox format in /var/mail/ # Possible choices: mbox format in /var/mail/, Maildir format in home directory ############################ #### exim4-daemon-heavy_4.84.2-2+deb8u5_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### exim4-daemon-light_4.84.2-2+deb8u5_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### ez-ipupdate_3.0.11b8-13.4.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Dynamic DNS provider to use: # There are many Dynamic DNS providers supported by ez-ipupdate. If you want # your default configuration to be created automatically, you must select the # provider that you wish to use here. You must configure an account on your # chosen provider's service yourself. # . # If you prefer your default ez-ipupdate configuration not to be managed for # you, you may choose "configure manually". # . # Whatever your decision, you can later put as many additional configuration # files in /etc/ez-ipupdate/ as you need. # d-i ez-ipupdate/service_type select # Possible choices: configure manually, zoneedit, ez-ip, pgpow, dhs, dyndns, dyndns-static, dyndns-custom, ods, tzo, easydns, easydns-partner, gnudip, justlinux, dyns, hn, heipv6tb ### Description: Does this system use dialup PPP to connect to the internet? # If you use dialup PPP to connect to the internet, then ez-ipupdate can # be run to notify providers of your new address when ppp connects to the # network. Otherwise it will run in the background, and scan for changes # to your address while you are online. # d-i ez-ipupdate/ppp boolean false ### Description: Address for your Dynamic DNS server: # The service type you selected requires a server address to connect to. You # may specify either a full hostname or an IP address. # d-i ez-ipupdate/server string ### Description: Username for your Dynamic DNS account: # d-i ez-ipupdate/username string ### Description: Password for your Dynamic DNS account: # d-i ez-ipupdate/password password ### Description: Network interface to monitor: # ez-ipupdate will monitor the chosen network interface for changes of IP # address. It is not possible to automatically detect which interface should # be monitored, so you must name the interface here. # d-i ez-ipupdate/interface string eth0 ### Description: Dynamic DNS hostname to keep updated: # d-i ez-ipupdate/hostname string ### Description: Enable DNS wildcards for your Dynamic DNS hostname? # Many Dynamic DNS providers are capable of supporting "wildcard" DNS # lookups. This means that for yourdomain, a lookup for anything.yourdomain # will return an answer that points to yourdomain. # d-i ez-ipupdate/dns_wildcard boolean false ### Description: MX record to add: # Many Dynamic DNS providers are capable of supporting MX records. If you # want an MX record enabled for your domain, specify the content of that MX # record here. If you do not want an MX record, leave it blank. # . # For further information on MX records, what they do, and how they are # used, see your Dynamic DNS provider. # d-i ez-ipupdate/dns_mx string ############################ #### fdutils_5.5-20060227-7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should fdmount be installed 'setuid root'? # In order to enable ordinary users to mount a floppy disk, # the fdmount program can be installed with the set-user-ID bit set, so # that it will run with the permissions of the superuser. # . # Such a setting may have security implications in the case of # vulnerabilities in fdmount's code. # d-i fdutils/fdmount_setuid boolean false ############################ #### ferm_2.2-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable ferm on bootup? # Ferm can load firewall rules on every bootup from /etc/ferm/ferm.conf. # . # The default configuration allows SSH login on port 22; if you are # installing this package remotely on another port, you should not # choose this option, and later edit /etc/default/ferm to enable ferm. # d-i ferm/enable boolean true ############################ #### fiaif_1.23.1-4_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable the fiaif init.d script? # FIAIF init.d setup is completely optional, but is highly recommended. # If you accept here, the package will create init.d runlevel # symlinks to FIAIF. This allows FIAIF to be started automatically at # every boot. # . # Note that fiaif will not start until you edited the configuration file # /etc/fiaif/fiaif.conf, set DONT_START to zero, and reboot. So if you # install fiaif for the first time, it is safe to accept here. If you # have already set DONT_START to zero from an earlier installation, fiaif # will be started after the next reboot. # . # Refuse here to not allow the package to create the runlevel # symlinks. Existing symlinks to FIAIF will be removed. # d-i fiaif/enable_initd boolean true ### Description: Send daily firewall log mail? # The fiaif-scan utility can be run as a cron job to send a # daily firewall log to the site administrator. # Do you want to run a daily script to send firewall log per mail? # d-i fiaif/enable_cron boolean true ############################ #### firebird2.5-classic_2.5.3.26778.ds4-5+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable Firebird server? # Accept if you want Firebird server to start automatically. # . # If you only need the Firebird client and there are no databases that # will be served by this host, decline. # d-i shared/firebird/enabled boolean true ### Description: Password for SYSDBA: # Firebird has a special user named SYSDBA, which is the user that has # access to all databases. SYSDBA can also create new databases and users. # Because of this, it is necessary to secure SYSDBA with a password. # . # The password is stored in /etc/firebird/${FB_VER}/SYSDBA.password # (readable only by root). You may modify it there (don't forget to update # the security database too, using the gsec utility), or you may use # dpkg-reconfigure to update both. # . # If you don't enter a password, a random one will be used (and stored in # SYSDBA.password). # d-i shared/firebird/sysdba_password/first_install password ### Description: Password for SYSDBA: # Firebird has a special user named SYSDBA, which is the user that has # access to all databases. SYSDBA can also create new databases and users. # Because of this, it is necessary to secure SYSDBA with a password. # . # The password is stored in /etc/firebird/${FB_VER}/SYSDBA.password # (readable only by root). You may modify it there (don't forget to update # the security database too, using the gsec utility), or you may use # dpkg-reconfigure to update both. # . # To keep your existing password, leave this blank. # d-i shared/firebird/sysdba_password/upgrade_reconfigure password ### Description: New password for SYSDBA (for internal use) # *DO NOT TRANSLATE* # This is an internal, hidden template # d-i shared/firebird/sysdba_password/new_password password ############################ #### firebird2.5-super_2.5.3.26778.ds4-5+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable Firebird server? # Accept if you want Firebird server to start automatically. # . # If you only need the Firebird client and there are no databases that # will be served by this host, decline. # d-i shared/firebird/enabled boolean true ### Description: Password for SYSDBA: # Firebird has a special user named SYSDBA, which is the user that has # access to all databases. SYSDBA can also create new databases and users. # Because of this, it is necessary to secure SYSDBA with a password. # . # The password is stored in /etc/firebird/${FB_VER}/SYSDBA.password # (readable only by root). You may modify it there (don't forget to update # the security database too, using the gsec utility), or you may use # dpkg-reconfigure to update both. # . # If you don't enter a password, a random one will be used (and stored in # SYSDBA.password). # d-i shared/firebird/sysdba_password/first_install password ### Description: Password for SYSDBA: # Firebird has a special user named SYSDBA, which is the user that has # access to all databases. SYSDBA can also create new databases and users. # Because of this, it is necessary to secure SYSDBA with a password. # . # The password is stored in /etc/firebird/${FB_VER}/SYSDBA.password # (readable only by root). You may modify it there (don't forget to update # the security database too, using the gsec utility), or you may use # dpkg-reconfigure to update both. # . # To keep your existing password, leave this blank. # d-i shared/firebird/sysdba_password/upgrade_reconfigure password ### Description: New password for SYSDBA (for internal use) # *DO NOT TRANSLATE* # This is an internal, hidden template # d-i shared/firebird/sysdba_password/new_password password ############################ #### firebird2.5-superclassic_2.5.3.26778.ds4-5+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable Firebird server? # Accept if you want Firebird server to start automatically. # . # If you only need the Firebird client and there are no databases that # will be served by this host, decline. # d-i shared/firebird/enabled boolean true ### Description: Password for SYSDBA: # Firebird has a special user named SYSDBA, which is the user that has # access to all databases. SYSDBA can also create new databases and users. # Because of this, it is necessary to secure SYSDBA with a password. # . # The password is stored in /etc/firebird/${FB_VER}/SYSDBA.password # (readable only by root). You may modify it there (don't forget to update # the security database too, using the gsec utility), or you may use # dpkg-reconfigure to update both. # . # If you don't enter a password, a random one will be used (and stored in # SYSDBA.password). # d-i shared/firebird/sysdba_password/first_install password ### Description: Password for SYSDBA: # Firebird has a special user named SYSDBA, which is the user that has # access to all databases. SYSDBA can also create new databases and users. # Because of this, it is necessary to secure SYSDBA with a password. # . # The password is stored in /etc/firebird/${FB_VER}/SYSDBA.password # (readable only by root). You may modify it there (don't forget to update # the security database too, using the gsec utility), or you may use # dpkg-reconfigure to update both. # . # To keep your existing password, leave this blank. # d-i shared/firebird/sysdba_password/upgrade_reconfigure password ### Description: New password for SYSDBA (for internal use) # *DO NOT TRANSLATE* # This is an internal, hidden template # d-i shared/firebird/sysdba_password/new_password password ############################ #### flashybrid_0.18_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### libfltk1.1-dev_1.1.10-19+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Make .h links to ? # For compatibility with some older code, FLTK used to make its C++-specific # headers available as as well as . However, the # lowercase-h names are deprecated and should be eliminated from # source code. # . # Please choose whether such compatibility symlinks should be created. # d-i libfltk1.1-dev/header-links boolean false ############################ #### fontconfig-config_2.11.0-6.3+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Font tuning method for screen (system default): # Please select the preferred method for tuning fonts for screen rendering. # . # Select 'Native' if you mostly use DejaVu (the default in Debian) or # any of the Microsoft fonts. Select 'Autohinter' if you mostly use other # TrueType fonts. Select 'None' if you want blurry text. # d-i fontconfig/hinting_type select Native # Possible choices: Native, Autohinter, None ### Description: Enable subpixel rendering for screen: # Rendering text at a subpixel level generally makes it look a bit better # on flat (LCD) screens, but can show color artifacts on CRT screens. The # "Automatic" choice will enable it only if a LCD screen is detected. # d-i fontconfig/subpixel_rendering select Automatic # Possible choices: Automatic, Always, Never ### Description: Enable bitmapped fonts by default? # By default, only outline fonts are used by applications which support # fontconfig. # . # Outline fonts are fonts which scale well to various sizes. In # contrast, bitmapped fonts are often lower quality. Enabling this # option will affect the systemwide default; this and many other # fontconfig options may be enabled or disabled on a per-user basis. # d-i fontconfig/enable_bitmaps boolean false ############################ #### foomatic-filters_4.0.17-5+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable logging debug output into a log file (INSECURE)? # If you choose this option, the log file will be named /tmp/foomatic-rip.log. # . # This option is a potential security issue and should not be used # in production. However, if you are having trouble printing, you should # enable it and include the log file in bug reports. # d-i foomatic-filters/filter_debug boolean false ### Description: Command for converting text files to PostScript: # If you select 'Automagic', Foomatic will search for one of a2ps, # mpage, and enscript (in that order) each time the filter script is executed. # . # Please make sure that the selected command is actually available; otherwise # print jobs may get lost. # . # This setting is ignored when foomatic-filters is used with CUPS; # instead, the texttops program included in the cups package is # always used to convert jobs submitted as plain text to PostScript for # printing to raster devices. # d-i foomatic-filters/textfilter select Automagic # Possible choices: Automagic, a2ps, mpage, enscript, Custom ### Description: Command to convert standard input to PostScript: # Please enter the full command line of a command that converts text from # standard input to PostScript on standard output. # . # Please note that entering an invalid command line here may result in lost # print jobs. # d-i foomatic-filters/custom_textfilter string ### Description: Enable PostScript accounting for CUPS? # You should choose this option if you want to insert PostScript code # for accounting into each print job. This is currently only useful # with CUPS. # d-i foomatic-filters/ps_accounting boolean true ### Description: Printer spooler backend for Foomatic: # Foomatic normally requires a printer spooler (like CUPS or LPRng) to # handle communication with the printer and manage print jobs. If # no spooler is installed, you can use the 'direct' backend, but # this is only recommended for single-user systems. # . # The installation process may have already detected the correct # spooler; however, if this is the initial installation of this system, # or if more than one spooler is installed, # the detected spooler may be incorrect. # d-i foomatic-filters/spooler select direct # Possible choices: cups, lpd, lprng, pdq, ppr, direct ### Description: (for internal use only) # d-i foomatic-filters/config_parsed boolean false ############################ #### fortunes-de_0.31-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Fortunes to use: # You can choose fortunes packages to be used by fortune. # . # If you later change your mind, you can run: 'dpkg-reconfigure # ${pkg}'. # d-i fortunes-de/fortunes_to_install multiselect Anekdoten, ASCIIart, Bahnhof, Bauernregeln, Computer, Debian Tips, Elefanten, Gedichte, Holenlassen, Huhn, Kinder, Letzte Worte, Lieber als, Löwe, Mathematiker, MS, Murphy, Namen, Quiz, Sicherheitshinweise, Sprichworte, Sprüche, Stilblüten, Tips, Translations, Unfug, Vornamen, Warmduscher, Witze, Wörterbuch, Wußten Sie, Zitate # Possible choices: Anekdoten, ASCIIart, Bahnhof, Bauernregeln, Channel Debian, Computer, Debian Tips, Elefanten, Gedichte, Holenlassen, Huhn, Infodrom, Kinder, Letzte Worte, Lieber als, Linuxtag, Löwe, Mathematiker, MS, Murphy, Namen, Rezepte, Quiz, Sicherheitshinweise, Sprichworte, Sprüche, Stilblüten, Tips, Translations, Unfug, Vornamen, Warmduscher, Witze, Wörterbuch, Wußten Sie, Zitate ############################ #### fortunes-fr_0.65+nmu2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Select fortunes to use. # You can choose fortunes packages to be used by fortune. # . # If you later change your mind, you can run: 'dpkg-reconfigure # fortunes-fr'. # d-i fortunes-fr/fortunes_to_install multiselect BD, Cinema, Droit, Haiku, Humoristes, Humour, Informatique, Litterature francaise, Litterature etrangere, Mysoginie, Personnalites, Philosophie, Politique, Proverbes, Religion, Sciences, Guide du Cabaliste Usenet, Guide du Debianiste Pervers, Guide du Fmblien Assassin, Guide du Linuxien Pervers, Guide du Petit Joueur, Maurice et Patapon, Oulipo, Les fortunes de Multidesk OS, Les fortunes de Multidesk OS (2), La tribune libre de linuxfr, #linuxfr@Undernet, Les bonnes fortunes de J.R.R. Tolkien, fr.rec.photo, #debian-fr@freenode # Possible choices: BD, Cinema, Droit, Haiku, Humoristes, Humour, Informatique, Litterature francaise, Litterature etrangere, Mysoginie, Personnalites, Philosophie, Politique, Proverbes, Religion, Sciences, Guide du Cabaliste Usenet, Guide du Debianiste Pervers, Guide du Fmblien Assassin, Guide du Linuxien Pervers, Guide du Petit Joueur, Maurice et Patapon, Oulipo, Les fortunes de Multidesk OS, Les fortunes de Multidesk OS (2), La tribune libre de linuxfr, #linuxfr@Undernet, Les bonnes fortunes de J.R.R. Tolkien, fr.rec.photo, #debian-fr@freenode ############################ #### fp-compiler-2.6.4_2.6.4+dfsg-4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Rename "/etc/fpc.cfg" to "/etc/fpc.cfg.bak"? # FPC now supports having multiple versions installed on the same system. # The update-alternatives command can be used to set a default version for # * fpc (the compiler); # * fpc.cfg (the configuration file); # * fp-utils (the helper tools). # . # Whatever version you may choose as default, the configuration files are # always backward compatible, so it should always be safe to use the latest # version. # . # In order to use the alternatives system on the system wide FPC configuration # file you must accept renaming "/etc/fpc.cfg"; otherwise you will need to # manage this manually by yourself. # d-i fp-compiler/rename_cfg boolean true ### Description: Default MS Windows .rc resource compiler: # FPC supports compiling programs that embed resources as MS Windows # .rc-format files on all platforms where the MinGW windres tool is available. # . # In order to be able to compile projects using .rc files, you need first to # manually install the package mingw32-binutils. mingw32-binutils is suggested # by fp-compiler but not pulled in automatically. # . # If you want to enter a custom .rc file compiler that does not appear in this # list or if you simply want to disable this feature, please select # "Select manually". # d-i fp-compiler/windres-select select Select manually # Possible choices: ${choices}, Select manually ### Description: Default MS Windows .rc resource compiler: # FPC supports compiling programs that embed resources as MS Windows # .rc-format files on all platforms where the MinGW windres tool is available. # . # In order to be able to compile projects using .rc files, you need first to # manually install the package mingw32-binutils. mingw32-binutils is suggested # by fp-compiler but not pulled in automatically. # . # If you don't want to use a default .rc file compiler, leave this blank. # d-i fp-compiler/windres string ############################ #### fprobe_1.1-7.3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Interface to capture: # fprobe will listen on this interface and send the traffic to the collector. # d-i fprobe/interface string eth0 ### Description: Collector address: # Please enter the collector's IP address and port number, separated by a colon. # d-i fprobe/collector string localhost:555 ############################ #### fprobe-ulog_1.1-7.3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Interface(s) to capture: # Each interface must be associated to a SNMP Index and they are separated by a colon. # Please enter a list of interfaces and their corresponding SNMP indexes (for # example eth0:100,ppp0:200). # d-i fprobe-ulog/interface string eth0:100,ppp0:200 ### Description: Collector address: # Please enter the collector's IP address and port number, separated by a colon. # d-i fprobe-ulog/collector string localhost:555 ############################ #### tdsodbc_0.91-6+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want FreeTDS to be registered as an ODBC driver? # You appear to have an ODBC manager (unixodbc or iODBC) installed on your # system. FreeTDS now provides an Open Database Connectivity driver that # can be registered with the manager using the /usr/bin/odbcinst utility. # . # If you wish, FreeTDS will be automatically added as an ODBC driver now and # will be automatically deleted from the list when you remove the freetds # package. # d-i freetds/addtoodbc boolean false ############################ #### freevo_1.9.2b2-4.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Video output: # Please choose the type of video output to use with Freevo. # d-i freevo/display select # Possible choices: x11, fbdev, dxr3, mga, directfb, dfbmga, dga ### Description: Output resolution: # Please choose the resolution to use with Freevo. Most CRT television # systems should be configured as 768x576 (NTSC or PAL). HD television # systems use 1280x720, and FullHD uses 1920x1080. # d-i freevo/geometry select # Possible choices: 1920x1080, 1280x720, 800x600, 768x576, 640x480 ### Description: TV standard: # Please choose the TV standard to use. NTSC is used in North America, # much of South America, and Japan; SECAM in France, the former USSR, # and parts of Africa and the Middle East; and PAL elsewhere. # d-i freevo/norm select # Possible choices: ntsc, pal, secam ### Description: Channel list: # Please choose the channel list (set of tuning frequencies) that most # closely matches the one used in your country. # d-i freevo/chanlist select # Possible choices: USA broadcast, USA cable, USA cable HRC, Japan broadcast, Japan cable, Europe (West), Europe (East), Italy, New Zealand, Australia, Ireland, France, China broadcast, South Africa, Argentina ### Description: Title of video folder: # Please choose the title of the video folder. # . # This will be displayed by Freevo in overview. # d-i freevo/title_video string Video folder ### Description: Path to videos: # Please choose the directory where video files are stored. # . # You must use an absolute path (with a leading "/" character). # d-i freevo/path_to_video string /var/lib/freevo/video ### Description: Title of audio folder: # Please choose the title of the audio folder. # . # This will be displayed by Freevo in overview. # d-i freevo/title_audio string Audio folder ### Description: Path to audio folder: # Please choose the directory where audio files are stored. # . # You must use an absolute path (with a leading "/" character). # d-i freevo/path_to_audio string /var/lib/freevo/audio ### Description: Title of image folder: # Please choose the title of the image folder. # . # This will be displayed by Freevo in overview. # d-i freevo/title_image string Image folder ### Description: Path to image folder: # Please choose the directory where image files are stored. # . # You must use an absolute path (with a leading "/" character). # d-i freevo/path_to_image string /var/lib/freevo/image ### Description: Path to recorded video folder: # Please choose the directory where video recording files are stored. # . # You must use an absolute path (with a leading "/" character). # d-i freevo/path_to_recordings string /var/lib/freevo/recordings ### Description: Services to start during boot: # Freevo can be started automatically when the machine boots, using a # dedicated X server. Web, encoding, RSS, and recording servers can be # launched at the same time. # . # Please choose the services you wish to start on boot. # d-i freevo/services multiselect xserver, recordserver, encodingserver # Possible choices: xserver, recordserver, encodingserver, webserver, rssserver ############################ #### fts_1.1-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Base directory for the TFTP files: # Please note that the configuration directory for TFTP is the one that # usually contains the pxelinux.0 file. It has to be configured to the same # value that is used by your TFTP server. # d-i fts/tftppath string /var/lib/tftpboot ############################ #### gforge-common_5.3.2+20141104-3+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: FusionForge domain or subdomain name: # Please enter the domain that will host the FusionForge installation. Some # services (scm, lists, etc.) will be given their own subdomain in that # domain. # d-i fusionforge/shared/web_host string ### Description: FusionForge system name: # Please enter the name of the FusionForge system. It is used in various places # throughout the system. # d-i fusionforge/shared/forge_name string FusionForge ############################ #### gforge-db-postgresql_5.3.2+20141104-3+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: FusionForge administrator password: # The FusionForge administrator account will have full privileges on the # forge. It will be used to approve the creation of new projects. # . # Please choose the password for this forge account. # d-i fusionforge/shared/admin_password password ### Description: Password confirmation: # Please re-type the password for confirmation. # d-i fusionforge/shared/admin_password_confirm password ### Description: What do you want to do about configuration file ${BASENAME}? # The configuration file ${FILE} needs to be modified by fusionforge, # whereas it is also a configuration file of the postgresql package. # d-i fusionforge/ucfchangeprompt select install_new # Possible choices: install the new version configured by fusionforge, keep the local version currently installed, show the differences between the versions, show a side-by-side difference between the versions, start a new shell to examine the situation ############################ #### fwanalog_0.6.9-6.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Output language: # Please select the language you would like the reports to be generated in. # If you want your own custom language, please look in # /usr/share/doc/fwanalog/support - there are a few scripts to convert # analog .lng files to other languages. If you make a custom # translation, please submit it to the author. # d-i fwanalog/language select English # Possible choices: English, German, French, Italian ### Description: Do you wish to run fwanalog from cron daily ? # Enabling this option a daily cron-job will be set up to start fwanalog, # thereby producing fresh reports every day. # d-i fwanalog/cron boolean true ### Description: User who will receive the report via e-mail: # Enter the email-address of the person who should receive the log created # by the cron-job. Just enter a blank line, and no mail will be sent. # d-i fwanalog/mailto string root ############################ #### fwlogwatch_1.2-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Would you like fwlogwatch as a daemon (realtime mode)? # Running fwlogwatch as a daemon will let fwlogwatch act (i.e. adding new # firewall rules) against active 'attacks', or warn you (i.e. sending email) # about them. It could also run a web server to access fwlogwatch's current # status. # d-i fwlogwatch/realtime boolean false ### Description: Add new firewall rules (or take another action) in case of alert? # Don't use this option unless you know what you're doing. Doing so could # expose your system to a Denial of Service attack. i.e. spoofed packets # could be made to look like coming from your DNS. Adding a rule to block # packets from your DNS won't be good ;-) # . # In case of choosing 'other', you'll have to edit # '/etc/fwlogwatch/fwlw_respond' to meet your requirements. # d-i fwlogwatch/respond select no # Possible choices: no, yes (iptables), yes (ipchains), yes (other) ### Description: Send alerts by mail or other ways? # This option will make fwlogwatch send you alerts by email or other ways. # You may wish to adjust 'alert_threshold' in # '/etc/fwlogwatch/fwlogwatch.config' to avoid getting too many warnings. # . # In case of choosing 'other', you'll have to edit # '/etc/fwlogwatch/fwlw_notify' to meet your requirements. # d-i fwlogwatch/notify select no # Possible choices: no, yes (mail), yes (other) ### Description: Email address to send the alerts to: # d-i fwlogwatch/email string root@localhost ### Description: Email address to send daily reports on firewall events: # If you want a daily cron job to send you an email with a report of the # day's log entries, just type the address where you want the email to be # sent. # . # If you don't want these emails, just set the field to 'none' (without # quotes). # d-i fwlogwatch/cron_email string none ### Description: fwlogwatch parameters to use in the cron job: # If you do not know what these mean, it's safe to leave the defaults. # d-i fwlogwatch/cron_parameters string -p -d -O ta -t -e -l 1d ### Description: Rebuild configuration file from debconf's values? # d-i fwlogwatch/buildconfig boolean true ############################ #### fwsnort_1.6.5-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Download the rules? # The latest Snort rules can be downloaded from http://www.emergingthreats.net # in order to keep fwsnort up-to-date. # d-i fwsnort/download boolean false ############################ #### ganeti-2.12_2.12.4-1+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Abort ${package} removal? # You are attempting to remove ${package}, but it seems that the running Ganeti # version is still ${version}. # . # This can happen if you upgrade the ganeti package to a new minor version, but # have not run "gnt-cluster upgrade" yet. Removing ${package} will cause Ganeti to # stop functioning correctly. # . # It is highly recommended to abort the removal now and upgrade the cluster before # removing ${package}. # d-i ganeti-2.12/abort-removal boolean true ############################ #### ganeti-haskell-2.12_2.12.4-1+deb8u3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Abort ${package} removal? # You are attempting to remove ${package}, but it seems that the running Ganeti # version is still ${version}. # . # This can happen if you upgrade the ganeti package to a new minor version, but # have not run "gnt-cluster upgrade" yet. Removing ${package} will cause Ganeti to # stop functioning correctly. # . # It is highly recommended to abort the removal now and upgrade the cluster before # removing ${package}. # d-i ganeti-haskell-2.12/abort-removal boolean true ############################ #### ganeti-htools-2.12_2.12.4-1+deb8u3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Abort ${package} removal? # You are attempting to remove ${package}, but it seems that the running Ganeti # version is still ${version}. # . # This can happen if you upgrade the ganeti package to a new minor version, but # have not run "gnt-cluster upgrade" yet. Removing ${package} will cause Ganeti to # stop functioning correctly. # . # It is highly recommended to abort the removal now and upgrade the cluster before # removing ${package}. # d-i ganeti-htools-2.12/abort-removal boolean true ############################ #### ganglia-webfrontend_3.6.1-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically configure apache2? # The ganglia front-end will be unavailable until a web server is configured. # Automatic configuration can be performed for the Apache 2 web server. # d-i ganglia-webfrontend/webserver boolean false ### Description: Restart apache2? # In order to activate the new configuration, the web server needs # to be restarted. If you choose not to do this automatically, you should # do so manually at the first opportunity. # d-i ganglia-webfrontend/restart boolean false ############################ #### gcl_2.6.12-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Use the work-in-progress ANSI build by default? # GCL is in the process of providing an ANSI compliant image in addition to # its traditional CLtL1 image still in production use. # . # Please see the README.Debian file for a brief description of these terms. # Choosing this option will determine which image will be used by default # when executing 'gcl'. # . # This setting may be overridden by setting the GCL_ANSI # environment variable to any non-empty string for the ANSI build, and to # the empty string for the CLtL1 build, e.g. GCL_ANSI=t gcl. The # currently enforced build flavor will be reported in the initial startup # banner. # d-i gcl/default_gcl_ansi boolean ### Description: Use the profiling build by default? # GCL has optional support for profiling via gprof. # . # Please see the documentation for si::gprof-start and si::gprof-quit # for details. As this build is slower than builds without gprof # support, it is not recommended for final production use. # . # Set the GCL_PROF environment variable to the empty string for more # optimized builds, or any non-empty string for profiling support; e.g. # GCL_PROF=t gcl. If profiling is enabled, this will be reported # in the initial startup banner. # d-i gcl/default_gcl_prof boolean ############################ #### gdm3_3.14.1-7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # d-i gdm3/daemon_name string /usr/sbin/gdm3 ### Description: Default display manager: # A display manager is a program that provides graphical login capabilities for # the X Window System. # . # Only one display manager can manage a given X server, but multiple display # manager packages are installed. Please select which display manager should # run by default. # . # Multiple display managers can run simultaneously if they are configured to # manage different servers; to achieve this, configure the display managers # accordingly, edit each of their init scripts in /etc/init.d, and disable the # check for a default display manager. # d-i shared/default-x-display-manager select # Possible choices: ${choices} ############################ #### geneweb_6.05.1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Geneweb default language: # Geneweb can display its prompts in a number of languages. # . # Select a default language for Geneweb to use in its page rendering. # . # Other languages will still be available. # d-i geneweb/lang select English # Possible choices: Afrikaans, Bulgarian, Breton, Catalan; Valencian, Chinese, Czech, Danish, Dutch; Flemish, English, Esperanto, Estonian, Finnish, French, German, Hebrew, Icelandic, Italian, Latvian, Norwegian, Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Slovenian, Spanish; Castilian, Swedish ### Description: Geneweb daemon listening port: # The port used by the geneweb daemon (gwd) for incoming connections may be configured here. # . # Choose a port number above 1023 for the port gwd will listen to. # . # If unsure, leave the default value of 2317. # d-i geneweb/port string 2317 ### Description: Geneweb start mode: # The Geneweb daemon gwd can be launched automatically at startup, # manually by the system administrator, or by any user when it is needed. # . # If you choose "Always on", Geneweb will be launched at the system startup. # . # If you want to prevent the automatic startup of Geneweb, for # example if you prefer to run it as a CGI program, then choose "Manual". # d-i geneweb/run_mode select Always on # Possible choices: Always on, Manual ### Description: Remove Geneweb database directory on package purge? # Geneweb's databases will be stored in the database directory /var/lib/geneweb. # These databases may be put there by authorized users who must be members of # the "geneweb" group. # . # Please choose whether you want to remove databases automatically when # purging the package (completely removing it). # . # THIS WOULD ERASE USER-OWNED DATA. You have to be sure if you accept the # purge. # . # Note that if this directory is empty at the time you purge or simply # remove the package, it will always be automatically removed. # d-i geneweb/remove_databases boolean false ############################ #### gwsetup_6.05.1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Gwsetup daemon listening port: # The port used by the gwsetup daemon for incoming connections may be configured here. # . # Choose a port number above 1023 for the port gwsetup will listen to. # . # If unsure, leave the default value of 2316. # d-i gwsetup/port string 2316 ### Description: Gwsetup start mode: # The Gwsetup daemon can be launched automatically at startup, # manually by the system administrator, or by any user when it is needed. # . # If you choose "Always on", gwsetup will be launched at the system startup. # . # If you want to prevent the automatic startup of gwsetup, then choose "Manual". # d-i gwsetup/run_mode select Always on # Possible choices: Always on, Manual ############################ #### gitolite3_3.6.1-2+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: System username for gitolite: # Please enter the name for the system user which should be used by # gitolite to access repositories. It will be created if necessary. # d-i gitolite3/gituser string gitolite3 ### Description: Repository path: # Please enter the path in which gitolite should store the repositories. # This will become the gitolite system user's home directory. # d-i gitolite3/gitdir string /var/lib/gitolite3 ### Description: Administrator's SSH key: # Please specify the key of the user that will administer the access # configuration of gitolite. # . # This can be either the SSH public key itself, or the path to a file # containing it. If it is blank, gitolite will be left unconfigured and # must be set up manually. # . # If migrating from gitolite version 2.x, leave this blank. # d-i gitolite3/adminkey string ############################ #### glance-api_2014.1.3-12+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Register Glance in the Keystone endpoint catalog? # Each OpenStack service (each API) should be registered in order to be # accessible. This is done using "keystone service-create" and "keystone # endpoint-create". This can be done automatically now. # . # Note that you will need to have an up and running Keystone server on which to # connect using the Keystone authentication token. # d-i glance/register-endpoint boolean false ### Description: Keystone server IP address: # Please enter the IP address of the Keystone server, so that glance-api can # contact Keystone to do the Glance service and endpoint creation. # d-i glance/keystone-ip string ### Description: Keystone authentication token: # To configure its endpoint in Keystone, glance-api needs the Keystone # authentication token. # d-i glance/keystone-auth-token password ### Description: Glance endpoint IP address: # Please enter the IP address that will be used to contact Glance. # . # This IP address should be accessible from the clients that will use this # service, so if you are installing a public cloud, this should be a public # IP address. # d-i glance/endpoint-ip string ### Description: Name of the region to register: # OpenStack supports using availability zones, with each region representing # a location. Please enter the zone that you wish to use when registering the # endpoint. # d-i glance/region-name string regionOne ############################ #### glance-common_2014.1.3-12+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Pipeline flavor: # Please specify the flavor of the pipeline to be used by Glance. # . # If you use the OpenStack Identity Service (Keystone), you might want to # select "keystone". If you don't use this service, you can safely choose # "caching" only. # d-i glance/paste-flavor select caching # Possible choices: keystone, caching, keystone+caching, cachemanagement, keystone+cachemanagement ### Description: Authentication server hostname: # Please specify the hostname of the authentication server for Glance. Typically # this is also the hostname of the OpenStack Identity Service (Keystone). # d-i glance/auth-host string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Authentication server tenant name: # Please specify the authentication server tenant name. # d-i glance/admin-tenant-name string admin ### Description: Authentication server username: # Please specify the username to use with the authentication server. # d-i glance/admin-user string admin ### Description: Authentication server password: # Please specify the password to use with the authentication server. # d-i glance/admin-password password ### Description: Set up a database for Glance? # No database has been set up for glance-registry or glance-api to use. Before # continuing, you should make sure you have the following information: # . # * the type of database that you want to use; # * the database server hostname (that server must allow TCP connections from this # machine); # * a username and password to access the database. # . # If some of these requirements are missing, do not choose this option and run with # regular SQLite support. # . # You can change this setting later on by running "dpkg-reconfigure -plow # glance-common". # d-i glance/configure_db boolean false ### Description: IP address of your RabbitMQ host: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the IP address of that server. # d-i glance/rabbit_host string localhost ### Description: Username for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the username used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i glance/rabbit_userid string guest ### Description: Password for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the password used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i glance/rabbit_password password ############################ #### libc6_2.19-18+deb8u10_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to upgrade glibc now? # Running services and programs that are using NSS need to be restarted, # otherwise they might not be able to do lookup or authentication any more. # The installation process is able to restart some services (such as ssh or # telnetd), but other programs cannot be restarted automatically. One such # program that needs manual stopping and restart after the glibc upgrade by # yourself is xdm - because automatic restart might disconnect your active # X11 sessions. # . # This script detected the following installed services which must be # stopped before the upgrade: ${services} # . # If you want to interrupt the upgrade now and continue later, please # answer No to the question below. # d-i glibc/upgrade boolean true ### Description: Services to restart for GNU libc library upgrade: # Running services and programs that are using NSS need to be restarted, # otherwise they might not be able to do lookup or authentication any more # (for services such as ssh, this can affect your ability to login). # Please review the following space-separated list of init.d scripts for # services to be restarted now, and correct it if needed. # . # Note: restarting sshd/telnetd should not affect any existing connections. # d-i glibc/restart-services string ### Description: Restart services during package upgrades without asking? # There are services installed on your system which need to be restarted # when certain libraries, such as libpam, libc, and libssl, are upgraded. # Since these restarts may cause interruptions of service for the system, # you will normally be prompted on each upgrade for the list of services # you wish to restart. You can choose this option to avoid being prompted; # instead, all necessary restarts will be done for you automatically so you # can avoid being asked questions on each library upgrade. # d-i libraries/restart-without-asking boolean false ############################ #### locales_2.19-18+deb8u10_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Locales to be generated: # Locales are a framework to switch between multiple languages and # allow users to use their language, country, characters, collation # order, etc. # . # Please choose which locales to generate. UTF-8 locales should be # chosen by default, particularly for new installations. Other # character sets may be useful for backwards compatibility with older # systems and software. # d-i locales/locales_to_be_generated multiselect # Possible choices: All locales, ${locales} ### Description: Default locale for the system environment: # Many packages in Debian use locales to display text in the correct # language for the user. You can choose a default locale for the system # from the generated locales. # . # This will select the default language for the entire system. If this # system is a multi-user system where not all users are able to speak # the default language, they will experience difficulties. # d-i locales/default_environment_locale select None # Possible choices: None, C.UTF-8, ${locales} ############################ #### libglide3_2002.04.10ds1-11_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Manually select driver for 3Dfx card? # No 3Dfx card that is supported by glide3 was found. This package # supports cards based on the following 3Dfx chipsets: Voodoo # Banshee, Voodoo 3, Voodoo 4, and Voodoo 5. # . # If the graphics card in this computer does not use one of these # chipsets, and you are not compiling programs against glide, # this package will not be useful. # . # If the graphics card is based on one of these chipsets, you # should file a bug report against this package, including the output from the # "lspci -vm" command. # . # Please choose whether you want to manually select the driver to use for now. # d-i libglide3/no_card boolean false ### Description: Driver for 3D acceleration: # Please select the driver you would like to use for 3D acceleration: # * h3: Voodoo Banshee and Voodoo 3; # * h5: Voodoo 4 and Voodoo 5. # d-i libglide3/driver select ${default} # Possible choices: h3, h5 ### Description: Card to use for 3D acceleration: # Multiple 3Dfx-based cards were detected based on one of the # following 3Dfx chipsets: Voodoo 2, Voodoo Banshee, Voodoo 3, Voodoo 4, and Voodoo 5. # . # Please select the card you would like to use for 3D acceleration. # d-i libglide3/card select # Possible choices: ${choices} ############################ #### glpi_0.84.8+dfsg.1-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Web server to reconfigure automatically: # If you do not select a web server to reconfigure automatically, glpi will # not be usable until you reconfigure your webserver to enable glpi. # d-i glpi/webserver multiselect apache, apache-ssl, apache-perl, apache2 # Possible choices: apache, apache-ssl, apache-perl, apache2 ############################ #### gnarwl_3.6.dfsg-6.2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Name/address of the LDAP server: # Gnarwl contacts a LDAP server in order to get information about # vacation messages and accounts. Please specify the server, # optionally with the port to be used. # . # Example: ldap.yourdomain.local:389 # d-i gnarwl/server string ### Description: Base DN of the LDAP server: # In order to access the LDAP server, please specify the base gnarwl # should use for LDAP queries. # . # Example: dc=yourdomain,dc=somewhere # d-i gnarwl/base string ############################ #### gnats-user_4.1.0-3+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: What is the name of the GNATS site? # This name should be a single word, it is used as a part of the e-mail # alias for delivering problem reports. # d-i gnats/site string ############################ #### gnubg_1.04.000-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Build bearoff database? # For maximum strength, GNU Backgammon needs a two-sided bearoff database, # used to evaluate positions in the end-game. This database takes up # 6.6MB of disk space and requires several minutes to generate on a # reasonably fast computer. GNU Backgammon is fully playable without this # database, but will use weaker heuristics for the end of the game. # d-i gnubg/build-bearoffs boolean false ############################ #### gnumeric_1.12.18-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Really upgrade gnumeric? # An instance of gnumeric is currently running. If you # upgrade now, it may no longer be able to save its data. # . # You should close the running instances of gnumeric # before upgrading this package. # d-i gnumeric/existing-process boolean false ############################ #### gnunet_0.10.1-2.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: GNUnet user: # Please choose the user that the GNUnet server process will run as. # . # This should be a dedicated account. If the specified account does not # already exist, it will automatically be created, with no login shell. # d-i gnunet-server/username string gnunet ### Description: GNUnet group: # Please choose the group that the GNUnet server process will run as. # . # This should be a dedicated group, not one that already owns data. # Only the members of this group will have access to GNUnet data, and # be allowed to start and stop the GNUnet server. # d-i gnunet-server/groupname string gnunet ### Description: Should the GNUnet server be launched on boot? # If you choose this option, a GNUnet server will be launched each time # the system is started. Otherwise, you will need to launch # GNUnet each time you want to use it. # d-i gnunet-server/autostart boolean true ############################ #### gom_0.30.2-6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Initialize mixer on system startup? # If you choose this option, "/etc/init.d/gom start" (on system # startup, or if run manually) will set mixer settings to your saved # configuration. # . # You may use upstream's "gomconfig" script as root later to fine-tune # the settings. # d-i gom/auto_init boolean false ### Description: Space-separated list of valid sound devices: # If none of these device names exists in /proc/devices, # /etc/init.d/gom will exit silently (so it does not produce errors if # the system has no sound at all). # . # You would usually not touch the default value ("sound" is OSS, "alsa" # is ALSA). # d-i gom/valid_sound_devices string sound alsa ### Description: Remove /etc/gom completely? # The /etc/gom directory seems to contain additional local # customization files. Please choose whether you want to remove it # entirely. # d-i gom/purge_etc_gom boolean true ### Description: Remove obsoleted /etc/rc.boot/gom? # The /etc/rc.boot/gom file is obsoleted but might contain local # customizations. # d-i gom/remove_obsolete_rcboot boolean true ############################ #### gosa-desktop_2.7.4+reloaded2-1+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: URL to your GOsa installation: # The gosa start script can automatically point your # browser to a system wide default location of your # GOsa instance. # . # Enter the URL in order to set this default. # d-i gosa-desktop/url string https://www.gosa-project.org/demo/trunk ############################ #### goto-fai-progress_3.0-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### gpm_1.20.4-6.1+b2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to (re)start GPM while X is running? # Usually, GPM should be started or restarted when it is installed or # upgraded. However, when X is running and trying to use the same mouse # device, this can sometimes cause a problem with the X mouse cursor. # Switching to the console and then back to X will usually fix it. # d-i gpm/restart boolean false ### Description: Mouse device for GPM: # Please enter the mouse device name. # . # Common mouse devices names: # - PS/2 mouse: /dev/psaux # - Serial mouse: /dev/ttySx # - USB mouse: /dev/input/mice # - Sun mouse: /dev/sunmouse # - M68k Mac mouse: /dev/mouse # d-i gpm/device string ### Description: Mouse type: # Available mouse types are: # . # Name Description # . # PS/2 mice: round 6-pin connector # autops2 Most PS/2 mice; specific protocol will be auto-detected. # Also use this for USB and ADB mice. # ps2 Standard PS/2 mice, 2 or 3 buttons # imps2 Microsoft IntelliMouse and compatibles; PS/2 mice with # 3 buttons and a scroll wheel # exps2 Newer Microsoft IntelliMouse and compatible, may have # more than 3 buttons. Most newer PS/2 mice are this type. # synps2 Synaptics PS/2 TouchPad, found on many laptops # netmouse Genius NetMouse, 2 normal buttons plus an "Up/Down" button # fups2 Same as "ps2" but may be needed for certain broken # mice or KVM switches # fuimps2 Same as "imps2" but may be needed for certain broken # mice or KVM switches # . # Serial mice: 9-pin or 25-pin serial connector # msc The MouseSystems protocol. Most 3-button serial mice. # mman The MouseMan protocol used by newer Logitech serial mice # ms3 Microsoft IntelliMouse, 3 buttons plus scroll wheel # ms Microsoft serial mice, 2 or 3 buttons, no wheel # ms+ Like 'ms', but allows dragging with the middle button # ms+lr 'ms+', but you can reset m by pressing lr (see man page) # pnp Microsoft's "plug and play" serial mouse standard # bare 2-button Microsoft serial mice. Use this one if the 'ms' # protocol seems to produce spurious middle-button events. # mm MM series. Probably an old protocol. # logi Old serial Logitech mice # logim Old Logitech serial mice in MouseSystems mode (3 buttons) # syn Synaptics TouchPad, serial version # brw Fellowes Browser - 4 buttons and a wheel # . # Other mice # bm Some Microsoft and Logitech bus mice: 8-pin round connector # vsxxxaa The DEC VSXXX-AA/GA serial mouse on DEC workstations # sun Sparc mice # . # Non-mice # js Mouse emulation with a joystick # cal Calcomp UltraSlate in absolute mode # calr Calcomp UltraSlate in relative mode # twid Handykey Twiddler keyboard # ncr Ncr3125pen, found on some laptops # wacom Wacom Protocol IV Tablets: Pen+Mouse, # relative+absolute mode # genitizer Genitizer tablet, in relative mode # summa Summa/Genius tablet in absolute mode # (906, 1212B, EasyPainter...) # mtouch MicroTouch touch-screens (only button-1 events reported) # gunze Gunze touch-screens (only button-1 events reported) # acecad Acecad tablet in absolute mode (Summagraphics MM-Series mode) # wp Genius WizardPad tablet # d-i gpm/type string ### Description: Mouse responsiveness: # The responsiveness defines how often the cursor responds to mouse # movement, and is expressed as a number. If the mouse seems to # move too slowly, try setting this to 15. # d-i gpm/responsiveness string ### Description: Protocol to use for repeating mouse events: # GPM can act as a repeater via /dev/gpmdata, and give both GPM and X access # to the mouse data in configurations where it would otherwise only be available # to only X or GPM. # . # Enter 'none' to turn repeating off. # d-i gpm/repeat_type string ms3 ### Description: Mouse sample rate: # The sample rate defines how often GPM polls the mouse device for new # position data. Tweaking it can make the mouse appear to move more # smoothly, but this option is for experts only. # d-i gpm/sample_rate string ### Description: Additional arguments for the GPM daemon: # Please enter any additional arguments that the GPM daemon should use. # d-i gpm/append string ############################ #### gpr_0.15deb-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: divert lpr with a wrapper that points to gpr? # gpr can install a wrapper in place of the command lpr. The wrapper will # call the real lpr command if: either it is called from a terminal, or # there is no access to an X DISPLAY; otherwise it will call gpr. This # wrapper can be useful when printing from graphical programs (such as # mozilla or openoffice), so that the users will be able to choose the # printer and other printer-related settings. # d-i gpr/divert_lpr boolean false ############################ #### graphite-carbon_0.9.12-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove database files when purging graphite-carbon? # The /var/lib/graphite/whisper directory contains the whisper database # files. # . # You may want to keep these database files even if you completely # remove graphite-carbon, in case you plan to reinstall it later. # d-i graphite-carbon/postrm_remove_databases boolean false ############################ #### greylistd_0.8.8.5_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Restart Exim after adding it to the greylist group? # You are using Exim 4 as your Mail Transport Agent (MTA). Great! # . # The "Debian-exim" user will be added to the "greylist" group, so that the # Exim daemon process can talk to greylistd. However, for this change to # take effect, the process must also be restarted. # d-i greylistd/restartexim boolean true ############################ #### grub-coreboot_2.02~beta2-22+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Linux command line: # The following Linux command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline string ### Description: Linux default command line: # The following string will be used as Linux parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline_default string quiet ### Description: Force extra installation to the EFI removable media path? # Some EFI-based systems are buggy and do not handle new bootloaders correctly. # If you force an extra installation of GRUB to the EFI removable media path, # this should ensure that this system will boot Debian correctly despite such a # problem. However, it may remove the ability to boot any other operating # systems that also depend on this path. If so, you will need to make sure that # GRUB is configured successfully to be able to boot any other OS installations # correctly. # d-i grub2/force_efi_extra_removable boolean false ### Description: kFreeBSD command line: # The following kFreeBSD command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline string ### Description: kFreeBSD default command line: # The following string will be used as kFreeBSD parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline_default string quiet ############################ #### grub-efi-amd64_2.02~beta2-22+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Linux command line: # The following Linux command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline string ### Description: Linux default command line: # The following string will be used as Linux parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline_default string quiet ### Description: Force extra installation to the EFI removable media path? # Some EFI-based systems are buggy and do not handle new bootloaders correctly. # If you force an extra installation of GRUB to the EFI removable media path, # this should ensure that this system will boot Debian correctly despite such a # problem. However, it may remove the ability to boot any other operating # systems that also depend on this path. If so, you will need to make sure that # GRUB is configured successfully to be able to boot any other OS installations # correctly. # d-i grub2/force_efi_extra_removable boolean false ### Description: kFreeBSD command line: # The following kFreeBSD command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline string ### Description: kFreeBSD default command line: # The following string will be used as kFreeBSD parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline_default string quiet ############################ #### grub-efi-ia32_2.02~beta2-22+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Linux command line: # The following Linux command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline string ### Description: Linux default command line: # The following string will be used as Linux parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline_default string quiet ### Description: Force extra installation to the EFI removable media path? # Some EFI-based systems are buggy and do not handle new bootloaders correctly. # If you force an extra installation of GRUB to the EFI removable media path, # this should ensure that this system will boot Debian correctly despite such a # problem. However, it may remove the ability to boot any other operating # systems that also depend on this path. If so, you will need to make sure that # GRUB is configured successfully to be able to boot any other OS installations # correctly. # d-i grub2/force_efi_extra_removable boolean false ### Description: kFreeBSD command line: # The following kFreeBSD command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline string ### Description: kFreeBSD default command line: # The following string will be used as kFreeBSD parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline_default string quiet ############################ #### grub-ieee1275_2.02~beta2-22+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Linux command line: # The following Linux command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline string ### Description: Linux default command line: # The following string will be used as Linux parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline_default string quiet ### Description: Force extra installation to the EFI removable media path? # Some EFI-based systems are buggy and do not handle new bootloaders correctly. # If you force an extra installation of GRUB to the EFI removable media path, # this should ensure that this system will boot Debian correctly despite such a # problem. However, it may remove the ability to boot any other operating # systems that also depend on this path. If so, you will need to make sure that # GRUB is configured successfully to be able to boot any other OS installations # correctly. # d-i grub2/force_efi_extra_removable boolean false ### Description: kFreeBSD command line: # The following kFreeBSD command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline string ### Description: kFreeBSD default command line: # The following string will be used as kFreeBSD parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline_default string quiet ############################ #### grub-pc_2.02~beta2-22+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Linux command line: # The following Linux command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline string ### Description: Linux default command line: # The following string will be used as Linux parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline_default string quiet ### Description: Force extra installation to the EFI removable media path? # Some EFI-based systems are buggy and do not handle new bootloaders correctly. # If you force an extra installation of GRUB to the EFI removable media path, # this should ensure that this system will boot Debian correctly despite such a # problem. However, it may remove the ability to boot any other operating # systems that also depend on this path. If so, you will need to make sure that # GRUB is configured successfully to be able to boot any other OS installations # correctly. # d-i grub2/force_efi_extra_removable boolean false ### Description: kFreeBSD command line: # The following kFreeBSD command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline string ### Description: kFreeBSD default command line: # The following string will be used as kFreeBSD parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline_default string quiet ### Description: Chainload from menu.lst? # GRUB upgrade scripts have detected a GRUB Legacy setup in /boot/grub. # . # In order to replace the Legacy version of GRUB in your system, it is # recommended that /boot/grub/menu.lst is adjusted to load a GRUB 2 boot # image from your existing GRUB Legacy setup. This step can be automatically # performed now. # . # It's recommended that you accept chainloading GRUB 2 from menu.lst, and # verify that the new GRUB 2 setup works before it is written to the MBR # (Master Boot Record). # . # Whatever your decision, you can replace the old MBR image with GRUB 2 # later by issuing the following command as root: # . # upgrade-from-grub-legacy # d-i grub-pc/chainload_from_menu.lst boolean true ### Description: GRUB install devices: # The grub-pc package is being upgraded. This menu allows you to select which # devices you'd like grub-install to be automatically run for, if any. # . # Running grub-install automatically is recommended in most situations, to # prevent the installed GRUB core image from getting out of sync with GRUB # modules or grub.cfg. # . # If you're unsure which drive is designated as boot drive by your BIOS, it is # often a good idea to install GRUB to all of them. # . # Note: it is possible to install GRUB to partition boot records as well, and # some appropriate partitions are offered here. However, this forces GRUB to # use the blocklist mechanism, which makes it less reliable, and therefore is # not recommended. # d-i grub-pc/install_devices multiselect # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: GRUB install devices: # The GRUB boot loader was previously installed to a disk that is no longer # present, or whose unique identifier has changed for some reason. It is # important to make sure that the installed GRUB core image stays in sync # with GRUB modules and grub.cfg. Please check again to make sure that GRUB # is written to the appropriate boot devices. # . # If you're unsure which drive is designated as boot drive by your BIOS, it is # often a good idea to install GRUB to all of them. # . # Note: it is possible to install GRUB to partition boot records as well, and # some appropriate partitions are offered here. However, this forces GRUB to # use the blocklist mechanism, which makes it less reliable, and therefore is # not recommended. # d-i grub-pc/install_devices_disks_changed multiselect # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Writing GRUB to boot device failed - continue? # GRUB failed to install to the following devices: # . # ${FAILED_DEVICES} # . # Do you want to continue anyway? If you do, your computer may not start up # properly. # d-i grub-pc/install_devices_failed boolean false ### Description: Writing GRUB to boot device failed - try again? # GRUB failed to install to the following devices: # . # ${FAILED_DEVICES} # . # You may be able to install GRUB to some other device, although you should # check that your system will boot from that device. Otherwise, the upgrade # from GRUB Legacy will be canceled. # d-i grub-pc/install_devices_failed_upgrade boolean true ### Description: Continue without installing GRUB? # You chose not to install GRUB to any devices. If you continue, the boot # loader may not be properly configured, and when this computer next starts # up it will use whatever was previously in the boot sector. If there is an # earlier version of GRUB 2 in the boot sector, it may be unable to load # modules or handle the current configuration file. # . # If you are already using a different boot loader and want to carry on # doing so, or if this is a special environment where you do not need a boot # loader, then you should continue anyway. Otherwise, you should install # GRUB somewhere. # d-i grub-pc/install_devices_empty boolean false ### Description: Remove GRUB 2 from /boot/grub? # Do you want to have all GRUB 2 files removed from /boot/grub? # . # This will make the system unbootable unless another boot loader is # installed. # d-i grub-pc/postrm_purge_boot_grub boolean false ### Description: Finish conversion to GRUB 2 now? # This system still has files from the GRUB Legacy boot loader installed, but # it now also has GRUB 2 boot records installed on these disks: # . # ${DISKS} # . # It seems likely that GRUB Legacy is no longer in use, and that you should # instead upgrade the GRUB 2 images on these disks and finish the conversion # to GRUB 2 by removing old GRUB Legacy files. If you do not upgrade these # GRUB 2 images, then they may be incompatible with the new packages and # cause your system to stop booting properly. # . # You should generally finish the conversion to GRUB 2 unless these boot # records were created by a GRUB 2 installation on some other operating # system. # d-i grub-pc/mixed_legacy_and_grub2 boolean true ### Description: for internal use # d-i grub-pc/kopt_extracted boolean false ### Description: GRUB timeout; for internal use # d-i grub-pc/timeout string 5 ### Description: Hide the GRUB timeout; for internal use # d-i grub-pc/hidden_timeout boolean false ############################ #### grub-xen_2.02~beta2-22+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Linux command line: # The following Linux command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline string ### Description: Linux default command line: # The following string will be used as Linux parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/linux_cmdline_default string quiet ### Description: Force extra installation to the EFI removable media path? # Some EFI-based systems are buggy and do not handle new bootloaders correctly. # If you force an extra installation of GRUB to the EFI removable media path, # this should ensure that this system will boot Debian correctly despite such a # problem. However, it may remove the ability to boot any other operating # systems that also depend on this path. If so, you will need to make sure that # GRUB is configured successfully to be able to boot any other OS installations # correctly. # d-i grub2/force_efi_extra_removable boolean false ### Description: kFreeBSD command line: # The following kFreeBSD command line was extracted from /etc/default/grub or the # `kopt' parameter in GRUB Legacy's menu.lst. Please verify that it is correct, # and modify it if necessary. The command line is allowed to be empty. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline string ### Description: kFreeBSD default command line: # The following string will be used as kFreeBSD parameters for the default menu # entry but not for the recovery mode. # d-i grub2/kfreebsd_cmdline_default string quiet ############################ #### guacamole-tomcat_0.8.3-1.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Restart Tomcat server? # The installation of Guacamole under Tomcat requires restarting the Tomcat # server, as Tomcat will only read configuration files on startup. # . # You can also restart Tomcat manually by running # "invoke-rc.d tomcat8 restart" as root. # d-i guacamole-tomcat/restart-server boolean false ############################ #### gwhois_20120626-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Install gwhois as a whois proxy server? # If gwhois is installed as a whois proxy server (using inetd) it # will listen on the standard whois port (43) allowing normal # whois clients to query it. # . # This can be interesting for example if you want to setup a generic whois # server for your company or coworkers which can then use their standard # whois-client (e.g. a windows client) and still make use of the intelligent # features of gwhois. # d-i gwhois/inetd boolean false ############################ #### haserl_0.9.33-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Install haserl binary with suid root permissions? # When haserl is installed with suid root permissions, it will automatically set # its UID and GID to match the owner and group of the script. # . # This is a potential security vulnerability, as scripts that are owned # by root will be run as root, even when they do not have the suid root bit. # d-i haserl/setuid boolean false ############################ #### havp_0.92a-3+b2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to create a loopback spool file system? # HAVP strictly requires the file system where it stores its temporary files # during scanning to support mandatory locking. Many of the standard Linux # file systems support this, but do not enable it by default. # . # To use HAVP, you can either mount the file system that contains # /var/spool/havp with the option "mand", or create a loopback file system that # is mounted at /var/spool/havp only for HAVP. # . # If you are in doubt, you should accept this option to create a # loopback spool file system. # d-i havp/loopback_mount boolean true ### Description: Loopback file system size: # Please enter the size (in megabytes) of the loopback file system to # be created. # d-i havp/loopback_size string 100 ############################ #### hddtemp_0.3-beta15-52_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should /usr/sbin/hddtemp be installed SUID root? # You have the option of installing hddtemp with the SUID bit set, # allowing it to be run (reporting hard drive temperatures) by regular # users and not only the superuser. # . # This could potentially allow hddtemp to be used during an attack # against the computer's security. If in doubt, do not choose this option. # . # This setting can be modified later by running 'dpkg-reconfigure hddtemp'. # d-i hddtemp/SUID_bit boolean false ### Description: Interval between hard drive temperature checks: # The temperature of the hard drive(s) can be logged by hddtemp via # the generic system logging interface. # . # Please enter a value in seconds corresponding to the interval between # two checks. To disable this feature, enter 0. # d-i hddtemp/syslog string 0 ### Description: Should the hddtemp daemon be started at boot? # The hddtemp program can be run as a daemon, listening on port 7634 # for incoming connections. It is used by some software such as gkrellm to get # the temperature of hard drives. # . # You have the option of starting the hddtemp daemon automatically on # system boot. If in doubt, it is suggested to not start it # automatically on boot. # . # This setting can be modified later by running 'dpkg-reconfigure hddtemp'. # d-i hddtemp/daemon boolean false ### Description: Interface to listen on: # The hddtemp program can listen for incoming connections on a specific # interface, or on all interfaces. # . # To listen on a specific interface, enter the IP address of that interface # (choosing 127.0.0.1 will accept local connections only). To listen on all interfaces, # enter 0.0.0.0. # d-i hddtemp/interface string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Port to listen on: # By default, hddtemp listens for incoming connections on port 7634. This # can be changed for another port number. # d-i hddtemp/port string 7634 ############################ #### hearse_1.5-8.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Email address to submit to the Hearse server: # The Hearse server requires that you supply an email address before # you can exchange bones files. If you supply an address here it will # be submitted to the server for you. If you don't supply an address, # hearse will be installed but it won't run automatically until you # create an account yourself. # . # The server operator states that your email address will only be used # to contact you about Hearse, and will never be given to any third # party. If you enter an invalid address, the server won't be able to # support you if you download a bad bones file, and will be forced to # ban you if any of your uploaded files are bad. # d-i hearse/user-email string ############################ #### heat-common_2014.1.3-7_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Authentication server hostname: # Please specify the hostname of the authentication server. Typically # this is also the hostname of the OpenStack Identity Service (Keystone). # d-i heat/auth-host string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Authentication server tenant name: # Please specify the authentication server tenant name. # d-i heat/admin-tenant-name string admin ### Description: Authentication server username: # Please specify the username to use with the authentication server. # d-i heat/admin-user string admin ### Description: Authentication server password: # Please specify the password to use with the authentication server. # d-i heat/admin-password password ### Description: Register Heat in the Keystone endpoint catalog? # Each OpenStack service (each API) should be registered in order to be # accessible. This is done using "keystone service-create" and "keystone # endpoint-create". This can be done automatically now. # . # Note that you will need to have an up and running Keystone server on which to # connect using the Keystone authentication token. # d-i heat/register-endpoint boolean false ### Description: Keystone server IP address: # Please enter the IP address of the Keystone server, so that heat-api can # contact Keystone to do the Heat service and endpoint creation. # d-i heat/keystone-ip string ### Description: Keystone authentication token: # To configure its endpoint in Keystone, heat-api needs the Keystone # authentication token. # d-i heat/keystone-auth-token password ### Description: Heat endpoint IP address: # Please enter the IP address that will be used to contact Heat. # . # This IP address should be accessible from the clients that will use this # service, so if you are installing a public cloud, this should be a public # IP address. # d-i heat/endpoint-ip string ### Description: Name of the region to register: # OpenStack supports using availability zones, with each region representing # a location. Please enter the zone that you wish to use when registering the # endpoint. # d-i heat/region-name string regionOne ### Description: Set up a database for heat-common? # No database has been set up for heat-common to use. Before # continuing, you should make sure you have the following information: # . # * the type of database that you want to use; # * the database server host name (that server must allow TCP connections from this # machine); # * a username and password to access the database. # . # If some of these requirements are missing, do not choose this option and run with # regular SQLite support. # . # You can change this setting later on by running "dpkg-reconfigure -plow # heat-common". # d-i heat/configure_db boolean false ### Description: IP address of your RabbitMQ host: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the IP address of that server. # d-i heat/rabbit_host string localhost ### Description: Username for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the username used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i heat/rabbit_userid string guest ### Description: Password for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the password used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i heat/rabbit_password password ############################ #### heimdal-kdc_1.6~rc2+dfsg-9+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Local realm name: # Please enter the name of the local Kerberos realm. # . # Using the uppercase domain name is common. For instance, if the host # name is host.example.org, then the realm will become EXAMPLE.ORG. The # default for this host is ${default_realm}. # d-i heimdal/realm string ### Description: KDC password: # Heimdal can encrypt the key distribution center (KDC) data with # a password. A hashed representation of this password will be stored # in /var/lib/heimdal-kdc/m-key. # d-i heimdal-kdc/password password ############################ #### libhesiod0_3.2.1-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Hesiod domain for searches: # Please enter the Hesiod RHS (right hand-side) to do searches in. # . # If the Hesiod server is 'ns.example.org' then the LHS will be '.ns', the # RHS will be '.example.org' (note leading periods) and directory lookups # will be performed as DNS requests to (e.g.) 'sam.passwd.ns.example.org'. # d-i hesiod/rhs string .athena.mit.edu ### Description: Hesiod prefix for searches: # Please enter the Hesiod LHS (left hand-side) to do searches in. # . # If the Hesiod server is 'ns.example.org' then the LHS will be '.ns', the # RHS will be '.example.org' (note leading periods) and directory lookups # will be performed as DNS requests to (e.g.) 'sam.passwd.ns.example.org'. # d-i hesiod/lhs string .ns ### Description: DNS class search order: # Hesiod looks up names using DNS TXT records. In addition to using the # standard IN DNS class for Internet names, it also uses by default the # special HS class. # . # Please enter the class search order (the default value is suitable for # most sites). There should be no spaces in this search order value. # . # Sites using # older Hesiod installations may need to use the 'HS,IN' search order. # d-i hesiod/classes string IN,HS ############################ #### iogerman_2-28_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### wogerman_2-28_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### openstack-dashboard-apache_2014.1.3-7+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Activate Dashboard and disable default VirtualHost? # The Apache package sets up a default web site and a default page, configured # in /etc/apache2/sites-available/default. # . # Choose this option to replace that default with the OpenStack Dashboard # configuration. # d-i horizon/activate_vhost boolean false ### Description: Should the Dashboard use HTTPS? # Select this option if you would like Horizon to be served over HTTPS only, # with a redirection to HTTPS if HTTP is in use. # d-i horizon/use_ssl boolean true ############################ #### hoteldruid_2.1.0-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically configure the Apache web server for HotelDruid? # HotelDruid runs on any web server supporting PHP, but automatic # configuration can only be performed for Apache. # . # Once configured, HotelDruid can be accessed locally at # "http://localhost/hoteldruid". # . # Please choose whether automatic configuration should be performed now. # d-i hoteldruid/configure-apache boolean true ### Description: Restrict HotelDruid access to localhost? # The Apache web server can be configured to forbid HotelDruid # connections from other machines. # . # It is recommended to activate this setting if HotelDruid is # going to be used only from this machine. # d-i hoteldruid/restrict-localhost boolean true ### Description: Reload the web server configuration for HotelDruid? # In order to activate the new configuration for HotelDruid, # the web server has to reload its configuration files. # d-i hoteldruid/restart-webserver boolean true ### Description: HotelDruid administrator username: # Please enter a name for the administrator user, which will be able to # manage HotelDruid's configuration and create new users. The # username should be composed of ASCII letters and numbers only. # . # You can later change the administrator username and password from # the "User management" page in HotelDruid. If this field is left blank, # no user login will be required to access HotelDruid. # d-i hoteldruid/administrator-username string admin ### Description: HotelDruid administrator password: # Please choose a password for the HotelDruid administrator. # d-i hoteldruid/administrator-password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same "admin" password again to verify # you have typed it correctly. # d-i hoteldruid/confirm-password password ### Description: Erase HotelDruid data when purging the package? # The hoteldruid package is about to be purged from this system. # . # HotelDruid stores its data in "/var/lib/hoteldruid". # If you choose this option, these data files will be erased now. # . # Refuse this option if there is operational information which should be # kept after HotelDruid is purged. # d-i hoteldruid/purgedata boolean false ############################ #### htdig_3.2.0b6-12_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Generate ht://Dig endings database now? # The ht://Dig search engine requires an endings database which has to be # generated before the first start. Generating the database will take a # short while. It can be done either now or later by calling the # '/usr/sbin/htdigconfig' script. # d-i htdig/generate-databases boolean true ### Description: Schedule a daily execution of the 'rundig' script? # On-line content must be indexed by the 'rundig' script before # ht://Dig can be used to search data. That script indexes the # web content defined in /etc/htdig/htdig.conf. # . # If you choose this option, a daily run of the script will be scheduled. # You may choose to not use this option if ht://Dig is used another # way (for instance by KDE, to # perform local indexing). If in doubt, do not choose this option. # d-i htdig/run-rundig boolean false ############################ #### hylafax-server_6.0.6-6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Start the HylaFAX daemon now? # Hylafax is already configured and may be started now. If you specify to # start it later manually, remember to change the value of RUN_HYLAFAX # in /etc/default/hylafax. # d-i hylafax-server/start_now boolean true ############################ #### icecast2_2.4.0-1.1+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Configure Icecast2? # Choose this option to set up passwords for Icecast2. Until these are # configured the server will not be activated. # . # You should not use this option if you have already manually tweaked # the configuration of Icecast2. # d-i icecast2/icecast-setup boolean false ### Description: Icecast2 hostname: # Please specify the fully qualified domain name that should be used # as prefix to all streams. # d-i icecast2/hostname string localhost ### Description: Icecast2 source password: # Please specify the password that should be used to control access to # Icecast2's media sources. # d-i icecast2/sourcepassword string hackme ### Description: Icecast2 relay password: # Please specify the password that should be used to control access to # Icecast2's stream relays. # d-i icecast2/relaypassword string hackme ### Description: Icecast2 administration password: # Please specify the password that should be used for Icecast2 # administration. # . # The administration web interface, at http://localhost:8000, can be # used to monitor connections or to block users from streaming. # d-i icecast2/adminpassword string hackme ############################ #### icinga-cgi_1.11.6-1+b4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Icinga web administration password: # Please provide the password to be created with the "icingaadmin" user. # . # This is the username and password to use when connecting to the Icinga # server after completing the configuration. If you do not provide # a password, you will have to configure access to Icinga manually # later on. # d-i icinga/adminpassword password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same user password again to verify you have typed it # correctly. # d-i icinga/adminpassword-repeat password ############################ #### icinga-common_1.11.6-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Use external commands with Icinga? # As a security feature, Icinga in its default configuration does not # look for external commands. Enabling external commands will give # the web server write access to the nagios command pipe and is required # if you want to be able to use the CGI command interface. # . # If unsure, do not enable external commands. # d-i icinga/check_external_commands boolean false ############################ #### icinga-web_1.11.2+dfsg1-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Icinga new web administrative password: # Please provide the password for the user "root" in Icinga's web interface. # . # This is the password you need to access the web interface with the # default administrative user. After login, you will be able # to create new users and set their permissions. # d-i icinga-web/rootpassword password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same root password again to verify that you have typed it # correctly. # d-i icinga-web/rootpassword-repeat password ############################ #### icinga2-classicui_2.1.1-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Icinga 2 ClassicUI administration password: # Please provide the password to be created with the "icingaadmin" user. # . # This is the username and password to use when connecting to the Icinga # server after completing the configuration. If you do not provide # a password, you will have to configure access to Icinga manually # later on. # d-i icinga2-classicui/adminpassword password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same user password again to verify you have typed it # correctly. # d-i icinga2-classicui/adminpassword-repeat password ############################ #### icinga2-ido-mysql_2.1.1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable Icinga 2's ido-mysql feature? # Please specify whether Icinga 2 should use MySQL. # . # You may later disable the feature by using the # "icinga2-disable-feature ido-mysql" command. # d-i icinga2-ido-mysql/enable boolean true ############################ #### icinga2-ido-pgsql_2.1.1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable Icinga 2's ido-pgsql feature? # Please specify whether Icinga 2 should use PostgreSQL. # . # You may later disable the feature by using the # "icinga2-disable-feature ido-pgsql" command. # d-i icinga2-ido-pgsql/enable boolean true ############################ #### libgempc410_1.0.7-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Communication port to use with the smart card reader: # The driver needs to know to which serial port the GemPC410 reader is # connected. # d-i libgempc410/port select # Possible choices: ttyS0, ttyS1, ttyS2, ttyS3, None ############################ #### ifetch-tools_0.15.24d2-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove all ifetch-tools data, logs, and settings files? # The /var/lib/ifetch-tools, /var/log/ifetch-tools, and /etc/ifetch-tools # directories which contain the ifetch-tools data, logs, and settings files # are about to be removed. # . # If you're removing the ifetch-tools package in order to later install a # more recent version or if a different ifetch-tools package is already # using the data, logs, and settings, they should be kept. # d-i ifetch-tools/purge boolean false ############################ #### ifplugd_0.28-19_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: static interfaces to be watched by ifplugd: # Specify the interfaces to control here, separated by spaces. Ifplugd # processes will be started for each of these interfaces when the ifplugd # initscript is called with the "start" argument. You may use the magic # string "auto" to make the initscript start or stop ifplugd processes for # ALL eth and wlan interfaces that are available according to # /proc/net/dev. Note that the list of interfaces appearing in # /proc/net/dev may depend on which kernel modules you have loaded. # . # You should not add interfaces that are hotplugged (USB or PCMCIA) here, # you will be asked for those in the next question. # d-i ifplugd/interfaces string ### Description: hotplugged interfaces to be watched by ifplugd: # Specify the hotplugged interfaces to control here, separated by spaces. # . # You may use the magic string "all" to make the hotplug script start an # ifplugd process for any hotplugged interface. # . # Hotplugged interfaces are usually interfaces on PCMCIA or WLAN adapters. # d-i ifplugd/hotplug_interfaces string ### Description: arguments to ifplugd: # You can give arguments to the ifplug daemon here. Relevant options are: # . # -q Don't run script on daemon quit # -f Ignore detection failure and retry # -u Specify delay for configuring interface # -d Specify delay for deconfiguring interface # -w Wait until daemon fork finished # -I Don't exit on nonzero return value of program executed # . # -a Do not enable interface automatically # -s Use stderr instead of syslog for debugging # -b Do not beep (-U/-D Do not beep on interface up/down) # -t Specify poll time in seconds (default: 1) # -p Don't run script on daemon startup # -l Run "down" script on startup if no cable is detected # -W Wait until the daemon died when running daemon is killed # -M Use interface monitoring # d-i ifplugd/args string -q -f -u0 -d10 -w -I ### Description: suspend behaviour: # When you put your notebook into suspend mode, you can choose between three # actions: # . # none: no action # . # suspend: this puts ifplugd into suspend mode. In this mode, ifplugd does # not check the link status. This is necessary for some broken network # drivers. # . # stop: this stops ifplugd. If the -q option is not given, ifplugd will stop # the interface. After resume, it will be restarted. This makes sense if you # use some mechanism (eg. guessnet or whereami) to detect your network # environment, which may have changed while suspending. # d-i ifplugd/suspend_action select stop # Possible choices: none, suspend, stop ############################ #### ifrench_1.4-26_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### ifrench-gut_1.0-30_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### wgaelic_0.50-10_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### ingerman_20131206-5_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### iswiss_20131206-5_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wngerman_20131206-5_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wswiss_20131206-5_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### igtf-policy-classic_1.59-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Trust IGTF classic CAs by default? # Trusted IGTF Certification Authority certificates are installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # . # Accept this option to have certificates included by default unless they # are explicitly excluded. Reject it to choose the reverse policy, # excluding them unless explicitly included. # . # You will then have the opportunity to define the list of exceptions. # d-i igtf-policy-classic/install_profile boolean true ### Description: Certificates to explicitly exclude: # Please select which certificates should not be installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # d-i igtf-policy-classic/exclude_ca multiselect # Possible choices: ${exclude_ca} ### Description: Certificates to explicitly include: # Please select which certificates should be installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # d-i igtf-policy-classic/include_ca multiselect # Possible choices: ${include_ca} ############################ #### igtf-policy-iota_1.59-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Trust IGTF iota CAs by default? # Trusted IGTF Certification Authority certificates are installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # . # Accept this option to have certificates included by default unless they # are explicitly excluded. Reject it to choose the reverse policy, # excluding them unless explicitly included. # . # You will then have the opportunity to define the list of exceptions. # d-i igtf-policy-iota/install_profile boolean true ### Description: Certificates to explicitly exclude: # Please select which certificates should not be installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # d-i igtf-policy-iota/exclude_ca multiselect # Possible choices: ${exclude_ca} ### Description: Certificates to explicitly include: # Please select which certificates should be installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # d-i igtf-policy-iota/include_ca multiselect # Possible choices: ${include_ca} ############################ #### igtf-policy-mics_1.59-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Trust IGTF mics CAs by default? # Trusted IGTF Certification Authority certificates are installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # . # Accept this option to have certificates included by default unless they # are explicitly excluded. Reject it to choose the reverse policy, # excluding them unless explicitly included. # . # You will then have the opportunity to define the list of exceptions. # d-i igtf-policy-mics/install_profile boolean true ### Description: Certificates to explicitly exclude: # Please select which certificates should not be installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # d-i igtf-policy-mics/exclude_ca multiselect # Possible choices: ${exclude_ca} ### Description: Certificates to explicitly include: # Please select which certificates should be installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # d-i igtf-policy-mics/include_ca multiselect # Possible choices: ${include_ca} ############################ #### igtf-policy-slcs_1.59-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Trust IGTF slcs CAs by default? # Trusted IGTF Certification Authority certificates are installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # . # Accept this option to have certificates included by default unless they # are explicitly excluded. Reject it to choose the reverse policy, # excluding them unless explicitly included. # . # You will then have the opportunity to define the list of exceptions. # d-i igtf-policy-slcs/install_profile boolean true ### Description: Certificates to explicitly exclude: # Please select which certificates should not be installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # d-i igtf-policy-slcs/exclude_ca multiselect # Possible choices: ${exclude_ca} ### Description: Certificates to explicitly include: # Please select which certificates should be installed in # /etc/grid-security/certificates. # d-i igtf-policy-slcs/include_ca multiselect # Possible choices: ${include_ca} ############################ #### wirish_2.0-22_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### iitalian_2.3-3_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### ilisp_5.12.0+cvs.2004.12.26-21_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Use FSF-compliant keybindings? # ILISP allows the choice of using FSF-compliant keybindings which start # with a Control-C character. The older ILISP keybindings use a Control-Z # character as the prefix. # . # In general, the non-FSF compliant keybindings are easier to use: the ILISP # manual in the Debian package ilisp-doc uses the non-FSF compliant # keybindings and these keybindings often use fewer keystrokes. # . # If you change your mind later, you can run dpkg-reconfigure ilisp and # change your keybinding selection. # d-i ilisp/fsf-compliant boolean true ############################ #### ilohamail_0.8.14-0rc3sid6.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Webserver type: # By default IlohaMail supports any webserver that is PHP4 capable, but this # process only supports Apache. This installation will manage (or attempt to manage) # the configuration of the Apache portions specific necessary to run IlohaMail properly. # If you do not wish this to happen, please choose the 'Other' option. # d-i ilohamail/webserver_type select Apache # Possible choices: Apache, Apache-ssl, Apache2, Other ### Description: Apache Alias for IlohaMail: # An alias entry is added to the Apache configuration pointing to the IlohaMail # source. By default this is /IlohaMail, so that the webmail is reachable # at http://your.host/IlohaMail/. If you want another location (like /webmail) # enter it here. # d-i ilohamail/weblocation string /IlohaMail ############################ #### im_151-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Use setuid imget for RPOP? # The RPOP feature is disabled by default. It is an obsolete feature (The # RPOP command was used instead of the PASS command to authenticate access # to a maildrop. It was removed in RFC 1460). If you prefer, you can use RPOP # by setuid imget. # d-i im/rpop boolean false ### Description: Generate /etc/im/SiteConfig by hand? # This package normally generates /etc/im/SiteConfig. If you prefer, you can # generate /etc/im/SiteConfig by hand. # d-i im/siteconfig_by_hand boolean false ### Description: Default From: domain: # In a mail/news header, if a From: field does not have a domain part, imput # will add this domain automatically. # . # If unsure, you can ignore this. # d-i im/fromdomain string ### Description: Default To: domain: # In a mail header, if a To: field does not have a domain part, imput will # add this domain automatically. # . # If unsure, you can ignore this. # d-i im/todomain string ### Description: Organization: # In a news header, imput will add an Organization: field automatically. # . # If unsure, you can ignore this. # d-i im/organization string ### Description: Use imget with maildir? # A maildir is not used by default. If you prefer, imget can retrieve mails # from ~/Maildir/{new,cur}. # d-i im/use_maildir boolean false ############################ #### init-select_1.20140921+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Init system selection: # Please select an init system. # . # The init system is the first process started by the kernel. It manages the # initial boot process and system daemons. # d-i init-select/choose select systemd # Possible choices: sysvinit, systemd, openrc ############################ #### initz_0.0.11+20030603cvs-17.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to install a system-wide initz service? # If you accept here all users in your system can use Initz automatically. # d-i initz/systemwide boolean true ############################ #### iodine_0.7.0-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should iodined (server) start on boot? # If you want iodined to be started at boot time you can set this behaviour here. # d-i iodine/start_daemon boolean false ### Description: Options to iodined (server): # You need to give the necessary arguments to iodined; see iodined(8) for help. # Example: 10.0.0.1 tunnel.mydomain.example # d-i iodine/daemon_options string ### Description: Password for iodined (server): # Enter the password iodined uses at startup. It has to be used by clients # when connecting. # This password will be stored in plain text in /etc/default/iodine. # d-i iodine/daemon_password password ############################ #### iog_1.03-3.6_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Migrate old install out of /var/www/iog/? # A previous package release has left data installed in the # /var/www/iog/ directory. Current versions of the IOG package now use # /var/lib/iog/ for IOG data files. # . # If you choose this option, all existing network data will be moved # to the new location. # . # Consequently, directory settings in the IOG configuration file # (/etc/iog.cfg) will be changed to /var/lib/iog and a web server # alias declaration will be added so that old network statistics # are still published. # d-i iog/migrate boolean false ############################ #### ipolish_20140830-2_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wpolish_20140830-2_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### racoon_0.8.2+20140711-2+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Configuration mode for racoon IKE daemon: # Racoon can be configured either directly, by editing # /etc/racoon/racoon.conf, or using the racoon-tool administrative front end. # . # Use of the "direct" method is strongly recommended if you want to use all # the racoon examples on the Net, and if you want to use the full # racoon feature set. You will have to directly edit /etc/racoon/racoon.conf # and possibly manually set up the Security Policy Database via setkey. # . # Racoon-tool has been updated for racoon 0.8.0, and is for use in basic # configuration setups. It gives the benefit of managing the SPD along with the # IKE that strongSwan offers. IPv6, transport/tunnel mode (ESP/AH), PSK/X509 # auth, and basic "anonymous" VPN server are supported. # . # More information is available in /usr/share/doc/racoon/README.Debian. # d-i racoon/config_mode select direct # Possible choices: direct, racoon-tool ############################ #### iptables-persistent_1.0.3+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Save current IPv4 rules? # Current iptables rules can be saved to the configuration # file /etc/iptables/rules.v4. These rules will then be loaded automatically # during system startup. # . # Rules are only saved automatically during package installation. See the # manual page of iptables-save(8) for instructions on keeping the rules file # up-to-date. # d-i iptables-persistent/autosave_v4 boolean true ### Description: Save current IPv6 rules? # Current iptables rules can be saved to the configuration # file /etc/iptables/rules.v6. These rules will then be loaded automatically # during system startup. # . # Rules are only saved automatically during package installation. See the # manual page of ip6tables-save(8) for instructions on keeping the rules file # up-to-date. # d-i iptables-persistent/autosave_v6 boolean true ############################ #### ircd-hybrid_8.2.0+dfsg.1-2+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Restart ircd-hybrid on each upgrade? # Please choose whether the ircd-hybrid daemon should be restarted # every time a new version of this package is installed. # . # Automatic restarts may be problematic if, for instance, the server is # running with manually loaded modules, which will need to be reloaded # after the restart. # . # If you reject this option, you will have to restart ircd-hybrid via # "service ircd-hybrid restart" when needed. # d-i ircd-hybrid/restart_on_upgrade boolean true ### Description: Upgrade ircd-hybrid to version without cryptlink support? # The 8.x version of ircd-hybrid includes a change to the way secure server # links are implemented, which is not backwards-compatible with ircd-hybrid 7.x, # from which you are upgrading. # . # If you have any secure server links (cryptlinks) configured with this # server, you should plan to either upgrade all servers in lock-step, or # temporarily configure non-cryptlink server links, to ensure the continuity # of your IRC links. # d-i ircd-hybrid/upgrade_secure_links_warn boolean true ### Description: Upgrade ircd-hybrid to version without compatible services? # The 8.x version of ircd-hybrid includes a change to the way services are # supported, losing compatibility with hybserv. # . # The recommended services daemon for Hybrid 8 is Anope, for which no # package is available yet, although one is planned. # d-i ircd-hybrid/upgrade_no_services_warn boolean true ### Description: Upgrade ircd-hybrid to version without SSL support? # The currently installed version of this package is one with "ssl" in the # version number, which suggests that it is a locally compiled package with # SSL support. If this is the case, you probably don't want to install this # package but instead rebuild the SSL version following the instructions in # /usr/share/doc/ircd-hybrid/README.SSL. # d-i ircd-hybrid/upgrade_to_nossl_warn boolean true ############################ #### irda-utils_0.9.18-12_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: IrDA device type: # If you want to use a serial dongle, a FIR (Fast IrDA) serial emulation port or # something similar choose "serial". Otherwise choose "native" for a native # chip driver. Select "serial" if unsure, because nearly all FIR devices can # run in slow SIR (Serial IrDA) mode. You might cross-check with the package # "setserial" for the serial setup of your system. # d-i irda-utils/selectdevice select serial # Possible choices: serial, native ### Description: Serial device file for IrDA: # d-i irda-utils/ttydev string /dev/ttyS1 ### Description: Dongle type: # If you use a FIR serial emulation port, choose "none". Note that it is possible that your actual kernel supports more/less/other dongle types. In that case you # have to edit /etc/default/irda-utils by hand. # d-i irda-utils/dongle select none # Possible choices: none, act200l, actisys, actisys+, airport, ep7211, esi, girbil, litelink, ma600, mcp2120, old_belkin, tekram ### Description: FIR chip type: # Note that you must have a properly built kernel module if you want to use # a native chip. The modules offered here can be different to the ones that # are available for your actual kernel. In that case you have to edit # /etc/modutils/irda-utils (2.4) or /etc/modprobe.d/irda-utils (2.6) by hand. # d-i irda-utils/firdev select # Possible choices: ali-ircc, au1k_ir, irda-usb, nsc-ircc, sa1100_ir, smc-ircc, smsc-ircc2, stir4200, toshoboe, via-ircc, vlsi_ir, w83977af_ir ### Description: Module options for the FIR chip: # Some kernel modules require options to work. You can retrieve the possible # options for your module with the command "modinfo ". # d-i irda-utils/firopt string ### Description: Port for setserial to quiet: # Set the name of the serial port / device which should be quieted by setserial. # Only few machines need that when in FIR-mode, so most likely, it should be # left blank. See README.Debian for more information. # d-i irda-utils/setserial string ### Description: Discovery behavior? # Confirm if you want to use discovery mode. When in discovery mode, the # device in your machine looks for other devices on a regular basis. # d-i irda-utils/discovery boolean true ### Description: Enable IrDA on system startup? # Confirm if you want IrDA to be enabled when your system is booting. This is # necessary for devices that need "irattach" to be run. Most devices need it, # except for some rare FIR devices. # d-i irda-utils/enable boolean false ############################ #### irqbalance_1.0.6-3+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Would you like to enable irqbalance? # Enable the irqbalance daemon to balance IRQs on SMP systems and systems # with hyperthreading. # d-i irqbalance/enable boolean true ### Description: Would you like to balance the IRQs once? # irqbalance can run in one shot mode, where the IRQs are balanced only # once. This is advantageous on hyperthreading systems such as the Pentium # 4, which appear to be SMP systems, but are really one physical CPU. # d-i irqbalance/oneshot boolean false ############################ #### isc-dhcp-relay_4.3.1-6+deb8u3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Servers the DHCP relay should forward requests to: # Please enter the hostname or IP address of at least one DHCP server # to which DHCP and BOOTP requests should be relayed. # . # You can specify multiple server names or IP addresses (in a # space-separated list). # d-i isc-dhcp-relay/servers string ### Description: Interfaces the DHCP relay should listen on: # Please specify which network interface(s) the DHCP relay should # attempt to configure. Multiple interface names should be entered as a # space-separated list. # . # Leave this field blank to allow for automatic detection and # configuration of network interfaces by the DHCP relay, in which case # only broadcast interfaces will be used (if possible). # d-i isc-dhcp-relay/interfaces string ### Description: Additional options for the DHCP relay daemon: # Please specify any additional options for the DHCP relay daemon. # . # For example: '-m replace' or '-a -D'. # d-i isc-dhcp-relay/options string ############################ #### isc-dhcp-server_4.3.1-6+deb8u3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Network interfaces on which the DHCP server should listen: # Please specify on which network interface(s) the DHCP server should # listen for DHCP requests. Multiple interface names should be entered # as a space-separated list. # . # The interfaces will be automatically detected if this field is left # blank. # d-i isc-dhcp-server/interfaces string ############################ #### ipppd_3.25+dfsg1-3.5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Interface to configure: # The default setting should be safe for most configurations. # . # However, if you have special requirements or want to choose # to configure another interface, please enter it here. # . # Leave the field blank if you do not want to configure anything now. # d-i ipppd/whichif string ippp0 ### Description: ISP's telephone number: # At least one phone number has to be dialed in order to connect # to an Internet service provider (ISP). # . # Please enter that telephone number here, including dialing prefixes, # area codes, and so on, but without any spaces. # . # Multiple telephone numbers may be entered and should be separated by spaces. # . # Leave the field blank if you want to configure the connection manually. # d-i ipppd/ispphone string manual ### Description: Local MSN: # When making a call with ISDN, the MSN (phone number) that is originating # the call must be given in the call-setup message. While a wrong MSN will # usually be replaced by the main MSN for the ISDN line, especially on # PABXes, a wrong MSN (often the extension number in this case) will cause # the call-setup to fail. So, it is best to enter the correct local MSN # here. # . # This may also be necessary if you want the costs to be registered to one # particular MSN, in case you have more than one MSN and this is supported # by your telecommunication providing company. # d-i ipppd/eaz string 0 ### Description: ISP account name: # Most ISPs require an account name and password to be provided when # connecting. # d-i ipppd/isplogin string ### Description: ISP password: # Please enter the password to use when connecting to the ISP. This password # will be kept in /etc/ppp/pap-secrets and # /etc/ppp/chap-secrets together with the account name. # d-i ipppd/isppasswd password ############################ #### isdnlog_3.25+dfsg1-3.5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Country: # Please choose the local country. This will be used to set the rate table to # use for calculating the costs of calls. # d-i isdnlog/country select other # Possible choices: Austria, France, Germany, Luxembourg, Netherlands, Norway, Spain, Switzerland, other ### Description: Country's ISO two-letter code: # Please enter the ISO code of the local country. As no rate # tables are available, this setting will be unused. # d-i isdnlog/country_manual string ### Description: Prefix to dial before international number: # d-i isdnlog/countryprefix string + ### Description: Country ITU code: # Please enter the international code for the local country. # . # Example: ${default_countrycode} for ${default_country} # d-i isdnlog/countrycode string 49 ### Description: Prefix for area code, if applicable: # d-i isdnlog/areaprefix string 0 ### Description: Local area code, if applicable: # d-i isdnlog/areacode string ### Description: Run isdnrate as a daemon? # The isdnrate utility calculates the costs of a connection to a given # phone number, used e.g. for LCR systems to find the cheapest carrier on a # call-by-call basis. Having it run as a daemon speeds things up as then it # only has to load all the data once. # . # This setting is only useful for special setups, such as for an # ISDN-to-H.323 gateway. # d-i isdnlog/isdnrate-daemon boolean false ############################ #### isdnvboxserver_3.25+dfsg1-3.5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Number that vbox should answer: # Vbox must know what number to listen to. Depending on the country's ISDN # system, this may or may not include the area code. Leading "0" should most # often be dropped. # . # Leave the field blank if you want to configure by hand, or if you already # use an existing (working) vbox # configuration from the time when this was still part of isdnutils (unless # you want to create a new configuration). # d-i isdnvboxserver/msn string quit ### Description: Number of rings for vbox to pick up the line: # One ring is about 5 seconds. This setting can later be fine-tuned # for each incoming telephone number, for instance to aggressively # filter some incoming numbers. # . # You should read vbox.conf(5) for more information. # d-i isdnvboxserver/rings string 4 ### Description: Should incoming messages be attached to notification mails? # When a message is recorded, an email notification is sent. If that # email should contain the message as an attachment, choose the option. # d-i isdnvboxserver/attachmsg boolean true ### Description: Run the answering machine as: # The vboxd daemon should run as an unprivileged (non-root) user. It must be # a member of the "dialout" group. # d-i isdnvboxserver/daemonuser string vboxdaemonuser ### Description: Login for the answering machine: # Connections to the answering machine (using the vbox program provided # by the isdnvboxclient package) will be prompted for a username and # password. # . # The username you define here does not have to correspond to a login # account on this system. # d-i isdnvboxserver/user string ### Description: Password for ${User}: # Please choose the password for the ${User} connection user. # d-i isdnvboxserver/password password ### Description: Should vboxgetty be enabled? # A call for vboxgetty is defined in /etc/inittab, but not yet enabled. Choosing this option # will enable it once this package is fully configured. Refuse this option # if you want to tweak it manually. # d-i isdnvboxserver/doinit boolean true ############################ #### isenkram-cli_0.18+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Packages to install: # Some packages were found to be useful with your hardware. # Please select those you want to install. # d-i isenkram/install_hw_packages multiselect # Possible choices: ${PACKAGES} ############################ #### isoqlog_2.2.1-9_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: MTA log type: # Isoqlog has multi-mta support. You must select the logformat which is used by # your mail server. # d-i isoqlog/main_logtype select exim # Possible choices: qmail-multilog, qmail-syslog, postfix, sendmail, exim ### Description: Directory to use for HTML outputs: # Please choose the directory where isoqlog should write its output. It # must be in "WebRoot" of your webserver. # d-i isoqlog/main_outputdir string /var/www/isoqlog ### Description: Local host name: # d-i isoqlog/main_hostname string localhost ### Description: Language to use for outputs: # Isoqlog has multi language support on reports. You can select the # preferred language for outputs. # d-i isoqlog/main_langfile select English # Possible choices: Bulgarian, Czech, Danish, Dutch, English, Finnish, French, German, Italian, Norwegian, Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian, Spanish, Swedish, Turkish ### Description: Domains for which you want to make reports: # Isoqlog can display Top incoming, outgoing, total, and byte based # statistics for each domain. Please enter the domains separated by spaces. # d-i isoqlog/main_domains string ############################ #### iamerican_3.3.02-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### iamerican-huge_3.3.02-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### iamerican-insane_3.3.02-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### iamerican-large_3.3.02-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### iamerican-small_3.3.02-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### ibritish_3.3.02-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### ibritish-huge_3.3.02-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### ibritish-insane_3.3.02-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### ibritish-large_3.3.02-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### ibritish-small_3.3.02-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### iczech_20040229-5.1_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### iestonian_20030606-23_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### ifaroese_0.4.2-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wfaroese_0.4.2-6_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### igalician-minimos_0.5-40_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wgalician-minimos_0.5-40_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### ilithuanian_1.2.1-4_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### itagalog_0.3.1-4_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### iukrainian_1.7.1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### wukrainian_1.7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### iportuguese_20140704-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wportuguese_20140704-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### italc-client_2.0.2+dfsg1-2+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use # d-i italc-client/last-group-teacher string ### Description: for internal use # d-i italc-client/last-group-student string ### Description: for internal use # d-i italc-client/last-group-supporter string ### Description: for internal use # d-i italc-client/last-group-admin string ### Description: Automatically set up iTALC's role model and create key pairs? # iTALC knows four different access roles for iTALC clients (teacher, student, # supporter, and administrator). # . # iTALC manages this role-based client access via SSL keys. # . # Automatically generated SSL keys will be created in subfolders of # /etc/italc/keys. # d-i italc-client/create-keypairs boolean false ### Description: Create groups for iTALC roles now? # iTALC's role model requires four groups to exist: "teacher", "student", # "supporter", and "admin". # . # If these four groups are not created now, you will be asked to assign # existing groups in their place. # d-i italc-client/create-groups-for-roles boolean true ### Description: Use already existing groups for iTALC roles? # If groups reflecting the iTALC role model have already been set up # (e.g. in the LDAP user/group database) then you can specify those group # names on the next screens. # d-i italc-client/use-existing-groups-for-roles boolean false ### Description: iTALC teachers role group: # Please specify the group name for iTALC teachers. # . # The teacher role gives basic control over iTALC clients in classrooms. # . # If you leave this empty, the "root" group will be used. # d-i italc-client/group-italc-teacher string italc-teacher ### Description: Delete the group that was formerly used for this role? # The group for the iTALC teacher role has been modified. # . # Please specify whether the old group should be deleted. If unsure, # keep the formerly used group and manually investigate later. # d-i italc-client/del-last-group-teacher boolean false ### Description: iTALC students role group: # Please specify the group name for iTALC students. # . # The iTALC client only starts for users who are members of this group. # . # If you leave this empty, the "root" group will be used. # d-i italc-client/group-italc-student string italc-student ### Description: Delete the group that was formerly used for this role? # The group for the iTALC student role has been modified. # . # Please specify whether the old group should be deleted. If unsure, # keep the formerly used group and manually investigate later. # d-i italc-client/del-last-group-student boolean false ### Description: iTALC supporters role group: # Please specify the group name for iTALC supporters. # . # The supporter role gives extended control over the iTALC setup on this # site and facilitates giving support to iTALC users. # . # If you leave this empty, the "root" group will be used. # d-i italc-client/group-italc-supporter string italc-supporter ### Description: Delete the group that was formerly used for this role? # The group for the iTALC supporter role has been modified. # . # Please specify whether the old group should be deleted. If unsure, # keep the formerly used group and manually investigate later. # d-i italc-client/del-last-group-supporter boolean false ### Description: iTALC administrators role group: # Please specify the group name for iTALC administrators. # . # The administrator role grants full access to the iTALC instance on # this site. # . # If you leave this empty, the "root" group will be used. # d-i italc-client/group-italc-admin string italc-admin ### Description: Delete the group that was formerly used for this role? # The group for the iTALC administrator role has been modified. # . # Please specify whether the old group should be deleted. If unsure, # keep the formerly used group and manually investigate later. # d-i italc-client/del-last-group-admin boolean false ### Description: Make iTALC's SSL keys accessible to the role model groups? # To make the iTALC role model fully functional, the appropriate groups # now need to be granted access to the created SSL keys. # . # If you skip this step, iTALC SSL keys will only be accessible to the # super-user "root" and you will have to manually set up file permissions # on the keys later. # d-i italc-client/key-access-for-groups boolean true ### Description: Start the iTALC client on desktop session startup? # For the desktop session to be controlled via iTALC, the iTALC client # applet needs to be running, listening on a TCP/IP socket for authorized # VNC-like connections from the iTALC master application. # . # It can be configured to start automatically on desktop session startup, # but for security reasons this is not the default. # . # Remember that the iTALC client will only launch for users that are # members of the iTALC student group. # d-i italc-client/autostart-on-login boolean false ############################ #### jackd1_0.124.1+20140122git5013bed0-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable realtime process priority? # If you want to run jackd with realtime priorities, the user starting jackd # needs realtime permissions. Accept this option to create the # file /etc/security/limits.d/audio.conf, granting realtime # priority and memlock privileges to the audio group. # . # Running jackd with realtime priority minimizes latency, but # may lead to complete system lock-ups by requesting # all the available physical system memory, which is unacceptable in # multi-user environments. # d-i jackd/tweak_rt_limits boolean false ############################ #### jackd2_1.9.10+20140719git3eb0ae6a~dfsg-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable realtime process priority? # If you want to run jackd with realtime priorities, the user starting jackd # needs realtime permissions. Accept this option to create the # file /etc/security/limits.d/audio.conf, granting realtime # priority and memlock privileges to the audio group. # . # Running jackd with realtime priority minimizes latency, but # may lead to complete system lock-ups by requesting # all the available physical system memory, which is unacceptable in # multi-user environments. # d-i jackd/tweak_rt_limits boolean false ############################ #### jazip_0.34-15.1_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### jffnms_0.9.3-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Days until log files are compressed: # Please choose how many days of uncompressed JFFNMS log files should be kept. # The recommended value is two days. Reducing this value may cause problems, # and it doesn't make sense for it to be higher than the number of days before # log files are deleted. # d-i jffnms/compresslogs string 2 ### Description: Days until log files are deleted: # Please choose how many days of log files (compressed or not) should be kept. # The recommended value is seven days. It doesn't make sense to set this lower # than the number of days of uncompressed files, as the cron job will compress # the files and then delete them in the same run. # d-i jffnms/deletelogs string 7 ### Description: Error installing database for jffnms: # An error seems to have occurred while installing the database. # If it's of any help, this was the error encountered: # . # ${error} # . # At this point, you have the option to retry or abort the operation. # If you choose "retry", you will be prompted with all the configuration # questions once more and another attempt will be made at performing the # operation. "retry (skip questions)" will immediately attempt the operation # again, skipping all questions. If you choose "abort", the operation will # fail and you will need to downgrade, reinstall, reconfigure this package, # or otherwise manually intervene to continue using it. # d-i jffnms/install-error select abort # Possible choices: abort, retry, retry (skip questions) ############################ #### jove_4.16.0.73-2_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### jwchat_1.0+dfsg-1.3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: The name of apache's virtual server used for jwchat: # The automatic apache2 configuration needs a name for a virtual server that # is used exclusively by jwchat. If you do not want any automatic # configuration, please answer 'none' here (without quotes). # d-i jwchat/ApacheServerName string jabber ### Description: The URL of your jabber server: # Please enter the address where your jabber server can be reached. Usually you # can leave the default value unchanged if you have installed ejabberd locally. # d-i jwchat/JabberAddress string http://localhost:5280/http-bind/ ############################ #### kdm_4.11.13-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Default display manager: # A display manager is a program that provides graphical login capabilities for # the X Window System. # . # Only one display manager can manage a given X server, but multiple display # manager packages are installed. Please select which display manager should # run by default. # . # Multiple display managers can run simultaneously if they are configured to # manage different servers; to achieve this, configure the display managers # accordingly, edit each of their init scripts in /etc/init.d, and disable the # check for a default display manager. # d-i shared/default-x-display-manager select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require translation. # d-i kdm/daemon_name string /usr/bin/kdm ### Description: Stop the kdm daemon? # The K Desktop manager (kdm) daemon is typically stopped on package upgrade # and removal, but it appears to be managing at least one running X session. # . # If kdm is stopped now, any X sessions it manages will be terminated. # Otherwise, the new version will take effect the next time the daemon # is restarted. # d-i kdm/stop_running_server_with_children boolean false ############################ #### kdesudo_3.4.2.4-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Use KdeSudo in place of KdeSu? # KdeSudo is a drop-in replacement for KdeSu. # . # Please choose whether KdeSudo should be the default front-end for # gaining elevated privileges under KDE. # d-i kdesudo/kdesu boolean false ############################ #### krb5-config_2.3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Default Kerberos version 5 realm: # When users attempt to use Kerberos and specify a principal or user name # without specifying what administrative Kerberos realm that principal # belongs to, the system appends the default realm. The default realm # may also be used as the realm of a Kerberos service running on the # local machine. Often, the default # realm is the uppercase version of the local DNS domain. # d-i krb5-config/default_realm string ### Description: For internal use only # We want to try and capture user changes when they edit a config file # manually. To do this, we look in the config script to read the file. # However, in the case of preconfigure, the config script is run twice # before the postinst is run. Thus, we may read the wrong value before the # edited value is written out in postinst. If this is false, we skip # reading config files until postinst runs. # d-i krb5-config/read_conf boolean true ### Description: for internal use # d-i krb5-config/add_servers_realm string ### Description: Add locations of default Kerberos servers to /etc/krb5.conf? # Typically, clients find Kerberos servers for their default realm in # the domain-name system. ${dns} # d-i krb5-config/add_servers boolean false ### Description: Kerberos servers for your realm: # Enter the hostnames of Kerberos servers in the ${realm} Kerberos realm # separated by spaces. # d-i krb5-config/kerberos_servers string ### Description: Administrative server for your Kerberos realm: # Enter the hostname of the administrative (password changing) server for # the ${realm} Kerberos realm. # d-i krb5-config/admin_server string ############################ #### kexec-tools_2.0.7-5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should kexec-tools handle reboots? # If you choose this option, a system reboot will trigger a restart # into a kernel loaded by kexec instead of going through the full # system boot loader process. # d-i kexec-tools/load_kexec boolean true ### Description: Read GRUB configuration file to load the kernel? # If you choose this option, kexec will read the GRUB configuration file to # determine which kernel and options to load for kexec reboot, as opposed # to what is in /etc/default/kexec. # d-i kexec-tools/use_grub_config boolean false ############################ #### keystone_2014.1.3-6_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Set up a database for Keystone? # No database has been set up for Keystone to use. Before # continuing, you should make sure you have the following information: # . # * the type of database that you want to use; # * the database server host name (that server must allow TCP connections from this # machine); # * a username and password to access the database. # . # If some of these requirements are missing, do not choose this option and run with # regular SQLite support. # . # You can change this setting later on by running "dpkg-reconfigure -plow # keystone". # d-i keystone/configure_db boolean false ### Description: Authentication server administration token: # Please enter the token to use with the authentication # server. # d-i keystone/auth-token password ### Description: Register administration tenants? # For OpenStack to work, you need a basic tenant configuration. The # creation of these administration tenants can be done automatically. # d-i keystone/create-admin-tenant boolean false ### Description: Username of the administrative user: # Please enter a username for the administrative user. # d-i keystone/admin-user string admin ### Description: Email address of the administrative user: # Please enter the email address of the administrative user. # d-i keystone/admin-email string root@localhost ### Description: Password of the administrative user: # Please enter a password for the administrative user. # d-i keystone/admin-password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same administrative password again to verify that you have typed it # correctly. # d-i keystone/admin-password-confirm password ### Description: Name of the administrative role: # Please enter the name of the administrative role. # d-i keystone/admin-role-name string admin ### Description: Name of the administrative tenant: # Please enter the name of the administrative tenant. # d-i keystone/admin-tenant-name string admin ### Description: Register Keystone endpoint? # Each OpenStack service (each API) should be registered in order to be # accessible. This is done using "keystone service-create" and "keystone # endpoint-create". This can be done automatically now. # d-i keystone/register-endpoint boolean false ### Description: Keystone endpoint IP address: # Please enter the IP address that will be used to contact Keystone. # d-i keystone/endpoint-ip string ### Description: Name of the region to register: # OpenStack supports using availability zones, with each region representing # a location. Please enter the zone that you wish to use when registering the # endpoint. # d-i keystone/region-name string regionOne ############################ #### kinput2-canna-wnn_3.1-12_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Default system keybindings of Kinput2 for Wnn # Debian prepackaged version of Kinput2 provides a functionality to select # default keybindings of Kinput2 for Wnn from "Kinput2" and "Egg". Although # the former is the original keybindings of Kinput2, Egg on Emacs users may # prefer the latter. # d-i shared/kinput2/wnn/keybindings select Egg # Possible choices: Kinput2, Egg ############################ #### kinput2-wnn_3.1-12_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Default system keybindings of Kinput2 for Wnn # Debian prepackaged version of Kinput2 provides a functionality to select # default keybindings of Kinput2 for Wnn from "Kinput2" and "Egg". Although # the former is the original keybindings of Kinput2, Egg on Emacs users may # prefer the latter. # d-i shared/kinput2/wnn/keybindings select Egg # Possible choices: Kinput2, Egg ############################ #### kismet_2013.03.R1b-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Install Kismet "setuid root"? # Kismet needs root privileges for some of its functions. However, running it # as root ("sudo kismet") is not recommended, since running all of the code # with elevated privileges increases the risk of bugs doing system-wide # damage. Instead Kismet can be installed with the "setuid" bit set, which # will allow it to grant these privileges automatically to the processes that # need them, excluding the user interface and packet decoding parts. # . # Enabling this feature allows users in the "kismet" group to run Kismet # (and capture packets, change wireless card state, etc), so only thoroughly # trusted users should be granted membership of the group. # . # For more detailed information, see section 4 of the Kismet README # ("Suidroot & Security"), which can be found at # /usr/share/doc/kismet/README or "http://www.kismetwireless.net/README". # d-i kismet/install-setuid boolean true ### Description: Users to add to the kismet group: # Only users in the kismet group are able to use kismet under the setuid # model. # . # Please specify the users to be added to the group, as a # space-separated list. # . # Note that currently logged-in users who are added to a group will # typically need to log out and log in again before it is recognized. # d-i kismet/install-users string ############################ #### knews_1.0b.1-29+b2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: What news server should be used for reading and posting news? # knews is configured to read news via an NNTP connection, and needs to know # the fully-qualified host name of the server (such as news.example.com). If # you have a local news spool, you should consider installing some NNTP # server like inn2; in that case, enter "localhost" as your news server. # d-i shared/news/server string ### Description: What is your system's mail name? # Please enter the 'mail name' of your system. This is the hostname portion # of the address to be shown on outgoing news and mail messages, and is used # by many packages. # d-i knews/mail-name string ############################ #### krb5-admin-server_1.12.1+dfsg-19+deb8u4_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### krb5-kdc_1.12.1+dfsg-19+deb8u4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Create the Kerberos KDC configuration automatically? # The Kerberos Key Distribution Center (KDC) configuration files, in # /etc/krb5kdc, may be created automatically. # . # By default, an example template will be copied into this directory # with local parameters filled in. # . # Administrators who already have infrastructure to manage their # Kerberos configuration may wish to disable these automatic # configuration changes. # d-i krb5-kdc/debconf boolean true ### Description: Should the KDC database be deleted? # By default, removing this package will not delete the KDC database in # /var/lib/krb5kdc/principal since this database cannot be recovered once # it is deleted. # . # Choose this option if you wish to delete the KDC database now, deleting # all of the user accounts and passwords in the KDC. # d-i krb5-kdc/purge_data_too boolean false ############################ #### kumofs_0.4.13-6.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Kumofs components to run on this host: # Please choose which components of kumofs should run on this host. # * kumo-server stores data and replicates it into other servers; # * kumo-manager monitors and balances the servers; # * kumo-gateway relays requests from client applications. # d-i kumofs/select_components multiselect # Possible choices: kumo-manager, kumo-server, kumo-gateway ### Description: Command-line options for kumo-manager: # Please specify the command-line options to use with kumo-manager. # . # The default value is well adapted for a single-node setup. # d-i kumofs/manager_options string -l localhost ### Description: Command-line options for kumo-server: # Please specify the command-line options to use with kumo-server. # . # The default value is well adapted for a single-node setup. # d-i kumofs/server_options string -m localhost -l localhost -s /var/lib/kumofs/kumofs.tch ### Description: Command-line options for kumo-gateway: # Please specify the command-line options to use with kumo-gateway. # . # The default value is well adapted for a single-node setup. # d-i kumofs/gateway_options string -m localhost -t 11211 ############################ #### lava-server_2014.09.1-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Is this a standalone master instance of LAVA? # LAVA can be set up in either of two ways: as a single standalone # master instance with attached devices, or in a distributed # configuration with a central master instance and remote dispatchers # providing (more) devices. # . # Configuration of remote dispatchers requires manual intervention, # so the standalone configuration is recommended. # d-i lava-server/master boolean true ### Description: Port number of the PostgreSQL database: # Please enter the port number for the PostgreSQL database. # d-i lava-server/db-port string 5432 ### Description: Name for this LAVA instance: # LAVA servers need to have an instance name. If this is a new # instance, you can safely use the default name. If this is an upgrade # of a previous LAVA instance, specify the instance name here to # upgrade the database or use a different name to start fresh with # a new database. # d-i lava-server/instance-name string default ### Description: Name of the master instance for this worker: # LAVA servers need to have an instance name. Each remote # worker must be given the instance name of the master # LAVA server which it will poll for new jobs to run # on the devices attached to the worker. # d-i lava-worker/master-instance-name string default ### Description: Master scheduler for this worker: # Each remote worker needs to connect to a master scheduler # running lava-server. This hostname or IP address will be # used to connect to the master database. # . # To work with remote nodes, the master needs to be configured # to allow the database to listen to the workers. An SSH key also # needs to be generated on the worker and added to the master list # of authorized_keys. Ensure that the master allows remote access # from workers before submitting jobs or health checks. # . # You can continue setting up the worker, as long as # remote database access is enabled before jobs are submitted. # d-i lava-worker/db-server string ### Description: Name of the database on the master: # Please enter the name of the database on the master scheduler # running lava-server. The worker will use this name to contact # the database. # d-i lava-worker/db-name string ### Description: Username for the database on the master: # Please enter the username for the database on the master scheduler # running lava-server. The worker will use this username to contact # the database. # d-i lava-worker/db-user string ### Description: Port number of the database on the master: # Please enter the database port number for the database on the # master scheduler running lava-server. The worker will use this # port to contact the database. # d-i lava-worker/db-port string 5432 ### Description: Password for the database on the master: # Please enter the password for the database on the master scheduler # running lava-server. The worker will use this password to contact # the database. # d-i lava-worker/db-pass string ############################ #### lcl-utils-1.2.4_1.2.4+dfsg2-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Rename "/etc/lazarus" to "/etc/lazarus.bak"? # The Lazarus suite now supports keeping multiple versions installed # at the same time and using the alternatives system to set proper # defaults. Normally, the latest version of any component is used. # . # To use the alternatives system on the system-wide configuration # of the Lazarus suite, /etc/lazarus needs to be under control of the # alternatives system. Currently there is a real directory at # /etc/lazarus, probably from a previous installation. In order to # start using the alternatives system on the configuration you must # accept renaming "/etc/lazarus". If you don't, you will need to # review the configuration on every version update of Lazarus as, # unfortunately, the configuration files are not always # backward-compatible. Also switching between different versions # might need more intervention. # . # If you have made changes to your configuration files, you will # probably need to review them and apply them to all versioned # configurations, as they will not automatically propagate. # d-i lcl-utils-1.2.4/rename_cfg boolean true ############################ #### lcdproc_0.5.7-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Perform automatic configuration upgrade ? # lcdproc configuration can be merged automatically by cme # during package upgrade. This process will keep your # configuration customization, apply maintainer's changes and write back # the configuration files. # . # You can later edit lcdproc configuration with the command # 'sudo cme edit lcdproc'. # . # If you decline this option, your configuration file will not be managed # by the package manager. # d-i lcdproc/auto-upgrade-config boolean true ############################ #### ldap-account-manager_4.7.1-1+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Web server configuration: # LDAP Account Manager supports any webserver that supports PHP5, but this # automatic configuration process only supports Apache2. # If you choose to configure Apache2 then LAM can be accessed at http(s)://localhost/lam # d-i ldap-account-manager/config-webserver multiselect apache2 # Possible choices: apache2 ### Description: Alias name: # LAM will add an alias to your httpd.conf which allows you to # access LAM at http(s)://localhost/lam. You may select an alias other than # "lam". # d-i ldap-account-manager/alias string lam ### Description: Would you like to restart your webserver(s) now? # Your webserver(s) need to be restarted in order to apply the changes. # d-i ldap-account-manager/restart-webserver boolean true ############################ #### leafnode_1.11.10-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Server to download news from: # The name of the news server should be provided by the organization # providing you with network access, such as your Internet Service # Provider. # . # This server is generally called "news." or "nntp." # where is the local domain name. # d-i leafnode/server string news ### Description: Enable access controls for Leafnode? # If you do not enable some access controls for Leafnode, people everywhere # will be able to use the news server which opens opportunities # for spamming or resource abuse. # . # Access controls will prevent computers other than the news server # itself reading or posting to newsgroups using the server. If required # access can be granted to other computers by editing /etc/hosts.allow. # d-i leafnode/tcpd boolean true ### Description: Network connection type: # The Leafnode package can automatically download news. # . # The method used for this depends on the network connection type. # Scripts provided with the package support two network connection types: # - permanent: hourly news downloads; # - PPP : news downloads triggered by dialouts. # . # Either option will work for a dial-on-demand network connection. # . # Choosing 'none' will disable automatic news downloads. News # can be downloaded manually by running 'fetchnews'. # d-i leafnode/network select PPP # Possible choices: PPP, permanent, none ### Description: Update the list of available groups? # Leafnode updates the list of available newsgroups when # it checks for new news. No newsgroups will be available until this has # happened at least once. # . # If you choose to update the list of groups immediately, # newsgroups will be available to clients as soon as Leafnode has been # set up. # d-i leafnode/update-groups boolean true ### Description: Remove news groups and articles when purging the package? # The /var/spool/news directory holds the database of news articles # downloaded by Leafnode. Many other news servers also use this # directory to store their news database and you may wish to keep it # even when removing the leafnode package. # d-i leafnode/purge boolean false ############################ #### ledgersmb_1.3.40-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Database administrative user login: # Please enter the login of the LedgerSMB database administrative user. This # login is needed for the administrative web user interface, typically at # http://localhost/ledgersmb/setup.pl. # d-i ledgersmb/admin_login string ledgersmb ### Description: Database administrative user password: # Please enter the password of the LedgerSMB database administrative user. This # password is needed for the administrative web user interface, typically at # http://localhost/ledgersmb/setup.pl. # d-i ledgersmb/admin_password password LEDGERSMBINITIAL ### Description: Configure LedgerSMB automatically? # The configuration program for the package can automatically configure # some aspects of LedgerSMB, such as the LedgerSMB database user. # . # More general information about the initial configuration of the application # can be found in /usr/share/doc/ledgersmb/README.Debian. # d-i ledgersmb/debconf_install boolean false ############################ #### liblemonldap-ng-common-perl_1.3.3-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: LDAP server: # Set here name or IP address of the LDAP server that has to be used by # Lemonldap::NG. # You can modify this value later using the Lemonldap::NG manager. # d-i liblemonldap-ng-common-perl/ldapServer string localhost ### Description: Lemonldap::NG DNS domain: # Set here the main domain protected by Lemonldap::NG. # You can modify this value later using the Lemonldap::NG manager. # d-i liblemonldap-ng-common-perl/domain string example.com ### Description: Lemonldap::NG portal: # Set here the Lemonldap::NG portal URL. # You can modify this value later using the Lemonldap::NG manager. # d-i liblemonldap-ng-common-perl/portal string http://auth.example.com/ ### Description: LDAP server port: # Set here the port used by the LDAP server. # You can modify this value later using the Lemonldap::NG manager. # d-i liblemonldap-ng-common-perl/ldapPort string 389 ### Description: LDAP search base: # Set here the search base to use in LDAP queries. # You can modify this value later using the Lemonldap::NG manager. # d-i liblemonldap-ng-common-perl/ldapBase string dc=example,dc=com ### Description: LDAP account: # Set here the account that Lemonldap::NG has to use for its LDAP requests. # Leaving it blank causes Lemonldap::NG to use anonymous connections. # You can modify this value later using the Lemonldap::NG manager. # d-i liblemonldap-ng-common-perl/managerDn string ### Description: LDAP password: # Set here the password for the Lemonldap::NG LDAP account. # You can modify this value later using the Lemonldap::NG manager. # d-i liblemonldap-ng-common-perl/managerPassword string ### Description: Lemonldap::NG configuration files have changed, try to migrate your files? # d-i liblemonldap-ng-common-perl/migrate boolean ############################ #### libapache-sessionx-perl_2.01-4_all.deb ############################ ### Description: For internal use only # Keys used to find configured stores. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/priv_keys string ### Description: Action: # Choose "Add New" to add a new session storage method, or choose an already # configured store to modify or delete it. # . # Choose "Finished" when done. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/action select Finished # Possible choices: Finished, Add New, ${stores} ### Description: Action to perform on ${store}: # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_action select Modify # Possible choices: Modify, Delete ### Description: Session storage method: # Please select the storage method you wish to use: # File: File-based, using semaphores for locking. # FileFile: File-based, using lockfiles. # DB_File: DBM file storage, using lockfiles. # Mysql: MySQL storage, using semaphores for locking. # MysqlMysql: MySQL storage, using MySQL for locking. # Oracle: Oracle storage and locking. # Sybase: Sybase storage and locking. # Postgres: PostgreSQL storage and locking. # . # The file-based methods are the simplest to configure, but don't scale to # the needs of a high-volume site. # . # Semaphore locking is faster than file-based locking, but cannot be shared # between multiple hosts; in such a situation, you probably should be using # one of the database backends anyway. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_type select # Possible choices: File, FileFile, DB_File, Mysql, MysqlMysql, Oracle, Sybase, Postgres ### Description: Store name: # Please choose the name you will use when referring to this storage method. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_name string ### Description: File storage directory: # Please choose the directory in which to store session data. Each # session will be a new file in this directory. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_file_directory string ### Description: Lockfile storage directory: # Please choose the directory in which to store session locks. Each # lock is a new file in this directory. # . # The filenames are chosen such that they will not conflict with session # data, so you may repeat a file storage directory here. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_file_lockdirectory string ### Description: Database file: # Please enter the DBM file used to store sessions. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_dbfile_filename string ### Description: MySQL data source: # Please choose the MySQL data source used for storing session data, in # the form of a Perl DBI DSN (see the DBI manpage). # . # The general form is "dbi:mysql:". See the DBD::mysql manpage for # more details. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_mysql_datasource string dbi:mysql:sessions ### Description: MySQL username: # Please enter the username used to access the session database. If # left blank, the current user's login will be used. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_mysql_username string ### Description: MySQL password: # Please enter the password used to access the session database. May be # left blank if no password is needed. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_mysql_password password ### Description: MySQL lock data source: # Please enter the MySQL data source used for locking, in the form of a # Perl DBI DSN (see the DBI manpage). Locking is performed using # MySQL's GET_LOCK and RELEASE_LOCK functions. # . # The general form is "dbi:mysql:". See the DBD::mysql manpage for # more details. # . # You will almost certainly want to use the same value you used for the # session data. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_mysql_lockdatasource string dbi:mysql:sessions ### Description: MySQL username for locking: # Please enter the username used to access the database for locking. If # left blank, the current user's login will be used. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_mysql_lockusername string ### Description: MySQL password for locking: # Please enter the password used to access the database for # locking. May be left blank if no password is needed. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_mysql_lockpassword password ### Description: Oracle data source: # Please enter the Oracle data source used for storing session data, in # the form of a Perl DBI DSN (see the DBI manpage). The general # form is "dbi:Oracle:". See the DBD::Oracle manpage for more # details. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_oracle_datasource string dbi:Oracle:sessions ### Description: Oracle username: # Please enter the username used to access the session database. If # left blank, the current user's login will be used. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_oracle_username string ### Description: Oracle password: # Please enter the password used to access the session database. May be left blank if no # password is needed. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_oracle_password password ### Description: Sybase data source: # Please enter the Sybase data source used for storing session data, in # the form of a Perl DBI DSN (see the DBI manpage). # . # The general form is "dbi:Sybase:database=;server=". See # the DBD::Sybase manpage for more details. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_sybase_datasource string dbi:Sybase:database=sessions ### Description: Sybase username: # Please enter the username used to access the session database. If # left blank, the current user's login will be used. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_sybase_username string ### Description: Sybase password: # Please enter the password used to access the session database. May be # left blank if no password is needed. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_sybase_password password ### Description: PostgreSQL data source: # Please enter the PostgreSQL data source used for storing session # data, in the form of a Perl DBI DSN (see the DBI manpage). # . # The general form is "dbi:Pg:dbname=;host=". See the # DBD::Pg manpage for more details. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_postgres_datasource string dbi:Pg:dbname=sessions ### Description: PostgreSQL username: # Please enter the username used to access the session database. If left blank, the current # user's login will be used. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_postgres_username string ### Description: PostgreSQL password: # Please enter the password used to access the session database. May be # left blank if no password is needed. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/store_postgres_password password ### Description: Default storage method: # Please choose the storage method that will be used by default if you # don't specify a particular storage method at run time. # d-i libapache-sessionx-perl/default_store select # Possible choices: ${stores} ############################ #### libgcr410_2.4.0-9.2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Serial port to which the smartcard reader is connected: # The driver needs to know to which serial port the GemPlus GCR410 reader is # connected. # d-i libgcr410/port select # Possible choices: ttyS0, ttyS1, ttyS2, ttyS3 ############################ #### libnss-ldap_265-3+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Make the configuration file readable/writeable by its owner only? # If you use passwords in your libnss-ldap configuration, it is usually a # good idea to have the configuration set with mode 0600 (readable and # writable only by the file's owner). # . # Note: As a sanity check, libnss-ldap will check if you have nscd installed # and will only set the mode to 0600 if nscd is present. # d-i libnss-ldap/confperm boolean false ### Description: Distinguished name of the search base: # Please enter the distinguished name of the LDAP search base. Many sites # use the components of their domain names for this purpose. For example, # the domain "example.net" would use "dc=example,dc=net" as the # distinguished name of the search base. # d-i shared/ldapns/base-dn string dc=example,dc=net ### Description: Does the LDAP database require login? # Choose this option if you can't retrieve entries from # the database without logging in. # . # Note: Under a normal setup, this is not needed. # d-i libnss-ldap/dblogin boolean false ### Description: Automatically update libnss-ldap's configuration file? # The libnss-ldap package may use debconf for its configuration. # . # If you choose this option, the configuration file will be prepended # with "###DEBCONF###"; you can disable the debconf updates by removing # that line. # . # All new installations will use this option by default. # d-i libnss-ldap/override boolean true ### Description: Unprivileged database user: # Please enter the name of the account that will be used to log in to the LDAP # database. # d-i libnss-ldap/binddn string cn=proxyuser,dc=example,dc=net ### Description: Password for database login account: # Please enter the password that will be used to log in to the LDAP database. # d-i libnss-ldap/bindpw password ### Description: LDAP version to use: # Please enter which version of the LDAP protocol should be used by # ldapns. It is usually a good idea to set this to the highest # available version number. # d-i shared/ldapns/ldap_version select 3 # Possible choices: 3, 2 ### Description: LDAP server Uniform Resource Identifier: # Please enter the URI of the LDAP server used. This is a string in the # form ldap://:/ . ldaps:// or ldapi:// can also # be used. The port number is optional. # . # Note: It is usually a good idea to use an IP address; this reduces risks # of failure in the event name service is unavailable. # d-i shared/ldapns/ldap-server string ldap://127.0.0.1/ ### Description: Special LDAP privileges for root? # This option will allow tools that perform requests to the nss system # with libnss-ldap as backend to return more information when called # as root. # . # If you are using NFS mounted /etc or any other custom setup, you should # disable this. # d-i libnss-ldap/dbrootlogin boolean true ### Description: LDAP account for root: # Please choose which account will be used for nss requests with root # privileges. # . # Note: For this to work the account needs permission to access the # attributes in the LDAP directory that are related to the users' shadow # entries as well as users' and groups' passwords. # d-i libnss-ldap/rootbinddn string cn=manager,dc=example,dc=net ### Description: LDAP root account password: # Please enter the password to use when libnss-ldap tries to # login to the LDAP directory using the LDAP account for root. # . # The password will be stored in a separate file /etc/libnss-ldap.secret # which will be made readable to root only. # . # Entering an empty password will re-use the old password. # d-i libnss-ldap/rootbindpw password ############################ #### libpam-ldap_184-8.7+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: LDAP administrative account: # Please enter the name of the LDAP administrative account. # . # This account will be used automatically for database management, so # it must have the appropriate administrative privileges. # d-i libpam-ldap/rootbinddn string cn=manager,dc=example,dc=net ### Description: LDAP administrative password: # Please enter the password of the administrative account. # . # The password will be stored in the file ${filename}. # This will be made readable to root only, and will allow ${package} # to carry out automatic database management logins. # . # If this field is left empty, the previously stored password will # be re-used. # d-i libpam-ldap/rootbindpw password ### Description: Does the LDAP database require login? # Please choose whether the LDAP server enforces a login before # retrieving entries. # . # Such a setup is not usually needed. # d-i libpam-ldap/dblogin boolean false ### Description: Distinguished name of the search base: # Please enter the distinguished name of the LDAP search base. Many sites # use the components of their domain names for this purpose. For example, # the domain "example.net" would use "dc=example,dc=net" as the # distinguished name of the search base. # d-i shared/ldapns/base-dn string dc=example,dc=net ### Description: Local encryption algorithm to use for passwords: # The PAM module can encrypt the password locally when changing it, # which is recommended: # * clear: no encryption. This should be chosen when LDAP servers # automatically encrypt the userPassword entry; # * crypt: make userPassword use the same format as the flat # local password database. If in doubt, you should choose this option; # * nds: use Novell Directory Services-style updating. The old # password is first removed, then updated; # * ad: Active Directory-style. This creates a Unicode password and # updates the unicodePwd attribute; # * exop: use the OpenLDAP password change extended operation to update the # password. # d-i libpam-ldap/pam_password select crypt # Possible choices: clear, crypt, nds, ad, exop, md5 ### Description: LDAP version to use: # Please choose the version of the LDAP protocol that should be used by # ldapns. Using the highest available version number is recommended. # d-i shared/ldapns/ldap_version select 3 # Possible choices: 3, 2 ### Description: LDAP login user account: # Please enter the name of the LDAP account that should be used for # non-administrative (read-only) database logins. # . # It is highly recommended to use an unprivileged account, because # the configuration file that contains the account name and password # must be world-readable. # d-i libpam-ldap/binddn string cn=proxyuser,dc=example,dc=net ### Description: Allow LDAP admin account to behave like local root? # This option will allow password utilities that use PAM to # change local passwords. # . # The LDAP admin account password will be stored in a separate file which will be made # readable to root only. # . # If /etc is mounted by NFS, this option should be disabled. # d-i libpam-ldap/dbrootlogin boolean true ### Description: LDAP server URI: # Please enter the Uniform Resource Identifier of the LDAP server. # The format is 'ldap://:/'. Alternatively, # 'ldaps://' or 'ldapi://' can be used. The port number is optional. # . # Using an IP address is recommended to avoid failures when # domain name services are unavailable. # d-i shared/ldapns/ldap-server string ldapi:/// ### Description: Password for LDAP login user: # Please enter the password for the nonadministrative LDAP login account. # d-i libpam-ldap/bindpw password ### Description: Manage libpam-ldap configuration automatically? # The libpam-ldap package configuration may be managed automatically # using answers to questions asked during the configuration process. # The resulting configuration file may overwrite local changes. # . # If you do not choose this option, no further questions will be asked # and the configuration will need to be done manually. # d-i libpam-ldap/override boolean true ############################ #### libpaper1_1.1.24+nmu4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: System's default paper size: # Please select the default paper size for the system. # Various programs on the system will use this configuration option to # determine how to print output. # d-i libpaper/defaultpaper select # Possible choices: letter, a4, note, legal, executive, halfletter, halfexecutive, 11x17, statement, folio, quarto, 10x14, ledger, tabloid, a0, a1, a2, a3, a5, a6, a7, a8, a9, a10, b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, c5, DL, Comm10, Monarch, archE, archD, archC, archB, archA, flsa, flse, csheet, dsheet, esheet ############################ #### libphone-utils0_0.1+git20110523-2.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: International phone prefix: # Please enter the prefix to dial for international calls. # This prefix is "00" in most countries. # d-i libphone-utils/international_prefix string 00 ### Description: National phone prefix: # Please enter the prefix to dial for national calls. # This prefix is "0" in most countries. # d-i libphone-utils/national_prefix string 0 ### Description: Telephone country code: # Please enter the international telephone code for the local country # (for instance, "49" for Germany). # d-i libphone-utils/country_code string 49 ### Description: Area code: # Please enter the telephone code for the local area (for instance, # "30" for Berlin in Germany). # . # This is normally only needed with landline phones. # d-i libphone-utils/area_code string 0 ############################ #### libphp-adodb_5.15-1+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### libwiki-toolkit-perl_0.83-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Install version of Wiki::Toolkit requiring schema upgrade? # You are about to install a version of Wiki::Toolkit which requires a # database schema upgrade. Until you have run the upgrade procedure on # Wiki::Toolkit databases, this will cause applications using Wiki::Toolkit # to stop working. # . # If your Wiki::Toolkit application installed an upgrade hook, this upgrade # procedure will optionally run this hook to automatically upgrade the # database(s) belonging to this application. # d-i libwiki-toolkit-perl/schema_upgrade_warn boolean ### Description: Automatically upgrade Wiki::Toolkit databases? # Upgrade hooks provided by Wiki::Toolkit applications have been found. # They can be run after the package upgrade completes to automatically # upgrade the relevant databases. # . # It is recommended that you backup your Wiki::Toolkit databases before # upgrading them. # d-i libwiki-toolkit-perl/schema_upgrade_auto boolean ############################ #### libzorpll3.9-1_3.9.1.3-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Email address for Zorp notifications: # Some Zorp applications are able to send a notification email in case # of an unexpected process termination. Leave this empty (or specify # "NONE") if no such notifications should be sent. # d-i zorplib/admin-email string NONE ############################ #### lightdm_1.10.3-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # d-i lightdm/daemon_name string /usr/sbin/lightdm ### Description: Default display manager: # A display manager is a program that provides graphical login capabilities for # the X Window System. # . # Only one display manager can manage a given X server, but multiple display # manager packages are installed. Please select which display manager should # run by default. # . # Multiple display managers can run simultaneously if they are configured to # manage different servers; to achieve this, configure the display managers # accordingly, edit each of their init scripts in /etc/init.d, and disable the # check for a default display manager. # d-i shared/default-x-display-manager select # Possible choices: ${choices} ############################ #### lilo_24.1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to add the large-memory option? # Usually LILO loads the initrd file into the first 15MB of memory to # avoid a BIOS limitation with older systems (earlier than 2001 and # few systems until 2004). # . # With newer kernels the combination of kernel and initrd may not fit # into the first 15MB of memory. LILO will compute the needed size of memory # and will automatically use the memory above 15MB, too, if there is # enough physical memory. # . # If this machine has a recent BIOS without a 15MB limitation and you # want to use memory above 15MB for all kernels, set the 'large-memory' # option. # d-i lilo/add_large_memory boolean false ### Description: Do you want to run /sbin/lilo now? # It was detected that it's necessary to run /sbin/lilo in order to activate # the new LILO configuration. # . # WARNING: This procedure will write data in your MBR and may overwrite # some data there. If you skip this step, you must run /sbin/lilo before # rebooting your computer, or your system may not boot again. # d-i lilo/runme boolean false ### Description: Do you want to convert boot and root options? # Since kernel using the newer disk interface 'libata' you need the newer # DiskID and/or UUID in your /etc/lilo.conf for the boot and root options. # For the most modern systems you should use this conversion and then run # '/sbin/lilo'. # d-i lilo/diskid_uuid boolean false ############################ #### linux-image-3.16.0-6-amd64_3.16.56-1+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Abort installation after depmod error? # The 'depmod' command exited with the exit code ${exit_value} # (${SIGNAL}${CORE}). # . # Since this image uses initrd, the ${modules_base}/3.16.0-6-amd64/modules.dep file # will not be deleted, even though it may be invalid. # . # You should abort the installation and fix the # errors in depmod, or regenerate the initrd image with a known good # modules.dep file. If you don't abort the installation, there is # a danger that the system will fail to boot. # d-i linux-image-3.16.0-6-amd64/postinst/depmod-error-initrd-3.16.0-6-amd64 boolean false ### Description: Abort kernel removal? # You are running a kernel (version ${running}) and attempting to remove # the same version. # . # This can make the system unbootable as it will remove # /boot/vmlinuz-${running} and all modules under the directory # /lib/modules/${running}. This can only be fixed with a copy of the # kernel image and the corresponding modules. # . # It is highly recommended to abort the kernel removal unless you are # prepared to fix the system after removal. # d-i linux-image-3.16.0-6-amd64/prerm/removing-running-kernel-3.16.0-6-amd64 boolean true ############################ #### linux-base_3.5_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Update disk device IDs in system configuration? # The new Linux kernel version provides different drivers for some PATA # (IDE) controllers. The names of some hard disk, CD-ROM, and tape # devices may change. # . # It is now recommended to identify disk devices in configuration files # by label or UUID (unique identifier) rather than by device name, # which will work with both old and new kernel versions. # . # If you choose to not update the system configuration automatically, # you must update device IDs yourself before the next system reboot or # the system may become unbootable. # d-i linux-base/disk-id-convert-auto boolean true ### Description: Apply configuration changes to disk device IDs? # These devices will be assigned UUIDs or labels: # . # ${relabel} # . # These configuration files will be updated: # . # ${files} # . # The device IDs will be changed as follows: # . # ${id_map} # d-i linux-base/disk-id-convert-plan boolean true ### Description: Apply configuration changes to disk device IDs? # These configuration files will be updated: # . # ${files} # . # The device IDs will be changed as follows: # . # ${id_map} # d-i linux-base/disk-id-convert-plan-no-relabel boolean true ############################ #### linux-patch-grsecurity2_3.0+3.14.22-201410250026-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### localepurge_0.7.3.4_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Locale files to keep on this system: # The localepurge package will remove all locale files from the system # except those that you select here. # . # When selecting the locale corresponding to your language and country # code (such as "de_DE", "de_CH", "it_IT", etc.) it is recommended to # choose the two-character entry ("de", "it", etc.) as well. # . # Entries from /etc/locale.gen will be preselected # if no prior configuration has been successfully completed. # d-i localepurge/nopurge multiselect # Possible choices: ${locales} ### Description: Use dpkg --path-exclude? # dpkg supports --path-exclude and --path-include options to filter files # from packages being installed. # . # Please see /usr/share/doc/localepurge/README.dpkg-path for more # information about this feature. It can be enabled (or disabled) # later by running "dpkg-reconfigure localepurge". # . # This option will become active for packages # unpacked after localepurge has been (re)configured. Packages # installed or upgraded together with localepurge may (or may not) be # subject to the previous configuration of localepurge. # d-i localepurge/use-dpkg-feature boolean true ### Description: Really remove all locales? # No locale has been chosen for being kept. This means that all locales will be # removed from this system. Please confirm whether this is really your # intent. # d-i localepurge/none_selected boolean false ### Description: Also delete localized man pages? # Based on the same locale information you chose, localepurge can also # delete localized man pages. # d-i localepurge/mandelete boolean true ### Description: Inform about new locales? # If you choose this option, you will be given the opportunity # to decide whether to keep or delete newly introduced locales. # . # If you don't choose it, newly introduced locales will be # automatically dropped from the system. # d-i localepurge/dontbothernew boolean false ### Description: Display freed disk space? # The localepurge program can display the disk space freed by each # operation, and show a final summary of saved disk space. # d-i localepurge/showfreedspace boolean true ### Description: Accurate disk space calculation? # There are two ways available to calculate freed disk space. One is # much faster than the other but far less accurate if other changes occur # on the file system during disk space calculation. The other one is more # accurate but slower. # d-i localepurge/quickndirtycalc boolean true ### Description: Display verbose output? # The localepurge program can be configured to explicitly show which # locale files it deletes. This may cause a lot of screen output. # d-i localepurge/verbose boolean false ############################ #### logtool_1.2.8-8_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Manual configuration of logtool's database? # Logtool needs a database with regular expressions that describe logfile # entries that should be ignored, or considered less important. You can # write this database manually, or use the very flexible database in the # package logcheck-database for this purpose. # . # If you choose to use logcheck-database and already added values to the # files in /etc/logtool, these files will be replaced by symbolic links in # the logcheck database (although backups will be preserved). Make sure this # is not unwanted behaviour. # . # Reply positively to manually write a database, or negatively to use the # database from the package "logcheck-database". # . # Note: since logtool does not depend on this database (but instead # Recommends it), the default answer to this question is to manually # configure the database. # d-i logtool/manual boolean true ### Description: Ignored template # No longer used template (although its value is read for upgrade purposes), # no need to translate it. # d-i logtool/ignore-start select paranoid # Possible choices: paranoid, server, workstation ### Description: Do you want to use the '${level}' level regular expressions? # The database in the logcheck-database package defines three levels: # paranoid, server, and workstation; and it also has a database for cracking, # violations, and ignored violations ('violations-ignore'). Logcheck allows you # to pick one of the levels, and ignores the rest. # . # Logtool, on the other hand, can use multiple databases, which either # specify lines that should be completely excluded from output # (/etc/logtool/exclude) or lines that should be given a specific color # (green, yellow, blue, magenta, cyan, brightcyan). There is also the # possibility to not create an exclude file, and use an 'include' style of # file instead; its use is not recommended. Last but not least, files that # are not excluded from output but that do not match any other regular # expression are colored red. # . # If you want to map the '${level}' level database of regular expressions to # one of the above specified options, then answer positively to this # question. # d-i logtool/use-level boolean true ### Description: What do you want the ${level} level of regular expressions to do? # Please specify what you want to do with a line if it matches at least one # of the regular expressions in the ${level} level database. You have the # following options (note that regular expressions are matched on a # line-per-line basis): # . # * exclude: discard matching lines # * include: discard all but matching lines. Not recommended. Note that # this is mutually exclusive with 'exclude'. # * green, yellow, blue, magenta, cyan, brightcyan: give matching lines # the specified color. # . # Note that each option can be specified for only one of paranoid, # server, or workstation. # d-i logtool/map-level-to-file select # Possible choices: exclude, include, green, yellow, blue, magenta, cyan, brightcyan ############################ #### lprng_3.8.B-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Make lpr, lprm and lpq setuid root? # For full RFC1179 compliance you need to make these programs setuid root. # This is mainly so they can create a socket with a low port number. The low # port number may be important if you have network printers or have adjusted # /etc/lprng/lpd.perms to restrict access to non-privledged ports. For the # typical printer connected locally to parallel port (and many other) # scenario you can leave these programs non setuid root. # d-i lprng/setuid_tools boolean false ### Description: Start lpd (Printer Daemon) at boot? # Some people for various reasons do not want to start lpd. Refusing this # option means lpd will not start. Unless you know why you want lpd # not to start, just accept the default. # d-i lprng/start_lpd boolean true ############################ #### lsb-core_4.1+Debian13+nmu1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable shadow passwords? # The Linux Standard Base requires that certain features of adduser(8) # be available to conforming applications (such as password # aging). These features are only provided when shadow passwords are # enabled, while this system has them disabled. # . # Most LSB applications will work fine with either setting, but complete # conformance requires shadow passwords to be enabled. # . # Generally speaking, it is considered good practice to enable shadow # passwords. However, there are some situations in which shadow passwords # may not work properly (most notably, if non-root users need to # check passwords against /etc/passwd). # d-i lsb/shadowconfig boolean true ############################ #### lsh-server_2.1-5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: lsh server port: # The default port for lshd is 22. If lshd should run on a different port, # please specify the alternative port here. If you specify 22, you will # need to manually disable any other SSH servers running on port 22, other # than OpenSSH (from the package openssh-server), which will be disabled # automatically if you choose 22 here. # d-i lsh-server/lshd_port string 22 ### Description: Enable the SFTP subsystem? # Please choose whether you want to use the EXPERIMENTAL lsh SFTP support. # . # Since it is experimental, the default is for it to be disabled, but it # can be enabled now or later by manually changing /etc/default/lsh-server. # d-i lsh-server/sftp boolean false ### Description: Remove host key on purge? # When this package is installed, a host key is generated to authenticate # your host. # . # Please choose whether you want to purge the host key when the package # is removed. # d-i lsh-server/purge_hostkey boolean true ### Description: Additional arguments to pass to lshd: # d-i lsh-server/extra_args string ############################ #### ltsp-server_5.5.4-4_all.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use: Build LTSP client environment during package installation? # Internal template used to set the configuration value at install time. # Do not translate this. # d-i ltsp-server/build_client boolean false ############################ #### solr-common_3.6.2+dfsg-5+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove Solr index files? # The Solr data directory (/var/lib/solr), and the index files it contains, may # be removed while purging the package. # . # You should not choose this option if you intend to re-use Solr's index # files later. # d-i solr/purgeindexfiles boolean false ############################ #### lurker_2.3-5+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Archive Name: # The name that lurker uses to refer to the archive. # d-i lurker/archive string Local Mailing List Archive ### Description: Admin Name: # This is the administrative contact information displayed at the bottom-right # of generated pages. You should probably set it to something useful. # d-i lurker/admin_name string Unconfigured ### Description: Admin Address: # d-i lurker/admin_address string nill@bitbucket.org ### Description: Password for the lurker system group: # A password for the lurker system group needs to be set. It is requested when # deleting mail from archive through the web button. # You can change the password later by running 'gpasswd lurker'. # d-i lurker/group_passwd password ############################ #### lyskom-elisp-client_0.48+git.20140815.afa49c26-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Exclude non-English servers from default server list? # The LysKOM Elisp Client normally comes with a default server list that # includes one server for communication in English, one Finnish server and a # dozen Swedish servers. If you don't know Swedish (or Finnish), you # will have little or no use for those servers. # d-i lyskom-elisp-client/server-list-query boolean true ############################ #### lyskom-server_2.1.2-13_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Select the language of the initial database: # The LysKOM server comes with two pre-defined databases, one with English # names for conferences and the administrator account, and one in Swedish. # Please select the one you want to install on your machine. # . # The database is only installed once, and when you have installed it you # cannot switch. You can, of course, rename the conferences and accounts if # you wish. # d-i lyskom-server/language select English # Possible choices: English, Swedish ############################ #### macchanger_1.7.0-5.3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Change MAC automatically? # Please specify whether macchanger should be set up to run automatically # every time a network device is brought up or down. This gives a new MAC # address whenever you attach an ethernet cable or reenable wifi. # d-i macchanger/automatically_run boolean false ############################ #### ihungarian_1.6.1-2_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### mailagent_3.1-78-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Organization name for this computer: # The /etc/news/organization file does not exist. That file contains # the name of the organization this computer belongs to. This is the # name that will appear in the Organization header field of outgoing # articles, mail, or patches. # . # Please enter the name of the organization as you want it to appear in # that header field. It is common practice to add a location, typically # a city name, to the organization's name, for instance: # University of Southern North Dakota, Hoople # . # If you enter "--none--", no organization name will be setup. # d-i shared/news/organization string --none-- ############################ #### mailcrypt_3.5.9-7_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Should Mailcrypt be auto-loaded by default at your site? # Mailcrypt will globally (i.e., for all users on this site) overload certain # Emacs functions and key-bindings if you answer affirmatively to this # question. # . # This is generally a good thing, since Mailcrypt is a very useful package; # however you may not want it to happen, and instead let single users at your # site decide by themselves if they should load this package. # . # If you answer negatively, people who desire to use it will have to put the # string "(require 'mailcrypt-init)" in their personal Emacs configuration # file (e.g., "~/.emacs" or "~/.emacs.el") to load it. # d-i mailcrypt/default boolean true ############################ #### mailfilter_0.8.3-1_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### mailgraph_1.14-13_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Should Mailgraph start on boot? # Mailgraph can start on boot time as a daemon. Then it will monitor # your Postfix logfile for changes. This is recommended. # . # The other method is to call mailgraph by hand with the -c parameter. # d-i mailgraph/start_on_boot boolean true ### Description: Logfile used by mailgraph: # Enter the logfile which should be used to create the databases for # mailgraph. If unsure, leave default (/var/log/mail.log). # d-i mailgraph/mail_log string /var/log/mail.log ### Description: Ignore mail to/from localhost? # When using a content filter like amavis, incoming mail is counted more # than once, which will result in wrong values. # If you use some content filter, you should choose this option. # d-i mailgraph/ignore_localhost boolean false ############################ #### mailman_2.1.18-2+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Languages to support: # For each supported language, Mailman stores default language # specific texts in /etc/mailman/LANG/ giving them conffile like # treatment with the help of ucf. This means approximately 150kB for # each supported language on the root file system. # . # If you need a different set of languages at a later time, just run # dpkg-reconfigure mailman. # . # NOTE: Languages enabled on existing mailing lists are forcibly # re-enabled when deselected and mailman needs at least one language for # displaying its messages. # d-i mailman/site_languages multiselect en (English) # Possible choices: ar (Arabic), ca (Catalan), cs (Czech), da (Danish), de (German), en (English), es (Spanish), et (Estonian), eu (Basque), fi (Finnish), fr (French), hr (Croatian), hu (Hungarian), ia (Interlingua), it (Italian), ja (Japanese), ko (Korean), lt (Lithuanian), nl (Dutch), no (Norwegian), pl (Polish), pt (Portuguese), pt_BR (Brasilian Portuguese), ro (Romanian), ru (Russian), sl (Slovenian), sr (Serbian), sv (Swedish), tr (Turkish), uk (Ukrainian), vi (Vietnamese), zh_CN (Chinese - China), zh_TW (Chinese - Taiwan) ### Description: for internal use: holding result of scan # d-i mailman/used_languages string ### Description: Default language for Mailman: # The web page will be shown in this language, and in general, Mailman # will use this language to communicate with the user. # d-i mailman/default_server_language select en (English) # Possible choices: ${site_languages} ### Description: Old queue files present # The directory /var/lib/mailman/qfiles contains files. It needs to be # empty for the upgrade to work properly. You can try to handle them by: # - Stop new messages from coming in (at the MTA level). # - Start a mailman queue runner: /etc/init.d/mailman start # - Let it run until all messages are handled. # If they don't all get handled in a timely manner, look at the logs # to try to understand why and solve the cause. # - Stop it: /etc/init.d/mailman stop # - Retry the upgrade. # - Let messages come in again. # You can also decide to simply remove the files, which will make # Mailman forget about (and lose) the corresponding emails. # . # If these files correspond to shunted messages, you have to either # delete them or unshunt them (with /var/lib/mailman/bin/unshunt). # Shunted messages are messages on which Mailman has already abandoned # any further processing because of an error condition, but that are # kept for admin review. You can use /var/lib/mailman/bin/show_qfiles to # examine the contents of the queues. # . # You have the option to continue installation regardless of this problem, at # the risk of losing the messages in question or breaking your Mailman setup. # d-i mailman/queue_files_present select abort installation # Possible choices: abort installation, continue regardless ############################ #### man-db_2.7.0.2-5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should man and mandb be installed 'setuid man'? # The man and mandb program can be installed with the set-user-id bit set, so # that they will run with the permissions of the 'man' user. This allows # ordinary users to benefit from the caching of preformatted manual pages # ('cat pages'), which may aid performance on slower machines. # . # Cached man pages only work if you are using an 80-column terminal, to avoid # one user causing cat pages to be saved at widths that would be inconvenient # for other users. If you use a wide terminal, you can force man pages to be # formatted to 80 columns anyway by setting MANWIDTH=80. # . # Enabling this feature may be a security risk, so it is disabled by default. # If in doubt, you should leave it disabled. # d-i man-db/install-setuid boolean false ### Description: for internal use; can be preseeded # If true, automatically rebuild man-db's database when packages containing # manual pages are installed. # d-i man-db/auto-update boolean true ############################ #### man2html_1.6g-7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should post-installation script index your man pages? # Swish++ will be run once a week to index your man pages. # . # The index can also be generated (in the background) by the post-installation script. # This process needs quite a lot of computer resources, and can take several minutes # so you can choose now if you would like to do this. # d-i man2html/index_manpages boolean true ############################ #### mariadb-server-10.0_10.0.32-0+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Really proceed with downgrade? # A file named /var/lib/mysql/debian-*.flag exists on this system. # . # Such a file is an indication that a mariadb-server package with a higher # version has been installed previously. # . # There is no guarantee that the version you're currently installing # will be able to use the current databases. # d-i mariadb-server-10.0/really_downgrade boolean false ### Description: Remove all MariaDB databases? # The /var/lib/mysql directory which contains the MariaDB databases is about # to be removed. # . # If you're removing the MariaDB package in order to later install a more # recent version or if a different mariadb-server package is already # using it, the data should be kept. # d-i mysql-server-10.0/postrm_remove_databases boolean false ### Description: New password for the MariaDB "root" user: # While not mandatory, it is highly recommended that you set a password # for the MariaDB administrative "root" user. # . # If this field is left blank, the password will not be changed. # d-i mysql-server/root_password password ### Description: Repeat password for the MariaDB "root" user: # d-i mysql-server/root_password_again password ### Description: Really migrate to MariaDB? # MariaDB is a drop-in replacement for MySQL. It will use your current # configuration file (my.cnf) and current databases. # . # Note that MariaDB has some enhanced features, which do not exist in MySQL # and thus migration back to MySQL might not always work, at least not as # automatically as migrating from MySQL to MariaDB. # d-i mariadb-server/oneway_migration boolean true ############################ #### mason_1.0.0-12.3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Default action for new firewall rules: # The new rule default action specifies how Mason will handle unknown packets, when the firewall is in learning mode. # . # The "accept" action will allow the packet through. "Reject" will stop the # packet with a rejection reply, while "deny" will drop the packet silently. # d-i mason/newrulepolicy select accept # Possible choices: accept, reject, deny ### Description: Default action for rulesets: # The default action specifies how Mason will handle unknown packets, when the firewall is not in learning mode. # . # Again, "accept" allows the packet through, "reject" drops the packet with # a reply, and "deny" silently drops the packet. # d-i mason/defaultpolicy select accept # Possible choices: accept, reject, deny ############################ #### masqmail_0.2.30-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Manage masqmail.conf automatically? # The /etc/masqmail/masqmail.conf file can be handled automatically by # answering a few questions, or entirely manually by the local administrator. # . # Note that only specific, marked sections of the configuration file will be # managed this way if you choose this option; if those markers are missing, # you will have to update the file manually, or remove the file. # d-i masqmail/manage_config_with_debconf boolean true ### Description: Replace existing /etc/masqmail/masqmail.conf file? # The existing /etc/masqmail/masqmail.conf file currently on the system does # not contain a marked section for automatic configuration management. # . # If you choose this option, the existing configuration # file will be backed up to /etc/masqmail/masqmail.conf.debconf-backup and a # new file written to /etc/masqmail/masqmail.conf. If you do not choose this # option, the existing configuration file will not be managed automatically, # and no further questions about masqmail configuration will be # asked. # d-i masqmail/move_existing_nondebconf_config boolean false ### Description: Masqmail host name: # Please enter the name used by masqmail to identify itself to others. # This is most likely the machine's hostname. It is used in the SMTP # greetings banner and generated Message-ID fields, as well as for # expansion of unqualified addresses, and so on. # d-i masqmail/host_name string ### Description: Hosts considered local: # Please enter a list, separated with semicolons (;), of hosts which are # considered "local". Mail to these hosts will be delivered to a # mailbox (or Maildir or MDA) on this host. # . # You will most likely insert "localhost" as well as this host's fully # qualified name and short name. # . # You can also use wildcard expressions containing "*" and "?". # d-i masqmail/local_hosts string ### Description: Networks considered local: # Please enter a list, separated with semicolons (;), of hosts which are # on the local network. That is, they should be always reachable, without a # dialup connection. Mail to these hosts will be delivered immediately, # without checking for the online status. # . # You can use wildcard expressions containing "*" and "?", for # instance "*.yournet.local". # . # That field can be left empty if this host is the only host on the # network. If you do not want # to use Masqmail as an offline MTA and all servers likely to receive # outbound mail from this host are always reachable, just use "*" # here. # d-i masqmail/local_nets string ### Description: Interfaces for incoming connections: # For security reasons, Masqmail does not listen an all network # interfaces by default. If there are no other hosts connected to this # host, "localhost:25" is enough for local operation. If there are other # hosts that need to send SMTP mail to this host, you should add the # address of the relevant network interface, for instance # "localhost:25;192.168.1.2:25". # d-i masqmail/listen_addresses string localhost:25 ### Description: Use the system log daemon for logging? # Masqmail may log via the system log daemon (syslog) or use its # own custom logging in /var/log/masqmail/masqmail.log. # d-i masqmail/use_syslog boolean false ### Description: Online detection method: # Masqmail has two methods to determine whether it is online or not: # "file" and "pipe". # - With "file", it checks for the existence of a file. If it # exists, the name of the connection is read from that file. # - With "pipe", it calls a program or script, which outputs the name # if online or nothing if not. The "guessnet" program is a good # candidate for such use. # d-i masqmail/online_detect select file # Possible choices: file, pipe ### Description: File used to determine the online status: # d-i masqmail/online_file string /var/run/masqmail-route ### Description: Name of the program used to determine the online status: # Please choose the program to use to determine the online # status. This program is called with "mail" as user ID. # d-i masqmail/online_pipe string ### Description: Local delivery style: # Local mail can be delivered to a mailbox, to a mail delivery # agent (MDA) such as procmail # or to Maildir-style mailboxes in the users' home directories. # . # This choice affects the default delivery mechanism. It can be defined # on a per-user basis with the "mbox_users", "mda_users" and # "maildir_users" options. # d-i masqmail/mbox_default select mbox # Possible choices: mbox, mda, maildir ### Description: MDA command line (including options): # Please choose the path to the mail delivery agent (MDA), including # its arguments. You can use variable substitution here, # such as ${rcpt_local} for the user name. # . # Masqmail's manual page describes all available variable substitutions. # . # This question is meaningful even when choosing another option than # MDA delivery, in case MDA is used for a restricted set of users. # d-i masqmail/mda string /usr/bin/procmail -Y -d ${rcpt_local} ### Description: Should alias expansion be case sensitive? # Masqmail uses the file /etc/aliases to redirect local addresses. # The search for a match in /etc/aliases can be case sensitive or not. # d-i masqmail/alias_local_caseless boolean false ### Description: Start SMTP listening daemon? # Please choose whether you want Masqmail to start as an SMTP listening # daemon. You will need this if: # - there are other hosts in the local network that may want to send # mail via this host; # - you use a local mail client that sends mail via SMTP. # d-i masqmail/init_smtp_daemon boolean true ### Description: Start SMTP queue running daemon? # Please choose this option if you want Masqmail to start as a queue # running daemon. You're very likely to need this. It is used for mail # that cannot delivered immediately, either because of delivery # failures or because the host is not online on the first attempt to send # a mail. # d-i masqmail/init_queue_daemon boolean true ### Description: Interval for the queue running daemon: # Please choose the interval for the queue running daemon. # . # The format is "-q", followed by a numeric value and one of the letters # s, m, h, d, or w, for seconds, minutes, hours, days, or weeks, # respectively. For instance, "-q10m" defines a ten-minute interval # between runs. # . # Reasonable values are between five minutes (-q5m) and two hours (-q2h). # d-i masqmail/queue_daemon_ival string -q10m ### Description: Start POP3 fetch daemon? # Please choose this option if you want Masqmail to start as a fetch # daemon. If you do so, it will try to fetch mail from configured POP3 # servers, detecting the online # status first. # . # No matter what you choose here, you can later select whether you want to fetch # mail when the host becomes online. # d-i masqmail/init_fetch_daemon boolean false ### Description: Interval for the fetch daemon: # Please choose the interval for the fetch daemon. # . # The format is "-go", followed by a numeric value and one of the letters # s, m, h, d, or w, for seconds, minutes, hours, days, or weeks, # respectively. # . # Reasonable values are between two minutes (-go2m) and two hours (-go2h). # d-i masqmail/fetch_daemon_ival string -go5m ### Description: Flush mail queue when online? # Please choose whether you want Masqmail to immediately flush its mail # queue as soon as the host comes online. This will be done by Masqmail's # ip-up script # in /etc/ppp/ip-up or in /etc/network/if-up.d/. # d-i masqmail/ipup_runqueue boolean true ### Description: Fetch mail when online? # Please choose whether you want Masqmail to immediately fetch mail # from POP3 servers as soon as the host comes online. This will be done # by Masqmail's ip-up script in /etc/ppp/ip-up or in /etc/network/if-up.d/. # d-i masqmail/ipup_fetch boolean false ### Description: List of interfaces used for Masqmail online detection: # Please choose a list of network interfaces which will trigger queue # runs and/or fetching mails when going up. The list will be used in # the /etc/ppp/ip-up and /etc/network/if-up.d/ scripts, when the # interface goes up. # . # A reasonable choice is for instance "ppp0" for a home computer connected # by PPP or "ppp0 eth0" for # a notebook. # . # Other possible choices are "all" to listen on all network interfaces, or # "none" for not listening on any interface. # d-i masqmail/ifup_ifaces string all ############################ #### mdadm_3.3.2-5+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: MD arrays needed for the root file system: # ${msg} # . # Please enter 'all', 'none', or a space-separated list of devices such as # 'md0 md1' or 'md/1 md/d0' (the leading '/dev/' can be omitted). # d-i mdadm/initrdstart string all ### Description: Start arrays not listed in mdadm.conf? # The specified array (${array}) is not listed in the configuration # file (${config}). Therefore, it cannot be started during boot, unless you # correct the configuration file and recreate the initial ramdisk. # . # This warning is only relevant if you need arrays to be started from the # initial ramdisk to be able to boot. If you use kernel autostarting, or do not # need any arrays to be started as early as the initial ramdisk is loaded, you # can simply continue. Alternatively, choose not to continue and enter 'none' # when prompted which arrays to start from the initial ramdisk. # d-i mdadm/initrdstart_notinconf boolean false ### Description: Should mdadm run monthly redundancy checks of the MD arrays? # If the kernel supports it (versions greater than 2.6.14), mdadm can periodically check the # redundancy of MD arrays (RAIDs). This may be a resource-intensive process, # depending on the local setup, but it could help prevent rare cases of data loss. # Note that this is a read-only check unless errors are found; if errors are # found, mdadm will try to correct them, which may result in write access to # the media. # . # The default, if turned on, is to check on the first Sunday of every # month at 01:06. # d-i mdadm/autocheck boolean true ### Description: Do you want to start the MD monitoring daemon? # The MD (RAID) monitor daemon sends email notifications in response to # important MD events (such as a disk failure). # . # Enabling this option is recommended. # d-i mdadm/start_daemon boolean true ### Description: Recipient for email notifications: # Please enter the email address of the user who should get the email # notifications for important MD events. # d-i mdadm/mail_to string root ############################ #### wgerman-medical_20110608-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### memtest86_4.3.7-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Run lilo automatically after upgrade (if found)? # If lilo is installed and its configuration file contains the # memtest86/memtest86+ image, then it should be re-run in order to # allow booting the new image. # d-i shared/memtest86-run-lilo boolean false ############################ #### memtest86+_5.01-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Run lilo automatically after upgrade (if found)? # If lilo is installed and its configuration file contains the # memtest86/memtest86+ image, then it should be re-run in order to # allow booting the new image. # d-i shared/memtest86-run-lilo boolean false ############################ #### mercurial-server_1.2-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want the repositories to be removed when mercurial-server is purged? # d-i mercurial-server/purge_repositories boolean false ############################ #### metche_1.2.2-4_all.deb ############################ ### Description: E-mail address receiving metche reports: # metche monitors "system state" changes. An hour after the last change has # been recorded an e-mail report is sent describing changes made to: # - files inside the watched directory (/etc by default), # - user maintained changelog file(s) (if configured to do so), # - the list of installed Debian packages (if configured to do so). # . # Please enter the e-mail that should receive these reports. It typically # corresponds to the alias or mailing-list used by system administrators for # this computer. # . # Note: by default, metche does not send detailed diffs describing file # changes as this can leak confidential information. If you want to use # this feature, you are strongly encouraged to turn on GPG encryption at the # same time. See the metche(8) man page and the configuration file for more # details. # d-i metche/email string root@localhost ### Description: Changelog monitoring type: # metche can monitor one or more changelogs written by the system # administrators. # . # These changelogs should contain comments describing the changes made to # the system. The easiest way to organize these comments is to put them all # together in one file. # . # Another possibility is to have a subdirectory for each administrative task # with a file named "Changelog". This way, you can store source code or # configuration examples along with the documentation on how they have been # used. # d-i metche/changelog/type select No changelog monitoring # Possible choices: Single changelog file, Multiple changelog files, No changelog monitoring ### Description: Changelog file to be monitored: # This option sets the path of the changelog file to be monitored. # d-i metche/changelog/file string /root/Changelog ### Description: Changelog directory to be monitored: # This option sets the path to the root directory containing the Changelogs. # Each "Changelog" file should be in a sub-directory of this directory. # d-i metche/changelog/directory string /root/changelogs ############################ #### mgetty-fax_1.1.36-2.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Run faxrunqd during system startup? # The mgetty-fax package contains a daemon ("faxrunqd") that can # automatically take in charge the sending of the faxes spooled with # faxspool. This daemon and the faxrunq utility need # /etc/mgetty/faxrunq.config to be configured appropriately in order to run. # If you plan to use faxrunqd, please indicate so. # d-i mgetty-fax/start_faxrunqd boolean true ############################ #### mimedefang_2.75-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should MIMEDefang use an embedded Perl interpreter? # Choosing this option is generally safe and will significantly improve # performance. However, some systems do not support it. See # mimedefang-multiplexor(8) for more details on using an embedded Perl # interpreter # d-i mimedefang/embedperl boolean true ############################ #### mini-buildd_1.0.5_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Home path: # Please choose the directory where mini-buildd data will be stored. # The directory will also be the home directory for the mini-buildd user. # . # It should have enough space for all the builders and repositories # you plan to use. # d-i mini-buildd/home string /var/lib/mini-buildd ### Description: Administrator password for mini-buildd: # Please choose the password for the administrative user of # mini-buildd. This password will be used for the "admin" user # in mini-buildd's web interface. # . # If you enter a password, this will also trigger the creation of a # local "admin" user. # . # If you leave this empty, no user creation will happen. # d-i mini-buildd/admin_password password ### Description: Extra options: # Please add any mini-buildd command line options you would like to use # ("mini-buildd --help" gives a list of available options). # . # The only options really recommended for use here are "-v"/"--verbose" # to increase the log level or "-q"/"--quiet" to decrease it. # d-i mini-buildd/options string --verbose ############################ #### miniupnpd_1.8.20140523-4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Start the MiniUPnP daemon automatically? # Choose this option if the MiniUPnP daemon should start automatically, # now and at boot time. # d-i miniupnpd/start_daemon boolean false ### Description: LAN IP address to listen on for UPnP queries: # The MiniUPnP daemon will listen for requests on the local network. Please # enter the IP address it should listen on. # d-i miniupnpd/listen string ### Description: External WAN network interface to open ports on: # The MiniUPnP daemon will listen on a specific IP address on the local # network, then open ports on the WAN interface. Please enter the name of # the WAN network interface on which the MiniUPnP daemon should perform # port forwarding. # d-i miniupnpd/iface string ### Description: Enable IPv6 firewall chain? # Please specify whether the MiniUPnP daemon should run its # ip6tables script on startup to initialize the IPv6 firewall chain. # d-i miniupnpd/ip6script boolean false ############################ #### mirrormagic_2.0.2.0deb1-11_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove old highscores in /var/lib/games/mirrormagic? # You have old highscore files in /var/lib/games/mirrormagic, coming from # version 1.3 of mirrormagic. Starting from version 2.0.0, mirrormagic uses # a different file format for highscores, and these are placed in # /var/games/mirrormagic. Therefore, /var/lib/games/mirrormagic should be # deleted. # . # However, if the old highscores are important to you or if you think you # might want to go back to version 1.3, then you may want to keep the old # directory. # d-i mirrormagic/remove_old_highscores boolean ############################ #### miscfiles_1.4.2.dfsg.1-9.1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### mixmaster_3.0.0-7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you wish to update the reliability statistics now? # If you choose this option, up to date reliability statistics and keyrings # will be downloaded from the Internet once Mixmaster has been set up. Once # this has happened this option will be disabled to prevent further updates # when the package will be updated. # d-i mixmaster/stats-update boolean true ############################ #### mldonkey-server_3.1.5-2+b2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Launch MLDonkey at startup? # If enabled, each time your machine starts, the MLDonkey server will be started. # . # Otherwise, you will need to launch MLDonkey yourself each time you want to # use it. # d-i mldonkey-server/launch_at_startup boolean false ############################ #### mlmmj_1.2.18.1-1+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove mlmmj lists on purge? # Removing mlmmj on purge includes the removal of all subscriber lists, # archives and configuration options for all lists currently stored. # . # Accepting here basically means that everything under /var/spool/mlmmj # and /etc/mlmmj/lists will be removed when this package is purged. Also # please note that any changes you might have made to /etc/aliases will not # be unmade automatically when this package is removed. (A notice will be # displayed however, to remind you to clean up your aliases.) # d-i mlmmj/remove-on-purge boolean false ############################ #### monotone-server_1.1-4+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically manage monotone database? # Select this option to automatically manage the monotone database. If # selected, the database will automatically be created. Also when upgrading, # the database will be automatically migrated if necessary. # d-i monotone-server/manage-db boolean true ### Description: Monotone key id: # Enter the id of the key your monotone server will use. The key id # is typically an email address. # d-i monotone-server/key string ### Description: Monotone key passphrase: # Please choose a passphrase for your monotone key. If left blank, one will # be generated for you. # d-i monotone-server/passphrase password ############################ #### moon-buggy_1.0.51-10_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### moon-buggy-esd_1.0.51-10_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you have sound hardware installed? # The moon-buggy-esd package will only work properly if you have sound # hardware installed (see Bug #76059). If you want to play moon-buggy, but # do not have sound hardware, install the moon-buggy package instead. # d-i moon-buggy-esd/sound_hardware boolean ############################ #### mopidy_0.19.4-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Start the Mopidy server at boot? # The Mopidy server can be run as a system service, automatically starting # at boot. It will be listening to MPD connections on port 6600 and HTTP # connections on port 6680. By default, it will only accept connections from # the local machine. # . # You have the option of starting the Mopidy server automatically on system # boot. If in doubt, it is suggested to not start it automatically on boot. # . # This setting can be modified later by running "dpkg-reconfigure mopidy". # d-i mopidy/daemon boolean false ############################ #### motion_3.2.12+git20140228-4+b3_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### mpdscribble_0.22-5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Install system mpdscribble service? # You can install mpdscribble as a system daemon. The mpdscribble service will be started on boot. # Note that is not necessary to run mpd as a system service as it runs fine # when started manually using a regular user account. # d-i mpdscribble/systemwide boolean false ### Description: Last.fm username: # Enter username you use on Last.fm. # d-i mpdscribble/user string ### Description: Last.fm password: # Enter password you use on Last.fm. # d-i mpdscribble/password password ############################ #### mrtg_2.17.4-2+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Make /etc/mrtg.cfg owned by and readable only by root? # If your MRTG configuration file is readable by users other than the user # MRTG runs as ('root' by default) it can present a security risk, as this # file contains SNMP community names. # . # It is recommended that you make the file owned by and readable only by # 'root', unless you have specific reasons not to (for example, because # third-party tools need to read that file, like 'mrtg-rrd'). # d-i mrtg/conf_mods boolean true ############################ #### msmtp_1.4.32-2+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Create a system wide configuration file? # msmtp has a sendmail emulation mode which allow to create a default # system account that can be used by any user. # d-i msmtp/sysconfig boolean false ### Description: SMTP server hostname: # d-i msmtp/host string ### Description: SMTP port number: # d-i msmtp/port string 25 ### Description: Generate an envelope-from address? # msmtp can generate an envelope-from address based on the login name and the # "maildomain" configuration variable. # d-i msmtp/auto_from boolean true ### Description: Domain to use for the envelope-from address: # d-i msmtp/maildomain string ### Description: Use TLS to encrypt connection? # Connection to remote hosts can be encrypted using TLS. This option should be # enabled if the remote server supports such connections. # d-i msmtp/tls boolean false ############################ #### mtink_1.0.16-8_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### multipath-tools-boot_0.5.0-6+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### mumble-server_1.2.8-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Password to set on SuperUser account: # Murmur has a special account called "SuperUser" which bypasses all # privilege checks. # . # If you set a password here, the password for the "SuperUser" account will # be updated. # . # If you leave this blank, the password will not be changed. # d-i mumble-server/password password ### Description: Autostart mumble-server on server boot? # Mumble-server (murmurd) can start automatically when the server is booted. # d-i mumble-server/start_daemon boolean true ### Description: Allow mumble-server to use higher priority? # Mumble-server (murmurd) can use higher process and network priority to # ensure low latency audio forwarding even on highly loaded servers. # d-i mumble-server/use_capabilities boolean false ############################ #### muse_2.1.2-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want MusE to run with superuser rights? # For good timing, MusE needs to set the real time clock (/dev/rtc) to a # higher clock rate, and raise its scheduling priority. Usually, only the # root user is allowed to do so. MusE can be installed "suid-root", so # that it always runs with superuser capabilities. This is convenient, but # programming errors in MusE likely present a hazard for system security in # this setup. # . # File /usr/share/doc/muse/README.Debian summarizes several more secure # methods to meet the timing requirements, but they all require manual # configuration. # . # If you intend to use MusE for timing-sensitive recordings, and security # is of no concern on this computer, opt for the suid-root installation # by giving an affirmative answer to this question. Deny if unsure. # d-i muse/muse-setuid boolean false ############################ #### mxallowd_1.9-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Real mailservers: # Enter the IP addresses of the real mailservers. # d-i mxallowd/real_mailservers string ### Description: Fake mailservers: # Enter the IP addresses of the fake mailservers. # d-i mxallowd/fake_mailservers string ############################ #### libmyodbc_5.1.10-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want MyODBC to be registered as an ODBC driver? # You appear to have an ODBC manager (unixodbc or iODBC) installed on your # system. # . # If you wish, MyODBC will be automatically added as an ODBC driver now and # will be automatically deleted from the list when you remove the libmyodbc # package, using the /usr/bin/odbcinst utility from unixodbc. # d-i libmyodbc/addtoodbc boolean false ############################ #### mysql-server-5.5_5.5.60-0+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Really proceed with downgrade? # A file named /var/lib/mysql/debian-*.flag exists on this system. # . # Such a file is an indication that a mysql-server package with a higher # version has been installed previously. # . # There is no guarantee that the version you're currently installing # will be able to use the current databases. # d-i mysql-server-5.5/really_downgrade boolean false ### Description: Remove all MySQL databases? # The /var/lib/mysql directory which contains the MySQL databases is about # to be removed. # . # If you're removing the MySQL package in order to later install a more # recent version or if a different mysql-server package is already # using it, the data should be kept. # d-i mysql-server-5.5/postrm_remove_databases boolean false ### Description: Start the MySQL server on boot? # The MySQL server can be launched automatically at boot time or manually # with the '/etc/init.d/mysql start' command. # d-i mysql-server-5.5/start_on_boot boolean true ### Description: New password for the MySQL "root" user: # While not mandatory, it is highly recommended that you set a password # for the MySQL administrative "root" user. # . # If this field is left blank, the password will not be changed. # d-i mysql-server/root_password password ### Description: Repeat password for the MySQL "root" user: # d-i mysql-server/root_password_again password ############################ #### mysqmail_0.4.9-10.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Reuse MySQL authentication information from DTC? # MySQMail can use the same MySQL credentials as DTC. # . # If you choose this option, you will not be prompted for a login # and password to configure MySQMail. # d-i mysqmail/conf_mysqlautoconfig boolean true ### Description: MySQL hostname: # Please enter the hostname or IP address of the MySQL server for MySQMail. # d-i mysqmail/conf_mysqlhost string localhost ### Description: MySQL login: # Please enter the MySQL login needed to create (and later, access) the MySQMail # database. # d-i mysqmail/conf_mysqllogin string root ### Description: MySQL password: # Please enter the MySQL password needed to create (and later, access) the MySQMail # database. # d-i mysqmail/conf_mysqlpass password ### Description: MySQL database name: # Please enter the name of the database where MySQMail will store its data. # d-i mysqmail/conf_mysqldb string dtc ############################ #### mythtv-status_0.10.6-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: MythTV backend to check: # The MythTV backend to check, you only need to change this if you want to check # a different host. # d-i mythtv-status/host string localhost ### Description: Update the system MOTD? # Whether the Message of the Day should be updated on system boot and on a # regular basis. # . # To adjust how often the MOTD is updated, edit /etc/cron.d/mythtv-status. # d-i mythtv-status/enable boolean true ### Description: Send email status to: # Status emails can be sent on a daily basis. # . # By default an email is only sent if there are alerts. You must have # the MythTV Perl API installed for conflict alerts to be generated. # . # To disable set the email address to "none". To specify multiple email # addresses, seperate them with a comma. # d-i mythtv-status/email string none ############################ #### nagios3-cgi_3.5.1.dfsg-2+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Nagios web administration password: # Please provide the password to be created with the "nagiosadmin" user. # . # This is the username and password you will use to log in to your nagios # installation after configuration is complete. If you do not provide # a password, you will have to configure access to nagios yourself. # d-i nagios3/adminpassword password ### Description: Password confirmation: # d-i nagios3/adminpassword-repeat password ############################ #### nagvis_1.7.10+dfsg1-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Monitoring suite used with NagVis: # The NagVis package supports Icinga as well as # Nagios, using the check-mk-live broker backend. # . # If you would like to use NagVis with a different backend or a different # monitoring suite, please choose "other". You'll have to configure it # manually. # d-i nagvis/monitoring_system select icinga # Possible choices: icinga, nagios, shinken, other ### Description: Delete NagVis data when purging the package? # NagVis creates files in /var/{cache,lib}/nagvis and # /etc/nagvis (for instance background images and map files), including a small # database for authentification. If you don't need any of these files, # they can be removed now, or you may want to keep them and clean up by hand # later. # d-i nagvis/delete_on_purge boolean false ############################ #### namazu2_2.0.21-10_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Directories in which to copy the cgi: # Namazu package will be installed in /usr/lib/cgi-bin/namazu.cgi by # default. But for VirtualHost, you may also need copy the cgi scripts to another # location. The cgi will be copied automatically on upgrade or installation. # . # Directories should be space separated. If you don't need this feature, # please leave this option to the empty string. # d-i namazu2/install string ############################ #### nap_1.5.4-7.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want napping to be installed setuid? # The napping executable, which is responsible for collecting ping results # for nap, can be installed with the set-user-id bit set, so that it will be # able to open a raw network socket required to send ping packets. # . # Enabling this feature may be a security risk, so it is disabled by # default. If in doubt, it is suggested that you leave it disabled. # d-i nap/napping-setuid boolean false ############################ #### nas_1.9.4-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should nasd release /dev/dsp? # By default, the NAS server will open the configured audio device # at startup, and then keep it open until the server is stopped. This will # stop any non-NAS-aware audio clients from using the audio device. # . # The daemon can be configured to release the audio device when it is # not using it, with some delay after the # application completes before the device is available. # . # An alternative is to use the "audiooss" package to wrap any programs # that use /dev/dsp to make them use equivalent NAS calls. # d-i nas/relinquish boolean true ### Description: Should nasd change mixer settings at startup? # If you choose this option, the NAS server will change the mixer settings # at startup as follows: # . # - set PCM volume to 50%; # - change the record input device to LINE. # d-i nas/mixer boolean false ############################ #### nbd-client_3.8-4+deb8u3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Number of nbd-client connections to use: # nbd-client can handle multiple concurrent connections. Please specify the # number of connections you'd like this configuration script to set up. # . # Note that if something has already been specified in /etc/nbd-client, the # current configuration will be used as defaults in these dialogs. # d-i nbd-client/number string 0 ### Description: Intended use of the network block device number ${number}: # The network block device can serve multiple purposes. One of the most # interesting is to provide swap space over the network for diskless clients, # but you can store a filesystem on it, or do other things with it for which # a block device is interesting. # . # If you intend to use the network block device as a swap device, choose # "swap". If you intend to use it as a filesystem, add a line to /etc/fstab, # give it the option "_netdev" (else init will try to mount it before it's # usable), and choose "filesystem". For all other purposes, choose "raw". # The only thing the nbd-client boot script will do then is start an # nbd-client process; you will have to set it up manually. # d-i nbd-client/type select raw # Possible choices: swap, filesystem, raw ### Description: Hostname of the server (number: ${number})? # Please enter the network name or IP address of the machine on which # the nbd-server process is running. # d-i nbd-client/host string ### Description: Port or name for nbd export (number: ${number})? # Please enter the TCP port number or NBD export name needed to access # nbd-server. # . # Versions of nbd-server of 2.9.16 or lower did not support specifying a # name for the NBD export. If your NBD server is of an older version, you # should enter the TCP port number here, and should make sure not to # enter any non-numeric characters in the field. # . # More recent versions of nbd-server support providing a name for an # export. If the data entered in this field contains any non-numeric # characters, then this configuration system will accept that as a name # and provide it to nbd-client as a name-based export rather than a # port-based one. # d-i nbd-client/port string ### Description: /dev entry for this nbd-client (number: ${number})? # Every nbd-client process needs to be associated with a /dev entry with # major number 43. Please enter the name of the /dev entry you want to use for # this nbd-client. Note that this needs to be the full path to that entry, # not just the last part. # . # If the /dev entry specified does not exist, it will be created with minor # number ${number}. # d-i nbd-client/device string ### Description: Disconnect all NBD devices on "stop"? # When the nbd-client init script is called to stop the nbd-client service, # there are two things that can be done: either it can disconnect all # nbd-client devices (which are assumed not to be in use), or it can # disconnect only those nbd-client devices that it knows about in its # config file. # . # The default (and the traditional behavior) is to disconnect all # nbd-client devices. If the root device or other critical file systems # are on NBD this will cause data loss and should not be accepted. # d-i nbd-client/killall boolean true ### Description: Extra parameters (number: ${number}) # If you wish to add any extra parameters to nbd-client, then please # enter them here. # d-i nbd-client/extra string ############################ #### nbd-server_3.8-4+deb8u3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Number of nbd-server instances to run: # Multiple nbd-server processes may run to export multiple files or # block devices. Please specify how many configurations for such servers you # want to generate. # . # Note that you can always add extra servers by adding them to # /etc/nbd-server/config, or by running "dpkg-reconfigure nbd-server". # d-i nbd-server/number string 0 ### Description: TCP Port for server number ${number}: # Please specify the TCP port this instance of nbd server will use for # backwards compatibility with older clients. # d-i nbd-server/port string ### Description: Name of export ${number}: # Please specify a name for this export. # d-i nbd-server/name string ### Description: File to export (server number ${number}): # Please specify a file name or block device that should be exported # over the network. You can export a real block device (for instance # "/dev/hda1"); a normal file (such as "/export/nbd/bl1"); or a # bunch of files all at once. For the third option, you can # use "%s" in the filename, which will be expanded to the # IP-address of the connecting client. An example would be # "/export/swaps/swp%s". # . # Note that it is possible to tune the way in which the IP address will # be substituted in the file name. See "man 5 nbd-server" for details. # d-i nbd-server/filename string ### Description: Convert old-style nbd-server configuration file? # A pre-2.9 nbd-server configuration file has been found on this system. # The current nbd-server package no longer supports this file and will # not work if it is kept as is. # . # If you choose this option, the system will generate a new style # configuration file based upon the old-style configuration file, which # will be removed. Otherwise, configuration questions will be asked and # the system will generate a new configuration file. # . # If a new-style configuration file already exists and you choose this # option, you will shortly see a "modified configuration file" prompt, as # usual. # d-i nbd-server/convert boolean true ### Description: Support port-based exports? # Since version 2.9.18, nbd-server supports name-based exports, rather # than port-based ones. While this is generally preferable, you may have # to support systems running an older version of nbd-client, or might # need to go through a lot of trouble to update your older configurations # in order to migrate to name-based exports. In either of those cases, # you should accept this option. # . # Everyone else should leave the option at the default setting, which # will cause nbd-server to only support name-based exports. # d-i nbd-server/useports boolean false ############################ #### snmpd_5.7.2.1+dfsg-1+deb8u1+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### netdiag_1.1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Start statnetd at boot time? # Please specify whether statnetd should be started as part of the boot # process. This can be changed later by editing /etc/default/netdiag. # d-i netdiag/run_statnetd boolean true ############################ #### netenv_0.94.3-30_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Upon upgrade, ask again to renew configuration? # You've answered that you want to keep your current configuration this # time. Because the automatic configuration may get new features, you will # be asked the question again when you upgrade netenv the next time. # . # If, however, you want debconf to remember your decision and never touch # your configuration, you can specify that now, by not choosing this option. # d-i netenv/showagain boolean true ### Description: Keep existing configuration? # It appears that you already have configured netenv for ${NODE}. Now you # can select whether you want to keep the actual configuration or whether # netenv setup should create a new one, overriding the old file. # d-i netenv/is_configured0 boolean true ### Description: Configuration options: # netenv has checked your current network settings. It seems it can set up # one working networking environment configuration for you, based on the # settings you currently use. To be able to switch environments, you have to # create additional configurations along this example. # . # Alternatively, you can bypass automatic configuration and do it all # manually later. In this case, netenv will be disabled for now. # d-i netenv/auto_configure select Use current settings # Possible choices: Use current settings, Disable for now ### Description: for internal use # d-i netenv/auto_method select # Possible choices: interfaces, pcmcia ############################ #### nethack-common_3.4.3-15_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Use setgid bit with NetHack's recover utility? # The "recover" program in the package nethack-common is traditionally # installed with the "setgid" bit set, so that all users can use it to # recover their own save files after a crash (with "games" group # privileges). This is a potential source of security problems. # . # This package includes a script that runs during system boot, invoking # recover on any broken save files it finds. This makes it less likely # that users will need to run it themselves, so the default is to install # recover without the special permission bits required for that. # . # If you choose this option, unprivileged users will be able to run "recover". # d-i nethack-common/recover-setgid boolean true ############################ #### netmrg_0.20-7_amd64.deb ############################ ### description: Web server to configure: # d-i netmrg/webserver select # Possible choices: None, Apache2, Apache, Apache-SSL, All ### description: Host name of the mysql database server: # d-i netmrg/db/host string localhost ### description: Name for the database: # d-i netmrg/db/name string netmrg ### description: Name of the database user: # This user will have read/write access to the netmrg database. # d-i netmrg/db/user/name string netmrg ### description: Password of the database user: # d-i netmrg/db/user/password password ### description: Confirm the password of the database user: # d-i netmrg/db/user/password/confirm password ### description: Name of the database system administrator: # In order to be able to create the initial database and database user # for netmrg, the account name of the database system administrator # is needed. # d-i netmrg/db/admin/name string ### description: Password of the database system administrator: # d-i netmrg/db/admin/password password ### description: Name of web host: # netmrg's user interface is web based. The hostname of the web server # is used for URLs within the netmrg web interface. Leaving this # entry field empty is usually a good choice. # d-i netmrg/web/host string ### description: Name of your company: # The web front end of netmrg shows the name of your company in the header # of each web page. # d-i netmrg/company/name string ### description: URL of your company's website: # Clicking on the company name will follow a link. It is usually # the URL pointing to the start page of your company's web site. # d-i netmrg/company/link string http:// ### description: Delete data after purging software? # Purging a package usually removes all data collected by the software # including the log files. # Choose 'no' if you would like to keep the mysql database and # the datafiles even if the netmrg package is purged sometime in the # future. # d-i netmrg/postrm boolean true ############################ #### netselect_0.3.ds1-26_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should netselect be installed setuid root? # Netselect can be installed with the set-user-id bit set, so that it will # run with the permissions of the "root" user. Since netselect needs these # permissions to work properly, unprivileged users cannot run it unless it is # installed this way. # . # Enabling this feature may be a security risk. If in doubt, it is # suggested to leave it disabled. # d-i netselect/install-setuid boolean false ############################ #### neutron-common_2014.1.3-12_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Authentication server hostname: # Please specify the hostname of your Neutron authentication server. Typically # this is also the hostname of your OpenStack Identity Service (Keystone). # d-i neutron/auth-host string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Authentication server tenant name: # Please specify the authentication server tenant name. # d-i neutron/admin-tenant-name string admin ### Description: Authentication server username: # Please specify the username to use with the authentication server. # d-i neutron/admin-user string admin ### Description: Authentication server password: # Please specify the password to use with the authentication server. # d-i neutron/admin-password password ### Description: Neutron plugin: # Neutron uses a plugin architecture to manage networking. When starting the # Neutron server daemon, the configuration file corresponding to the plugin you # wish to use needs to be loaded, by giving it as a parameter when starting the # neutron-server daemon. Also, the core_plugin directive needs to match. Please # select which plugin to use. # d-i neutron/plugin-select select ml2 # Possible choices: OpenVSwitch, LinuxBridge, ml2, Brocade, Nicira, Midonet, NEC, Mellanox, Hyper-V, RYU, ml2/ml2_conf.ini, MetaPlugin, BigSwitch, Cisco, PLUMgrid ### Description: Set up a database for Neutron? # No database has been set up for Neutron to use. Before continuing, you should # make sure you have the following information: # . # * the type of database that you want to use; # * the database server hostname (that server must allow TCP connections from this # machine); # * a username and password to access the database. # . # If some of these requirements are missing, do not choose this option and run with # regular SQLite support. # . # You can change this setting later on by running "dpkg-reconfigure -plow # neutron". # d-i neutron/configure_db boolean false ### Description: IP address of your RabbitMQ host: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the IP address of that server. # d-i neutron/rabbit_host string localhost ### Description: Username for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the username used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i neutron/rabbit_userid string guest ### Description: Password for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the password used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i neutron/rabbit_password password ### Description: Type of network to allocate for tenant networks: # The value "local" is useful only for single-box testing. In order for # tenant networks to provide connectivity between hosts, it is necessary # to either choose "vlan" and then configure "network_vlan_ranges" or to # choose "gre" and then configure "tunnel_id_ranges". Choose "none" to # disable creation of tenant networks. # d-i neutron/tenant_network_type select gre # Possible choices: local, gre, vlan, none ### Description: Enable tunneling? # Please choose whether support should be activated for GRE networks on the # server and agents. This requires kernel support for OVS patch ports and # GRE tunneling. # d-i neutron/enable_tunneling boolean true ### Description: Tunnel id ranges: # Please enter a comma-separated list of : tuples enumerating # ranges of GRE tunnel IDs that are available for tenant network allocation # if tenant_network_type is "gre". # d-i neutron/tunnel_id_ranges string 1:1000 ### Description: Local IP address of this hypervisor: # Please enter the local IP address for this hypervisor. # d-i neutron/local_ip string ############################ #### neutron-metadata-agent_2014.1.3-12_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Auth server hostname: # Please specify the URL of your Neutron authentication server. Typically # this is also the URL of your OpenStack Identity Service (Keystone). # d-i neutron-metadata/auth-host string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Auth server tenant name: # d-i neutron-metadata/admin-tenant-name string admin ### Description: Auth server username: # d-i neutron-metadata/admin-user string admin ### Description: Auth server password: # d-i neutron-metadata/admin-password password ### Description: Name of the region to be used by the metadata server: # Openstack can be used using availability zones, with each region representing # a location. Please enter the zone that the metadata server should use. # d-i neutron-metadata/region-name string regionOne ############################ #### neutron-server_2014.1.3-12_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Register Neutron in the Keystone endpoint catalog? # Each OpenStack service (each API) should be registered in order to be # accessible. This is done using "keystone service-create" and "keystone # endpoint-create". This can be done automatically now. # . # Note that you will need to have an up and running Keystone server on which to # connect using the Keystone authentication token. # d-i neutron/register-endpoint boolean false ### Description: Keystone server IP address: # Please enter the IP address of the Keystone server, so that neutron-api can # contact Keystone to do the Neutron service and endpoint creation. # d-i neutron/keystone-ip string ### Description: Keystone authentication token: # To configure its endpoint in Keystone, neutron-server needs the Keystone auth # token. # d-i neutron/keystone-auth-token password ### Description: Neutron endpoint IP address: # Please enter the IP address that will be used to contact Neutron. # . # This IP address should be accessible from the clients that will use this # service, so if you are installing a public cloud, this should be a public # IP address. # d-i neutron/endpoint-ip string ### Description: Name of the region to register: # OpenStack supports using availability zones, with each region representing # a location. Please enter the zone that you wish to use when registering the # endpoint. # d-i neutron/region-name string regionOne ############################ #### nginx-common_1.6.2-5+deb8u5_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### nis_3.17-33_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: NIS domain: # Please choose the NIS "domainname" for this system. If you want this # machine to just be a client, you should enter the name of the # NIS domain you wish to join. # . # Alternatively, if this machine is to be a NIS server, you can # either enter a new NIS "domainname" or # the name of an existing NIS domain. # d-i nis/domain string ############################ #### nn_6.7.3-8_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: NNTP server to use: # Enter the fully qualified host name of the news server to use for reading. # d-i nn/ask-newsserver string news ############################ #### nodm_0.11-1.3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Start nodm on boot? # Designed for embedded or kiosk systems, nodm starts an X session # for a user without asking for authentication. On regular # machines, this has security implications and is therefore disabled # by default. # . # You should enable nodm only if you need autologin on this machine. # d-i nodm/enabled boolean false ### Description: User to start a session for: # Please enter the login name of the user that will automatically be logged into X by nodm. # d-i nodm/user string root ### Description: Lowest numbered vt on which X may start: # nodm needs to find a free virtual terminal on which to start the X server. # . # Since X and getty get to conflict, this parameter will specify the lowest # numbered virtual terminal on which to start the search. # . # This value should be set to one higher than the highest numbered virtual # terminal on which a getty may start. # d-i nodm/first_vt string 7 ### Description: Options for the X server: # Please enter the options to pass to the X server when starting it. # . # If no vtN option is used, nodm will perform automatic vt allocation. # d-i nodm/x_options string -nolisten tcp ### Description: Minimum time (in seconds) for a session to be considered OK: # If an X session will run for less than this time in seconds, nodm will wait an # amount of time before restarting the session. The waiting time will grow # until a session lasts longer than this amount. # d-i nodm/min_session_time string 60 ### Description: X session to use: # Please choose the name of the X session script to use with nodm. # d-i nodm/xsession string /etc/X11/Xsession ############################ #### aspell-no_2.0.10-5.2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Norwegian language variant: # Norwegian has two different written forms: bokmaal and nynorsk. # . # Please choose the one you wish to use. # d-i aspell-no/whichvariant select bokmaal # Possible choices: nynorsk, bokmaal ############################ #### inorwegian_2.0.10-5.2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Norwegian language variant: # Norwegian has two different written forms: bokmaal and nynorsk. # . # Please choose the one you wish to use. # d-i inorwegian/whichvariant select bokmaal # Possible choices: nynorsk, bokmaal ############################ #### wnorwegian_2.0.10-5.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Norwegian language variant: # Norwegian has two different written forms: bokmaal and nynorsk. # . # Please choose the one you wish to use. # d-i wnorwegian/whichvariant select bokmaal # Possible choices: nynorsk, bokmaal ############################ #### nova-api_2014.1.3-11_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Register Nova in the keystone endpoint catalog? # Each Openstack services (each API) should be registered in order to be # accessible. This is done using "keystone service-create" and "keystone # endpoint-create". Select if you want to run these commands now. # . # Note that you will need to have an up and running keystone server on which to # connect using the Keystone auth token. # d-i nova/register-endpoint boolean false ### Description: Keystone IP address: # Enter the IP address of your keystone server, so that nova-api can # contact Keystone to do the Nova service and endpoint creation. # d-i nova/keystone-ip string ### Description: Keystone Auth Token: # To configure its endpoint in Keystone, nova-api needs the Keystone auth # token. # d-i nova/keystone-auth-token password ### Description: Nova endpoint IP address: # Enter the IP address that will be used to contact Nova (eg: the Nova # endpoint IP address). # . # This IP address should be accessible from the clients that will use this # service, so if you are installing a public cloud, this should be a public # IP address. # d-i nova/endpoint-ip string ### Description: Name of the region to register: # Openstack can be used using availability zones, with each region representing # a location. Please enter the zone that you wish to use when registering the # endpoint. # d-i nova/region-name string regionOne ############################ #### nova-common_2014.1.3-11_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Auth server hostname: # Please specify the URL of your Nova authentication server. Typically # this is also the URL of your OpenStack Identity Service (Keystone). # d-i nova/auth-host string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Auth server tenant name: # d-i nova/admin-tenant-name string admin ### Description: Auth server username: # d-i nova/admin-user string admin ### Description: Auth server password: # d-i nova/admin-password password ### Description: Set up a database for Nova? # No database has been set up for Nova to use. If you want # to set one up now, please make sure you have all needed # information: # . # * the host name of the database server (which must allow TCP # connections from this machine); # * a username and password to access the database; # * the type of database management software you want to use. # . # If you don't choose this option, no database will be set up and Nova # will use regular SQLite support. # . # You can change this setting later on by running "dpkg-reconfigure # -plow nova-common". # d-i nova/configure_db boolean false ### Description: API to activate: # Openstack Nova supports different API services, each of them binding on a # different port. Select which one nova-api should support. # . # If it is a compute node that you are setting-up, then you only need to run the # metadata API server. If you run Cinder, then you don't need osapi_volume (you # cannot run osapi_volume and cinder-api on the same server: they bind on the # same port). # d-i nova/active-api multiselect # Possible choices: ec2, osapi_compute, metadata ### Description: Value for my_ip: # This value will be stored in the my_ip directive of nova.conf. # d-i nova/my-ip string ### Description: Neutron server URL: # Please enter the URL of the Neutron server. # d-i nova/neutron_url string http://127.0.0.1:9696 ### Description: Neutron admin tenant name: # Nova needs to be able to communicate with Neutron through Keystone. Therefore # Nova needs to know the Neutron admin tenant, username and password. # . # Please enter the name of the admin tenant for Neutron. # d-i nova/neutron_admin_tenant_name string admin ### Description: Neutron administrator username: # Please enter the username of the Neutron administrator. # d-i nova/neutron_admin_username string admin ### Description: Neutron administrator password: # Please enter the password of the Neutron administrator. # d-i nova/neutron_admin_password password ### Description: IP address of your RabbitMQ host: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the IP address of that server. # d-i nova/rabbit_host string localhost ### Description: Username for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the username used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i nova/rabbit_userid string guest ### Description: Password for connection to the RabbitMQ server: # In order to interoperate with other components of OpenStack, this package # needs to connect to a central RabbitMQ server. # . # Please specify the password used to connect to the RabbitMQ server. # d-i nova/rabbit_password password ############################ #### nova-consoleproxy_2014.1.3-11_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Type of console daemon to start at boot time: # Nova Console supports 3 types of consoles. One is specific to Xen, called # XVP (Xen VNC Proxy), and the other daemon supports KVM. While the SPICE # protocol is normally faster than VNC, it also requires support for web # sockets in your browser, and that is a feature only very modern browsers # have support for. # . # This can later be edited in /etc/default/nova-consoleproxy. # d-i nova-consoleproxy/daemon_type select spicehtml5 # Possible choices: spicehtml5, xenvnc, novnc ############################ #### nsca_2.9.1-3.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should the nsca daemon be enabled by default? # The nsca daemon is the process that handles results service checks sent # via send_nsca on remote hosts. Typically the nsca daemon is only needed # on hosts that run the nagios daemon. # . # If the system on which you are installing nsca also runs the nagios # daemon, you should most likely choose this option. If you are installing # nsca on a remote "satellite" system for the purpose of sending service # checks to a central nagios host, you should not choose this option. If # you wish to run nsca as a service through inetd/xinetd, you should # also not choose this option. # d-i nsca/run-nsca-daemon boolean ############################ #### nsd_4.1.0-3_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### libnss-ldapd_0.9.4-3+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Name services to configure: # For this package to work, you need to modify the /etc/nsswitch.conf file to use # the ldap datasource. # . # You can select the services that should have LDAP lookups enabled. The # new LDAP lookups will be added as the last datasource. Be sure to review # these changes. # d-i libnss-ldapd/nsswitch multiselect # Possible choices: aliases, ethers, group, hosts, netgroup, networks, passwd, protocols, rpc, services, shadow ### Description: Remove LDAP from nsswitch.conf now? # The following services are still configured to use LDAP for lookups: # ${services} # but the libnss-ldapd package is about to be removed. # . # You are advised to remove the entries if you don't plan on using LDAP for # name resolution any more. Not removing ldap from nsswitch.conf should, for # most services, not cause problems, but host name resolution could be affected # in subtle ways. # . # You can edit /etc/nsswitch.conf by hand or choose to remove the entries # automatically now. Be sure to review the changes to /etc/nsswitch.conf if you # choose to remove the entries now. # d-i libnss-ldapd/clean_nsswitch boolean false ############################ #### nslcd_0.9.4-3+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: LDAP server URI: # Please enter the Uniform Resource Identifier of the LDAP server. The format # is "ldap://:/". Alternatively, "ldaps://" or # "ldapi://" can be used. The port number is optional. # . # When using an ldap or ldaps scheme it is recommended to use an IP address to # avoid failures when domain name services are unavailable. # . # Multiple URIs can be separated by spaces. # d-i nslcd/ldap-uris string ### Description: LDAP server search base: # Please enter the distinguished name of the LDAP search base. Many sites use # the components of their domain names for this purpose. For example, the # domain "example.net" would use "dc=example,dc=net" as the distinguished name # of the search base. # d-i nslcd/ldap-base string ### Description: LDAP authentication to use: # Please choose what type of authentication the LDAP database should # require (if any): # . # * none: no authentication; # * simple: simple bind DN and password authentication; # * SASL: any Simple Authentication and Security Layer mechanism. # d-i nslcd/ldap-auth-type select # Possible choices: none, simple, SASL ### Description: LDAP database user: # Please enter the name of the account that will be used to log in to the LDAP # database. This value should be specified as a DN (distinguished name). # d-i nslcd/ldap-binddn string ### Description: LDAP user password: # Please enter the password that will be used to log in to the LDAP database. # d-i nslcd/ldap-bindpw password ### Description: SASL mechanism to use: # Please choose the SASL mechanism that will be used to authenticate to the LDAP # database: # . # * auto: auto-negotiation; # * LOGIN: deprecated in favor of PLAIN; # * PLAIN: simple cleartext password mechanism; # * NTLM: NT LAN Manager authentication mechanism; # * CRAM-MD5: challenge-response scheme based on HMAC-MD5; # * DIGEST-MD5: HTTP Digest compatible challenge-response scheme; # * SCRAM: salted challenge-response mechanism; # * GSSAPI: used for Kerberos; # * SKEY: S/KEY mechanism (obsoleted by OTP); # * OTP: One Time Password mechanism; # * EXTERNAL: authentication is implicit in the context. # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-mech select # Possible choices: auto, LOGIN, PLAIN, NTLM, CRAM-MD5, DIGEST-MD5, SCRAM, GSSAPI, SKEY, OTP, EXTERNAL ### Description: SASL realm: # Please enter the SASL realm that will be used to authenticate to the LDAP # database. # . # The realm is appended to authentication and authorization identities. # . # For GSSAPI, this can be left blank to use information from the Kerberos # credentials cache. # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-realm string ### Description: SASL authentication identity: # Please enter the SASL authentication identity that will be used to authenticate to # the LDAP database. # . # This is the login used in LOGIN, PLAIN, CRAM-MD5, and DIGEST-MD5 mechanisms. # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-authcid string ### Description: SASL proxy authorization identity: # Please enter the proxy authorization identity that will be used to authenticate to # the LDAP database. # . # This is the object in the name of which the LDAP request is done. # This value should be specified as a DN (distinguished name). # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-authzid string ### Description: Cyrus SASL security properties: # Please enter the Cyrus SASL security properties. # . # Allowed values are described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page # in the SASL OPTIONS section. # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-secprops string ### Description: Kerberos credential cache file path: # Please enter the GSSAPI/Kerberos credential cache file name that will be used. # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-krb5-ccname string /var/run/nslcd/nslcd.tkt ### Description: Use StartTLS? # Please choose whether the connection to the LDAP server should use # StartTLS to encrypt the connection. # d-i nslcd/ldap-starttls boolean ### Description: Check server's SSL certificate: # When an encrypted connection is used, a server certificate can be requested # and checked. Please choose whether lookups should be configured to require # a certificate, and whether certificates should be checked for validity: # . # * never: no certificate will be requested or checked; # * allow: a certificate will be requested, but it is not # required or checked; # * try: a certificate will be requested and checked, but if no # certificate is provided, it is ignored; # * demand: a certificate will be requested, required, and checked. # d-i nslcd/ldap-reqcert select # Possible choices: never, allow, try, demand ### Description: Certificate authority certificate: # When certificate checking is enabled this file contains the X.509 # certificate that is used to check the certificate provided by the server. # d-i nslcd/ldap-cacertfile string /etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt ### Description: Restart services during package upgrades without asking? # There are services installed on your system which need to be restarted # when certain libraries, such as libpam, libc, and libssl, are upgraded. # Since these restarts may cause interruptions of service for the system, # you will normally be prompted on each upgrade for the list of services # you wish to restart. You can choose this option to avoid being prompted; # instead, all necessary restarts will be done for you automatically so you # can avoid being asked questions on each library upgrade. # d-i libraries/restart-without-asking boolean false ### Description: Services to restart for nslcd upgrade: # Running services and programs that are using nslcd need to be restarted, # otherwise they might not be able to do lookup or authentication any more # (for services such as ssh, this can affect your ability to login). # Please review the following space-separated list of init.d scripts for # services to be restarted now, and correct it if needed. # d-i nslcd/restart-services string ############################ #### pynslcd_0.9.4-3+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: LDAP server URI: # Please enter the Uniform Resource Identifier of the LDAP server. The format # is "ldap://:/". Alternatively, "ldaps://" or # "ldapi://" can be used. The port number is optional. # . # When using an ldap or ldaps scheme it is recommended to use an IP address to # avoid failures when domain name services are unavailable. # . # Multiple URIs can be separated by spaces. # d-i nslcd/ldap-uris string ### Description: LDAP server search base: # Please enter the distinguished name of the LDAP search base. Many sites use # the components of their domain names for this purpose. For example, the # domain "example.net" would use "dc=example,dc=net" as the distinguished name # of the search base. # d-i nslcd/ldap-base string ### Description: LDAP authentication to use: # Please choose what type of authentication the LDAP database should # require (if any): # . # * none: no authentication; # * simple: simple bind DN and password authentication; # * SASL: any Simple Authentication and Security Layer mechanism. # d-i nslcd/ldap-auth-type select # Possible choices: none, simple, SASL ### Description: LDAP database user: # Please enter the name of the account that will be used to log in to the LDAP # database. This value should be specified as a DN (distinguished name). # d-i nslcd/ldap-binddn string ### Description: LDAP user password: # Please enter the password that will be used to log in to the LDAP database. # d-i nslcd/ldap-bindpw password ### Description: SASL mechanism to use: # Please choose the SASL mechanism that will be used to authenticate to the LDAP # database: # . # * auto: auto-negotiation; # * LOGIN: deprecated in favor of PLAIN; # * PLAIN: simple cleartext password mechanism; # * NTLM: NT LAN Manager authentication mechanism; # * CRAM-MD5: challenge-response scheme based on HMAC-MD5; # * DIGEST-MD5: HTTP Digest compatible challenge-response scheme; # * SCRAM: salted challenge-response mechanism; # * GSSAPI: used for Kerberos; # * SKEY: S/KEY mechanism (obsoleted by OTP); # * OTP: One Time Password mechanism; # * EXTERNAL: authentication is implicit in the context. # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-mech select # Possible choices: auto, LOGIN, PLAIN, NTLM, CRAM-MD5, DIGEST-MD5, SCRAM, GSSAPI, SKEY, OTP, EXTERNAL ### Description: SASL realm: # Please enter the SASL realm that will be used to authenticate to the LDAP # database. # . # The realm is appended to authentication and authorization identities. # . # For GSSAPI, this can be left blank to use information from the Kerberos # credentials cache. # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-realm string ### Description: SASL authentication identity: # Please enter the SASL authentication identity that will be used to authenticate to # the LDAP database. # . # This is the login used in LOGIN, PLAIN, CRAM-MD5, and DIGEST-MD5 mechanisms. # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-authcid string ### Description: SASL proxy authorization identity: # Please enter the proxy authorization identity that will be used to authenticate to # the LDAP database. # . # This is the object in the name of which the LDAP request is done. # This value should be specified as a DN (distinguished name). # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-authzid string ### Description: Cyrus SASL security properties: # Please enter the Cyrus SASL security properties. # . # Allowed values are described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page # in the SASL OPTIONS section. # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-secprops string ### Description: Kerberos credential cache file path: # Please enter the GSSAPI/Kerberos credential cache file name that will be used. # d-i nslcd/ldap-sasl-krb5-ccname string /var/run/nslcd/nslcd.tkt ### Description: Use StartTLS? # Please choose whether the connection to the LDAP server should use # StartTLS to encrypt the connection. # d-i nslcd/ldap-starttls boolean ### Description: Check server's SSL certificate: # When an encrypted connection is used, a server certificate can be requested # and checked. Please choose whether lookups should be configured to require # a certificate, and whether certificates should be checked for validity: # . # * never: no certificate will be requested or checked; # * allow: a certificate will be requested, but it is not # required or checked; # * try: a certificate will be requested and checked, but if no # certificate is provided, it is ignored; # * demand: a certificate will be requested, required, and checked. # d-i nslcd/ldap-reqcert select # Possible choices: never, allow, try, demand ### Description: Certificate authority certificate: # When certificate checking is enabled this file contains the X.509 # certificate that is used to check the certificate provided by the server. # d-i nslcd/ldap-cacertfile string /etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt ### Description: Restart services during package upgrades without asking? # There are services installed on your system which need to be restarted # when certain libraries, such as libpam, libc, and libssl, are upgraded. # Since these restarts may cause interruptions of service for the system, # you will normally be prompted on each upgrade for the list of services # you wish to restart. You can choose this option to avoid being prompted; # instead, all necessary restarts will be done for you automatically so you # can avoid being asked questions on each library upgrade. # d-i libraries/restart-without-asking boolean false ### Description: Services to restart for nslcd upgrade: # Running services and programs that are using nslcd need to be restarted, # otherwise they might not be able to do lookup or authentication any more # (for services such as ssh, this can affect your ability to login). # Please review the following space-separated list of init.d scripts for # services to be restarted now, and correct it if needed. # d-i nslcd/restart-services string ############################ #### ntlmaps_0.9.9.0.1-11.3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Listen port: # The NTLM Authorization Proxy Server listens to this port. This is # the port number you use in your http_proxy or web browser settings. # . # Proxy servers are commonly set to listen to port 8080, but in NTLM # APS the default value is 5865. # d-i ntlmaps/listen_port string 5865 ### Description: Parent proxy: # This is the address of the NTLM proxy server (e.g. the Microsoft ISA # server) which NTLM APS is authenticating against. # . # The address may be given with or without the leading http://, # for example: # proxy.myworkplace.com # http://proxy.myworkplace.com # d-i ntlmaps/parent_proxy string your_parentproxy ### Description: Parent proxy port: # This is the port number which the NTLM proxy server (e.g. the Microsoft ISA # server), that NTLM APS is authenticating against, listens to. # . # It is commonly set to 8080. # d-i ntlmaps/parent_proxy_port string 8080 ### Description: NT Windows username: # This field identifies the NT Windows username that you use for authentication. # d-i ntlmaps/username string username_to_use ### Description: NT Windows password: # This field identifies the NT Windows password that you use for authentication. # . # To help with security, it is not stored permanently in the debconf # database, but is deleted from there after being written to the # ntlmaps config file. Be aware that it is temporarily stored in the # debconf database while this setup procedure is taking place. It is # deleted from there at the end of setup. # . # If you prefer not to have the password stored, even temporarily, in # the debconf database, then leave this entry blank, and insert the # value manually into the config file /etc/ntlmaps/server.cfg. # d-i ntlmaps/password password your_nt_password ### Description: NT Windows domain: # This field identifies the NT Windows domain that you authenticate against. # d-i ntlmaps/nt_domain string ############################ #### ntop_5.0.1+dfsg1-2.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: User for the ntop process to run as: # Please choose the login that should be used to execute the ntop # process. The use of the root user is not allowed. # . # The account will be created if it does not already exist, but # if you leave it blank, no login will be created and ntop will # not run until manually configured. # d-i ntop/user string ntop ### Description: Interfaces for ntop to listen on: # Please enter a comma-separated list of interfaces that ntop # should listen on. # d-i ntop/interfaces string none ### Description: Administrator password: # Please choose a password to be used for the privileged user "admin" in # ntop's web interface. # d-i ntop/admin_password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same password again to verify that you have typed it # correctly. # d-i ntop/admin_password_again password ### Description: Set a new administrator password? # A password for ntop's administrative web interface has already been set. # . # Please choose whether you want to change that password. # d-i ntop/password_reset boolean false ############################ #### nullmailer_1.13-1+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Mailname of your system: # This is the fully-qualified host name of the computer running nullmailer. # It defaults to the literal name 'me'. # d-i shared/mailname string ### Description: The domain name to be appended to hostnames: # This is the domain name which will be added to any hostnames that don't # contain a dot (that is to say, which aren't already qualified by a domain). # d-i nullmailer/defaultdomain string ### Description: Smarthosts: # This is a colon-separated list of remote servers to which to send each # message. Each entry contains a remote host name or address followed by # an optional protocol string 'host protocol'. The protocol name defaults # to smtp, and may be followed by command-line arguments for that module. # . # Examples: # . # smarthost # smarthost smtp --port=10025 # mail.example.com smtp --user=foo --pass=bar # 192.168.1.254 qmqp # [fe80::5054:ff:fef4:ef81] smtp # d-i nullmailer/relayhost string ### Description: Where to send local emails (optional): # If not empty, all recipients to users at either 'localhost' (the literal # string) or the canonical host name (from /etc/mailname) are remapped to # this address. This is provided to allow local daemons to be able to send # email to 'somebody@localhost' and have it go somewhere sensible instead of # being bounced by your relay host. # d-i nullmailer/adminaddr string ############################ #### ocfs2-tools_1.6.4-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Would you like to start an OCFS2 cluster (O2CB) at boot time? # d-i ocfs2-tools/init boolean false ### Description: Name of the cluster to start at boot time: # d-i ocfs2-tools/clustername string ocfs2 ### Description: O2CB heartbeat threshold: # The O2CB heartbeat threshold sets up the maximum time in seconds that a # node awaits for an I/O operation. After it, the node "fences" itself, # and you will probably see a crash. # . # It is calculated as the result of: (threshold - 1) x 2. # . # Its default value is 31 (60 seconds). # . # Raise it if you have slow disks and/or crashes with kernel messages # like: # . # o2hb_write_timeout: 164 ERROR: heartbeat write timeout to device XXXX # after NNNN milliseconds # d-i ocfs2-tools/heartbeat_threshold string 31 ### Description: O2CB idle timeout: # The O2CB idle timeout (expressed in milliseconds) is the time before # a network connection is considered dead. # . # Its default value is 30000 (30 seconds) and the minimum recommended value # is 5000 (5 seconds). # d-i ocfs2-tools/idle_timeout string 30000 ### Description: O2CB keepalive delay: # The O2CB keepalive delay (expressed in milliseconds) is the maximum time before # a keepalive packet is sent. # . # Its default value is 2000 (2 seconds) and the minimum recommended value # is 1000 (1 second). # d-i ocfs2-tools/keepalive_delay string 2000 ### Description: O2CB reconnect delay: # The O2CB reconnect delay (expressed in milliseconds) is the minimum time between # connection attempts. # . # Its default and recommended minimum value is 2000 (2 seconds). # d-i ocfs2-tools/reconnect_delay string 2000 ############################ #### ocsinventory-agent_2.0.5-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Method used to generate the inventory: # Choose the 'local' method if you do not have a network connection. # . # Choose the 'http' method if an OCS Inventory server is set up. # d-i ocsinventory-agent/method select local # Possible choices: local, http ### Description: OCS Inventory server host name: # Please enter the host name of the OCS inventory server. # d-i ocsinventory-agent/server string ### Description: Tag for the generated inventory: # Each inventory can have an associated tag. Please enter the tag you would # like for the new inventory. # . # This field can be left blank to continue without setting a new tag for the # inventory. # d-i ocsinventory-agent/tag string ############################ #### openafs-client_1.6.9-2+deb8u7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: DB server host names for your home cell: # AFS uses the file /etc/openafs/CellServDB to hold the list of servers that # should be contacted to find parts of a cell. The cell you claim this # workstation belongs to is not in that file. Enter the host names of the # database servers separated by spaces. IMPORTANT: If you are creating a new # cell and this machine is to be a database server in that cell, only enter # this machine's name; add the other servers later after they are # functioning. Also, do not enable the AFS client to start at boot on this # server until the cell is configured. When you are ready you can edit # /etc/openafs/afs.conf.client to enable the client. # d-i openafs-client/cell-info string ### Description: AFS cell this workstation belongs to: # AFS filespace is organized into cells or administrative domains. # Each workstation belongs to one cell. Usually the cell is the DNS # domain name of the site. # d-i openafs-client/thiscell string ### Description: Size of AFS cache in kB: # AFS uses an area of the disk to cache remote files for faster # access. This cache will be mounted on /var/cache/openafs. It is # important that the cache not overfill the partition it is located # on. Often, people find it useful to dedicate a partition to their # AFS cache. # d-i openafs-client/cachesize string 50000 ### Description: Run Openafs client now and at boot? # Normally, most users who install the openafs-client package expect AFS to # be mounted automatically at boot. However, if you are planning on # setting up a new cell or are on a laptop, you may not want it started at # boot time. If you choose not to start AFS at boot, run # /etc/init.d/openafs-client force-start to start the client when you wish # to run it. # d-i openafs-client/run-client boolean true ### Description: Look up AFS cells in DNS? # In order to contact an AFS cell, you need the IP addresses of the cell's # database servers. Normally, this information is read from # /etc/openafs/CellServDB. However, if Openafs cannot find a cell in that # file, it can use DNS to look for AFSDB records that contain the # information. # d-i openafs-client/afsdb boolean true ### Description: Encrypt authenticated traffic with AFS fileserver? # AFS provides a weak form of encryption that can optionally be used between # a client and the fileservers. While this encryption is weaker than DES # and thus is not sufficient for highly confidential data, it does provide # some confidentiality and is likely to make the job of a casual attacker # significantly more difficult. # d-i openafs-client/crypt boolean true ### Description: Dynamically generate the contents of /afs? # /afs generally contains an entry for each cell that a client can talk to. # Traditionally, these entries were generated by servers in the client's # home cell. However, OpenAFS clients can generate the contents of /afs # dynamically based on the contents of /etc/openafs/CellServDB and DNS. # . # If you generate /afs dynamically, you may need to create # /etc/openafs/CellAlias to include aliases for common cells. (The syntax # of this file is one line per alias, with the cell name, a space, and then # the alias for that cell.) # . # The Sparse option is the same as Yes except that, rather than populating # /afs from /etc/openafs/CellServDB immediately, cells other than the local # cell will not appear until they are accessed. Cell aliases as set in the # CellAlias file are shown as normal, although they may appear to be # dangling links until traversed. # d-i openafs-client/dynroot select Yes # Possible choices: Yes, Sparse, No ### Description: Use fakestat to avoid hangs when listing /afs? # Because AFS is a global file space, operations on the /afs directory can # generate significant network traffic. If some AFS cells are unavailable # then looking at /afs using ls or a graphical file browser may hang your # machine for minutes. AFS has an option to simulate answers to these # operations locally to avoid these hangs. You want this option under most # circumstances. # d-i openafs-client/fakestat boolean true ############################ #### openafs-fileserver_1.6.9-2+deb8u7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Cell this server serves files for: # AFS fileservers belong to a cell. They have the key for that cell's # Kerberos service and serve volumes into that cell. Normally, this cell is # the same cell as the workstation's client belongs to. # d-i openafs-fileserver/thiscell string ############################ #### openguides_0.76-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Okay to proceed with upgrade? # You are trying to upgrade from a version of OpenGuides that used an old # database schema. The migration is somewhat risky and so it is strongly # recommended that you backup your OpenGuides databases before proceeding. # d-i openguides/check_old_upgrade boolean ############################ #### slapd_2.4.40+dfsg-1+deb8u4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Omit OpenLDAP server configuration? # If you enable this option, no initial configuration or database will be # created for you. # d-i slapd/no_configuration boolean false ### Description: Dump databases to file on upgrade: # Before upgrading to a new version of the OpenLDAP server, the data from # your LDAP directories can be dumped into plain text files in the # standard LDAP Data Interchange Format. # . # Selecting "always" will cause the databases to be dumped # unconditionally before an upgrade. Selecting "when needed" will only # dump the database if the new version is incompatible with the old # database format and it needs to be reimported. If you select "never", # no dump will be done. # d-i slapd/dump_database select when needed # Possible choices: always, when needed, never ### Description: Directory to use for dumped databases: # Please specify the directory where the LDAP databases will be exported. # In this directory, several LDIF files will be created which correspond # to the search bases located on the server. Make sure you have enough # free space on the partition where the directory is located. The first # occurrence of the string "VERSION" is replaced with the server version # you are upgrading from. # d-i slapd/dump_database_destdir string /var/backups/slapd-VERSION ### Description: Move old database? # There are still files in /var/lib/ldap which will probably break # the configuration process. If you enable this option, the maintainer # scripts will move the old database files out of the way before # creating a new database. # d-i slapd/move_old_database boolean true ### Description: Retry configuration? # The configuration you entered is invalid. Make sure that the DNS domain name # is syntactically valid, the field for the organization is not left empty and # the admin passwords match. If you decide not to retry the configuration the # LDAP server will not be set up. Run 'dpkg-reconfigure slapd' if you want to # retry later. # d-i slapd/invalid_config boolean true ### Description: DNS domain name: # The DNS domain name is used to construct the base DN of the LDAP directory. # For example, 'foo.example.org' will create the directory with # 'dc=foo, dc=example, dc=org' as base DN. # d-i slapd/domain string ### Description: Organization name: # Please enter the name of the organization to use in the base DN of your # LDAP directory. # d-i shared/organization string ### Description: Administrator password: # Please enter the password for the admin entry in your LDAP directory. # d-i slapd/password1 password ### Description: Confirm password: # Please enter the admin password for your LDAP directory again to verify # that you have typed it correctly. # d-i slapd/password2 password ### Description: Do you want the database to be removed when slapd is purged? # d-i slapd/purge_database boolean false ### Description: Encrypted admin password: # Internal template, should never be displayed to users. # d-i slapd/internal/adminpw password ### Description: Generated admin password: # Internal template, should never be displayed to users. # d-i slapd/internal/generated_adminpw password ### Description: Allow LDAPv2 protocol? # The obsolete LDAPv2 protocol is disabled by default in slapd. Programs # and users should upgrade to LDAPv3. If you have old programs which # can't use LDAPv3, you should select this option and 'allow bind_v2' # will be added to your slapd.conf file. # d-i slapd/allow_ldap_v2 boolean false ### Description: Database backend to use: # HDB and BDB use similar storage formats, but HDB adds support for # subtree renames. Both support the same configuration options. # . # The MDB backend is recommended. MDB uses a new storage format and # requires less configuration than BDB or HDB. # . # In any case, you should review the resulting database configuration for # your needs. See /usr/share/doc/slapd/README.Debian.gz for more details. # d-i slapd/backend select MDB # Possible choices: BDB, HDB, MDB ############################ #### openssh-server_6.7p1-5+deb8u4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Disable SSH password authentication for root? # Previous versions of openssh-server permitted logging in as root over SSH # using password authentication. The default for new installations is now # "PermitRootLogin without-password", which disables password authentication # for root without breaking systems that have explicitly configured SSH # public key authentication for root. # . # This change makes systems more secure against brute-force password # dictionary attacks on the root user (a very common target for such # attacks). However, it may break systems that are set up with the # expectation of being able to SSH as root using password authentication. You # should only make this change if you do not need to do that. # d-i openssh-server/permit-root-login boolean false ############################ #### libssl1.0.0_1.0.1t-1+deb8u8_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Services to restart to make them use the new libraries: # This release of OpenSSL fixes some security issues. Services will not # use these fixes until they are restarted. Please note that restarting # the SSH server (sshd) should not affect any existing connections. # . # Please check the list of detected services that need to be restarted # and correct it, if needed. The services names must be identical to the # initialization script names in /etc/init.d and separated by # spaces. No services will be restarted if the list is empty. # . # Any service that later fails unexpectedly after this upgrade should # be restarted. It is recommended to reboot this host to avoid any # SSL-related trouble. # d-i libssl1.0.0/restart-services string ############################ #### trove-api_2014.1.3-8_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Register Glance in the Keystone endpoint catalog? # Each OpenStack service (each API) should be registered in order to be # accessible. This is done using "keystone service-create" and "keystone # endpoint-create". This can be done automatically now. # . # Note that you will need to have an up and running Keystone server on which to # connect using the Keystone authentication token. # d-i trove/register-endpoint boolean false ### Description: Keystone server IP address: # Please enter the IP address of the Keystone server, so that trove-api can # contact Keystone to do the Glance service and endpoint creation. # d-i trove/keystone-ip string ### Description: Keystone authentication token: # To configure its endpoint in Keystone, trove-api needs the Keystone # authentication token. # d-i trove/keystone-auth-token password ### Description: Glance endpoint IP address: # Please enter the IP address that will be used to contact Glance. # . # This IP address should be accessible from the clients that will use this # service, so if you are installing a public cloud, this should be a public # IP address. # d-i trove/endpoint-ip string ### Description: Name of the region to register: # OpenStack supports using availability zones, with each region representing # a location. Please enter the zone that you wish to use when registering the # endpoint. # d-i trove/region-name string regionOne ############################ #### trove-common_2014.1.3-8_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Set up a database for Trove? # No database has been set up for trove to use. Before continuing, you should # make sure you have the following information: # . # * the type of database that you want to use; # * the database server hostname (that server must allow TCP connections from this # machine); # * a username and password to access the database. # . # If some of these requirements are missing, do not choose this option and run with # regular SQLite support. # . # You can change this setting later on by running "dpkg-reconfigure -plow # trove-common". # d-i trove/configure_db boolean false ### Description: Authentication server hostname: # Please specify the hostname of the authentication server for Trove. Typically # this is also the hostname of the OpenStack Identity Service (Keystone). # d-i trove/auth-host string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Authentication server tenant name: # Please specify the authentication server tenant name. # d-i trove/admin-tenant-name string admin ### Description: Authentication server username: # Please specify the username to use with the authentication server. # d-i trove/admin-user string admin ### Description: Authentication server password: # Please specify the password to use with the authentication server. # d-i trove/admin-password password ############################ #### openvpn_2.3.4-5+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Create the TUN/TAP device? # If you choose this option, the /dev/net/tun device # needed by OpenVPN will be created. # . # You should not choose this option if you're using devfs. # d-i openvpn/create_tun boolean false ############################ #### orville-write_2.55-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Would you like the write and mesg programs to be setuid root? # Some features of Orville Write require write and mesg to run with root # privileges. These features include auto-disconnect, non-world-readable # .nowrite files and some others. # . # If you don't need these additional features you can refuse here and have # write and mesg setgid only. # d-i orville-write/setuid boolean true ############################ #### libpam-modules_1.1.8-3.1+deb8u2+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### libpam-runtime_1.1.8-3.1+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: PAM profiles to enable: # Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) determine how authentication, # authorization, and password changing are handled on the system, as well # as allowing configuration of additional actions to take when starting # user sessions. # . # Some PAM module packages provide profiles that can be used to # automatically adjust the behavior of all PAM-using applications on the # system. Please indicate which of these behaviors you wish to enable. # d-i libpam-runtime/profiles multiselect # Possible choices: ${profiles} ### Description: Override local changes to /etc/pam.d/common-*? # One or more of the files /etc/pam.d/common-{auth,account,password,session} # have been locally modified. Please indicate whether these local changes # should be overridden using the system-provided configuration. If you # decline this option, you will need to manage your system's # authentication configuration by hand. # d-i libpam-runtime/override boolean false ############################ #### libpam0g_1.1.8-3.1+deb8u2+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Services to restart for PAM library upgrade: # Most services that use PAM need to be restarted to use modules built for # this new version of libpam. Please review the following space-separated # list of init.d scripts for services to be restarted now, and correct it # if needed. # d-i libpam0g/restart-services string ### Description: Restart services during package upgrades without asking? # There are services installed on your system which need to be restarted # when certain libraries, such as libpam, libc, and libssl, are upgraded. # Since these restarts may cause interruptions of service for the system, # you will normally be prompted on each upgrade for the list of services # you wish to restart. You can choose this option to avoid being prompted; # instead, all necessary restarts will be done for you automatically so you # can avoid being asked questions on each library upgrade. # d-i libraries/restart-without-asking boolean false ############################ #### libpam-mysql_0.7~RC1-4+b3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Chmod configuration file? # This version of pam-mysql has a configuration file which may include # passwords. Do you want to disable normal users from reading this # file? # . # There is probably no good reason *not* to do this. As the most common # reason to use the configuration file is to hide the password. # d-i pam-mysql/config_file_noread boolean true ############################ #### pbuilder_0.215+nmu3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Default mirror site: # Please enter the default mirror you want to be used by pbuilder. # . # If you leave this field blank, there will be one attempt to autodetect # this information. If this attempt fails, you will be prompted again # to insert some valid mirror information. # . # Here is a valid mirror example: http://cdn.debian.net/debian # d-i pbuilder/mirrorsite string ### Description: Overwrite current configuration? # Your system seems to have already pbuilder configuration. # Proceeding might discard or overwrite part or the entire # pbuilder's configuration. # d-i pbuilder/rewrite boolean false ############################ #### pconsole_1.0-11_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want /usr/bin/pconsole to be installed SUID root? # You are strongly encouraged to leave pconsole without the SUID bit on. # . # If you are using a multiuser system, setting the SUID bit on pconsole will # be a major risk for a breach, since normal users will be able to attach # their consoles to a root PTY/TTY and send commands as root. # . # However, on a single-user system, setting the SUID bit might be a good # idea to avoid logging as root user. # . # If in doubt, you should install it without SUID. If it causes problems # you can change your mind later by running: dpkg-reconfigure pconsole # d-i pconsole/setuid boolean false ############################ #### pdns-server_3.4.1-4+deb8u8_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: IP address where PowerDNS should listen on: # If you have multiple IPs, the default behaviour of binding to all addresses # can cause the OS to select the wrong IP for outgoing packets, so it is # recommended to bind PowerDNS to a specific IP here. # d-i pdns-server/localaddress string ### Description: List of subnets that are allowed to recurse: # Enter here, comma separated, the subnets that are allowed to recurse. # Allowed values are 127.0.0.1 for an ip address and 192.168.0.0/24 for a # subnet. # d-i pdns-server/allowrecursion string 127.0.0.1 ############################ #### pdnsd_1.2.9a-par-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: General type of pdnsd configuration: # Please select the pdnsd configuration method that best meets your needs. # . # - Use resolvconf : use informations provided by resolvconf. # - Use root servers: make pdnsd behave like a caching, recursive DNS # server. # - Manual : completely manual configuration. The pdnsd daemon # will not start until you edit /etc/pdnsd.conf and # /etc/default/pdnsd. # . # Note: If you already use a DNS server that listens to 127.0.0.1:53, # you have to choose "Manual". # d-i pdnsd/conf select Manual # Possible choices: Use resolvconf, Use root servers, Manual ############################ #### pdsh_2.31-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should the pdsh binary be installed setuid root? # The pdsh program can be installed setuid root, so that it will run with # the permissions of the 'root' user. # . # This is required for non-root accounts to use the rsh remote-command method # of pdsh. However, enabling this could be a security risk. # . # In short, unless you know what you are doing or have a very controlled # user base, you should not enable this feature. If you choose not to enable # setuid root, then you can still use pdsh through tools like sudo or with # the ssh remote-command module. # d-i pdsh/setuidroot boolean false ############################ #### perlindex_1.606-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove the index when purging the package? # perlindex creates some index files under /var/cache/perlindex/. # d-i perlindex/removeindexonpurge boolean true ############################ #### phalanx_22+d051004-13.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Learning file size (1-999999): # The learning file may improve Phalanx strength. Each item in this # file uses 8 bytes. # . # Please specify a number in the range 1-999999. The size may be # changed later by reconfiguring the package but this will erase any # data the file may then contain. # d-i phalanx/learning_file_size string 32768 ### Description: Really change the size of the learning file and erase its data? # You chose to change the size of the learning file used by phalanx # for improving its strength. This will erase all the learned data. # d-i phalanx/learning_file_erase boolean false ############################ #### phamm_0.6.2-1.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: LDAP server host: # Please enter the host name or IP address of the LDAP server that # Phamm should connect to. # d-i phamm/ldap-server string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Distinguished Name of the search base: # Please enter the Distinguished Name (DN) of the LDAP search base. Many sites # use the components of their domain names for this purpose. For example, # the domain "example.org" would use "dc=example,dc=org". # d-i phamm/ldap-basedn string dc=example,dc=org ### Description: Login DN for the LDAP server: # Please enter the Distinguished Name of the account that will be used # to log in to the LDAP server. If you use form-based authentication # this will be the default login DN. In this case leaving it empty will # prevent the creation of a default login DN. # d-i phamm/ldap-binddn string cn=manager,dc=example,dc=tld ############################ #### phamm-ldap_0.6.2-1.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Create empty LDAP base for Phamm? # d-i phamm-ldap/init_base_ldap boolean false ### Description: Distinguished Name of the search base: # Please enter the Distinguished Name (DN) of the LDAP search base. Many sites # use the components of their domain names for this purpose. For example, # the domain "example.org" would use "dc=example,dc=org". # d-i phamm-ldap/ldap-basedn string dc=example,dc=org ### Description: Login DN for the LDAP server: # Please enter the Distinguished Name of the account that will be used # to log in to the LDAP server. If you use form-based authentication # this will be the default login DN. In this case leaving it empty will # prevent the creation of a default login DN. # d-i phamm-ldap/ldap-binddn string cn=manager,dc=example,dc=tld ### Description: Login password for the LDAP server: # Please enter the password that will be used to log in to the LDAP server. # d-i phamm-ldap/ldap-bindpw password secret ### Description: Login password for the LDAP phamm user: # Please enter the password for "phamm user" useful for binding with limited privileges. # d-i phamm-ldap/ldap-phammpw password secret ############################ #### phonon_4.8.0-4_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### phonon-backend-null_4.8.0-4_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### phonon4qt5-backend-null_4.8.0-4_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### phpbb3_3.0.12-5+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Web server to configure automatically: # Please select any web server that should be configured automatically # for phpBB. # d-i phpbb3/httpd multiselect apache2 # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Configure the phpBB admin password? # d-i phpbb3/admin-pass-ask boolean ### Description: Password for phpBB admin: # Please provide a password for the phpBB user "admin". # . # The password must be at least 6 characters long. # . # If the password is left blank, a random one will be generated. # d-i phpbb3/admin-pass password ### Description: Password confirmation: # Please confirm the password for the phpBB user "admin". # d-i phpbb3/admin-pass-confirm password ############################ #### phpldapadmin_1.2.2-5.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: LDAP server host address: # Please enter the host name or the address of the LDAP server you want to # connect to. # d-i phpldapadmin/ldap-server string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Enable support for ldaps protocol? # If your LDAP server supports TLS (Transport Security Layer), you can use # the ldaps protocol to connect to it. # d-i phpldapadmin/ldap-tls boolean false ### Description: Distinguished name of the search base: # Please enter the distinguished name of the LDAP search base. Many sites # use the components of their domain names for this purpose. For example, # the domain "example.com" would use "dc=example,dc=com" as the # distinguished name of the search base. # d-i phpldapadmin/ldap-basedn string dc=example,dc=com ### Description: Type of authentication # session : You will be prompted for a login dn and a password everytime # you connect to phpLDAPadmin, and a session variable on the # web server will store them. It is more secure so this is the # default. # . # cookie : You will be prompted for a login dn and a password everytime # you connect to phpLDAPadmin, and a cookie on your client will # store them. # . # config : login dn and password are stored in the configuration file, # so you have not to specify them when you connect to # phpLDAPadmin. # d-i phpldapadmin/ldap-authtype select session # Possible choices: session, cookie, config ### Description: Login dn for the LDAP server: # Enter the name of the account that will be used to log in to the LDAP # server. If you chose a form based authentication this will be the # default login dn. In this case you can also leave it empty, if you do # not want a default one. # d-i phpldapadmin/ldap-binddn string cn=admin,dc=example,dc=com ### Description: Login password for the LDAP server: # Enter the password that will be used to log in to the LDAP server. Note: # the password will be stored in clear text in config.php, which is not # world-readable. # d-i phpldapadmin/ldap-bindpw string secret ### Description: Web server(s) which will be reconfigured automatically: # phpLDAPadmin supports any web server that PHP does, but this automatic # configuration process only supports Apache2. # d-i phpldapadmin/reconfigure-webserver multiselect apache2 # Possible choices: apache2 ### Description: Should your webserver(s) be restarted? # Remember that in order to apply the changes your webserver(s) has/have to # be restarted. # d-i phpldapadmin/restart-webserver boolean true ############################ #### phpmyadmin_4.2.12-2+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Web server to reconfigure automatically: # Please choose the web server that should be automatically configured # to run phpMyAdmin. # d-i phpmyadmin/reconfigure-webserver multiselect # Possible choices: apache2, lighttpd ### Description: Username for web-based setup system: # The setup system for phpMyAdmin may be used, after installation, from # http://localhost/phpmyadmin/setup/index.php. # . # Access to this system requires identification with a username and a # password. # . # If you leave this field empty, the default username ('admin') will be used. # d-i phpmyadmin/setup-username string admin ### Description: Password for web-based setup system: # The setup system for phpMyAdmin may be used, after installation, from # http://localhost/phpmyadmin/setup/index.php. # . # Access to this system requires identification with a username and a # password. # . # Usernames and passwords may be managed with the `htpasswd' command and # are stored in /etc/phpmyadmin/htpasswd.setup. # . # If you leave this field empty, access to the web-based setup will be # disabled. # d-i phpmyadmin/setup-password password ############################ #### pinto_0.97+dfsg-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Pinto web administration password: # Please choose the password for the "pintoadmin" user. # . # This username/password combination is needed, after installation, to log # in to Pinto through its web interface. # . # If this is left empty, you will have to manually configure # accounts for Pinto. # d-i pinto/adminpassword password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same user password again to verify you have typed it # correctly. # d-i pinto/adminpassword-repeat password ############################ #### pioneers-meta-server_14.1-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Port range for creating new games on the metaserver: # The metaserver can create new games, so players don't need to install and # run the pioneers server. The ports which are used for these games can be # specified. If this field is left empty, the metaserver will disable its # game creation functionality. # . # If the value is not empty, it must be two port numbers, separated by a minus # sign. # d-i pioneers-meta-server/ports string 5560-5569 ### Description: Server name for created games: # In some cases, the name the metaserver uses for itself when creating new # games is incorrect. If this field is not left empty, it is used to override # the detected hostname. # d-i pioneers-meta-server/name string ### Description: Extra arguments to pass to the metaserver: # These arguments are passed to the metaserver. There are only two sensible # arguments: # * --syslog-debug: Send debugging output to syslog # * --redirect: Redirect clients to another metaserver # d-i pioneers-meta-server/arguments string ############################ #### plan_1.10.1-5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: What default holiday scheme do you want? # Please choose a holiday scheme from the list. This will be the default # holiday used in plan. You can override this default by copying the # required holiday file from /usr/share/doc/plan/examples/holiday to # /etc/plan/holiday. # . # Alternatively, per user holiday schemes might be had by copying the # required holiday files to ~/.plan.dir/holiday. # d-i plan/holiday select us # Possible choices: australia, austria, bavarian, belgium, belgium_french, canada, combi, czech, denmark, dutch, finnish, french, frswiss, german, greek, hungary, italy, japan, norway, portugal, quebec, spain, swedish, uk, us, none ############################ #### playmidi_2.4debian-10_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Options for playmidi when invoked through MIME: # The playmidi package sets up a MIME entry which allows mail user agents # and other applications to play MIDI files. # . # In order for playmidi to work properly, you may need to set # hardware-specific options: # . # '-a': Sound Blaster AWE32; # '-e': external MIDI device, Ensoniq SoundScape, Turtle # Beach WaveFront or WaveBlaster sound card; # '-g': Gravis Ultrasound. # . # Most other cards require no specific options and will work with this # field left blank. This setting is kept in # /etc/playmidi/playmidi.conf. # d-i playmidi/options string ############################ #### pleiades_1.5.0-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable Pleiades in Eclipse configuration? # Eclipse is not currently configured to use Pleiades for Japanese # language support. # . # Please choose whether Pleiades should be activated in the Eclipse # configuration file (/etc/eclipse.ini). # d-i pleiades/eclipse boolean false ############################ #### plptools_1.0.9-2.4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should ncpd be started during boot? # Normally, ncpd - the daemon which handles the serial connection to a # Psion - is started on boot-up. If you intend to connect your Psion to # another machine on the net and NEVER will use it locally, you can # disable this here. # d-i plptools/ncpd/start boolean true ### Description: Specify serial line to be used # By default, the Psion is expected to be connected to the first serial # line (COM1:) of your machine. You can change this here. # d-i plptools/ncpd/serial string /dev/ttyS0 ### Description: Specify the IP address and port for ncpd # If you intend to use the plptools front-ends from other machines, you # can specify 0.0.0.0 or the IP address of your machine here. Normal # users should keep the default 127.0.0.1! # . # Note, that THIS IS A SECURITY THREAT as no authentication and no # encryption is used! DO NOT USE THIS on machines which are accessible # from the Internet! # d-i plptools/ncpd/listenat string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Should plpfuse be started during boot? # If plpfuse is started during boot-up, it will wait for a Psion being # connected and then automatically mount that Psion. Since this is # done as root, non-privileged users will not have access to the # mounted directory. If you have a single-user machine, you probably # want to start plpfuse manually when you need it. # d-i plptools/plpfuse/start boolean false ### Description: Should plpprintd be started during boot? # If you intend to use the Psion's "Print via PC" feature, you can # enable this option. You must have a working print queue which # is capable of printing Postscript in order to use this feature. # d-i plptools/plpprintd/start boolean false ### Description: Specify the print queue to be used # Please enter the name of the print queue you want to use for # printing from the Psion. # d-i plptools/plpprintd/printqueue string psion ### Description: Specify remote host to be contacted # Since you have ncpd either disabled or listening on a non-standard # address, you should specify the address for the frontends again. # d-i plptools/frontends/remoteaddr string ############################ #### pluxml_5.3.1-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Web servers to configure: # PluXml can run on any web server supporting PHP, but only listed web servers # can be configured automatically by this package. # . # Please select the web servers that should be configured for PluXml. # . # Note that you will have to make sure a PHP interpreter is enabled for the # web server. # d-i pluxml/system/webservers multiselect apache2 # Possible choices: apache2, lighttpd ### Description: Should the web server(s) be reloaded? # To activate the configuration for PluXml, the web server(s) have to be # reloaded. # . # Accepting this option will reload the web server(s) when the installation is # complete, otherwise you will have to do that yourself. # d-i pluxml/system/reload-webserver boolean true ### Description: Purge blog data on package removal? # PluXml will store all blog data in /var/lib/pluxml. # . # Accepting this option will remove all blog data when this package is # purged, which will leave you with a tidy system but may cause data loss if you # purge an operational blog. # d-i pluxml/system/purgedata boolean false ### Description: Allow editing the configuration files from the web interface? # PluXml includes a web-based configuration interface that allows the user to # change blog settings, including the list of registered users. To be usable, it # requires the web server to have write permission to the configuration files. # . # Accepting this option will give the web server write permissions to the # configuration files. These files will still be readable and editable by hand # regardless of whether or not you accept this option. # d-i pluxml/system/writeconf boolean false ### Description: Blog default language: # Please choose the default language of this blog, which will be used for the # public pages. # . # Registered blog contributors will be able to choose their language for the # administration pages. # d-i pluxml/blog/lang select en # Possible choices: German, English, Spanish, French, Italian, Dutch, Polish, Portuguese, Romanian, Russian ### Description: Blog title: # Please choose a title for this blog. It will be displayed at the top of each # page and in the browser window title. # d-i pluxml/blog/title string PluXml ### Description: Blog description or subtitle: # Please choose a short description for this blog. It will be displayed as a # subtitle at the top of each page and in the browser window title. # d-i pluxml/blog/description string Blog or CMS, XML powered! ### Description: Administrator real name: # Please enter the real name associated with the blog administrator account. # . # This name will be displayed for articles written with the administrator # account. # d-i pluxml/blog/name string PluXml Administrator ### Description: Administrator username: # Please enter a name for the administrator account, which will be used to manage # PluXml's configuration, users, and content. The username should only # contain lowercase ASCII letters. # d-i pluxml/blog/login string admin ### Description: Administrator password: # Please choose a password for the blog administrator account. # d-i pluxml/blog/password password ### Description: Confirm password: # Please enter the same password again to verify that you have # typed it correctly. # d-i pluxml/blog/confirm password ############################ #### printer-driver-pnm2ppa_1.13-6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Would you like debconf to configure pnm2ppa? # You can have debconf perform some simple configuration steps for your # default pnm2ppa setup (edited in your /etc/pnm2ppa.conf file). # d-i pnm2ppa/use_debconf boolean true ### Description: What model of HP Deskjet printer do you use? # The pnm2ppa printer filter behaves differently depending upon which HP # DeskJet model you use. Choose your model of printer for the default # configuration file /etc/pnm2ppa.conf. # d-i pnm2ppa/printer_model select 710 # Possible choices: 710, 712, 720, 722, 820, 1000 ### Description: Would you like debconf to create magicfilter filters? # Magicfilter is a customizable, extensible automatic printer filter. It # uses its own magic database (a la file(1)) to decide how to print out a # given print job. Debconf can run the custom pnm2ppa script called # "update-magicfilter" to generate a default set of filters for color and # black-and-white printing. # . # The template filter is found in /usr/share/pnm2ppa/ as # "pnm2ppa-magicfilter.in". update-magicfilter uses sed to replace # @OPTIONS@ from the template and place the resulting filters in # /etc/magicfilter. Additionally, symbolic links are created from the # generated pnm2ppa filters to pbm2ppa filters (the deprecated # predecessor to pnm2ppa). # . # The only thing left for you to do is run magicfilterconfig to # generate your /etc/printcap. # d-i pnm2ppa/create_magicfilter boolean false ############################ #### popa3d_1.0.2-8_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Run popa3d in standalone mode? # In standalone mode, popa3d will become a daemon, accepting connections on # the pop3 port (110/tcp) and forking child processes to handle them. This # has lower overhead than starting popa3d from an inetd equivalent and is # thus useful on busy servers to reduce load. See popa3d(8) for more # details. # d-i popa3d/standalone boolean true ############################ #### popularity-contest_1.61_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Participate in the package usage survey? # The system may anonymously supply the distribution developers with # statistics about the most used packages on this system. This # information influences decisions such as which packages should go on # the first distribution CD. # . # If you choose to participate, the automatic submission script will # run once every week, sending statistics to the distribution developers. # The collected statistics can be viewed on http://popcon.debian.org/. # . # This choice can be later modified by running "dpkg-reconfigure # popularity-contest". # d-i popularity-contest/participate boolean false ### Description: for internal use # Preseed this during installation to replace the URL used for # submitting reports. # d-i popularity-contest/submiturls string ############################ #### portsentry_1.2-13_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### posh_0.12.3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Install posh as /bin/sh? # dash is the default /bin/sh on a Debian system. However, since our policy # requires all shell scripts using /bin/sh to be POSIX-compliant, any shell # that conforms to POSIX can serve as /bin/sh. Since posh is # POSIX-compliant, it can be used as /bin/sh. # d-i posh/sh boolean false ############################ #### post-faq_0.10-19_all.deb ############################ ### Description: News server: # Please enter the fully qualified name of the NNTP server. This # server will be used for reading and posting news. # d-i shared/news/server string localhost ############################ #### postfix_2.11.3-1+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Add a 'mydomain' entry in main.cf for upgrade? # Postfix version 2.3.3-2 and later require changes in main.cf. # Specifically, mydomain must be specified, since hostname(1) is not # a fully qualified domain name (FQDN). # . # Failure to fix this will result in a broken mailer. Decline this option # to abort the upgrade, giving you the opportunity to add this configuration # yourself. Accept this option to automatically set mydomain based on the # FQDN of the machine. # d-i postfix/mydomain_warning boolean ### Description: Set smtpd_relay_restrictions in main.cf for upgrade? # Postfix version 2.10 adds smtpd_relay_restrictions, to separate relaying # restrictions from recipient restrictions, and you have a non-default value # for smtpd_recipient_restrictions. # . # Failure to do this may result in deferred or bounced mail after the # upgrade. Accept this option to set smtpd_relay_restrictions equal to # smtpd_recipient_restrictions. # d-i postfix/relay_restrictions_warning boolean ### Description: add 'sqlite' entry to dynamicmaps.cf? # Postfix version 2.9 adds sqlite support to maps, but your dynamicmaps.cf does # not reflect that. Accept this option to add support for sqlite maps. # d-i postfix/sqlite_warning boolean ### Description: Install postfix despite an unsupported kernel? # Postfix uses features that are not found in kernels prior to 2.6. If you # proceed with the installation, Postfix will not run. # d-i postfix/kernel_version_warning boolean ### Description: Correct retry entry in master.cf for upgrade? # Postfix version 2.4 requires that the retry service be added to master.cf. # . # Failure to fix this will result in a broken mailer. Decline this option # to abort the upgrade, giving you the opportunity to add this configuration # yourself. Accept this option to automatically make master.cf compatible # with Postfix 2.4 in this respect. # d-i postfix/retry_upgrade_warning boolean ### Description: Correct tlsmgr entry in master.cf for upgrade? # Postfix version 2.2 has changed the invocation of tlsmgr. # . # Failure to fix this will result in a broken mailer. Decline this option # to abort the upgrade, giving you the opportunity to add this configuration # yourself. Accept this option to automatically make master.cf compatible # with Postfix 2.2 in this respect. # d-i postfix/tlsmgr_upgrade_warning boolean ### Description: Ignore incorrect hostname entry? # The string '${enteredstring}' does not follow RFC 1035 and does not # appear to be a valid IP address. # . # RFC 1035 states that 'each component must start with an alphanum, end with # an alphanum and contain only alphanums and hyphens. Components must be # separated by full stops.' # . # Please choose whether you want to keep that choice anyway. # d-i postfix/rfc1035_violation boolean false ### Description: General type of mail configuration: # Please select the mail server configuration type that best meets your needs. # . # No configuration: # Should be chosen to leave the current configuration unchanged. # Internet site: # Mail is sent and received directly using SMTP. # Internet with smarthost: # Mail is received directly using SMTP or by running a utility such # as fetchmail. Outgoing mail is sent using a smarthost. # Satellite system: # All mail is sent to another machine, called a 'smarthost', for delivery. # Local only: # The only delivered mail is the mail for local users. There is no network. # d-i postfix/main_mailer_type select Internet Site # Possible choices: No configuration, Internet Site, Internet with smarthost, Satellite system, Local only ### Description: System mail name: # The "mail name" is the domain name used to "qualify" _ALL_ mail addresses # without a domain name. This includes mail to and from : please do not # make your machine send out mail from root@example.org unless root@example.org # has told you to. # . # This name will also be used by other programs. It should be the # single, fully qualified domain name (FQDN). # . # Thus, if a mail address on the local host is foo@example.org, # the correct value for this option would be example.org. # . # d-i postfix/mailname string /etc/mailname ### Description: Other destinations to accept mail for (blank for none): # Please give a comma-separated list of domains for which this machine # should consider itself the final destination. If this is a mail # domain gateway, you probably want to include the top-level domain. # d-i postfix/destinations string ### Description: SMTP relay host (blank for none): # Please specify a domain, host, host:port, [address] or # [address]:port. Use the form [destination] to turn off MX lookups. # Leave this blank for no relay host. # . # Do not specify more than one host. # . # The relayhost parameter specifies the default host to send mail to when no # entry is matched in the optional transport(5) table. When no relay host is # given, mail is routed directly to the destination. # d-i postfix/relayhost string ### Description: Use procmail for local delivery? # Please choose whether you want to use procmail to deliver local mail. # . # Note that if you use procmail to deliver mail system-wide, you should set # up an alias that forwards mail for root to a real user. # d-i postfix/procmail boolean ### Description: Internet protocols to use: # By default, whichever Internet protocols are enabled on the system at # installation time will be used. You may override this default with any # of the following: # . # all : use both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses; # ipv6: listen only on IPv6 addresses; # ipv4: listen only on IPv4 addresses. # d-i postfix/protocols select # Possible choices: all, ipv6, ipv4 ### Description: Local address extension character: # Please choose the character that will be used to define a local address # extension. # . # To not use address extensions, leave the string blank. # d-i postfix/recipient_delim string + ### Description: Force synchronous updates on mail queue? # If synchronous updates are forced, then mail is processed more slowly. # If not forced, then there is a remote chance of losing some mail if # the system crashes at an inopportune time, and you are not using a # journaled filesystem (such as ext3). # d-i postfix/chattr boolean false ### Description: Local networks: # Please specify the network blocks for which this host should relay mail. # The default is just the local host, which is needed by some mail user agents. # The default includes local host for both IPv4 and IPv6. If just connecting # via one IP version, the unused value(s) may be removed. # . # If this host is a smarthost for a block of machines, you need to specify the # netblocks here, or mail will be rejected rather than relayed. # . # To use the postfix default (which is based on the connected subnets), leave # this blank. # d-i postfix/mynetworks string 127.0.0.0/8 [::ffff:127.0.0.0]/104 [::1]/128 ### Description: Mailbox size limit (bytes): # Please specify the limit that Postfix should place on mailbox files # to prevent runaway software errors. A value of zero (0) means no # limit. The upstream default is 51200000. # d-i postfix/mailbox_limit string 0 ### Description: Root and postmaster mail recipient: # Mail for the 'postmaster', 'root', and other system accounts needs to # be redirected to the user account of the actual system administrator. # . # If this value is left empty, such mail will be saved in /var/mail/nobody, # which is not recommended. # . # Mail is not delivered to external delivery agents as root. # . # If you already have a /etc/aliases file and it does not have an entry # for root, then you should add this entry. Leave this blank to not add one. # d-i postfix/root_address string ############################ #### postgresql-common_165+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable SSL by default in new PostgreSQL clusters? # PostgreSQL supports SSL-encrypted connections. This is usually a good thing. # However, if the database is solely accessed using TCP connections on # localhost, SSL can be turned off without introducing security issues. # . # UNIX domain socket connections (called "local" in pg_hba.conf) are not # affected by this setting. This setting concerns new PostgreSQL clusters # created during package install, or by using the pg_createcluster command. It # does not reconfigure existing clusters. # . # If unsure, enable SSL. # d-i postgresql-common/ssl boolean true ############################ #### postgrey_1.35-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### powstatd_1.5.1-9.1_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### prey_0.6.2-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Frequency of Prey reports and actions (minutes): # Please enter the time to wait before waking up Prey. Control Panel users can # change this setting later through the web interface. # d-i prey/reporting_frequency string 20 ### Description: Modules to enable: # Prey has many optional modules; if enabled they will be triggered # automatically if prey recognizes that the device is stolen. # . # * alarm: plays a loud sound for 30 seconds; # * alert: shows the thief a short message (and may change the # wallpaper); # * geo: attempts to geolocate the device by using its internal # GPS or the nearest WiFi access points as reference; # * lock: locks the device and asks for a password; # * network: collects information about the Internet connection; # * secure: deletes browser cookies and stored passwords; # * session: takes a screenshot, collects information about modified # files and running programs; # * system: collects information about the hardware configuration of # the machine; # * webcam: tries to take a picture using the webcam. # d-i prey/active_modules multiselect alarm # Possible choices: ${choices} ############################ #### proftpd-basic_1.3.5-1.1+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Run proftpd: # ProFTPD can be run either as a service from inetd, or as a standalone # server. Each choice has its own benefits. With only a few FTP # connections per day, it is probably better to run ProFTPD from inetd in # order to save resources. # . # On the other hand, with higher traffic, # ProFTPD should run as a standalone server to avoid spawning a new # process for each incoming connection. # d-i shared/proftpd/inetd_or_standalone select standalone # Possible choices: from inetd, standalone ############################ #### pure-ftpd-common_1.0.36-3.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Run pure-ftpd from inetd or as a standalone server: # Pure-ftpd can be run from inetd or as a standalone daemon. Using inetd is # a suitable option for small ftp servers because the inetd super-server # will only launch pure-ftpd to handle incoming connections. Standalone # operation is more efficient for busy ftp sites. # . # Keep in mind that a few options only work in standalone mode, such as # limiting connections per-IP and binding the server to a specific IP # address. # d-i pure-ftpd/standalone-or-inetd select standalone # Possible choices: inetd, standalone ### Description: Do you want pure-ftpwho to be installed setuid root? # The pure-ftpwho program only works with root privileges. Since it's a # fairly trivial program, this poses little security risk. Still, it is only # recommended that you install any program setuid root if you need it. # . # You can always change your mind later by reconfiguring this package with # "dpkg-reconfigure pure-ftpd-common". # d-i pure-ftpd/ftpwho-setuid boolean false ### Description: Enable virtual chroots ? # Chrooted users are usually restricted to their home directory. # With virtual chroots symbolic links are always followed, even if they are # pointing to directories not located in the user's home directory. # This is useful for having shared directories like a symbolic link # to /var/incoming in every home directory. # d-i pure-ftpd/virtualchroot boolean false ############################ #### pybit-client_1.0.0-2.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: PyBit client-ID string: # Please specify a unique string that can be used to identify this client # within the job list and queues. # d-i pybit-client/clientid string ### Description: Use LVM snapshots on this client? # If the sbuild configuration uses LVM snapshots, pybit-client can ensure # that your snapshot APT cache data is kept up-to-date whilst keeping the # snapshot clean. # d-i pybit-client/lvmsnapshot boolean false ### Description: Buildd location: # Please specify a writeable directory where the version control handler # and the upload task can write files. # . # If this is left blank, the default /home/buildd/pybit will be used. # d-i pybit-client/buildroot string /home/buildd/pybit ### Description: Host machine running RabbitMQ: # Please specify the server running RabbitMQ that this buildd client will # communicate with, receiving details of the jobs it needs to attempt to # build. # d-i pybit-client/rabbitmqhost string ### Description: Destination for dput package uploads: # Please specify the machine that this client will use as upload host. # This destination will be stored in its dput configuration. # . # This entry must not be empty. # d-i pybit-client/dputdest string ############################ #### pybit-web_1.0.0-2.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Host machine running RabbitMQ: # Please specify the server running RabbitMQ with which the web front-end # and the pyBit controller need to communicate, sending the details of the # jobs to be built. # d-i pybit-web/rabbitmqhost string ### Description: Fully qualified hostname for the web front-end: # Please specify the host running the web front-end (which will also be # running the pyBit controller). # . # You may choose to use a named Apache virtual host or accept the default # if all the pyBit clients also run on this one machine. # . # The hostname is passed down to the build clients to allow them to post # failure messages back to the controller. # d-i pybit-web/hostname string localhost ### Description: Port for web front-end: # Please specify the port that the web front-end should be available on. # If it is serving localhost, it is probably easiest to use port 8080. # . # If the web front-end is running on a dedicated host or an Apache # virtual host, it may be preferable to use port 80. # d-i pybit-web/port string 80 ############################ #### qpsmtpd_0.84-11+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable qpsmtpd startup at boot time? # Because most MTAs in Debian listen on one or all network interfaces by # default, when first installed qpsmtpd cannot normally be started. # . # Before enabling qpsmtpd, you must first configure your local MTA not to # bind to the SMTP TCP port on at least one interface. The most common # approach is to leave your MTA listening on the loopback interface # (127.0.0.1), with qpsmtpd listening on the external interface. # Instructions for configuring common MTAs to work with qpsmtpd can be found # after installation in /usr/share/doc/qpsmtpd/README.Debian. # . # Once you have adjusted your MTA configuration, you can enable qpsmtpd by # restarting this configuration, by running 'dpkg-reconfigure qpsmtpd'. # d-i qpsmtpd/startup_enabled boolean false ### Description: Qpsmtpd server type: # Qpsmtpd supports two process models for handling connections. The # 'forkserver' model uses a single process when idle, and forks new processes # to handle connections. This uses less memory but slightly reduces # server throughput. The 'prefork' model keeps a pool of idle processes # available to handle new connections, offering slightly better performance # at the cost of more memory. # d-i qpsmtpd/server_type select forkserver # Possible choices: forkserver, prefork ### Description: Addresses on which to listen for incoming SMTP connections: # Enter one or more of your local IP addresses, separated by spaces, on # which qpsmtpd should listen for incoming SMTP connections. If you leave # this setting empty, qpsmtpd will listen on all interfaces available at # startup time. # . # If you intend to use qpsmtpd to spool deliveries from remote hosts into a # local MTA, you may wish to have qpsmtpd listen on all external interfaces, # while leaving your local MTA listening on the loopback device (127.0.0.1). # . # For each interface you may optionally specify a port to listen on instead # of the default port 25; do this by appending : to the interface, as # in "127.0.0.1:2526". # d-i qpsmtpd/listen_interfaces string unset ### Description: Queueing method for accepted mail: # Select the method for queueing mail once it's been delivered via SMTP. If # you deliver your mail locally, choose the method corresponding to the # installed MTA (the installer will try to pick the correct default.) # . # Select "proxy" if you'd like qpsmtpd to act as an SMTP proxy for another # MTA (local or remote). You will then be prompted to enter a destination # host. # . # Select "maildir" to have qpsmtpd deliver into a local maildir-format spool # instead of queueing it for delivery (e.g. if you're setting up a # spamtrap.) # . # If you select "none," no queueing will be done at all, unless you manually # configure it yourself by editing /etc/qpsmtpd/plugins. # d-i qpsmtpd/queue_plugin select # Possible choices: exim, postfix, qmail, proxy, maildir, none ### Description: Destination host/port for SMTP proxy delivery: # To have qpsmtpd act as an SMTP proxy for another host, supply the hostname # or IP address of that host here. You can optionally add a port number # after a colon, such as "localhost:25". # d-i qpsmtpd/queue_smtp_proxy_destination string localhost ### Description: Destination Maildir for maildir-type delivery: # To have qpsmtpd deliver received mail into a local maildir-format spool, # enter a location for that maildir. A maildir will be created in that # location if it does not exist already. # d-i qpsmtpd/queue_maildir_destination string /var/spool/qpsmtpd/Maildir ### Description: Proceed without a queueing plugin selected? # By selecting "none" as a queueing plugin, you have disabled local queueing # of inbound mail. This will prevent any mail being spooled by qpsmtpd # until you manually configure a queueing method. Any hosts attempting to # deliver mail to you will receive 4xx soft-failure messages until then, at # the potential cost of wasted bandwidth and eventual bouncing of possibly # legitimate mail. # . # To configure queueing manually, edit /etc/qpsmtpd/plugins and select one # of the queueing methods listed there. If you didn't see your installed # MTA in the list and aren't sure what to do, pick "Cancel" here and # select the SMTP proxy method instead, configuring it to proxy into your # MTA on a suitable local address/port. # d-i qpsmtpd/queue_none_confirm boolean ### Description: Destination domain(s) to accept mail for (blank for none): # Enter a list of domain name(s) for which qpsmtpd should accept mail, # separated by spaces. This list should include any hostname or domain name # for which you intend to accept delivery locally, as well as any recipient # domains for which you intend to act as a mail relay. In general, if you # intend to spool received mail into a local MTA, this list should be the # same as used for that MTA (the installer will attempt to extract that # setting as a default.) # . # If you prefer to manage this list manually, leave the entry blank and edit # the file /etc/qpsmtpd/rcpthosts. # d-i qpsmtpd/rcpthosts string unset ############################ #### quagga_0.99.23.1-1+deb8u5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you really want to stop the Quagga daemon? # WARNING: The Quagga routing daemon has to be stopped to proceed. This # could lead to BGP flaps or loss of network connectivity. # d-i quagga/really_stop boolean false ############################ #### quota_4.01-8+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Send daily reminders to users over quota? # Enable this option if you want the warnquota utility to be run daily to # alert users when they are over quota. # d-i quota/run_warnquota boolean false ### Description: Phone support number of the admin: # Enter the phone number a user can call if he needs assistance with his # "over quota" emails. You do not have to enter anything here if you specify # a signature later. # d-i quota/supportphone string ### Description: Support email of the admin: # Enter the email address a user can write to if he needs assistance with # his "over quota" emails. You do not have to enter anything here if you # specify a signature later. # d-i quota/supportemail string ### Description: From header of warnquota emails: # The email address you specify here is used as the "From:" field of any # mail sent by the warnquota utility. # d-i quota/mailfrom string ### Description: Message of warnquota emails: # The text you specify here is used as message in any mail sent by the # warnquota utility. Use "|" to specify a line break. Leave empty if you # want the default message. # d-i quota/message string ### Description: Signature of warnquota emails: # The text you specify here is used as signature in any mail sent by the # warnquota utility. Use "|" to specify a line break. Leave empty if you # want the default signature. # d-i quota/signature string ### Description: Message of warnquota group emails: # The text you specify here is used as message in any mail sent by the # warnquota utility for groups that are over quota. Use "|" to specify a # line break. Leave empty if you want the default message. # d-i quota/group_message string ### Description: Subject header of warnquota emails: # The text you specify here is used as the "Subject:" field of any # mail sent by the warnquota utility. # d-i quota/subject string ### Description: CC header of warnquota emails: # The text you specify here is used as the "CC:" field of any # mail sent by the warnquota utility. # d-i quota/cc string ### Description: Character set in which the e-mail is sent: # The text you specify here is used as the "charset:" field in the MIME header # of any mail sent by the warnquota utility. # d-i quota/charset string ### Description: Time slot in which admin gets email: # During this time slot before the end of the grace period admin # will be CCed on all generated emails. # Leave empty to get the whole grace period. # d-i quota/cc_before string ### Description: Signature of warnquota group emails: # The text you specify here is used as signature in any mail sent by the # warnquota utility for groups that are over quota. Use "|" to specify a # line break. Leave empty if you want the default message. # d-i quota/group_signature string ############################ #### radioclk_1.0.ds1-12_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Serial port the radio receiver is connected to: # Your time signal receiver should be connected to a serial port. # Please enter the device name of the serial port, without the /dev/ # part. # . # Example: for the second serial port, /dev/ttyS1, enter ttyS1. # d-i radioclk/serialport string ttyS0 ############################ #### rancid_2.3.8-6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Really continue? # Please check, whether you made a backup copy of your rancid data. If # it's your first installation of rancid accept here, otherwise # decline, perform the backup and then run "dpkg-reconfigure rancid" # d-i rancid/go_on boolean false ############################ #### cman_3.1.8-1.2+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to abort the Red Hat Cluster Suite upgrade? # The new version 3 of the Red Hat Cluster Suite is not compatible with # the currently installed one. Upgrading these packages without stopping # the complete cluster can cause file system corruption on shared storage # devices. # d-i cman/upgrade-warning boolean false ############################ #### remembrance-agent_2.12-7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Directories to index: # In order to work, the Remembrance Agent needs to build a database of # documents of interest. Please introduce the directories (and/or files) to # be indexed separated by spaces, afterwards the database will be made. If # you do not select any directories (default) the database will not be made. # For more info look at /usr/share/doc/remembrance-agent. # d-i remembrance-agent/index-dir string ### Description: Directories to exclude from the index: # You can exclude sensitive directories from being indexed by ra-index if # you want. Only three directories can be given here. NOTE: If you are # installing on a multiuser environment where each user may want to have # their personal index, DO NOT index user directories (that is /home) as # root since there are no mechanisms to prevent users from invading other's # privacy. Instead, all users can run 'ra-index' in order to build their own # databases. # d-i remembrance-agent/exclude-dir string ############################ #### request-tracker4_4.2.8-3+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Name for this Request Tracker (RT) instance: # Every installation of Request Tracker must have a unique name. # The domain name or an abbreviation of the organization name are # usually good candidates. # . # Please note that once you start using a name, you should probably never # change it. Otherwise, mail for existing tickets won't get put in the right # place. # . # This setting corresponds to the $rtname configuration variable. # d-i request-tracker4/rtname string ### Description: Identifier for this RT instance: # In addition to its name, every installation of Request Tracker must also have # a unique identifier. It is used when linking between RT installations. # . # It should be a persistent DNS domain relating to your installation, for # example example.org, or perhaps rt.example.org. It should not be changed # during the lifetime of the RT database, so it is recommended not to use the # default value of the system hostname. Therefore, if you plan to restore # an existing database to this installation, you should use the same value # as previous installations using the same database. # . # This setting corresponds to the $Organization configuration variable. # d-i request-tracker4/organization string ### Description: Default email address for RT correspondence: # Please choose the address that will be listed in From: and Reply-To: headers of # emails tracked by RT, unless overridden by a queue-specific # address. # . # This setting corresponds to the $CorrespondAddress configuration variable. # d-i request-tracker4/correspondaddress string ### Description: Default email address for RT comments: # Please choose the address that will be listed in From: and Reply-To: headers of comment # emails, unless overridden by a queue-specific address. Comments can be # used for adding ticket information that is not visible to the client. # . # This setting corresponds to the $CommentAddress configuration variable. # d-i request-tracker4/commentaddress string ### Description: Base URL for the RT web interface: # Please specify the scheme, server and (optionally) port for constructing # RT web interface URLs. # . # The value should not have a trailing slash (/). # . # This setting corresponds to the $WebBaseURL configuration variable. # d-i request-tracker4/webbaseurl string ### Description: Path to the RT web interface: # If the RT web interface is going to be installed somewhere other than at # the documents root of the web server, you should specify the path to it here. # . # The value requires a leading slash (/) but not a trailing one. # . # This setting corresponds to the $WebPath configuration variable. # d-i request-tracker4/webpath string ### Description: Handle RT_SiteConfig.pm permissions? # The RT web interface needs access to the database password, stored in the # main RT configuration file. Because of this, the file is made readable by # the www-data group in normal setups. This may have security implications. # . # If you reject this option, the file will be readable only by root, and # you will have to set up appropriate access controls yourself. # . # With the SQLite backend, this choice will also affect the # permissions of automatically-generated local database files. # d-i request-tracker4/handle-siteconfig-permissions boolean ### Description: Install cron jobs? # Some features of RT depend on cron jobs, and they can be set up for you # by this package. You should normally accept this option unless you are # working on a snapshot of data (and would like to avoid events which send # out email to users) or this system will be part of a cluster (in which # case only one system should have cron jobs enabled). # d-i request-tracker4/install-cronjobs boolean ### Description: Initial root password for RT system: # The RT system will be populated with an initial superuser, named 'root', # and the password you provide here will be used as the initial password # of this superuser. It should be five characters or more. # d-i request-tracker4/initial-root-password password ############################ #### rt4-db-mysql_4.2.8-3+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # The package stores information about its availability here for the # interval between the config script is run and the package is unpacked. # d-i rt4-db-mysql/available boolean ############################ #### rt4-db-postgresql_4.2.8-3+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # The package stores information about its availability here for the # interval between the config script is run and the package is unpacked. # d-i rt4-db-postgresql/available boolean ############################ #### rt4-db-sqlite_4.2.8-3+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # The package stores information about its availability here for the # interval between the config script is run and the package is unpacked. # d-i rt4-db-sqlite/available boolean ############################ #### resolvconf_1.76.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Prepare /etc/resolv.conf for dynamic updates? # The resolvconf package contains the infrastructure required for # dynamic updating of the resolver configuration file. Part of the # necessary infrastructure is a symbolic link from /etc/resolv.conf to # /etc/resolvconf/run/resolv.conf. If you choose this option then this # link will be created; the existing /etc/resolv.conf file will be # preserved as /etc/resolvconf/resolv.conf.d/original, and will be # restored if this package is removed. # . # Declining this option will prevent future installations from # recreating the symbolic link and therefore the resolver configuration # file will not be dynamically updated. Dynamic updating can then be # activated following instructions in the README file. # . # The presence of resolvconf can affect the behavior of other programs, # so it should not be left installed if unconfigured. # d-i resolvconf/linkify-resolvconf boolean true ### Description: Append original file to dynamic file? # If the original static resolver configuration file (/etc/resolv.conf) # contains name server addresses, those addresses should be listed on # "dns-nameservers" lines in /etc/network/interfaces. For more # information, please consult the resolvconf(8) man page and the # README file. # . # Until /etc/network/interfaces has been edited and the affected # interfaces brought down and up again, the name server addresses will # not be included in the dynamically generated resolver configuration # file. # . # If you choose this option, a temporary workaround will be put in # place: a symbolic link will be created (if it does not already exist) # from /etc/resolvconf/resolv.conf.d/tail to # /etc/resolvconf/resolv.conf.d/original. This will cause the whole of # that original resolver configuration file to be appended to the # dynamically generated file. # . # After the required "dns-nameservers" lines have been added to # /etc/network/interfaces, the /etc/resolvconf/resolv.conf.d/tail link # should be replaced by one to /dev/null. # d-i resolvconf/link-tail-to-original boolean false ############################ #### rkhunter_1.4.2-0.4+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Activate daily run of rkhunter? # If you choose this option, rkhunter will be run automatically # by a daily cron job. # d-i rkhunter/cron_daily_run boolean ### Description: Activate weekly update of rkhunter's databases? # If you choose this option, rkhunter databases will be # updated automatically by a weekly cron job. # d-i rkhunter/cron_db_update boolean ### Description: Automatically update rkhunter's file properties database? # The file properties database can be updated automatically # by the package management system. # . # This feature is not enabled by default as # database updates may be slow on low-end machines. # Even if it is enabled, the database won't be updated if the # 'hashes' test is disabled in rkhunter configuration. # d-i rkhunter/apt_autogen boolean false ############################ #### rlinetd_0.9-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Convert inetd's configuration file to rlinetd's? # Currently, there are no services defined in your rlinetd's configuration # files. You can import services from /etc/inetd.conf by using inetd2rlinetd # program. # d-i rlinetd/convert_from_inetd boolean true ############################ #### rssh_2.3.4-4+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want rssh_chroot_helper to be installed setuid root? # If you plan to use chroot jails for the users using rssh, the program # /usr/lib/rssh/rssh_chroot_helper has to be installed setuid root so that # it can chroot into the jail when the user connects. If you are not using # chroot jails, it's better to not install setuid root programs you don't # need. # . # If in doubt, install it without setuid root. If you later decide to use # chroot jails, you can change this configuration by running # dpkg-reconfigure rssh. # d-i rssh/chroot_helper_setuid boolean false ############################ #### irussian_0.99g5-19_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### sa-exim_4.2.1-14_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove saved mails in sa-exim's spool directory? # There are some saved mails in subdirectories of /var/spool/sa-exim. # Depending on the configuration, sa-exim may save mails matching specific # criteria (such as "an error occurred", "rejected as spam", or "passed # through although recognized as spam") in these directories. # . # Please choose whether you want to keep these mails for further analysis # or delete them now. # d-i sa-exim/purge_spool boolean false ############################ #### safe-rm_0.12-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Abort package upgrade? # WARNING! Your system could become unusable (i.e. you could lose the # /bin/rm command). # . # Due to a bug in previous versions of safe-rm, this package should be # upgraded separately from other packages. If it is currently part of # a larger upgrade, you should abort this upgrade now. # . # Then, upgrade the safe-rm package all by itself and this problem # will be resolved. The new version no longer diverts important system # files and will therefore not be subject to similar problems. # . # If you do end up losing the /bin/rm command for whatever reason, you # should still be able to use /bin/rm.real directly. # d-i safe-rm/abort_upgrade boolean true ############################ #### samba-common_4.2.14+dfsg-0+deb8u9_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Modify smb.conf to use WINS settings from DHCP? # If your computer gets IP address information from a DHCP server on the # network, the DHCP server may also provide information about WINS servers # ("NetBIOS name servers") present on the network. This requires a # change to your smb.conf file so that DHCP-provided WINS settings will # automatically be read from /etc/samba/dhcp.conf. # . # The dhcp-client package must be installed to take advantage of this # feature. # d-i samba-common/dhcp boolean false ### Description: Configure smb.conf automatically? # The rest of the configuration of Samba deals with questions that # affect parameters in /etc/samba/smb.conf, which is the file used to # configure the Samba programs (nmbd and smbd). Your current smb.conf # contains an "include" line or an option that spans multiple lines, # which could confuse the automated configuration process and require # you to edit your smb.conf by hand to get it working again. # . # If you do not choose this option, you will have to handle # any configuration changes yourself, and will not be able to take # advantage of periodic configuration enhancements. # d-i samba-common/do_debconf boolean true ### Description: Workgroup/Domain Name: # Please specify the workgroup for this system. This setting controls which # workgroup the system will appear in when used as a server, the default # workgroup to be used when browsing with various frontends, and the domain # name used with the "security=domain" setting. # d-i samba-common/workgroup string WORKGROUP ############################ #### samhain_3.1.0-7_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### sane-utils_1.0.24-8+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable saned as a standalone server? # The saned server, when enabled, makes scanners available over the network. # . # There are two ways of running saned: # - as an inetd service, started by the inetd superserver. In this mode, # saned is started on demand when a client connects to the server; # - as a standalone daemon, started at system boot. In this mode, saned # runs in the background all by itself and listens for client connections. # . # When run in standalone mode, saned advertises itself on the network and # can be detected automatically by the SANE clients with no configuration # on the client side. You still need to configure the server to accept # connections from your clients. This feature is experimental and requires # a running Avahi daemon. # . # Accept this option if you want to make use of this feature. # d-i sane-utils/saned_run boolean false ### Description: Add saned user to the scanner group? # The saned server, when enabled, makes scanners available over the network. # By applying different permissions to the different scanners connected to # your machine, you can control which ones will be made available over the # network. # . # Read /usr/share/doc/sane-utils/README.Debian for details on how to manage # permissions for saned. By default, saned is run under the saned user and # group. # . # Accept this option if you want to make all your scanners available over # the network without restriction. # d-i sane-utils/saned_scanner_group boolean true ############################ #### sbnc_1.3.9-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Autostart shroudBNC on server boot? # shroudBNC (sbnc) can start automatically when the server is booted. # d-i sbnc/start_daemon boolean true ### Description: IP on which shroudBNC should listen for connections: # shroudBNC will only listen for new client connections on the given # IP address. # . # If you choose 0.0.0.0 as address, shroudBNC will listen on all interfaces. # d-i sbnc/host string 0.0.0.0 ### Description: TCP/IP port for shroudBNC: # shroudBNC will listen on this port for new connections. # . # Please note that you have to choose a port which is higher than 1023 and # which is not used by any other program. # d-i sbnc/port string 9000 ### Description: Username for the first administrative user: # shroudBNC needs a first user with administrative rights. # Enter here the login name for your administrator. # d-i sbnc/username string ### Description: Password to set for the first user: # Enter here your password for your first administrative user account. # d-i sbnc/password password ############################ #### sbox-dtc_1.11.7-1+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Use dtc:dtcgrp for the sbox binary? # Under Debian, apache runs under www-data:www-data. This is ok if running only # apache, but if using sbox-dtc together with the DTC control panel, you need to # have sbox chown to dtc:dtcgrp. In that case, you want create the dtc user and # dtcgrp group, and chown the sbox binary to dtc:dtcgrp, otherwise you don't. # d-i sbox-dtc/conf_use_dtc_dtcgrp boolean true ############################ #### wamerican_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wamerican-huge_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wamerican-insane_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wamerican-large_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wamerican-small_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wbritish_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wbritish-huge_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wbritish-insane_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wbritish-large_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wbritish-small_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wcanadian_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wcanadian-huge_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wcanadian-insane_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wcanadian-large_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wcanadian-small_7.1-1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### scuttle_0.7.4-8.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Preferred locale: # Select the locale that you desire to use with scuttle. # d-i scuttle/locale select en_GB # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: Do you want to configure apache2? # d-i scuttle/webserver boolean ############################ #### setserial_2.17-48_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically configure the serial port parameters? # It is recommended that the serial port parameters should be # configured automatically. It is also possible to configure them # manually by editing the file /etc/serial.conf. # . # PCMCIA serial-type devices should be configured with pcmciautils. See # /usr/share/doc/setserial/README.Debian.gz for details. # d-i setserial/autosave boolean true ### Description: Type of automatic serial port configuration: # Setserial allows saving the current serial configuration in various ways: # . # autosave once : save only once, now; # manual : never save the configuration automatically; # autosave always: save on every system shutdown (risks overwriting the # serial.conf file with errors); # kernel : do not use the serial.conf file and use the kernel settings # at bootup. # d-i setserial/autosave-types select autosave once # Possible choices: autosave once, manual, autosave always, kernel ############################ #### sftpcloudfs_0.12.2-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Authentication server URL: # In order to authenticate its users, SFTPCloudFS needs to connect to an # authentication server (such as RackSpace Cloud Files or OpenStack). # Please enter the URL of that server. # . # URL examples: # * Rackspace in the US: https://auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0 # * Rackspace in the UK: https://lon.auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0 # * Swift: some URL like https://example.com/v1.0 (or an IP address) # d-i sftpcloudfs/auth-url string https://auth.api.rackspacecloud.com/v1.0 ############################ #### sheepdog_0.8.3-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically start the sheepdog service? # Please choose whether the sheepdog service should start automatically # when the system is booted. # d-i sheepdog/start boolean false ### Description: Arguments for the sheepdog daemon: # Please choose the command line arguments that should be passed to the # sheepdog daemon. If no argument is given, the default behavior is to # start on port 7000, using the corosync driver. # . # Available options include: # -p, --port specify the TCP port to listen to # -l, --loglevel specify the level of logging detail # -d, --debug include debug messages in the log # -D, --directio use direct I/O when accessing the object store # -z, --zone specify the zone ID # -c, --cluster specify the cluster driver # More information can be found in the sheep(8) manual page. # d-i sheepdog/daemon_args string ############################ #### shorewall_4.6.4.3-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Restart Shorewall? # This release of Shorewall introduces some changes in the # configuration files - see # /usr/share/doc/shorewall/releasenotes.txt.gz. # . # To avoid the risk of failures and network outages these files should # be checked carefully before the firewall is restarted. # . # Please choose whether you want to restart Shorewall immediately. # d-i shorewall/major_release boolean ############################ #### shorewall6_4.6.4.3-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Restart Shorewall6? # To avoid the risk of failures and network outages, configuration files # should be checked carefully before the firewall is restarted. # . # Please choose whether you want to restart Shorewall6 immediately. # d-i shorewall6/major_release boolean ############################ #### sinfo_0.0.47-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable the sinfo CGI script? # A CGI script is included, to provide a web interface for sinfo. It is # disabled by default as it might publish information about the computer not # intended to be public. # d-i sinfo/cgi boolean false ############################ #### sitesummary_0.1.17+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Activate the munin config replacement feature? # This is an internal (hidden) debconf question. It should not be translated. # d-i sitesummary/replace-munin-config boolean false ### Description: Activate the Nagios autoconfig feature? # This is an internal (hidden) debconf question. It should not be translated. # d-i sitesummary/enable-nagios-config boolean false ############################ #### sitesummary-client_0.1.17+deb8u3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: URL: # Insert the URL to the sitesummary collector, where should the # sitesummary information be submitted. Several URLs can be specified # separated by space. # . # The default URL is http://localhost/cgi-bin/sitesummary-collector.cgi # d-i sitesummary-client/collector_url string ### Description: Site: # Insert a string identifying the site where this machine is located. # d-i sitesummary-client/site string ### Description: Sitegroup: # Insert a string identifying the subgroup within the site where this # machine is located. # d-i sitesummary-client/sitegroup string ### Description: Host class: # Insert string identifying the host class, like workstation, server, # laptop, thin client etc. # d-i sitesummary-client/hostclass string ### Description: Activate the Nagios NRPE config feature? # This is an internal (hidden) debconf question. It should not be translated. # d-i sitesummary-client/enable-nagios-nrpe-config boolean false ### Description: Host name of nagios server allowed to contact NRPE: # This is an internal (hidden) debconf question. It should not be translated. # d-i db_get sitesummary-client/nagios-server string ############################ #### slapos-client_1.2.4.1-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: SlapOS master node URL: # d-i shared/slapos/master_url string ############################ #### slapos-node-unofficial_1.2.4.1-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: SlapOS master node URL: # d-i shared/slapos/master_url string ### Description: SlapOS computer ID: # Please specify a unique identifier for this SlapOS node. # d-i slapos-node-unofficial/computer_id string ### Description: Software Releases root directory: # If you intend to use this package only for development, then # /var/lib/slapos/software is a sensible choice, however, when using a master # with network cache, it is highly recommended to use the same path on all the # nodes, for example /opt/slapgrid. # d-i slapos-node-unofficial/software_root string ### Description: Number of Computer Partitions on this computer: # A Computer Partition (CP) is an instance of a Software Release # (SR). You can now define how many instances will be available on this # computer. # . # Note that the Software Releases will be stored in # /var/lib/slapos/software/, whereas the Computer Partition will be # stored in /var/lib/slapos/instance/. # d-i slapos-node-unofficial/partition_amount string ### Description: Local IPv4 network to be used for Computer Partitions: # Every Computer Partition must have an address on the same IPv4 network. # Please specify a network in CIDR notation (e.g.: 192.0.2.0/24). # d-i slapos-node-unofficial/ipv4_local_network string 10.0.0.0/16 ############################ #### slashem-common_0.0.7E7F3-7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should Slash'em back up your old, incompatible save files? # You are upgrading from a version of Slashe'em whose save files are not # compatible with the version you are upgrading to. You may either have them # backed up into /tmp, purge them, ignore this problem completely, or abort # this installation and manually handle Slashem's save files. # . # If you choose to back up, the files will be backed up into a # gzip-compressed tar archive in /tmp with a random name starting with # 'slash' and ending in '.tar.gz'. # d-i slashem-common/backup-incompatible select backup # Possible choices: abort, backup, purge, ignore ### Description: Should Slash'em back up your old, incompatible save files? # You are upgrading from a version of Slashe'em whose save files are not # compatible with the version you are upgrading to. You may either have them # backed up into /tmp, purge them, ignore this problem completely, or abort # this installation and manually handle Slashem's save files. # . # If you choose to back up, the files will be backed up into a # gzip-compressed tar archive in /tmp with a random name starting with # 'slash' and ending in '.tar.gz'. # d-i slashem-common/do-backup select backup # Possible choices: abort, backup, purge, ignore ############################ #### slay_2.7.0_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Shall slay punish users? # Normally slay will punish ordinary users trying to run it by slaying # themselves. This is The Right Thing(TM), as users should not mess with # administrative commands like slay, but some administrators find it # inconvenient. Therefore slay can be configured to punish users or just to # display error message. # d-i slay/punish boolean false ### Description: Shall slay use `Butt-head' mode by default? # Slay has two sets of messages: a standard set and an alternative set that # is more informal. The alternative set is named after "Butt-head" from # MTV's "Beavis & Butt-head" cartoon show, a character who uses the sort of # language you'll find in the alternative set. In most cases, the standard # set of messages is more appropriate. # d-i slay/butthead boolean false ############################ #### slbackup_0.0.12-7_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Configure the backup system now? # Select this if you want to configure the backup system now. # . # If you choose to do so, you will get the opportunity to configure one # client and the backup server, and a cron job will be configured to start # the backup session once a day, on a moment of time of your choice. # . # To configure more than one backup client, you could either use the # Webmin-module provided by the webmin-slbackup package, or you can do this # manually in the file /etc/slbackup/slbackup.conf. # . # If you choose to not configure slbackup now, an example configuration file # will be installed, but cron will not be configured to start any backup # sessions. To activate backup, you can reconfigure the system by running # 'dpkg-reconfigure slbackup' (as root) or manually by editing the # /etc/slbackup/slbackup.conf and /etc/cron.d/slbackup files. # d-i slbackup/enable boolean false ### Description: Start time of the backup session: # By default slbackup starts one backup session each day, and here you can # choose when to start this session. Enter the time in a HH:MM-format. # d-i slbackup/backuptime string 01:00 ### Description: Name of your client: # In slbackup each client has a unique name which identifies it. This name # does not necessarily have anything to do with the hostname. Please enter # the unique name of the client you want to configure. # d-i slbackup/client_name string localhost ### Description: Type of client to configure: # This determines what type of client that will be configured now. # . # If you choose local, the server will back up data from this computer. If # you choose extern, the server will back up data from another computer # using a SSH connection (this choice assumes that you install SSH and # provide a passwordless connection between the user running the backup # software on this computer (probably root) and the user running the backup # software on the client). # d-i slbackup/client_type select local # Possible choices: local, extern ### Description: Client hostname or IP address: # You have choosen to configure an external client. Please enter the # client's hostname or IP address. # d-i slbackup/client_address string localhost ### Description: User running the backup software on the client: # The backup software (rdiff-backup) will also run on the client, and the # user that runs it has to have access to all the files that shall be # backed up. Enter the username of the user that shall run the backup # software on the client. # d-i slbackup/client_user string root ### Description: Files and directories to back up: # Enter the location of the files and/or directories that you want to back # up on the client. Use a whitespace as a delimiter. # . # Example: /etc /home /var/backups # d-i slbackup/client_location string /etc /home /var/backups ### Description: Time life of backups (in days): # slbackup is doing a kind of maintenance before each backup session, where # backups that are older than a certain number of days will be deleted. In # this dialog you can specify the number of days that you want to keep the # backups for this client on the backup server. The default is 185 days # (approximately six months). # . # If you want to keep the backups for this client forever, or want to do the # maintenance yourself, 0 days will be treated as infinite. # d-i slbackup/client_keep string 185 ### Description: Type of server to configure / connect to: # This determines what type of server slbackup will configure. # . # If you choose local, the backup will be stored on this computer. If you # choose extern, the backup will be stored on another computer using a SSH # connection (this choice assumes that you install SSH and provide a # passwordless connection between the user running the backup software on # this computer (probably root) and the user running the backup software on # the backup server). # d-i slbackup/server_type select local # Possible choices: local, extern ### Description: Server's hostname or IP address: # You have chosen to configure an external backup server. Please enter the # backup server's hostname or IP address. # d-i slbackup/server_address string localhost ### Description: Backup location on the server: # Enter the location where you want the backups to be stored. slbackup will # not create this directory for you. When you create this directory, make # sure that you have enough disk space to store all the backups you define. # d-i slbackup/server_destdir string /var/lib/slbackup ### Description: User running the backup software on the server: # The backup software (rdiff-backup) will also run on the server, and the # user that runs it has to have access to the location where the files are # going to be stored. Enter the username that shall run the backup software # on the backup server. # d-i slbackup/server_user string root ############################ #### slbackup-php_0.4.5-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Activate SSL support in slbackup-php? # Please note that SSL is needed to connect to the slbackup-php server. # Activating it is therefore strongly recommended. # . # However, SSL should also be activated in the web server which will not # be done by choosing this option. # d-i slbackup-php/use-ssl boolean false ############################ #### slim_1.3.6-4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # d-i slim/daemon_name string /usr/bin/slim ### Description: Default display manager: # A display manager is a program that provides graphical login capabilities for # the X Window System. # . # Only one display manager can manage a given X server, but multiple display # manager packages are installed. Please select which display manager should # run by default. # . # Multiple display managers can run simultaneously if they are configured to # manage different servers; to achieve this, configure the display managers # accordingly, edit each of their init scripts in /etc/init.d, and disable the # check for a default display manager. # d-i shared/default-x-display-manager select # Possible choices: ${choices} ############################ #### slrn_1.0.2-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: News server for reading and posting news: # Enter the fully qualified domain name of the news server (NNTP server) that # should be used by default for reading and posting news. # d-i shared/news/server string ### Description: Please enter the mail name of your system: # The "mail name" is the hostname portion of the address to be shown on # outgoing news and mail messages. # d-i shared/mailname string ### Description: How should newsgroup descriptions be refreshed? # Slrn needs to periodically connect to the network to download new # descriptions of newsgroups. This can be handled in a variety of ways. # . # A cron job that is run weekly can be used. This works well if you have a # permanent network connection, or if you are using diald or a similar # program that connects to the network on demand. # . # The ip-up script will make slrn refresh the descriptions when you connect # to the network via ppp. The new descriptions will still only be retrieved # once a week if you choose this method, no matter how often you connect to # the network. # . # Or you can choose to handle this manually and run as root the command # /usr/sbin/slrn_getdescs every week or so while you're online. # d-i slrn/getdescs select cron job # Possible choices: cron job, ip-up, manually ### Description: Download newsgroup descriptions now? # This appears to be a new install of slrn; no newsgroup descriptions have # been downloaded so far. If you are online now, you should download the # newsgroup descriptions. (It will take a few minutes, depending on the speed # of your network connection.) # d-i slrn/getdescs_now boolean false ############################ #### slrnpull_1.0.2-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: News server for reading and posting news: # Enter the fully qualified domain name of the news server (NNTP server) that # should be used by default for reading and posting news. # d-i shared/news/server string ### Description: When should slrnpull be run? # Slrnpull needs to run periodically to download news. This can be # accomplished in a variety of ways. # . # A cron job that is run daily can be used. This works well if you have a # permanent network connection, or if you are using diald or a similar # program that connects to the network on demand. # . # The ip-up script will make slrnpull download news when you connect to the # network via ppp. # . # Or you can choose to handle this manually and run as root the command # slrnpull -h `cat /etc/news/server` as you like it. # d-i slrnpull/run_from select cron job # Possible choices: cron job, ip-up, manually ############################ #### smb2www_980804-41_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to enable smb2www? # d-i smb2www/set_link boolean false ### Description: Master browser server: # Please enter the name of the server which will be used by smb2www as a master # browser. # d-i smb2www/master_browser string localhost ### Description: Language for smb2www pages: # Smb2www can generate its HTML pages in several languages. # . # Please choose the language you want to use on generated pages. # d-i smb2www/language select English # Possible choices: English, Czech, Dutch, Finnish, French, Polish, Spanish, Swedish, Vietnamese ### Description: for internal use # This is an INTERNAL option. If you see it while configuring the package, # please file a bug report against smb2www. # d-i smb2www/need_reconfigure boolean false ############################ #### smstools_3.1.15-1.1+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Manage smsd configuration automatically? # Reject this option if you want to configure smsd manually. # d-i smstools/configure boolean true ### Description: Global event-handler: # Please specify an external program or script that will execute, # whenever a message is sent or received, or on failures. # This is useful for instance when running an email2sms gateway. # . # Examples of event-handlers are detailed in /usr/share/doc/smstools/examples. # d-i smstools/eventhandler string ### Description: Modem name: # Please specify the short name for the modem device. This is a mandatory # setting. # d-i smstools/devicename string GSM1 ### Description: Modem device: # Please specify the modem device. Usually the modem device is # /dev/ttyS0 (the first serial port), but your setup may differ; # e.g. for a USB device, choose 'Other' and specify the full path of # the appropriate device node. # d-i smstools/devicenode select # Possible choices: /dev/ttyS0, /dev/ttyS1, /dev/ttyS2, /dev/ttyS3, /dev/ttyS4, Other ### Description: Modem device: # Please specify an optional extra device for the modem. # d-i smstools/devicenodeother string ### Description: Modem device speed (bps): # Most modems work well with a speed of 19200bps, but some modems may # require 9600 bps. If your modem does not support any of the baud # rates in the list, select 'Other'. # d-i smstools/devicebaudrate select 19200 # Possible choices: 9600, 19200, 28800, 38400, 115200, Other ### Description: Modem device speed (bps): # d-i smstools/devicebaudrateother string ### Description: Receive SMS with this device? # Please choose whether the device should be used to receive incoming SMS. # d-i smstools/deviceincoming boolean true ### Description: Modem initialization string: # Please specify the modem initialization command. That may be left empty # for most modems. Please consult your modem's manual for more details # about its supported commands. # d-i smstools/deviceinit string ### Description: SIM device PIN code: # If the device's SIM needs a PIN to be unlocked, please enter it here. # d-i smstools/devicepin password ### Description: Configure another modem? # d-i smstools/configureanothermodem boolean false ############################ #### sn_0.3.8-10.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: sn should run from: # The scripts provided with the package support several ways to run snget # (the program to fetch new news): # . # cron -- The program will be executed daily by cron -- useful e.g # for permanent connections; # ip-up -- The program will called from ip-up, that is, when your # computer makes a connection -- useful for e.g. dialup # connections; # manually -- The program will never be called, you have to call it # manually to get new news (just type snget as root). # d-i sn/runfrom select cron # Possible choices: cron, ip-up, manually ### Description: Should sn only accept connections from localhost? # sn is a small newsserver, intended mainly to be run for single user # systems. On such systems, it's better to have sn only answer connections # from localhost. If you intend to use sn from multiple machines, refuse # here. # d-i sn/onlylocal boolean true ############################ #### snoopy_1.8.0-5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Install snoopy library to /etc/ld.so.preload? # snoopy is a library that can only reliably do its work if it is # mandatorily preloaded via /etc/ld.so.preload. Since this can potentially # do harm to the system, your consent is needed. # d-i snoopy/install-ld-preload boolean false ############################ #### icatalan_0.20111230b-7_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wcatalan_0.20111230b-7_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### solaar_0.9.2+dfsg-4_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Use plugdev group? # Please specify how non-root users should be given access to the Logitech # receiver devices. # . # If systemd or consolekit are in use, they can apply ACLs to make them # accessible via Solaar for the user logged in on the current seat. Right # now, ${SEAT_DAEMON_STATUS} daemon is running. # . # If neither of these daemons is in use, or if the receiver should also be # accessible for remotely logged in users, it is possible to grant access # for members of the "plugdev" system group. # . # If you do use the "plugdev" group, don't forget to make sure all the # appropriate users are members of that group. You can add new members to # the group by running, as root: # adduser plugdev # For the group membership to take effect, the affected users need to log # out and back in again. # d-i solaar/use_plugdev_group boolean false ############################ #### solid-pop3d_0.15-27_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: How do you want to run solid-pop3d? # The solid-pop3d POP server can run as a standalone daemon or from inetd. # Running from inetd is the recommended approach. # d-i solid-pop3d/run_mode select inetd # Possible choices: inetd, daemon ############################ #### spamprobe_1.4d-13_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### spip_3.0.17-2+deb8u4_all.deb ############################ ### description: Web server(s) to configure automatically: # Please select the web server(s) that should be configured automatically # for spip. # d-i spip/webserver multiselect apache2 # Possible choices: apache2, cherokee ############################ #### squid-deb-proxy_0.8.9_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Allow PPA access? # By default, squid-deb-proxy does not allow access to Personal Package # Archive (PPA) repositories on Launchpad. # . # Choosing this option will whitelist these repositories. # d-i squid-deb-proxy/ppa-enable boolean false ### Description: Allow unrestricted network access? # By default, squid-deb-proxy allows access to the cache from private # networks only (10.0.0.0/8, 172.16.0.0/12, 192.168.0.0/16). # . # Choosing this option will allow other IP addresses to access the cache. # d-i squid-deb-proxy/acl-disable boolean false ############################ #### squidguard_1.5-4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Rebuild Squidguard blacklist database during postinst? # Rebuilding the blacklist databases is time consuming and under some # circumstances could cause problems. With the breakout of individual # blacklist section packages the time it takes for each package to rebuild # will be extensive. Also it may not be desireable to rebuild these # databases on production servers. You can manually perform a rebuild by # running /usr/sbin/update-squidguard. # d-i squidguard/dbreload boolean true ############################ #### ssl-cert_1.0.35_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Host name: # Please enter the host name to use in the SSL certificate. # . # It will become the 'commonName' field of the generated SSL certificate. # d-i make-ssl-cert/hostname string localhost ### Description: Alternative name(s): # Please enter any additional names to use in the SSL certificate. # . # It will become the 'subjectAltName' field of the generated SSL certificate. # . # Multiple alternative names should be delimited with comma and no spaces. # For a web server with multiple DNS names this could look like: # . # DNS:www.example.com,DNS:images.example.com # . # A more complex example including a hostname, a WebID, an email address, and # an IPv4 address: # . # DNS:example.com,URI:http://example.com/joe#me,email:me@example.com,IP:192.168.7.3 # d-i make-ssl-cert/altname string ############################ #### sslh_1.16-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Run sslh: # sslh can be run either as a service from inetd, or as a standalone # server. Each choice has its own benefits. With only a few connection # per day, it is probably better to run sslh from inetd in # order to save resources. # . # On the other hand, with many connections, # sslh should run as a standalone server to avoid spawning a new # process for each incoming connection. # d-i sslh/inetd_or_standalone select standalone # Possible choices: from inetd, standalone ############################ #### ssmtp_2.64-8_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically overwrite config files? # The mail configuration file /etc/ssmtp/ssmtp.conf can be automatically # updated on each upgrade with the information supplied to the debconf # database. If you do not want this to happen (ie/ you want to maintain # control of this file yourself) then set this option to have the program # never touch this file. # d-i ssmtp/overwriteconfig boolean true ### Description: Username who gets mail for userids < 1000: # Mail sent to a local user whose UID is less than 1000 will instead be # sent here. This is useful for daemons which mail reports to root and # other system UIDs. # Make this empty to disable rewriting. # d-i ssmtp/root string postmaster ### Description: Name of your mailhub: # This sets the host to which mail is delivered. The actual machine # name is required; no MX records are consulted. Commonly, mailhosts # are named "mail.domain.com". # d-i ssmtp/mailhub string mail ### Description: Remote SMTP port number: # If your remote SMTP server listens on a port other than 25 (Standard/RFC) # then set it here. # d-i ssmtp/port string 25 ### Description: Domain to masquerade as: # ssmtp will use "username@REWRITEDOMAIN" as the default From: address # for outgoing mail which contains only a local username. # d-i ssmtp/rewritedomain string ### Description: Name to store in /etc/mailname: # This is the portion of the address after the '@' sign to be shown on # outgoing news and mail messages. # d-i ssmtp/mailname string ### Description: Fully qualified hostname: # This should specify the real hostname of this machine, and will be # sent to the mailhub when delivering mail. # d-i ssmtp/hostname string ### Description: Allow override of From: line in email header? # A "positive" response will permit local users to enter any From: line # in their messages without it being mangled, and cause ssmtp to rewrite # the envelope header with that address. A "negative" response will # disallow this, and use only the default address or addresses set in # /etc/ssmtp/revaliases. # d-i ssmtp/fromoverride boolean false ############################ #### strongswan-starter_5.2.1-6+deb8u6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Restart strongSwan now? # Restarting strongSwan is recommended, since if there is a security fix, it # will not be applied until the daemon restarts. Most people expect the daemon # to restart, so this is generally a good idea. However, this might take down # existing connections and then bring them back up, so if you are using such # a strongSwan tunnel to connect for this update, restarting is not recommended. # d-i strongswan/restart boolean true ### Description: Start strongSwan's charon daemon? # The charon daemon must be running to support the Internet Key # Exchange protocol. # d-i strongswan/charon boolean true ### Description: Use an X.509 certificate for this host? # An X.509 certificate for this host can be automatically created or imported. # It can be used to authenticate IPsec connections to other hosts # and is the preferred way of building up secure IPsec connections. The other # possibility would be to use shared secrets (passwords that are the same on # both sides of the tunnel) for authenticating a connection, but for a larger # number of connections, key based authentication is easier to administer and # more secure. # . # Alternatively you can reject this option and later use the command # "dpkg-reconfigure strongswan" to come back. # d-i strongswan/install_x509_certificate boolean false ### Description: Methods for using a X.509 certificate to authenticate this host: # It is possible to create a new X.509 certificate with user-defined settings # or to import an existing public and private key stored in PEM file(s) for # authenticating IPsec connections. # . # If you choose to create a new X.509 certificate you will first be asked # a number of questions which must be answered before the creation can start. # Please keep in mind that if you want the public key to get signed by # an existing Certificate Authority you should not select to create a # self-signed certificate and all the answers given must match exactly the # requirements of the CA, otherwise the certificate request may be rejected. # . # If you want to import an existing public and private key you will be # prompted for their filenames (which may be identical if both parts are stored # together in one file). Optionally you may also specify a filename where the # public key(s) of the Certificate Authority are kept, but this file cannot # be the same as the former ones. Please also be aware that the format for the # X.509 certificates has to be PEM and that the private key must not be encrypted # or the import procedure will fail. # d-i strongswan/how_to_get_x509_certificate select create # Possible choices: create, import ### Description: File name of your PEM format X.509 certificate: # Please enter the location of the file containing your X.509 certificate in # PEM format. # d-i strongswan/existing_x509_certificate_filename string ### Description: File name of your PEM format X.509 private key: # Please enter the location of the file containing the private RSA key # matching your X.509 certificate in PEM format. This can be the same file # that contains the X.509 certificate. # d-i strongswan/existing_x509_key_filename string ### Description: File name of your PEM format X.509 RootCA: # Optionally you can now enter the location of the file containing the X.509 # Certificate Authority root used to sign your certificate in PEM format. If you # do not have one or do not want to use it please leave the field empty. Please # note that it's not possible to store the RootCA in the same file as your X.509 # certificate or private key. # d-i strongswan/existing_x509_rootca_filename string ### Description: Please enter which length the created RSA key should have: # Please enter the length of the created RSA key. It should not be less than # 1024 bits because this should be considered unsecure and you will probably # not need anything more than 4096 bits because it only slows the # authentication process down and is not needed at the moment. # d-i strongswan/rsa_key_length string 2048 ### Description: Create a self-signed X.509 certificate? # Only self-signed X.509 certificates can be created # automatically, because otherwise a Certificate Authority is needed to sign # the certificate request. If you choose to create a self-signed certificate, # you can use it immediately to connect to other IPsec hosts that support # X.509 certificate for authentication of IPsec connections. However, using # strongSwan's PKI features requires all certificates to be signed by a single # Certificate Authority to create a trust path. # . # If you do not choose to create a self-signed certificate, only the RSA # private key and the certificate request will be created, and you will # have to sign the certificate request with your Certificate Authority. # d-i strongswan/x509_self_signed boolean true ### Description: Country code for the X.509 certificate request: # Please enter the two-letter code for the country the server resides in # (such as "AT" for Austria). # . # OpenSSL will refuse to generate a certificate unless this is a valid # ISO-3166 country code; an empty field is allowed elsewhere in the X.509 # certificate, but not here. # d-i strongswan/x509_country_code string AT ### Description: State or province name for the X.509 certificate request: # Please enter the full name of the state or province the server resides in # (such as "Upper Austria"). # d-i strongswan/x509_state_name string ### Description: Locality name for the X.509 certificate request: # Please enter the locality the server resides in (often a city, such # as "Vienna"). # d-i strongswan/x509_locality_name string ### Description: Organization name for the X.509 certificate request: # Please enter the organization the server belongs to (such as "Debian"). # d-i strongswan/x509_organization_name string ### Description: Organizational unit for the X.509 certificate request: # Please enter the organizational unit the server belongs to (such as # "security group"). # d-i strongswan/x509_organizational_unit string ### Description: Common Name for the X.509 certificate request: # Please enter the Common Name for this host (such as # "gateway.example.org"). # d-i strongswan/x509_common_name string ### Description: Email address for the X.509 certificate request: # Please enter the email address of the person or organization # responsible for the X.509 certificate. # d-i strongswan/x509_email_address string ### Description: Enable opportunistic encryption? # This version of strongSwan supports opportunistic encryption (OE), which stores # IPSec authentication information in # DNS records. Until this is widely deployed, activating it will # cause a significant delay for every new outgoing connection. # . # You should only enable opportunistic encryption if you are sure you want it. # It may break the Internet connection (default route) as the daemon starts. # d-i strongswan/enable-oe boolean false ############################ #### sugarplum_0.9.10-17.2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to configure your web servers for sugarplum? # To activate sugarplum, your web servers' configuration may need to be # modified. # d-i sugarplum/configure_httpd boolean false ### Description: Do you want to deconfigure your web servers for sugarplum? # If you have configured your web servers for sugarplum, they should (or # must, if you are purging sugarplum) now be de-configured to ensure that # they will properly function the next time you restart them. # d-i sugarplum/deconfigure_httpd boolean false ############################ #### iswedish_1.4.5-2.1_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### wswedish_1.4.5-2.1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### swish-e_2.4.7-4_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### sympa_6.1.23~dfsg-2+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Default language for Sympa: # d-i sympa/language select en # Possible choices: ${supported_langs} ### Description: Sympa hostname: # This is the name of the machine or the alias you will use to reach sympa. # . # Example: # . # listhost.cru.fr # . # Then, you will send your sympa commands to: # . # sympa@listhost.cru.fr # d-i sympa/hostname string ### Description: Listmaster email address(es): # Listmasters are privileged people who administrate mailing lists (mailing # list superusers). # . # Please give listmasters email addresses separated by commas. # . # Example: # . # postmaster@cru.fr, root@home.cru.fr # d-i sympa/listmaster string ### Description: Should lists home and spool directories be removed? # The lists home directory (/var/lib/sympa) contains the mailing lists # configurations, mailing list archives and S/MIME user certificates # (when sympa is configured for using S/MIME encryption and authentication). # The spool directory (/var/spool/sympa) contains various queue directories. # . # Note that if those directories are empty, they will be automatically # removed. # . # Please choose whether you want to remove lists home and spool directories. # d-i sympa/remove_spool boolean false ### Description: URL to access WWSympa: # d-i wwsympa/wwsympa_url string ### Description: Which Web Server(s) are you running? # d-i wwsympa/webserver_type select Apache 2 # Possible choices: Apache 2, Other ### Description: Do you want WWSympa to run with FastCGI? # FastCGI is an Apache module that makes WWSympa run much faster. This # option will be activated only if the `libapache2-mod-fcgid' package is # installed on your system. Please first make sure you installed this # package. FastCGI is required for using the Sympa SOAP server. # d-i wwsympa/fastcgi boolean false ### Description: Do you want the sympa SOAP server to be used? # Sympa SOAP server allows to access a Sympa service from within another # program, written in any programming language and on any computer. The SOAP # server provides a limited set of high level functions including login, # which, lists, subscribe, signoff. # . # The SOAP server uses libsoap-lite-perl package and a webserver like apache. # d-i sympa/use_soap boolean false ### Description: Should the web archives and the bounce directory be removed? # If you used the default configuration, WWSympa web archives are located in # /var/lib/sympa/wwsarchive. The WWSympa bounce directory contains bounces # (non-delivery reports) and is set to /var/spool/sympa/wwsbounce by # default. # . # Please choose whether you want to remove the web archives and the bounce # directory. # d-i wwsympa/remove_spool boolean false ############################ #### synce-serial_0.11-5.3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Serial interface: # Specify the serial interface used to connect your Windows CE device to the # desktop. Possible serial interfaces are: # ttyS0: First serial port (COM1: on DOS and Windows) # ttyS1: Second serial port (COM2: on DOS and Windows) # ircomm0: First IrDA communication port # ircomm1: Second IrDA communication port # ttyUSB0: First USB-Serial port # ttyUSB1: Second USB-Serial port # d-i synce-serial/tty string /dev/ttyUSB0 ### Description: Local IP-Address: # The local IP-Address to use for the ppp connection to your Windows CE # device. It is best practice to use the default one (192.168.131.102). If # you want to specify this address yourself, you may want to read about the # same option on the man page for pppd. # d-i synce-serial/localip string 192.168.131.102 ### Description: Remote IP-Address: # The remote IP-Address to use for the ppp connection to your Windows CE # device. It is best practice to use the default one (192.168.131.201). If # you want to specify this address yourself, you may want to read about the # same option on the man page for pppd. # d-i synce-serial/remoteip string 192.168.131.201 ### Description: The IP-Address of your Domain Name server: # Specify the IP-Address of your Domain Name System (DNS) server. If you do # not have a DNS server let this field empty. Be aware, if you leave this # field empty, name-resolution would not work on your device. Nevertheless, # synce will work correctly without a DNS server. If your internet connection is # up you could use the DNS server specified in the /etc/resolv.conf file. # d-i synce-serial/dnsip string ############################ #### extlinux_6.03+dfsg-5+deb8u2_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### sysstat_11.0.1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove old format statistics data files? # The format of daily data statistics files has changed in version ${s_version} # of sysstat and is not compatible with the previous one. # . # If you choose this option, all existing data files in the /var/log/sysstat/ # directory will be deleted. # . # If you don't choose this option, the sar(1) command will not work properly # until you remove the files manually. # d-i sysstat/remove_files boolean true ### Description: Activate sysstat's cron job? # If this option is enabled the sysstat package will monitor system # activities and store the data in log files within /var/log/sysstat/. # . # This data allows the sar(1) command to display system statistics for the # whole day. # . # If you don't enable this option, the sar(1) command will only show the # current statistics. # d-i sysstat/enable boolean false ############################ #### udev_215-17+deb8u7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Proceed with the udev upgrade despite the kernel incompatibility? # You are currently upgrading udev to a version that is not # compatible with the currently running kernel. # . # You MUST install a compatible kernel version (2.6.32 or newer) before # upgrading, otherwise the system may become UNUSABLE. # Packages with a name starting with "linux-image-2.6-" provide a kernel # image usable with this new udev version. # . # If you choose to upgrade udev nevertheless, you should install a # compatible kernel and reboot with that kernel as soon as # possible. # d-i udev/new_kernel_needed boolean false ############################ #### sysv-rc_2.88dsf-59_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### sysvinit-core_2.88dsf-59_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Update getty pathnames and add hurd-console? # Your /etc/inittab seems to use /libexec/getty as getty and/or to miss # hurd-console entry. The default inittab has been changed, however your # /etc/inittab has been modified. Note that sysvinit has not been used # to boot an Hurd system for long, so any errors in that file would not # have shown up earlier. # . # If you allow this change, a backup will be stored in /etc/inittab.dpkg-old. # . # If you don't allow this change, an updated inittab will be written to # /etc/inittab.dpkg-new. Please review the changes and update your # /etc/inittab accordingly. # d-i sysvinit/hurd-fix-inittab boolean ############################ #### t-prot_3.3-1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to enable t-prot system wide for mutt? # The t-prot package provides a config file /etc/t-prot/Muttrc -- to use the # script from mutt you have to enable it. You can do this either by creating a # symlink in /etc/Muttrc.d/ for systemwide usage (rather, this can be done # automatically for you), or let the users decide to add a "source" line for it # in their ~/.muttrc or ~/.mutt/muttrc. If you acknowledge this question the # systemwide usage will be enabled. # d-i t-prot/muttrc.d boolean true ############################ #### tango-common_8.1.2c+dfsg-5_all.deb ############################ ### Description: TANGO host: # Please specify the name of the host where the TANGO database server is running. # d-i tango-common/tango-host string localhost:10000 ############################ #### tasksel_3.31+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Choose software to install: # At the moment, only the core of the system is installed. To tune the # system to your needs, you can choose to install one or more of the # following predefined collections of software. # d-i tasksel/first multiselect # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: Choose software to install: # You can choose to install one or more of the following predefined # collections of software. # d-i tasksel/tasks multiselect # Possible choices: ${CHOICES} ### Description: This can be preseeded to override the default desktop. # d-i tasksel/desktop multiselect # Possible choices: gnome, kde, xfce, lxde, cinnamon, mate ############################ #### terminatorx_3.90-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Install terminatorX SUID root so it can use realtime scheduling? # TerminatorX now supports installation of its binary SUID root. This # allows it to run in a realtime scheduled priority thereby greatly # improving performance. However, it is generally a good idea to minimize # the number of SUID programs on your machine to avoid security risks. # . # If you are installing this on your personal desktop with only 1 user, it # should be fairly safe to accept here. If in doubt, refuse. # d-i terminatorx/suid_bin boolean false ############################ #### tex-common_5.03_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### texlive-base_2014.20141024-2+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: TeX binaries that should use the system paper size: # This system's TeX binaries currently use different default paper # sizes. Please choose which of them should get the system paper size # (${libpaperPaper}) as their default. # d-i texlive-base/binary_chooser multiselect pdftex, dvips, dvipdfmx, xdvi # Possible choices: pdftex, dvips, dvipdfmx, xdvi ############################ #### tftpd-hpa_5.2+20140608-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Dedicated system account for the tftpd-hpa TFTP daemon: # The TFTP server must use a dedicated account for its operation so that # the system's security is not compromised by running it with superuser # privileges. # . # Please choose that account's username. # d-i tftpd-hpa/username string tftp ### Description: TFTP root directory: # Please specify the directory that will be used as root for the # TFTP server. # d-i tftpd-hpa/directory string /srv/tftp ### Description: TFTP server address and port: # Please specify an address and port to listen to in the form of # [address][:port]. # . # By default, the TFTP server listens to port 69 on all addresses and all # interfaces (0.0.0.0:69). If no port is specified, it defaults to 69. # . # Please note that numeric IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in square brackets # to avoid ambiguity with the optional port information. # d-i tftpd-hpa/address string 0.0.0.0:69 ### Description: TFTP server additional options: # Additional options can be passed to the TFTP server with this mechanism, # please consult the tftpd(8) manpage for more information about available # options. # . # Options other than the recommended '--secure' are rarely needed and only # for special situations. If unsure, leave it at the recommended default value. # d-i tftpd-hpa/options string --secure ############################ #### tiger_3.2.3-12.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Recipient of the daily mails: # The user you enter below will receive all the emails that 'tiger' sends # during the day when running the cron jobs. This does not mean that when # executing the 'tiger' program standalone this user will receive the # reports. Also note that any administrator will be able to access the # reports since they are available in the /var/log/tiger/ directory. # d-i tiger/mail_rcpt string root ############################ #### tin_2.2.1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enter the fully qualified domain name of your news server # What news server (NNTP server) should be used for reading and posting # news? # d-i shared/news/server string ############################ #### tmpreaper_1.6.13+nmu1_amd64.deb ############################ ############################ #### tomcat7_7.0.56-3+deb8u11_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Dedicated system account for the tomcat7 daemon: # The tomcat7 server must use a dedicated account for its operation so that # the system's security is not compromised by running it with superuser # privileges. # d-i tomcat7/username string tomcat7 ### Description: Dedicated system group for the tomcat7 daemon: # The tomcat7 server must use a dedicated group for its operation so that # the system's security is not compromised by running it with superuser # privileges. # d-i tomcat7/groupname string tomcat7 ### Description: Please choose the tomcat7 JVM Java options: # Tomcat's JVM will be launched with a specific set of Java options. # . # Note that if you use -XX:+UseConcMarkSweepGC you should add the # -XX:+CMSIncrementalMode option if you run Tomcat on a machine with # exactly one CPU chip that contains one or two cores. # d-i tomcat7/javaopts string -Djava.awt.headless=true -Xmx128m -XX:+UseConcMarkSweepGC ############################ #### tomcat8_8.0.14-1+deb8u11_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Dedicated system account for the tomcat8 daemon: # The tomcat8 server must use a dedicated account for its operation so that # the system's security is not compromised by running it with superuser # privileges. # d-i tomcat8/username string tomcat8 ### Description: Dedicated system group for the tomcat8 daemon: # The tomcat8 server must use a dedicated group for its operation so that # the system's security is not compromised by running it with superuser # privileges. # d-i tomcat8/groupname string tomcat8 ### Description: Please choose the tomcat8 JVM Java options: # Tomcat's JVM will be launched with a specific set of Java options. # . # Note that if you use -XX:+UseConcMarkSweepGC you should add the # -XX:+CMSIncrementalMode option if you run Tomcat on a machine with # exactly one CPU chip that contains one or two cores. # d-i tomcat8/javaopts string -Djava.awt.headless=true -Xmx128m -XX:+UseConcMarkSweepGC ############################ #### tomoyo-tools_2.5.0-20140601-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable TOMOYO Linux at boot time? # Enabling TOMOYO Linux functionality in the running kernel requires an # appropriate kernel command line at boot time. This can be configured by # setting GRUB_CMDLINE_LINUX="security=tomoyo" in /etc/default/grub and # running grub-update. # . # If you accept here, these actions will be performed automatically and # TOMOYO Linux will be enabled at next boot. # d-i tomoyo-tools/grub boolean false ############################ #### libtowitoko2_2.0.7-9_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: On which serial port is connected the smart card reader? # PCSC needs to know on which serial port the reader is connected. This # information is stored in the file /etc/reader.conf. # . # You should not edit this file directly but create or modify a file in # /etc/reader.conf.d/ and use update-reader.conf(8) to regenerate # /etc/reader.conf. # d-i libtowitoko2/port select # Possible choices: ttyS0, ttyS1, ttyS2, ttyS3, USB ############################ #### tpb_0.6.4-8_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Start tpb automatically? # tpb can be started automatically after X has been started for a user. # That can be either after startx from console or after login with a display manager. # d-i tpb/autostart boolean true ############################ #### tripwire_2.4.2.2-4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you wish to upgrade? # The format of the Tripwire database and configuration files have changed # substantially between previous versions and this release. # . # To ensure your system remains secure, the upgrade process keeps a copy of # the old version of Tripwire and the old configuration file along with any # old databases that may exist. You will find a detailed explanation for # using the old version of Tripwire in # /usr/share/doc/tripwire/README.Debian. # . # However, as no conversion of the old configuration file and database is # attempted, you may prefer not to upgrade. # . # Due to the way Debian handles configuration files, if you choose to # upgrade you must accept the new version of /etc/cron.daily/tripwire for # regular reporting to occur. The cron job associated with the previous # version will continue to run regardless. # d-i tripwire/upgrade boolean true ### Description: Do you wish to create/use your site key passphrase during installation? # Tripwire uses a pair of keys to sign various files, thus ensuring their # unaltered state. By accepting here, you will be prompted for the # passphrase for the first of those keys, the site key, during the # installation. You are also agreeing to create a site key if one # doesn't exist already. Tripwire uses the site key to sign files that may # be common to multiple systems, e.g. the configuration & policy files. See # twfiles(5) for more information. # . # Unfortunately, due to the Debian installation process, there is a period # of time where this passphrase exists in a unencrypted format. Were an # attacker to have access to your machine during this period, he could # possibly retrieve your passphrase and use it at some later point. # . # If you would rather not have this exposure, decline here. You will then # need to create a site key, configuration file & policy file by hand. See # twadmin(8) for more information. # d-i tripwire/use-sitekey boolean true ### Description: Do you wish to create/use your local key passphrase during installation? # Tripwire uses a pair of keys to sign various files, thus ensuring their # unaltered state. By accepting here, you will be prompted for the # passphrase for the second of those keys, the local key, during the # installation. You are also agreeing to create a local key if one # doesn't exist already. Tripwire uses the local key to sign files that are # specific to this system, e.g. the tripwire database. See twfiles(5) for # more information. # . # Unfortunately, due to the Debian installation process, there is a period # of time where this passphrase exists in a unencrypted format. Were an # attacker to have access to your machine during this period, he could # possibly retrieve your passphrase and use it at some later point. # . # If you would rather not have this exposure, decline here. You will then # need to create a local key file by hand. See twadmin(8) for more # information. # d-i tripwire/use-localkey boolean true ### Description: Enter site-key passphrase: # Tripwire uses two different keys for authentication and encryption of # files. The site key is used to protect files that could be used across # several systems. This includes the policy and configuration files. # . # You are being prompted for this passphrase either because no site key # exists at this time or because you have requested the rebuilding of the # policy or configuration files. # . # Remember this passphrase; it is not stored anywhere! # d-i tripwire/site-passphrase password ### Description: Repeat the site-key passphrase: # Please repeat the site pass phrase to be sure you didn't mistype. # d-i tripwire/site-passphrase-again password ### Description: Your site passphrase is incorrect. Retry operation? # The site passphrase you entered is incorrect. If you think you mistyped # it and would like to retry the current operation accept below. If # you can't remember the passphrase, decline below and the tripwire # installation process will terminate gracefully. When you remember the # site passphrase continue the installation process by running # . # dpkg-reconfigure tripwire # . # as root. # . # If you have completely forgotten your site passphrase, generate a new # site key with a new passphrase by running # . # twadmin -m G -S /etc/tripwire/site.key # . # as root. # d-i tripwire/site-passphrase-incorrect boolean false ### Description: Enter local key passphrase: # Tripwire uses two different keys for authentication and encryption of # files. The local key is used to protect files specific to the local # machine, such as the Tripwire database. The local key may also be used # for signing integrity check reports. # . # You are being prompted for this passphrase because no local key file # currently exists. # . # Remember this passphrase; it is not stored anywhere! # d-i tripwire/local-passphrase password ### Description: Repeat the local key passphrase: # Please repeat the local pass phrase to be sure you didn't mistype. # d-i tripwire/local-passphrase-again password ### Description: Your local passphrase is incorrect. Retry operation? # The local passphrase you entered is incorrect. If you think you mistyped # it and would like to retry the current operation accept below. If # you can't remember the passphrase, decline below and the tripwire # installation process will terminate gracefully. When you remember the # local passphrase continue the installation process by running # . # dpkg-reconfigure tripwire # . # as root. # . # If you have completely forgotten your local passphrase, generate a new # local key with a new passphrase by running # . # twadmin -m G -L /etc/tripwire/${hostname}-local.key # . # as root. # d-i tripwire/local-passphrase-incorrect boolean false ### Description: Rebuild Tripwire configuration file? # Tripwire keeps its configuration in a encrypted database that is # generated, by default, from /etc/tripwire/twcfg.txt # . # Any changes to /etc/tripwire/twcfg.txt, either as a result of a change in # this package or due to administrator activity, require the regeneration of # the encrypted database before they will take effect. # . # Selecting this action will result in your being prompted for the site key # passphrase during the post-installation process of this package. # d-i tripwire/rebuild-config boolean true ### Description: Rebuild Tripwire policy file? # Tripwire keeps its policies on what attributes of which files should be # monitored in a encrypted database that is generated, by default, from # /etc/tripwire/twpol.txt # . # Any changes to /etc/tripwire/twpol.txt, either as a result of a change in # this package or due to administrator activity, require the regeneration of # the encrypted database before they will take effect. # . # Selecting this action will result in your being prompted for the site key # passphrase during the post-installation process of this package. # d-i tripwire/rebuild-policy boolean true ############################ #### tunapie_2.1.17-3_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you wish to view uncensored video streams from Shoutcast? # Some Shoutcast video streams contain adult content. If you select this option, # adult content will be displayed by tunapie. # d-i tunapie/uncensored_streams boolean false ############################ #### tvtime_1.0.2-14_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: TV standard: # Please choose the TV standard to use. NTSC is used in North America, # much of South America, and Japan; SECAM in France, the former USSR, # and parts of Africa and the Middle East; and PAL elsewhere. # d-i tvtime/norm select # Possible choices: NTSC, PAL, SECAM, PAL-Nc, PAL-M, PAL-N, NTSC-JP, PAL-60 ### Description: Default frequency table: # Please choose the frequency table to use. It specifies which frequencies correspond to the familiar # channel numbers. You should select "Broadcast" if you use an antenna for over-the-air # signals. # d-i tvtime/frequencies-ntsc select # Possible choices: Cable, Broadcast, Cable including channels 100+ ### Description: Default frequency table: # Please choose the frequency table to use. It specifies which # frequencies correspond to the familiar channel numbers. # . # You should select "Broadcast" if you use an antenna for over-the-air # signals. # d-i tvtime/frequencies-jp select # Possible choices: Cable, Broadcast ### Description: Default frequency table: # Please choose the frequency table to use. It specifies which # frequencies correspond to the familiar channel numbers. # . # If you are a user of a cable company that does not use standard # frequencies, you should select "Custom" and run # the tvtime-scanner application before using tvtime. # d-i tvtime/frequencies-pal select # Possible choices: Europe, France, Russia, Australia, New Zealand, China Broadcast, Australia Optus, Custom (must run tvtime-scanner first) ### Description: Default television capture device: # Please choose the video4linux device which corresponds to your capture # card. # d-i tvtime/v4ldevice string /dev/video0 ### Description: Device to use for VBI decoding: # Please choose the device that will be used in NTSC areas for decoding closed captions and XDS # channel information. # d-i tvtime/vbidevice string /dev/vbi0 ### Description: Allow tvtime to run with root privileges? # Please choose whether tvtime should be "setuid root", therefore getting # root privileges when running. # . # This allows tvtime to run at a high priority to ensure smooth video and # should be used for high quality video output even during high CPU load. # d-i tvtime/setuid boolean false ### Description: Process priority for the tvtime binary: # This setting controls the priority of the tvtime process relative to other # processes on the system. # . # Allowed values are integers between -20 and 19. Lower # values indicate higher priority, and a value of 0 would give tvtime the # same priority as a normal process. # d-i tvtime/processpriority string -10 ############################ #### tzdata_2018e-0+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Geographic area: # Please select the geographic area in which you live. Subsequent # configuration questions will narrow this down by presenting a list of # cities, representing the time zones in which they are located. # d-i tzdata/Areas select # Possible choices: Africa, America, Antarctica, Australia, Arctic, Asia, Atlantic, Europe, Indian, Pacific, SystemV, US, Etc ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/Africa select # Possible choices: Abidjan, Accra, Addis_Ababa, Algiers, Asmara, Bamako, Bangui, Banjul, Bissau, Blantyre, Brazzaville, Bujumbura, Cairo, Casablanca, Ceuta, Conakry, Dakar, Dar_es_Salaam, Djibouti, Douala, El_Aaiun, Freetown, Gaborone, Harare, Johannesburg, Juba, Kampala, Khartoum, Kigali, Kinshasa, Lagos, Libreville, Lome, Luanda, Lubumbashi, Lusaka, Malabo, Maputo, Maseru, Mbabane, Mogadishu, Monrovia, Nairobi, Ndjamena, Niamey, Nouakchott, Ouagadougou, Porto-Novo, Sao_Tome, Timbuktu, Tripoli, Tunis, Windhoek ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/America select # Possible choices: Adak, Anchorage, Anguilla, Antigua, Araguaina, Argentina/Buenos_Aires, Argentina/Catamarca, Argentina/Cordoba, Argentina/Jujuy, Argentina/La_Rioja, Argentina/Mendoza, Argentina/Rio_Gallegos, Argentina/Salta, Argentina/San_Juan, Argentina/San_Luis, Argentina/Tucuman, Argentina/Ushuaia, Aruba, Asuncion, Atikokan, Atka, Bahia, Bahia_Banderas, Barbados, Belem, Belize, Blanc-Sablon, Boa_Vista, Bogota, Boise, Cambridge_Bay, Campo_Grande, Cancun, Caracas, Cayenne, Cayman, Chicago, Chihuahua, Coral_Harbour, Costa_Rica, Creston, Cuiaba, Curacao, Danmarkshavn, Dawson, Dawson_Creek, Denver, Detroit, Dominica, Edmonton, Eirunepe, El_Salvador, Ensenada, Fort_Nelson, Fortaleza, Glace_Bay, Godthab, Goose_Bay, Grand_Turk, Grenada, Guadeloupe, Guatemala, Guayaquil, Guyana, Halifax, Havana, Hermosillo, Indiana/Indianapolis, Indiana/Knox, Indiana/Marengo, Indiana/Petersburg, Indiana/Tell_City, Indiana/Vevay, Indiana/Vincennes, Indiana/Winamac, Inuvik, Iqaluit, Jamaica, Juneau, Kentucky/Louisville, Kentucky/Monticello, Kralendijk, La_Paz, Lima, Los_Angeles, Lower_Princes, Maceio, Managua, Manaus, Marigot, Martinique, Matamoros, Mazatlan, Menominee, Merida, Metlakatla, Mexico_City, Miquelon, Moncton, Monterrey, Montevideo, Montreal, Montserrat, Nassau, New_York, Nipigon, Nome, Noronha, North_Dakota/Beulah, North_Dakota/Center, North_Dakota/New_Salem, Ojinaga, Panama, Pangnirtung, Paramaribo, Phoenix, Port-au-Prince, Port_of_Spain, Porto_Acre, Porto_Velho, Puerto_Rico, Punta_Arenas, Rainy_River, Rankin_Inlet, Recife, Regina, Resolute, Rio_Branco, Santa_Isabel, Santarem, Santiago, Santo_Domingo, Sao_Paulo, Scoresbysund, Shiprock, Sitka, St_Barthelemy, St_Johns, St_Kitts, St_Lucia, St_Thomas, St_Vincent, Swift_Current, Tegucigalpa, Thule, Thunder_Bay, Tijuana, Toronto, Tortola, Vancouver, Virgin, Whitehorse, Winnipeg, Yakutat, Yellowknife ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/Antarctica select # Possible choices: Casey, Davis, DumontDUrville, Macquarie, Mawson, McMurdo, Palmer, Rothera, Syowa, Troll, Vostok ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/Australia select # Possible choices: Adelaide, Brisbane, Broken_Hill, Canberra, Currie, Darwin, Eucla, Hobart, Lindeman, Lord_Howe, Melbourne, Perth, Sydney, Yancowinna ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/Arctic select # Possible choices: Longyearbyen ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/Asia select # Possible choices: Aden, Almaty, Amman, Anadyr, Aqtau, Aqtobe, Ashgabat, Atyrau, Baghdad, Bahrain, Baku, Bangkok, Barnaul, Beirut, Bishkek, Brunei, Chita, Choibalsan, Chongqing, Colombo, Damascus, Dhaka, Dili, Dubai, Dushanbe, Famagusta, Gaza, Harbin, Hebron, Ho_Chi_Minh, Hong_Kong, Hovd, Irkutsk, Istanbul, Jakarta, Jayapura, Jerusalem, Kabul, Kamchatka, Karachi, Kashgar, Kathmandu, Khandyga, Kolkata, Krasnoyarsk, Kuala_Lumpur, Kuching, Kuwait, Macau, Magadan, Makassar, Manila, Muscat, Nicosia, Novokuznetsk, Novosibirsk, Omsk, Oral, Phnom_Penh, Pontianak, Pyongyang, Qatar, Qyzylorda, Rangoon, Riyadh, Sakhalin, Samarkand, Seoul, Shanghai, Singapore, Srednekolymsk, Taipei, Tashkent, Tbilisi, Tehran, Tel_Aviv, Thimphu, Tokyo, Tomsk, Ujung_Pandang, Ulaanbaatar, Urumqi, Ust-Nera, Vientiane, Vladivostok, Yakutsk, Yangon, Yekaterinburg, Yerevan ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/Atlantic select # Possible choices: Azores, Bermuda, Canary, Cape_Verde, Faroe, Jan_Mayen, Madeira, Reykjavik, South_Georgia, St_Helena, Stanley ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/Europe select # Possible choices: Amsterdam, Andorra, Astrakhan, Athens, Belfast, Belgrade, Berlin, Bratislava, Brussels, Bucharest, Budapest, Busingen, Chisinau, Copenhagen, Dublin, Gibraltar, Guernsey, Helsinki, Isle_of_Man, Istanbul, Jersey, Kaliningrad, Kiev, Kirov, Lisbon, Ljubljana, London, Luxembourg, Madrid, Malta, Mariehamn, Minsk, Monaco, Moscow, Nicosia, Oslo, Paris, Podgorica, Prague, Riga, Rome, Samara, San_Marino, Sarajevo, Saratov, Simferopol, Skopje, Sofia, Stockholm, Tallinn, Tirane, Tiraspol, Ulyanovsk, Uzhgorod, Vaduz, Vatican, Vienna, Vilnius, Volgograd, Warsaw, Zagreb, Zaporozhye, Zurich ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/Indian select # Possible choices: Antananarivo, Chagos, Christmas, Cocos, Comoro, Kerguelen, Mahe, Maldives, Mauritius, Mayotte, Reunion ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/Pacific select # Possible choices: Apia, Auckland, Bougainville, Chatham, Chuuk, Easter, Efate, Enderbury, Fakaofo, Fiji, Funafuti, Galapagos, Gambier, Guadalcanal, Guam, Honolulu, Johnston, Kiritimati, Kosrae, Kwajalein, Majuro, Marquesas, Midway, Nauru, Niue, Norfolk, Noumea, Pago_Pago, Palau, Pitcairn, Pohnpei, Ponape, Port_Moresby, Rarotonga, Saipan, Samoa, Tahiti, Tarawa, Tongatapu, Truk, Wake, Wallis, Yap ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/SystemV select # Possible choices: AST4, AST4ADT, CST6, CST6CDT, EST5, EST5EDT, HST10, MST7, MST7MDT, PST8, PST8PDT, YST9, YST9YDT ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/US select # Possible choices: Alaska, Aleutian, Arizona, Central, Eastern, Hawaii, Indiana-Starke, Michigan, Mountain, Pacific, Pacific-New, Samoa ### Description: Time zone: # Please select the city or region corresponding to your time zone. # d-i tzdata/Zones/Etc select # Possible choices: GMT, GMT+0, GMT+1, GMT+10, GMT+11, GMT+12, GMT+2, GMT+3, GMT+4, GMT+5, GMT+6, GMT+7, GMT+8, GMT+9, GMT-0, GMT-1, GMT-10, GMT-11, GMT-12, GMT-13, GMT-14, GMT-2, GMT-3, GMT-4, GMT-5, GMT-6, GMT-7, GMT-8, GMT-9, GMT0, Greenwich, UCT, UTC, Universal, Zulu ############################ #### ucf_3.0030_all.deb ############################ ### Description: What do you want to do about modified configuration file ${BASENAME}? # A new version (${NEW}) of configuration file ${FILE} is available, but the version installed # currently has been locally modified. # d-i ucf/changeprompt_threeway select keep_current # Possible choices: install the package maintainer's version, keep the local version currently installed, show the differences between the versions, show a side-by-side difference between the versions, show a 3-way difference between available versions, do a 3-way merge between available versions (experimental), start a new shell to examine the situation ### Description: What do you want to do about modified configuration file ${BASENAME}? # A new version (${NEW}) of configuration file ${FILE} is available, but the version installed # currently has been locally modified. # d-i ucf/changeprompt select keep_current # Possible choices: install the package maintainer's version, keep the local version currently installed, show the differences between the versions, show a side-by-side difference between the versions, start a new shell to examine the situation ############################ #### ufw_0.33-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Start ufw automatically? # If you choose this option, the rules you are about to set # will be enabled during system startup so that this host is protected # as early as possible. # . # To protect this host immediately, you must start ufw manually. # d-i ufw/enable boolean false ### Description: Authorized services: # Please choose the services that should be available for incoming connections. # . # Other services may be specified in the next configuration step. # d-i ufw/allow_known_ports multiselect # Possible choices: CUPS, DNS, IMAPS, POP3S, SSH, CIFS (Samba), SMTP, HTTP, HTTPS ### Description: Additional authorized services: # Please enter a space separated list of any additional ports you would like to # open. You may use a service name (as found in /etc/services), a # port number, or a port number with protocol. # . # Example: to allow a web server, port 53 # and tcp port 22, you should enter "www 53 22/tcp". # d-i ufw/allow_custom_ports string ############################ #### uif_1.1.4-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Firewall configuration method # The firewall can be initialized using debconf, or using information # you manually put into /etc/uif/uif.conf. # d-i uif/conf_method select don't touch # Possible choices: don't touch, workstation ### Description: Enter trusted hosts and/or networks: # In workstation mode, you can specify some hosts or networks to be # globally trusted. All incoming traffic coming from there will be # allowed. Multiple entries have to be separate with spaces. # . # Example: 10.1.0.0/16 trust.mydomain.com 192.168.1.55 # d-i uif/trusted string ### Description: Do you want your host to be reachable via ping? # Normally an Internet host should be reachable with pings. Choosing no here # will disable pings which might be somewhat confusing when analyzing # network problems. # d-i uif/pings boolean true ### Description: Do you want your host to react to traceroutes? # Normally an Internet host should react to traceroutes. Choosing no here # will disable this, which might be somewhat confusing when analyzing # network problems. # d-i uif/traceroute boolean true ############################ #### ukolovnik_1.4-2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Web server to reconfigure automatically: # Please choose the web server that should be automatically configured # to run Ukolovnik. # d-i ukolovnik/reconfigure-webserver multiselect # Possible choices: apache2, apache, apache-ssl, apache-perl, lighttpd ############################ #### unattended-upgrades_0.83.3.2+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically download and install stable updates? # Applying updates on a frequent basis is an important part of keeping # systems secure. By default, updates need to be applied manually using package # management tools. Alternatively, you can choose to have this system # automatically download and install security updates. # d-i unattended-upgrades/enable_auto_updates boolean false ############################ #### unclutter_8-19_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Start unclutter automatically? # unclutter can be started automatically after X has been started for a # user. That can be either after startx from console or after login with a # display manager. # d-i unclutter/autostart boolean true ############################ #### cw_3.3.1-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Run cw with root privileges? # If it is run with elevated privileges (which is not recommended), cw # can produce sounds using the console buzzer. # . # Please choose whether this should be achieved by giving the # executable the "setuid" attribute. # . # Alternatives include running the program with sudo or eliminating this # issue completely by using output via a sound card instead of the # buzzer. # d-i cw/suid_bit boolean false ############################ #### cwcp_3.3.1-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Run cwcp with root privileges? # If it is run with elevated privileges (which is not recommended), cwcp # can produce sounds using the console buzzer. # . # Please choose whether this should be achieved by giving the # executable the "setuid" attribute. # . # Alternatives include running the program with sudo or eliminating this # issue completely by using output via a sound card instead of the # buzzer. # d-i cwcp/suid_bit boolean false ############################ #### xcwcp_3.3.1-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Make xcwcp setuid root? # xcwcp can produce sounds using console buzzer, but this feature # is available only if xcwcp is run by root user. # You can achieve this by setting setuid bit here (not recommended) # or by running xcwcp with sudo (also not recommended). You can also # use soundcard output instead of console buzzer output and # eliminate this problem completely. # d-i xcwcp/suid_bit boolean false ############################ #### imapproxy_1.2.7-1.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: IMAP server to connect to: # Please enter the hostname or address of the IMAP server ImapProxy will # connect to. # d-i imapproxy/imap-server string localhost ############################ #### update-inetd_4.43_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Ignore multiple entries and continue without changes? # There are multiple entries in ${inetdcf} for the '${service}' service. # d-i update-inetd/ask-several-entries boolean true ### Description: Leave existing entry and continue without changes? # An unrecognized entry for ${sservice} was found in ${inetdcf} while # trying to add the following entry: # . # ${newentry} # . # The unrecognized entry is: # . # ${lookslike} # d-i update-inetd/ask-entry-present boolean true ### Description: Remove inetd entries? # There are multiple entries in ${inetdcf} for the '${service}' service. # . # Please confirm that you agree to remove these entries. # d-i update-inetd/ask-remove-entries boolean false ### Description: Disable inetd entries? # There are multiple entries in ${inetdcf} for the '${service}' service. # . # Please confirm that you agree to disable these entries. # d-i update-inetd/ask-disable-entries boolean false ############################ #### uprecords-cgi_0.3.17-4_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Format used by uprecords.cgi: # Three different layouts are available for use by the uprecords CGI script. # Which method you use is a matter of personal preference. # . # * pre: Encloses everything in
...
# * list: Makes a list, using
    ...
# * table: Creates an HTML table. # d-i uprecords-cgi/layout select pre # Possible choices: pre, list, table ### Description: Number of records shown by uprecords.cgi: # While uptimed may keep a large number of uptime records, not all of them # are interesting to the outside world. Thus, you can limit the number of # records that will be shown here. # d-i uprecords-cgi/maxentries string 10 ############################ #### uptimed_0.3.17-4_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Delay between database updates (seconds): # Uptimed will update its database regularly so that the uptime # doesn't get lost in case of a system crash. You can set how frequently # this will happen (use higher values if you want to avoid disk activity, # for instance on a laptop). # d-i uptimed/interval string 600 ### Description: Number of records that should be kept: # On systems that reboot frequently, you will get a # fairly large list of uptime records pretty soon. To avoid this, uptimed # will only keep the n highest uptimes. You may want to limit this to a # lower value if you want to get emails each time a record is broken or # if you reboot your machine often. # d-i uptimed/maxrecords string 50 ### Description: Send mails if a milestone or record is reached: # Uptimed can be configured to send a mail each time a record is broken or a # "milestone" is reached. You can choose whether you: # . # * never want to receive these mails; # * want to be notified only when a record is broken; # * would like to know about milestones; # * are interested in both. # d-i uptimed/mail/do_mail select Never # Possible choices: Never, Record, Milestone, Both ### Description: Uptimed email recipient: # Since you have chosen to be sent emails, you should specify where to send # these mails. # d-i uptimed/mail/address string root ############################ #### uqwk_2.21-15_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: What news server should be used for reading and posting news? # What news server (NNTP server) should be used for reading and posting # news? # . # Enter the fully qualified domain name of the server. # d-i shared/news/server string ############################ #### user-setup_1.61_all.deb ############################ ### Description: for internal use only # d-i passwd/root-password-crypted password ### Description: for internal use only # d-i passwd/user-password-crypted password ### Description: for internal use only # d-i passwd/user-uid string ### Description: for internal use only # d-i passwd/user-default-groups string audio cdrom dip floppy video plugdev netdev scanner bluetooth debian-tor lpadmin ### Description: Allow login as root? # If you choose not to allow root to log in, then a user account will be # created and given the power to become root using the 'sudo' command. # d-i passwd/root-login boolean true ### Description: Root password: # You need to set a password for 'root', the system administrative # account. A malicious or unqualified user with root access can have # disastrous results, so you should take care to choose a root password # that is not easy to guess. It should not be a word found in dictionaries, # or a word that could be easily associated with you. # . # A good password will contain a mixture of letters, numbers and punctuation # and should be changed at regular intervals. # . # The root user should not have an empty password. If you leave this # empty, the root account will be disabled and the system's initial user # account will be given the power to become root using the "sudo" # command. # . # Note that you will not be able to see the password as you type it. # d-i passwd/root-password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same root password again to verify that you have typed it # correctly. # d-i passwd/root-password-again password ### Description: Create a normal user account now? # It's a bad idea to use the root account for normal day-to-day activities, # such as the reading of electronic mail, because even a small mistake can # result in disaster. You should create a normal user account to use for # those day-to-day tasks. # . # Note that you may create it later (as well as any additional account) by # typing 'adduser ' as root, where is an username, # like 'imurdock' or 'rms'. # d-i passwd/make-user boolean true ### Description: Full name for the new user: # A user account will be created for you to use instead of the root # account for non-administrative activities. # . # Please enter the real name of this user. This information will be used # for instance as default origin for emails sent by this user as well as # any program which displays or uses the user's real name. Your full # name is a reasonable choice. # d-i passwd/user-fullname string ### Description: Username for your account: # Select a username for the new account. Your first name is a reasonable choice. # The username should start with a lower-case letter, which can be # followed by any combination of numbers and more lower-case letters. # d-i passwd/username string ### Description: Choose a password for the new user: # A good password will contain a mixture of letters, numbers and punctuation # and should be changed at regular intervals. # d-i passwd/user-password password ### Description: Re-enter password to verify: # Please enter the same user password again to verify you have typed it # correctly. # d-i passwd/user-password-again password ### Description: Enable shadow passwords? # Shadow passwords make your system more secure because nobody is able to # view even encrypted passwords. The passwords are stored in a separate file # that can only be read by special programs. The use of shadow passwords # is strongly recommended, except in a few cases such as NIS environments. # d-i passwd/shadow boolean true ############################ #### uswsusp_1.0+20120915-6_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Swap space to resume from: # To be able to suspend the system, uswsusp needs a swap partition or file # to store a system snapshot. Please choose the device to use, from the # list of suitable swap spaces, sorted by size (largest first). # d-i uswsusp/resume_device select # Possible choices: ${list} ### Description: Offset of swap file's header: # When using a swap file for storing the snapshot during suspend, the # location of the swap file's header must be specified. This will be # stored in units, as the offset from the beginning of the # partition that contains the swap file. # d-i uswsusp/resume_offset string ### Description: Continue without a valid swap space? # The swap file or partition that was found in uswsusp's configuration # file is not active. # . # In most cases this means userspace software suspend will # not work as expected. You should choose another # swap space. # . # However, in some rare cases, this configuration may be intentional. # d-i uswsusp/continue_without_swap boolean true ### Description: The device node through which uswsusp can talk to the kernel: # If this is empty, the hardcoded default, /dev/snapshot, is used. # This should be OK in almost all cases. Don't change this unless there is a # good reason to do so. # d-i uswsusp/snapshot_device string ### Description: Preferred maximum image size: # Please specify a maximum system snapshot image size (in bytes). # . # This limit is not strict; the uswsusp does its best to respect it, # but will exceed the specified limit if suspend needs a bigger image. # . # Using 0 here will enforce the use of the smallest possible snapshot # image. An empty value will use the hard coded default, which is # 500MB. The default value is 45% of the system's memory: this is not # the maximal size, but some additional free memory speeds up the # suspend and resume process. # d-i uswsusp/image_size string ### Description: Log level for software suspend: # Please specify the kernel console log level which the s2disk/s2both # and resume utilities will use to report the progress of suspend and # resume. On a stock kernel, messages with levels higher than 7 are # usually not shown. # d-i uswsusp/suspend_loglevel string ### Description: Maximal log level: # Please specify the kernel console log level which the resume utility will use # if the resume fails. # d-i uswsusp/max_loglevel string ### Description: Perform checksum on image? # Performing a checksum using the MD5 algorithm to verify the image # integrity is slightly safer, but also takes more time. # d-i uswsusp/compute_checksum boolean false ### Description: Compress image? # Compressing the image with the LZF compression algorithm will result in a # smaller image, which makes it possible to suspend with a smaller swap # partition. Generally, it will also make reading and writing the image faster # because there is less to read and write. # d-i uswsusp/compress boolean true ### Description: Perform early write out? # The synchronization of the resume device can start early in the # process of writing the image to it. This has been reported to speed # up suspend on some systems and eliminate the 'fast progress meter and # long fsync wait' effect. # d-i uswsusp/early_writeout boolean true ### Description: Encrypt snapshot? # For increased security, it is possible to encrypt the snapshot # that is written to disk during suspend. On resume (and suspend if you don't # use an RSA key), you will be prompted for a passphrase. Encryption # adds a significant time to the suspend and resume processes. # d-i uswsusp/encrypt boolean false ### Description: Path to RSA key file: # To avoid the need for a passphrase prompt during each suspend, an RSA # key can be used to encrypt the image. # . # Please specify the path to that file. Leave this field empty to # not use an RSA key. # d-i uswsusp/RSA_key_file string /etc/uswsusp.key ### Description: Create an RSA key? # The key necessary for using the RSA encryption scheme can be generated now. # You will be prompted for a passphrase. # d-i uswsusp/create_RSA_key boolean false ### Description: RSA key size: # Please specify the size of the RSA key (number of bits between 1024 # and 4096). A bigger key increases the encryption strength but slows # down the encryption process. # d-i uswsusp/RSA_key_bits string 1024 ### Description: RSA passphrase: # Please choose the passphrase to use on every resume to decrypt the # image. # d-i uswsusp/RSA_passphrase password ### Description: RSA passphrase confirmation: # d-i uswsusp/RSA_passphrase_v password ### Description: Shutdown method: # If this parameter is set to 'reboot', the s2disk utility will # reboot the machine rather than powering down. This can be useful # for testing purposes. # . # If it is set to 'platform', hardware-specific optimization is used # if available. # d-i uswsusp/shutdown_method select platform # Possible choices: reboot, platform, shutdown ############################ #### util-vserver_0.30.216-pre3054-1+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Remove local Linux-Vserver guest configurations? # Choose this option if you want the /etc/vservers directory, containing # your local Linux-Vserver guest configurations, to be removed. If you wish to keep # these configurations, do not choose this option. # d-i util-vserver/postrm_remove_vserver_configs boolean false ### Description: Stop running Linux-Vserver guests? # Running Vserver guests were detected! If you remove util-vserver without # stopping these vservers they will continue to run and you will not be able # to manage them from the host, unless you reinstall util-vserver. Choose # this option to stop any running Vserver guests now, otherwise they will # continue to run. # d-i util-vserver/prerm_stop_running_vservers boolean true ############################ #### vdr_2.0.3-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: DVB card type: # VDR needs to know your DVB card type to work correctly. # Using your selection, a channels.conf file will be installed to /var/lib/vdr. # You may have to change this file depending on your setup. # d-i vdr/select_dvb_card select Satellite # Possible choices: Satellite, Terrestrial, Cable ### Description: Create /var/lib/video.00? # By default VDR is configured to use /var/lib/video.00 to store recordings. # You can either create this directory now, or change this behavior later # by modifying the VIDEO_DIR variable in /etc/default/vdr. # d-i vdr/create_video_dir boolean false ############################ #### vdr-plugin-remote_0.5.0-5_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Try to automatically load the evdev module? # Enable this, if you want a setup which automatically loads the evdev module, # needed by the remote-plugin. # . # This script will try to load the module evdev and, if this is successful, # it will add a new entry for evdev to your /etc/modules. # . # If this fails, your kernel maybe does not have evdev support, and you will # need to rebuild your kernel with the CONFIG_INPUT_EVDEV option enabled. # d-i vdr-plugin-remote/install_evdev boolean false ############################ #### libvirtodbc0_6.1.6+dfsg2-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Register the Virtuoso ODBC driver? # An ODBC manager (unixodbc or iODBC) is already installed on this system. # . # The Virtuoso ODBC driver can be automatically added to the list of # available ODBC drivers (and automatically deleted from the list # when this package is removed). # d-i libvirtodbc0/register-odbc-driver boolean false ############################ #### virtuoso-opensource-6.1_6.1.6+dfsg2-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Password for DBA and DAV users: # Following installation, users and passwords in Virtuoso can be managed # using the command line tools (see the full documentation) or via # the Conductor web application which is installed by default at # http://localhost:8890/conductor. # . # Two users ("dba" and "dav") are created by default, with administrative # access to Virtuoso. Secure passwords must be chosen for these users # in order to complete the installation. # . # If you leave this blank, the daemon will be disabled # unless a non-default password already exists. # d-i virtuoso-opensource-6.1/dba-password password ### Description: Administrative users password confirmation: # d-i virtuoso-opensource-6.1/dba-password-again password ### Description: Remove all Virtuoso databases? # The /var/lib/virtuoso-opensource-6.1 directory which contains the Virtuoso # databases is about to be removed. # . # If you're removing the Virtuoso package in order to later install a more # recent version, or if a different Virtuoso package is already using it, # you can choose to keep databases. # d-i virtuoso-opensource-6.1/check-remove-databases boolean false ### Description: HTTP server port: # Virtuoso provides a web server capable of hosting HTML and VSP pages # (with optional support for other languages). If you are installing this # instance as a public web server directly on the Internet, you probably want # to choose 80 as web server port. # . # Please note that the default web server root directory is # /var/lib/virtuoso-opensource-6.1/vsp and will be empty unless you also # install the package containing the standard Virtuoso start page. # d-i virtuoso-opensource-6.1/http-server-port string 8890 ### Description: Database server port: # You may change here the port on which the Virtuoso database server will # listen for connections. # . # Modifying this default value can improve security on servers that # might be targets for unauthorized intrusion. # d-i virtuoso-opensource-6.1/db-server-port string 1111 ### Description: Register an ODBC system DSN for Virtuoso? # An ODBC manager (unixodbc or iODBC) is already installed on this system, # and the Virtuoso ODBC driver is installed. # . # The default Virtuoso instance can be automatically added to the list of # available System Data Sources (and automatically deleted from the list # when this package is removed). # . # If you choose this option, the DSN will be named "VOS". User and # password details are omitted from the DSN for security reasons. # d-i virtuoso-opensource-6.1/register-odbc-dsn boolean false ### Description: Default Virtuoso server package: # Please choose the version of virtuoso-server that will be linked to by the # default (unversioned) names, for init scripts and client tools. # d-i virtuoso-opensource/primary-server select # Possible choices: ${choices} ############################ #### libvpb0_4.2.58-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: ITU-T telephone code: # This is the numeric code for the region your phone system will be operating in # (eg. 61 for Australia or 33 for France). It is used to configure the default # regional standards that Voicetronix telephony hardware should comply with. # d-i libvpb0/countrycode string 61 ############################ #### vsftpd_3.0.2-17+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Dedicated system account for the vsftpd FTP daemon: # The FTP server must use a dedicated account for its operation so that # the system's security is not compromised by running it with superuser # privileges. # . # Please choose that account's username. # d-i vsftpd/username string ftp ### Description: FTP root directory: # Please specify the directory that will be used as root for the # FTP server. # d-i vsftpd/directory string /srv/ftp ############################ #### w3c-linkchecker_4.81-8_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Host name for W3C LinkChecker service: # Please specify the fully qualified domain name that the w3c-linkchecker # service should be remotely accessible on, if any. By default it will only be # available on localhost. # d-i w3c-linkchecker/hostname string localhost ### Description: Allow private IP addresses? # Please specify whether w3c-linkchecker should permit validation of websites # on private networks. By default it will only permit public IP addresses. # d-i w3c-linkchecker/private_ips boolean false ############################ #### watchdog_5.14-3_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Start watchdog at boot time? # Please specify whether watchdog should be started as part of the boot # process. This can be changed later by editing /etc/default/watchdog. # d-i watchdog/run boolean true ### Description: Start wd_keepalive after stopping watchdog? # Please specify whether stopping watchdog should start wd_keepalive to keep on # triggering the watchdog device. This can be changed later by editing # /etc/default/watchdog. # d-i watchdog/run_keepalive boolean true ### Description: Restart watchdog on upgrades? # If the kernel is configured with the CONFIG_WATCHDOG_NOWAYOUT option # (which is not the default setting), restarting watchdog will cause a # spurious reboot (the kernel will assume that the watchdog daemon # crashed). # d-i watchdog/restart boolean false ### Description: Watchdog module to preload: # Please choose which watchdog module should be preloaded before # starting watchdog. The 'softdog' module should be suited for all # installations. Enter 'none' if you don't want the script to load # a module. # d-i watchdog/module string none ############################ #### wdm_1.28-17_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Select the desired default display manager. # A display manager is a program that provides graphical login capabilities # for the X Window System. # . # Only one display manager can manage a given X server, but multiple display # manager packages are installed. Please select which display manager # should run by default. # . # (Multiple display managers can run simultaneously if they are configured # to manage different servers; to achieve this, configure the display # managers accordingly, edit each of their init scripts in /etc/init.d, and # disable the check for a default display manager.) # d-i shared/default-x-display-manager select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require translation. # d-i wdm/daemon_name string /usr/bin/wdm ############################ #### webalizer_2.23.08-1+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Directory to put the output in: # d-i webalizer/directory string /var/www/webalizer ### Description: Title of the reports webalizer will generate: # (your system's hostname will be appended to it) # d-i webalizer/doc_title string Usage Statistics for ### Description: Webserver's rotated log filename: # d-i webalizer/logfile string /var/log/apache/access.log.1 ### Description: Enable DNSCache Option? # Speed up name resolving with the DNSCache option enabled. See # /usr/share/doc/webalizer/DNS.README.gz for more information. # d-i webalizer/dnscache boolean false ############################ #### citadel-webcit_8.24-dfsg-1+b2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Integration with Apache webservers: # If you want Webcit to run alongside with one of your other installed # Apache webservers, select it from the list, else use Internal to make # Webcit use its own HTTP server facilities. # d-i citadel/WebcitApacheIntegration select Internal # Possible choices: Apache2, Internal ### Description: Webcit HTTP port: # Select the port which the plain HTTP Webcit server should listen on. # Use port 80 if you don't have another webserver running or enter -1 to disable # it. # d-i citadel/WebcitHttpPort string 8504 ### Description: Webcit HTTPS port: # Select the port which the SSL HTTP Webcit server should listen on or enter -1 # to disable it. # d-i citadel/WebcitHttpsPort string 443 ### Description: Limit Webcit's login language selection # Select language the Webcit server should run in. User-defined leaves this choice # to the user at the login prompt. # d-i citadel/WebcitOfferLang select UNLIMITED # Possible choices: User-defined, Danish, German, English, Spanish, French, Italian, Dutch, Brazilian Portuguese ############################ #### webfs_1.21+ds1-10_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: IP address webfsd should listen to: # On a system with multiple IP addresses, webfsd can be configured to # listen to only one of them. # . # If you leave this empty, webfsd will listen to all IP addresses. # d-i webfsd/web_ip string ### Description: Timeout for network connections: # d-i webfsd/web_timeout string ### Description: for internal use only # d-i webfsd/pending string no ### Description: Number of parallel network connections: # For small private networks, the default number of parallel network # connections should be fine. This can be increased for larger networks. # d-i webfsd/web_conn string ### Description: Directory cache size: # Directory listings can be cached by webfsd. By default, the size of # the cache is limited to 128 entries. If the web server has # very big directory trees, you might want to raise this value. # d-i webfsd/web_dircache string ### Description: Incoming port number for webfsd: # Please enter the port number for webfsd to listen to. If you leave # this blank, the default port (8000) will be used. # d-i webfsd/web_port string ### Description: Enable virtual hosts? # This option allows webfsd to support name-based virtual hosts, taking # the directories immediately below the document root as host names. # d-i webfsd/web_virtual boolean false ### Description: Document root for webfsd: # Webfsd is a lightweight HTTP server for mostly static content. Its # most obvious use is to provide HTTP access to an anonymous FTP server. # . # Please specify the document root for the webfs daemon. # . # If you leave this field blank, webfsd will not be started at boot time. # d-i webfsd/web_root string /var/www/html ### Description: Host name for webfsd: # By default, webfsd uses the machine name as host name. # . # You can specify an alternate host name to be used as an external # alias name (for instance "ftp.example.org") instead of the machine's # fully qualified domain name. # d-i webfsd/web_host string ### Description: User running the webfsd daemon: # d-i webfsd/web_user string www-data ### Description: Log webfsd events (start, stop, etc.) to syslog? # d-i webfsd/web_syslog boolean false ### Description: Access log file: # Access to webfsd is logged in common log format. # . # If this field is left empty, no logging of incoming connections will # be done. # d-i webfsd/web_accesslog string ### Description: Should logging be buffered? # With buffered logging, entries will be written in chunks, not as soon # as they are accepted as client calls. # d-i webfsd/web_logbuffering boolean true ### Description: Group running the webfsd daemon: # d-i webfsd/web_group string www-data ### Description: Directory index filename: # If webfsd receives a request for a directory, it can optionally look for an # index file to be sent to the client. Common names are "index.html" and # "default.html". # . # If you leave this field empty, webfsd will send a directory listing to the # client. # d-i webfsd/web_index string ### Description: CGI script catalog: # Please specify the location for CGI scripts to be served by webfsd. This # path should be located immediately below the document root. # . # Please specify the full path name, not a relative path. If this # field is left empty, CGI scripts will be disabled. # d-i webfsd/web_cgipath string ### Description: Extra options to include: # Please specify any webfsd options you want to use with the main # daemon. # . # For instance, webfsd can run chrooted, provide timed expiration of # files, and bind either IPv4 or IPv6 addresses. # . # See webfsd's manual page for further options and details. # d-i webfsd/web_extras string ############################ #### websvn_2.3.3-1.2+deb8u2_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want to configure WebSVN now? # WebSVN needs to be configured before its use, ie you must set the # locations of the repositories. # . # If you want to configure it later, you should run 'dpkg-reconfigure # websvn'. # d-i websvn/configuration boolean false ### Description: svn parent repositories: # If you have directories containing svn repositories, enter the location # of each parent directory you want to appear on websvn page. # . # You must specify at least one existing subversion repository or WebSVN # will not work. You can specify single repositories on the next step of # the config. # . # Separate each entry with a comma (,) but NO SPACE or leave empty. # d-i websvn/parentpath string /var/lib/svn ### Description: svn repositories: # Enter the location of each svn repository you want to appear on websvn # page. # . # You must specify at least one existing subversion repository or WebSVN # will not work, except if you have given a parent path previously. # . # Separate each entry with a comma (,) but NO SPACE or leave empty. # d-i websvn/repositories string /var/lib/svn ### Description: Apache configuration: # WebSVN supports any web server that php4 does, but this automatic # configuration process only supports Apache. # d-i websvn/webservers multiselect apache, apache-ssl, apache-perl, apache2 # Possible choices: apache, apache-ssl, apache-perl, apache2 ############################ #### wfrench_1.2.3-10_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### whatmaps_0.0.9-1+deb8u1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically restart services after library security updates? # Services need to be restarted to benefit from updates of shared libraries they # depend on. Otherwise they remain vulnerable to security bugs fixed in these # updates. # . # Automatic service restarts are only done if APT fetched the library from a # source providing security updates. This also affects packages installed # via "unattended-upgrades". # d-i whatmaps/enable_service_restarts boolean false ############################ #### wicd-daemon_1.7.2.4-4.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Users to add to the netdev group: # Users who should be able to run wicd clients need to be added to the # group "netdev". # d-i wicd/users multiselect # Possible choices: ${users} ############################ #### wide-dhcpv6-client_20080615-12_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Interfaces on which the DHCPv6 client sends requests: # Network interfaces on which the DHCPv6 client sends requests should be # specified here. Multiple interfaces are separated with spaces. An empty # line temporarily disables dhcp6c. # d-i wide-dhcpv6-client/interfaces string eth0 ############################ #### wide-dhcpv6-relay_20080615-12_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Interfaces on which the DHCPv6 relay operates: # Network interfaces on which the DHCPv6 relay handles requests should be # specified here. Multiple interfaces are separated with spaces. An empty # line temporarily disables dhcp6relay. # d-i wide-dhcpv6-relay/interfaces string eth0 ############################ #### wide-dhcpv6-server_20080615-12_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Interfaces on which the DHCPv6 server listens to requests: # Network interfaces on which the DHCPv6 server listens to requests should be # specified here. Multiple interfaces are separated with spaces. An empty # line temporarily disables dhcp6s. # d-i wide-dhcpv6-server/interfaces string eth0 ############################ #### wifi-radar_2.0.s08+dfsg-1.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Wi-Fi interface name: # Enter the name of the Wi-Fi interface that is to be managed by WiFi # Radar. Note that WiFi Radar does not support multiple Wi-Fi interfaces. # d-i wifi-radar/wifi_interface string ############################ #### wims_4.08~dfsg1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: List of web servers to reconfigure automatically: # Wims supports Apache, Apache2, Apache-SSL and Apache-Perl. # d-i wims/reconfigure-webserver multiselect apache2 # Possible choices: apache, apache2, apache-ssl, apache-perl ### Description: Do you want ${webserver} to be restarted now? # Remember that in order to activate the new configuration # ${webserver} has to be restarted. You can also restart ${webserver} # manually executing /etc/init.d/${webserver} restart # d-i wims/restart-webserver boolean false ############################ #### wims-moodle_4.0-17_all.deb ############################ ### Description: URL to access Wims from remote machines: # Please specify the URL that will allow users to access Wims assignments # from Moodle. # . # It should include the server hostname, but not the path, and must use the # HTTPS protocol (with the web server configured to answer HTTPS requests). # For instance, if Wims is accessed from https://wims.example.org/wims/ # then you should enter https://wims.example.org here. # d-i wims-moodle/remoteurl string https://wims.domain ############################ #### wireshark-common_1.12.1+g01b65bf-4+deb8u14_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Should non-superusers be able to capture packets? # Dumpcap can be installed in a way that allows members of the "wireshark" # system group to capture packets. This is recommended over the # alternative of running Wireshark/Tshark directly as root, because # less of the code will run with elevated privileges. # . # For more detailed information please see # /usr/share/doc/wireshark-common/README.Debian. # . # Enabling this feature may be a security risk, so it is disabled by # default. If in doubt, it is suggested to leave it disabled. # d-i wireshark-common/install-setuid boolean false ############################ #### witalian_1.7.5+nmu1_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wspanish_1.0.27_all.deb ############################ ############################ #### wvdial_1.61-4.1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically detect and configure the modem? # WvDial can automatically detect the modem and create its configuration # file. This detection may cause problems with some computers. # . # You may reconfigure WvDial by running a program called wvdialconf which # will write these settings into the /etc/wvdial.conf file. # d-i wvdial/wvdialconf boolean true ### Description: ISP's telephone number: # Please enter the telephone number that should be used to connect to the # Internet Service Provider (ISP). # d-i wvdial/phone string ### Description: Account username: # Please enter the username or login for an account issued by the ISP. # d-i wvdial/login string ### Description: Account passphrase: # Please enter the password or passphrase that corresponds with the account # username. # d-i wvdial/passphrase password ### Description: Confirm passphrase: # Please enter the password or passphrase again for verification. # d-i wvdial/passphrase2 password ############################ #### xawtv_3.103-3+b1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Create video4linux (/dev/video*) special files? # d-i xawtv/makedev boolean true ### Description: Scan for TV stations? # A list of TV stations found by scanning can be included in the # configuration file. # . # This requires a working bttv driver. If bttv isn't configured correctly, TV # stations will not be found. # . # Channel names will be retrieved from teletext information, which # will only work for PAL channels. # d-i xawtv/channel-scan boolean false ### Description: TV standard: # d-i xawtv/tvnorm select # Possible choices: PAL, SECAM, NTSC ### Description: Create a default configuration for xawtv? # A system-wide configuration file for xawtv can be created with reasonable # default values for the local country. # . # That file is not required but will simplify software configuration # for users. # d-i xawtv/build-config boolean false ### Description: Frequency table to use: # A frequency table is a list of TV channel names and numbers with # their broadcast frequencies. # d-i xawtv/freqtab select # Possible choices: us-bcast, us-cable, us-cable-hrc, japan-bcast, japan-cable, europe-west, europe-east, italy, newzealand, australia, ireland, france, china-bcast ############################ #### xdm_1.1.11-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Default display manager: # A display manager is a program that provides graphical login capabilities for # the X Window System. # . # Only one display manager can manage a given X server, but multiple display # manager packages are installed. Please select which display manager should # run by default. # . # Multiple display managers can run simultaneously if they are configured to # manage different servers; to achieve this, configure the display managers # accordingly, edit each of their init scripts in /etc/init.d, and disable the # check for a default display manager. # d-i shared/default-x-display-manager select # Possible choices: ${choices} ### Description: internal use only # This template is never shown to the user and does not require translation. # d-i xdm/daemon_name string /usr/bin/xdm ### Description: Stop the xdm daemon? # The X display manager (xdm) daemon is typically stopped on package upgrade # and removal, but it appears to be managing at least one running X session. # . # If xdm is stopped now, any X sessions it manages will be terminated. # Otherwise, the new version will take effect the next time the daemon # is restarted. # d-i xdm/stop_running_server_with_children boolean false ############################ #### xfonts-traditional_1.7.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Generate traditional versions of fonts? # xfonts-traditional can automatically generate traditional versions # (with foundry "Trad" instead of "Misc") of all fonts for which it has # an idea about the glyphs. (Currently this is versions of 6x13, aka # "fixed".) # . # But you may prefer not to do this automatically, and would rather # just have the tool installed. # d-i xfonts-traditional/generate boolean true ### Description: Configure xterm to use traditional fonts? # You can have the xterm default UTF-8 font changed to the traditional # version. # . # If you approve, I will edit /etc/X11/app-default/XTerm for you, and # save your old file as XTerm.backup.not-trad. (Note that this is a # conffile so you may get prompts from dpkg about it in the future.) # . # Alternatively, if you do not want me to change the default, I will # generate the file XTerm.trad, but it will not be used. # . # To revert the change, simply change the key "*VT100.utf8Fonts.font" # back from "-trad-..." to "-misc-...", or rename the old file back # into place. # d-i xfonts-traditional/reconfigure-xterm boolean false ### Description: Configure system to use traditional "fixed"? # I can remap the font alias "fixed" to the traditional version. # . # If you approve, I will edit /etc/X11/fonts/misc/xfonts-base.alias for # you, and save your old file as xfonts-base.alias.backup.not-trad. # (Note that this is a conffile, so you may get prompts from dpkg about # it in the future.) # . # Alternatively, if you do not want me to change the default, I will # generate xfonts-base-alias.trad for you to do what you like with. # . # To revert this change, simply change the alias "fixed" back from # "-trad-..." to "-misc-...", or rename the old file back into place. # d-i xfonts-traditional/remap-fixed boolean false ### Description: Remove xfonts-traditional, breaking "fixed" and your X server? # Removing xfonts-traditional would break your X server by removing "fixed". # . # You should not remove xfonts-traditional while "fixed" refers to one # of its fonts. You probably want to check the differences between the # various /etc/X11/fonts/misc/xfonts-base.alias*, reconcile any changes, # and then run "update-fonts-alias misc". After that you can retry the # removal. # d-i xfonts-traditional/confirm-break-remove boolean false ############################ #### xfonts-wqy_0.9.9-7_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Enable WenQuanYi font in fontconfig? # By default, bitmapped fonts are disabled in fontconfig setting because # they are often lower quality. Enabling this option will bypass the # system wide fontconfig setting and allow applications to use WenQuanYi # font without affecting other bitmapped fonts. # d-i xfonts-wqy/enable_wqy boolean true ############################ #### xfstt_1.9.1-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want xfstt to listen on a TCP port? # Xfstt runs as superuser, but only before a connection is established with # the client, then it drops superuser privileges and is run as user nobody. # . # This approach is fairly secure, but if you are not going to provide fonts # to remote hosts, it is recommended to not listen to network connections. # d-i xfstt/listen_tcp boolean false ############################ #### x11-common_7.7+7_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Users allowed to start the X server: # Because the X server runs with superuser privileges, it may be unwise to # permit any user to start it, for security reasons. On the other hand, it is # even more unwise to run general-purpose X client programs as root, which is # what may happen if only root is permitted to start the X server. A good # compromise is to permit the X server to be started only by users logged in to # one of the virtual consoles. # d-i x11-common/xwrapper/allowed_users select Console Users Only # Possible choices: Root Only, Console Users Only, Anybody ### Description: for internal use # This template is never shown to the user and does not require translation. # d-i x11-common/xwrapper/actual_allowed_users string ############################ #### xringd_1.20-25.2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Which device is your modem connected to? # Xringd needs to poll a modem, which connects to your machine via a serial # port. Please enter which serial port (usually /dev/ttyS[0-4]) your modem # is connected to. # d-i xringd/modem-device string /dev/ttyS0 ############################ #### mono-apache-server2_3.8-2.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Let mono-apache-server2 restart Apache? # The Debian version of mono-apache-server2 includes a # mono-server2-update script that creates a configuration file for # Apache to start the ASP.NET applications, and mono-server2-update can # restart Apache if there's a new configuration file # (/etc/mono-server2/mono-server2-hosts.conf). If this is true, then # Apache will be restarted when there is a new mono-server2-hosts.conf file. # d-i monoserver2/monoserver2_restartapache boolean true ############################ #### mono-apache-server4_3.8-2.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Let mono-apache-server4 restart Apache? # The Debian version of mono-apache-server4 includes a # mono-server4-update script that creates a configuration file for # Apache to start the ASP.NET applications, and mono-server4-update can # restart Apache if there's a new configuration file # (/etc/mono-server4/mono-server-hosts.conf). If this is true, then # Apache will be restarted when there is a new mono-server4-hosts.conf file. # d-i monoserver4/monoserver4_restartapache boolean true ############################ #### mono-xsp2_3.8-2.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Start on boot? # If this is true, then XSP2 will automatically start when the computer # is turned on. # d-i xsp2/xsp2_autostart boolean true ### Description: Bind to address: # To function properly, XSP2 needs to be bound to an IP address. The # default ("0.0.0.0") binds to all addresses of the server, but a # specific port can be selected. To use XSP2 only locally, use # "127.0.0.1" for the address. # d-i xsp2/xsp2_bind string 0.0.0.0 ### Description: Bind to port: # XSP is bound to a specific port on the server. Common values are 80, # 8080, or 8081. # d-i xsp2/xsp2_port string 8082 ############################ #### mono-xsp4_3.8-2.1_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Start on boot? # If this is true, then XSP4 will automatically start when the computer # is turned on. # d-i xsp4/xsp4_autostart boolean true ### Description: Bind to address: # To function properly, XSP4 needs to be bound to an IP address. The # default ("0.0.0.0") binds to all addresses of the server, but a # specific port can be selected. To use XSP4 only locally, use # "127.0.0.1" for the address. # d-i xsp4/xsp4_bind string 0.0.0.0 ### Description: Bind to port: # XSP is bound to a specific port on the server. Common values are 80, # 8080, or 8081. # d-i xsp4/xsp4_port string 8084 ############################ #### xtell_2.10.7_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Do you want xtell daemon to run from inetd? # By default, xtelld runs from inetd. # . # However, you can run it as standalone daemon. If you select No, xtell # daemon will be started automatically at boot time. # . # If unsure, select Yes # d-i xtelld/from_inetd boolean true ############################ #### xymon_4.3.17-6+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatically migrate old hobbit files to xymon? # The operating system user was renamed from "hobbit" to "xymon", and all # configuration, state, log directories and files have been renamed as well. # The package postinst scripts can do the migration automatically. This is # usually a good idea, but might not work so well if your config differs # substantially from the default. # d-i hobbit-client/automatic-xymon-migration boolean true ############################ #### xymon-client_4.3.17-6+deb8u1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Xymon server: # Please enter the network address used to access the Xymon # server(s). If you use multiple servers, use a space-separated list of # addresses. # . # Using host names instead of IP addresses is discouraged in case the # network experiences DNS failures. # d-i hobbit-client/HOBBITSERVERS string 127.0.0.1 ### Description: Client hostname: # Please enter the host name used by the Xymon client when sending # reports to the Xymon server. This name must match # the name used in the hosts.cfg file on the Xymon # server. # d-i hobbit-client/CLIENTHOSTNAME string ### Description: Automatically migrate old hobbit files to xymon? # The operating system user was renamed from "hobbit" to "xymon", and all # configuration, state, log directories and files have been renamed as well. # The package postinst scripts can do the migration automatically. This is # usually a good idea, but might not work so well if your config differs # substantially from the default. # d-i hobbit-client/automatic-xymon-migration boolean true ############################ #### libpam-yubico_2.17-2_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Parameters for Yubico PAM: # The Yubico PAM module supports two modes of operation: online # validation of YubiKey OTPs or offline validation of YubiKey HMAC-SHA-1 # responses to challenges. # . # The default is online validation, and for that to work you need to get # a free API key at https://upgrade.yubico.com/getapikey/ and # enter the key id as "id=NNNN" and the base64 secret as "key=...". # . # All the available parameters for the Yubico PAM module are described # in /usr/share/doc/libpam-yubico/README.gz. To avoid accidental # lock-outs the module will not be active until it is enabled with the # "pam-auth-update" command. # d-i libpam-yubico/module_args string mode=client try_first_pass id=N key=K ############################ #### zephyr-clients_3.1.2-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Zephyr servers: # Please specify the full names of the Zephyr servers, as a # space-separated list. # . # The list configured on clients can be a subset of the list configured # on servers. # . # This can be left empty if Hesiod is used to advertise Zephyr servers. # d-i zephyr-clients/servers string ### Description: for internal use # We want to try and capture user changes when they edit a config file # manually. To do this we look at the file in the config script. However, # in the case of preconfigure, the config script is run twice before the # postinst is run. Thus we may read the wrong value before the edited value # is written out in postinst. If this is false we skip reading config files # until postinst runs. # d-i zephyr-clients/read_conf boolean true ############################ #### zephyr-server_3.1.2-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Zephyr servers: # Please specify the full names of the Zephyr servers, as a # space-separated list. # . # The list configured on clients can be a subset of the list configured # on servers. # d-i zephyr-server/servers string ### Description: for internal use # We want to try and capture user changes when they edit a config file # manually. To do this we look at the file in the config script. However, # in the case of preconfigure, the config script is run twice before the # postinst is run. Thus we may read the wrong value before the edited value # is written out in postinst. If this is false we skip reading config files # until postinst runs. # d-i zephyr-server/read_conf boolean true ############################ #### zephyr-server-krb5_3.1.2-1_amd64.deb ############################ ### Description: Zephyr servers: # Please specify the full names of the Zephyr servers, as a # space-separated list. # . # The list configured on clients can be a subset of the list configured # on servers. # d-i zephyr-server/servers string ### Description: for internal use # We want to try and capture user changes when they edit a config file # manually. To do this we look at the file in the config script. However, # in the case of preconfigure, the config script is run twice before the # postinst is run. Thus we may read the wrong value before the edited value # is written out in postinst. If this is false we skip reading config files # until postinst runs. # d-i zephyr-server/read_conf boolean true ############################ #### zope-common_0.5.54_all.deb ############################ ### Description: Automatic restart of Zope instances: # Zope offers an extensible, modular structure that allows for the easy # addition of extra components (products) or features. These are # provided as packages with names that start with a 'zope-' prefix. # Each Zope instance needs to be restarted to use any new add-on. # . # Please choose the default behavior of Zope instances when Zope needs # to be restarted: # . # - configuring: restart instances after each product configuration; # - end: restart instances only once at the end of the whole # installation/upgrading process; # - manually: no automated restart. # d-i shared/zope/restart select end # Possible choices: configuring, end, manually ### Description: Action on old/incomplete zope instance '${instance}': # An old/incomplete ${instance} instance was found in # /var/lib/zope${zver}/instance/${instance}, with no Data.fs file. # This installation is either incomplete or incompletely removed. # . # Choosing 'abort' will allow you to inspect the state of the # instance. # . # Choosing 'remove and continue' will remove /var/lib/zope${zver}/instance/${instance} # and reinstall ${instance}. Existing log files in # /var/log/zope${zver}/${instance} and configuration files in # /etc/zope${zver}/${instance} will be preserved. # d-i zope-common/remove-instance-without-data select remove and continue # Possible choices: abort, remove and continue ### Description: Keep data for ${instance} on package purge? # Purging the data files of a Zope instance on package purge will # result in the loss of all data for that instance. These data files # are stored in /var/lib/zope${zver}/instance/${instance}. # d-i zope-common/keep-data-on-purge boolean true ### Description: Administrative user for '${instance}' Zope instance: # Please enter the login name of the administrative user for the # '${instance}' Zope instance. Valid names must start with a letter and # only include letters and digits. # . # This will only be used for instance creation. Please use the # following command to change the administrative user login name and # password at a later time: # . # /var/lib/zope${zver}/instance/${instance}/bin/zopectl adduser # d-i zope-common/admin-user string admin ### Description: Password for the administrative user: # Please enter a password for the administrative user. The password # must not be empty. The password is deleted from the configuration # database once the instance is successfully created and cannot be # recovered. # . # This will only be used for instance creation. Please use the # following command to change the administrative user login name and # password at a later time: # . # /var/lib/zope${zver}/instance/${instance}/bin/zopectl adduser # d-i zope-common/admin-password password ### Description: Password confirmation: # Please confirm the administrative user's password. # d-i zope-common/admin-password-confirmation password ### Description: HTTP port for this instance: # Please enter the HTTP port number for the ${instance} instance. # . # Other services (e.g. FTP, WebDAV, debug) will be disabled by default. # They can be enabled by editing /etc/zope${zver}/${instance}/zope.conf. # d-i zope-common/instance-http-port string ### Description: TCP port for the ZEO instance: # Please enter the TCP port number for the ${instance} ZEO instance. # d-i zope-common/instance-zeo-port string ############################ #### zope2.13-sandbox_2.13.22-1_all.deb ############################